4bca933195c908300bc75bad8f2ff8479f2d3365
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1274 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1275 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1276 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
3877 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
3878 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
3879 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
3880 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
3881 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
3882
3883 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3884 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3885 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3886 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3887 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3888 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3889
3890 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3891 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3892 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3893 classes.
3894
3895 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3896 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3897 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3901 @end smallexample
3902
3903 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3904 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3905 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3906 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3907 every function in a given file:
3908
3909 @smallexample
3910 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3911 @end smallexample
3912
3913 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3914 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3915
3916 @kindex info breakpoints
3917 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3918 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3919 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3920 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3921 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3922 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3923 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3924
3925 @table @emph
3926 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3927 @item Type
3928 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3929 @item Disposition
3930 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3931 @item Enabled or Disabled
3932 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3933 that are not enabled.
3934 @item Address
3935 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3936 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3937 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3938 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3939 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3940 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3941 @item What
3942 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3943 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3944 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3945 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3946 @end table
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3950 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3951 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3952 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3953 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3954 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3955
3956 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3957 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3958 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3959 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3963 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3964 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3965 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3966 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3967
3968 @noindent
3969 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3970 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3971 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3972 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3973 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3974 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3975
3976 @noindent
3977 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3978 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3979
3980 @end table
3981
3982 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3983 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3984 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3985 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3986
3987 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3988 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3989 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3990 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3991
3992 @itemize @bullet
3993 @item
3994 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3995
3996 @item
3997 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3998 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3999
4000 @item
4001 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4002 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4003
4004 @item
4005 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4006 several places where that function is inlined.
4007 @end itemize
4008
4009 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4010 the relevant locations.
4011
4012 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4013 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4014 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4015 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4016 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4017 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4018 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4019
4020 For example:
4021
4022 @smallexample
4023 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4024 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4025 stop only if i==1
4026 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4027 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4028 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4029 @end smallexample
4030
4031 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4032 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4033 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4034 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4035 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4036 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4037 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4038 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4039 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4040 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4041 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4042
4043 @cindex pending breakpoints
4044 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4045 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4046 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4047 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4048 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4049 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4050 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4051 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4052 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4053 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4054 is not yet resolved.
4055
4056 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4057 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4058 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4059 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4060 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4061 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4062
4063 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4064 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4065 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4066 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4067
4068 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4069 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4070 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4071
4072 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4073 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4074 address specification to an address:
4075
4076 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4077 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4078 @table @code
4079 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4080 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4081 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4082
4083 @item set breakpoint pending on
4084 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4085 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4086
4087 @item set breakpoint pending off
4088 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4089 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4090 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4091
4092 @item show breakpoint pending
4093 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4094 @end table
4095
4096 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4097 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4098 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4099
4100 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4101 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4102 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4103 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4104 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4105 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4106 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4107 breakpoints.
4108
4109 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4110
4111 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4112 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4113 @table @code
4114 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4115 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4116 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4117 breakpoint must be used.
4118
4119 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4120 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4121 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4122 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4123 @end table
4124
4125 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4126 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4127 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4128 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4129 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4130 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4131 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4132 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4133 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4134
4135 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4136 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4137 @table @code
4138 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4139 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4140 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4141 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4142
4143 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4144 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4145 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4146 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4147 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4148 @end table
4149
4150 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4151 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4152 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4153
4154 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4155 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4156
4157 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4158
4159 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4160 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4161 @table @code
4162 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4163 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4164 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4165 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4166 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4167
4168 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4169 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4170 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4171 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4172 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4173 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4174 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4175 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4176 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4177 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4178 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4179 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4180 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4181
4182 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4183 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4184 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4185 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4186 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4187 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4188 @end table
4189
4190
4191 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4192 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4193 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4194 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4195 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4196 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4197 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4198 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4199
4200
4201 @node Set Watchpoints
4202 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4203
4204 @cindex setting watchpoints
4205 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4206 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4207 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4208 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4209 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4210
4211 @itemize @bullet
4212 @item
4213 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4214
4215 @item
4216 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4217 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4218 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4219
4220 @item
4221 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4222 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4223 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4224 @end itemize
4225
4226 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4227 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4228 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4229 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4230 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4231 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4232 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4233 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4234 the expression changes.
4235
4236 @cindex software watchpoints
4237 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4238 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4239 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4240 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4241 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4242 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4243 culprit.)
4244
4245 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4246 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4247 slow down the running of your program.
4248
4249 @table @code
4250 @kindex watch
4251 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4252 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4253 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4254 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4255 to watch the value of a single variable:
4256
4257 @smallexample
4258 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4259 @end smallexample
4260
4261 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4262 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4263 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4264 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4265 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4266 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4267
4268 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4269 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4270 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4271 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4272 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4273 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4274 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4275 error.
4276
4277 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4278 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4279 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4280 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4281 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4282 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4283 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4284 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4285 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4286 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4287 Examples:
4288
4289 @smallexample
4290 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4291 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4292 @end smallexample
4293
4294 @kindex rwatch
4295 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4296 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4297 by the program.
4298
4299 @kindex awatch
4300 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4301 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4302 or written into by the program.
4303
4304 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4305 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4306 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4307 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4308 @end table
4309
4310 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4311 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4312 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4313 a never-changing value:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4317 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4318 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4319 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4320 @end smallexample
4321
4322 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4323 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4324 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4325 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4326 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4327 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4328
4329 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4330 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4331 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4332 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4333 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4334 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4335 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4336 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4337
4338 @table @code
4339 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4340 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4341 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4342
4343 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4344 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4345 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4346 @end table
4347
4348 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4349 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4350 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4351
4352 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4353
4354 @smallexample
4355 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4356 @end smallexample
4357
4358 @noindent
4359 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4360
4361 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4362 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4363 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4364 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4365 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4366 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4367 will print a message like this:
4368
4369 @smallexample
4370 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4371 @end smallexample
4372
4373 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4374 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4375 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4376 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4377 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4378 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4379 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4380 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4381
4382 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4383 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4384 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4385 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4386 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4387 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4388
4389 @smallexample
4390 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4391 @end smallexample
4392
4393 @noindent
4394 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4395
4396 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4397 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4398 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4399 expression with separately allocated resources.
4400
4401 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4402 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4403 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4404
4405 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4406 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4407 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4408 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4409 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4410 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4411 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4412 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4413 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4414
4415 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4416 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4417 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4418 watched expression from every thread.
4419
4420 @quotation
4421 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4422 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4423 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4424 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4425 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4426 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4427 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4428 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4429 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4430 @end quotation
4431
4432 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4433
4434 @node Set Catchpoints
4435 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4436 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4437 @cindex exception handlers
4438 @cindex event handling
4439
4440 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4441 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4442 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4443
4444 @table @code
4445 @kindex catch
4446 @item catch @var{event}
4447 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4448
4449 @table @code
4450 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4451 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4452 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4453 @kindex catch throw
4454 @kindex catch rethrow
4455 @kindex catch catch
4456 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4457 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4458
4459 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4460 regular expression will be caught.
4461
4462 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4463 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4464 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4465 exception being thrown.
4466
4467 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4468 @value{GDBN}:
4469
4470 @itemize @bullet
4471 @item
4472 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4473 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4474 supported.
4475
4476 @item
4477 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4478 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4479 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4480 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4481 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4482 built.
4483
4484 @item
4485 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4486 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4487
4488 @item
4489 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4490 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4491 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4492 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4493
4494 @item
4495 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4496 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4497 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4498 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4499 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4500 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4501 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4502 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4503 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4504
4505 @item
4506 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4507
4508 @item
4509 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4510 @end itemize
4511
4512 @item exception
4513 @kindex catch exception
4514 @cindex Ada exception catching
4515 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4516 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4517 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4518 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4519 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4520
4521 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4522 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4523 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4524 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4525 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4526 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4527 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4528 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4529
4530 @item handlers
4531 @kindex catch handlers
4532 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4533 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4534 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4535 specified at the end of the command
4536 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4537 only when this specific exception is handled.
4538 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4539
4540 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4541 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4542 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4543 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4544 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4545 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4546 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4547 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4548 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4549
4550 @item exception unhandled
4551 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4552 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4553
4554 @item assert
4555 @kindex catch assert
4556 A failed Ada assertion.
4557
4558 @item exec
4559 @kindex catch exec
4560 @cindex break on fork/exec
4561 A call to @code{exec}.
4562
4563 @anchor{catch syscall}
4564 @item syscall
4565 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4566 @kindex catch syscall
4567 @cindex break on a system call.
4568 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4569 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4570 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4571 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4572 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4573 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4574 will be caught.
4575
4576 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4577 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4578 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4579 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4580
4581 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4582 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4583 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4584 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4585
4586 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4587 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4588 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4589 available choices.
4590
4591 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4592 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4593 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4594 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4595 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4596 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4597 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4598 behind the OS upgrades).
4599
4600 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4601 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4602 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4603 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4604 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4605 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4606 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4607 syscall groups available on your environment.
4608
4609 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4610 arguments to it:
4611
4612 @smallexample
4613 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4614 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4615 (@value{GDBP}) r
4616 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4617
4618 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4619 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4620 (@value{GDBP}) c
4621 Continuing.
4622
4623 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4624 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4625 (@value{GDBP})
4626 @end smallexample
4627
4628 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4632 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4633 (@value{GDBP}) r
4634 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4635
4636 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4637 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4638 (@value{GDBP}) c
4639 Continuing.
4640
4641 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4642 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4643 (@value{GDBP})
4644 @end smallexample
4645
4646 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4647 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4648 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4652 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4653 (@value{GDBP}) r
4654 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4655
4656 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4657 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4658 (@value{GDBP}) c
4659 Continuing.
4660
4661 Program exited normally.
4662 (@value{GDBP})
4663 @end smallexample
4664
4665 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4666
4667 @smallexample
4668 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4669 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4670 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4671 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4672 (@value{GDBP}) r
4673 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4674
4675 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4676 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4677
4678 (@value{GDBP}) c
4679 Continuing.
4680 @end smallexample
4681
4682 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4683 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4684 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4685 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4689 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4690 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4691 (@value{GDBP})
4692 @end smallexample
4693
4694 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4695 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4696 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4697 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4698 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4699 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4703 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4704 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4705 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4706 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4707 (@value{GDBP})
4708 @end smallexample
4709
4710 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4711
4712 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4713 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4714
4715 @smallexample
4716 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4717 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4718 @end smallexample
4719
4720 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4721
4722 @item fork
4723 @kindex catch fork
4724 A call to @code{fork}.
4725
4726 @item vfork
4727 @kindex catch vfork
4728 A call to @code{vfork}.
4729
4730 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4731 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4732 @kindex catch load
4733 @kindex catch unload
4734 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4735 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4736 matches one of the affected libraries.
4737
4738 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4739 @kindex catch signal
4740 The delivery of a signal.
4741
4742 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4743 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4744 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4745
4746 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4747 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4748 signal names.
4749
4750 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4751 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4752 will be caught.
4753
4754 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4755 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4756 catchpoint.
4757
4758 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4759 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4760 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4761 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4762 commands.
4763
4764 @end table
4765
4766 @item tcatch @var{event}
4767 @kindex tcatch
4768 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4769 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4770
4771 @end table
4772
4773 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4774
4775
4776 @node Delete Breaks
4777 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4778
4779 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4780 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4781 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4782 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4783 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4784 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4785
4786 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4787 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4788 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4789 their breakpoint numbers.
4790
4791 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4792 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4793 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4794
4795 @table @code
4796 @kindex clear
4797 @item clear
4798 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4799 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4800 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4801 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4802
4803 @item clear @var{location}
4804 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4805 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4806 most useful ones are listed below:
4807
4808 @table @code
4809 @item clear @var{function}
4810 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4811 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4812
4813 @item clear @var{linenum}
4814 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4815 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4816 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4817 @end table
4818
4819 @cindex delete breakpoints
4820 @kindex delete
4821 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4822 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4823 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4824 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4825 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4826 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4827 @end table
4828
4829 @node Disabling
4830 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4831
4832 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4833 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4834 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4835 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4836 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4837
4838 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4839 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4840 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4841 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4842 do not know which numbers to use.
4843
4844 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4845 affects all of its locations.
4846
4847 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4848 different states of enablement:
4849
4850 @itemize @bullet
4851 @item
4852 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4853 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4854 @item
4855 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4856 @item
4857 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4858 disabled.
4859 @item
4860 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4861 N times, then becomes disabled.
4862 @item
4863 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4864 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4865 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4866 @end itemize
4867
4868 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4869 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4870
4871 @table @code
4872 @kindex disable
4873 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4874 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4876 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4877 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4878 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4879 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4880
4881 @kindex enable
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4884 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4885
4886 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4887 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4888 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4892 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4893 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4894 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4895 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4896 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4897
4898 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4899 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4900 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4901 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4902 @end table
4903
4904 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4905 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4906 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4907 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4908 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4909 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4910 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4911 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4912 Stepping}.)
4913
4914 @node Conditions
4915 @subsection Break Conditions
4916 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4917 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4918
4919 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4920 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4921 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4922 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4923 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4924 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4925 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4926 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4927
4928 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4929 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4930 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4931 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4932 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4933
4934 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4935 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4936 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4937 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4938 one.
4939
4940 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4941 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4942 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4943 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4944 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4945 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4946 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4947 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4948 conditions for the
4949 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4950 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4951
4952 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4953 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4954 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4955 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4956 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4957 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4958
4959 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4960 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4961 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4962 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4963 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4964
4965 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4966 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4967 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4968 with the @code{condition} command.
4969
4970 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4971 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4972 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4973 catchpoint.
4974
4975 @table @code
4976 @kindex condition
4977 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4978 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4979 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4980 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4981 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4982 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4983 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4984 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4985 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4986 prints an error message:
4987
4988 @smallexample
4989 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4990 @end smallexample
4991
4992 @noindent
4993 @value{GDBN} does
4994 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4995 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4996 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4997
4998 @item condition @var{bnum}
4999 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5000 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5001 @end table
5002
5003 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5004 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5005 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5006 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5007 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5008 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5009 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5010 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5011 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5012 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5013 your program reaches it.
5014
5015 @table @code
5016 @kindex ignore
5017 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5018 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5019 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5020 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5021 takes no action.
5022
5023 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5024 a count of zero.
5025
5026 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5027 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5028 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5029 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5030
5031 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5032 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5033 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5034
5035 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5036 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5037 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5038 Variables}.
5039 @end table
5040
5041 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5042
5043
5044 @node Break Commands
5045 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5046
5047 @cindex breakpoint commands
5048 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5049 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5050 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5051 enable other breakpoints.
5052
5053 @table @code
5054 @kindex commands
5055 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5056 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5057 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5058 @itemx end
5059 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5060 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5061 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5062
5063 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5064 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5065
5066 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5067 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5068 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5069 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5070 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5071 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5072 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5073 Expressions}).
5074 @end table
5075
5076 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5077 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5078
5079 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5080 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5081 that resumes execution.
5082
5083 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5084 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5085 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5086 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5087 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5088
5089 @kindex silent
5090 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5091 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5092 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5093 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5094 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5095 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5096
5097 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5098 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5099 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5100
5101 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5102 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5103
5104 @smallexample
5105 break foo if x>0
5106 commands
5107 silent
5108 printf "x is %d\n",x
5109 cont
5110 end
5111 @end smallexample
5112
5113 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5114 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5115 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5116 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5117 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5118 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5119 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5120
5121 @smallexample
5122 break 403
5123 commands
5124 silent
5125 set x = y + 4
5126 cont
5127 end
5128 @end smallexample
5129
5130 @node Dynamic Printf
5131 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5132
5133 @cindex dynamic printf
5134 @cindex dprintf
5135 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5136 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5137 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5138 having to recompile it.
5139
5140 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5141 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5142 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5143 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5144 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5145 redirects to files and so forth.
5146
5147 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5148 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5149 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5150 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5151 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5152 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5153 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @kindex dprintf
5157 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5158 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5159 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5160 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5161
5162 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5163 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5164 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5165 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5166 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5167 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5168
5169 @table @code
5170 @item gdb
5171 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5172 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5173
5174 @item call
5175 @kindex dprintf-style call
5176 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5177 @code{printf}).
5178
5179 @item agent
5180 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5181 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5182 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5183 support running commands on the target.
5184 @end table
5185
5186 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5187 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5188 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5189 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5190 command.
5191
5192 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5193 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5194 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5195 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5196 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5197 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5198
5199 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5200 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5201 you could do the following:
5202
5203 @example
5204 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5205 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5206 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5207 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5208 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5209 (gdb) info break
5210 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5211 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5212 continue
5213 (gdb)
5214 @end example
5215
5216 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5217 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5218 the variable settings.
5219
5220 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5221 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5222 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5223 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5224 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5225 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5226
5227 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5228 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5229 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5230
5231 @end table
5232
5233 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5234 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5235 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5236 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5237 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5238 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5239
5240 @node Save Breakpoints
5241 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5242
5243 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5244 breakpoints}} command.
5245
5246 @table @code
5247 @kindex save breakpoints
5248 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5249 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5250 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5251 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5252 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5253 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5254 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5255 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5256 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5257 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5258 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5259 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5260 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5261 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5262 that can no longer be recreated.
5263 @end table
5264
5265 @node Static Probe Points
5266 @subsection Static Probe Points
5267
5268 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5269 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5270 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5271 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5272 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5273
5274 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5275 ELF-compatible systems:
5276
5277 @itemize @bullet
5278
5279 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5280 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5281 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5282 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5283 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5284 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5285 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5286 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5287
5288 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5289 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5290 C@t{++} languages.
5291 @end itemize
5292
5293 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5294 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5295 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5296 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5297 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5298 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5299 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5300 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5301 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5302
5303 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5304 probes}, with optional arguments:
5305
5306 @table @code
5307 @kindex info probes
5308 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5309 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5310 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5311 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5312
5313 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5314 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5315 probes from all providers are listed.
5316
5317 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5318 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5319 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5320
5321 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5322 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5323 given, all object files are considered.
5324
5325 @item info probes all
5326 List the available static probes, from all types.
5327 @end table
5328
5329 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5330 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5331 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5332 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5333 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5334
5335 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5336 commands, with optional arguments:
5337
5338 @table @code
5339 @kindex enable probes
5340 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5342 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5343 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5344
5345 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5346 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5347 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5348
5349 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5350 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5351 given, all object files are considered.
5352
5353 @kindex disable probes
5354 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5355 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5356 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5357 @end table
5358
5359 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5360 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5361 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5362 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5363 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5364 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5365 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5366 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5367 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5368 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5369 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5370 at the current probe point.
5371
5372 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5373 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5374 an error message.
5375
5376
5377 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5378 @node Error in Breakpoints
5379 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5380
5381 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5382 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5383
5384 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5385 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5386 @smallexample
5387 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5388 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5389 @end smallexample
5390
5391 @noindent
5392 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5393 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5394 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5395
5396 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5397 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5398
5399 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5400 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5401 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5402
5403 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5404 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5405 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5406 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5407
5408 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5409 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5410 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5411 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5412 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5413 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5414 first in the bundle.
5415
5416 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5417 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5418 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5419 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5420 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5421 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5422 is hit.
5423
5424 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5425 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5426
5427 @smallexample
5428 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5429 @end smallexample
5430
5431 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5432 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5433 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5434 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5435 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5436 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5437 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5438 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5439
5440 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5441 adjusted breakpoints:
5442
5443 @smallexample
5444 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5445 to 0x00010410.
5446 @end smallexample
5447
5448 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5449 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5450 frequently than expected.
5451
5452 @node Continuing and Stepping
5453 @section Continuing and Stepping
5454
5455 @cindex stepping
5456 @cindex continuing
5457 @cindex resuming execution
5458 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5459 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5460 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5461 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5462 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5463 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5464 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5465 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5466 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5467 handlers}).)
5468
5469 @table @code
5470 @kindex continue
5471 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5472 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5473 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5474 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5475 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5476 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5477 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5478 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5479 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5480 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5481
5482 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5483 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5484 @code{continue} is ignored.
5485
5486 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5487 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5488 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5489 @code{continue}.
5490 @end table
5491
5492 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5493 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5494 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5495 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5496
5497 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5498 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5499 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5500 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5501 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5502 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5503
5504 @table @code
5505 @kindex step
5506 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5507 @item step
5508 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5509 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5510 abbreviated @code{s}.
5511
5512 @quotation
5513 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5514 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5515 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5516 @c distinction here.
5517 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5518 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5519 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5520 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5521 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5522 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5523 below.
5524 @end quotation
5525
5526 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5527 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5528 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5529 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5530 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5531 called within the line.
5532
5533 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5534 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5535 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5536 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5537 was any debugging information about the routine.
5538
5539 @item step @var{count}
5540 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5541 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5542 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5543
5544 @kindex next
5545 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5546 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5547 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5548 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5549 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5550 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5551 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5552 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5553
5554 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5555
5556
5557 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5558 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5559 @c
5560 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5561 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5562 @c function are executed without stopping.
5563
5564 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5565 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5566 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5567
5568 @kindex set step-mode
5569 @item set step-mode
5570 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5571 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5572 @itemx set step-mode on
5573 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5574 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5575 information rather than stepping over it.
5576
5577 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5578 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5579 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5580
5581 @item set step-mode off
5582 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5583 debug information. This is the default.
5584
5585 @item show step-mode
5586 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5587 source line debug information.
5588
5589 @kindex finish
5590 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5591 @item finish
5592 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5593 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5594 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5595
5596 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5597 ,Returning from a Function}).
5598
5599 @kindex until
5600 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5601 @cindex run until specified location
5602 @item until
5603 @itemx u
5604 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5605 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5606 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5607 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5608 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5609 than the address of the jump.
5610
5611 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5612 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5613 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5614 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5615 through the next iteration.
5616
5617 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5618 stack frame.
5619
5620 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5621 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5622 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5623 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5624 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5625
5626 @smallexample
5627 (@value{GDBP}) f
5628 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5629 206 expand_input();
5630 (@value{GDBP}) until
5631 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5632 @end smallexample
5633
5634 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5635 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5636 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5637 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5638 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5639 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5640 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5641
5642 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5643 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5644 argument.
5645
5646 @item until @var{location}
5647 @itemx u @var{location}
5648 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5649 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5650 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5651 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5652 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5653 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5654 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5655 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5656 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5657 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5658 invocations have returned.
5659
5660 @smallexample
5661 94 int factorial (int value)
5662 95 @{
5663 96 if (value > 1) @{
5664 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5665 98 @}
5666 99 return (value);
5667 100 @}
5668 @end smallexample
5669
5670
5671 @kindex advance @var{location}
5672 @item advance @var{location}
5673 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5674 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5675 @ref{Specify Location}.
5676 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5677 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5678 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5679 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5680
5681
5682 @kindex stepi
5683 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5684 @item stepi
5685 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5686 @itemx si
5687 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5688
5689 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5690 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5691 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5692 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5693
5694 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5695
5696 @need 750
5697 @kindex nexti
5698 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5699 @item nexti
5700 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5701 @itemx ni
5702 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5703 proceed until the function returns.
5704
5705 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5706
5707 @end table
5708
5709 @anchor{range stepping}
5710 @cindex range stepping
5711 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5712 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5713 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5714 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5715 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5716 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5717 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5718 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5719 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5720 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5721 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5722 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5723 if necessary:
5724
5725 @table @code
5726 @kindex set range-stepping
5727 @kindex show range-stepping
5728 @item set range-stepping
5729 @itemx show range-stepping
5730 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5731
5732 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5733 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5734 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5735 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5736 default is @code{on}.
5737
5738 @end table
5739
5740 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5741 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5742 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5743
5744 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5745 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5746 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5747 a particular file when stepping.
5748
5749 For example, consider the following C function:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 101 int func()
5753 102 @{
5754 103 foo(boring());
5755 104 bar(boring());
5756 105 @}
5757 @end smallexample
5758
5759 @noindent
5760 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5761 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5762 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5763 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5764
5765 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5766 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5767 is called from many places.
5768
5769 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5770 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5771 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5772 @code{foo}.
5773
5774 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5775 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5776 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5777
5778 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5779 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5780 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5781 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5782 the underlying system.
5783 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5784 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5785
5786 @table @code
5787 @kindex skip
5788 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5789 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5790 that specify what to skip.
5791 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5792
5793 @table @code
5794 @item -file @var{file}
5795 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5796 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5797
5798 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5799 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5800 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5801 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5802 over when stepping.
5803
5804 @smallexample
5805 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5806 @end smallexample
5807
5808 @item -function @var{linespec}
5809 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5810 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5811 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5812 @xref{Specify Location}.
5813
5814 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5815 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5816 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5817 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5818
5819 This form is useful for complex function names.
5820 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5821 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5822 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5823 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5824 regular expression makes this easier.
5825
5826 @smallexample
5827 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5831 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5832
5833 @smallexample
5834 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5835 @end smallexample
5836 @end table
5837
5838 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5839 will be skipped.
5840
5841 @kindex skip function
5842 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5843 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5844 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5845 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5846
5847 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5848 will be skipped.
5849
5850 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5851 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5852
5853 @kindex skip file
5854 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5855 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5856 will be skipped over when stepping.
5857
5858 @smallexample
5859 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5860 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5861 @end smallexample
5862
5863 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5864 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5865 @end table
5866
5867 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5868 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5869
5870 @table @code
5871 @kindex info skip
5872 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5873 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5874 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5875 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5876
5877 @table @emph
5878 @item Identifier
5879 A number identifying this skip.
5880 @item Enabled or Disabled
5881 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5882 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5883 @item Glob
5884 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5885 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5886 @item File
5887 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5888 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5889 @item RE
5890 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5891 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5892 @item Function
5893 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5894 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5895 @end table
5896
5897 @kindex skip delete
5898 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5899 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5900 skips.
5901
5902 @kindex skip enable
5903 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5904 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5905 skips.
5906
5907 @kindex skip disable
5908 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5909 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5910 skips.
5911
5912 @kindex set debug skip
5913 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5914 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5915
5916 @kindex show debug skip
5917 @item show debug skip
5918 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5919
5920 @end table
5921
5922 @node Signals
5923 @section Signals
5924 @cindex signals
5925
5926 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5927 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5928 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5929 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5930 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5931 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5932 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5933 requested an alarm).
5934
5935 @cindex fatal signals
5936 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5937 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5938 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5939 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5940 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5941 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5942
5943 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5944 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5945 signal.
5946
5947 @cindex handling signals
5948 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5949 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5950 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5951 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5952 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5953
5954 @table @code
5955 @kindex info signals
5956 @kindex info handle
5957 @item info signals
5958 @itemx info handle
5959 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5960 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5961 the defined types of signals.
5962
5963 @item info signals @var{sig}
5964 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5965
5966 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5967
5968 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5969 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5970 for details about this command.
5971
5972 @kindex handle
5973 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5974 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5975 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5976 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5977 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5978 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5979 say what change to make.
5980 @end table
5981
5982 @c @group
5983 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5984 Their full names are:
5985
5986 @table @code
5987 @item nostop
5988 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5989 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5990
5991 @item stop
5992 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5993 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5994
5995 @item print
5996 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5997
5998 @item noprint
5999 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6000 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6001
6002 @item pass
6003 @itemx noignore
6004 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6005 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6006 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6007
6008 @item nopass
6009 @itemx ignore
6010 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6011 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6012 @end table
6013 @c @end group
6014
6015 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6016 program until you
6017 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6018 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6019 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6020 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6021 program sees that signal when you continue.
6022
6023 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6024 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6025 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6026 erroneous signals.
6027
6028 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6029 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6030 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6031 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6032 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6033 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6034 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6035 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6036 Program a Signal}.
6037
6038 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6039 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6040
6041 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6042 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6043 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6044 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6045 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6046 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6047 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6048 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6049 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6050 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6051 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6052 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6053 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6054
6055 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6056
6057 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6058 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6059 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6060 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6061
6062 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6063 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6064 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6065 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6066
6067 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6068 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6072 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6073 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6074 (@value{GDBP}) c
6075 Continuing.
6076
6077 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6078 main () sigusr1.c:28
6079 28 p = 0;
6080 (@value{GDBP}) si
6081 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6082 9 @{
6083 @end smallexample
6084
6085 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6086 program to receive the signal first:
6087
6088 @smallexample
6089 (@value{GDBP}) n
6090 28 p = 0;
6091 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6092 (@value{GDBP}) si
6093 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6094 9 @{
6095 (@value{GDBP})
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 @cindex extra signal information
6099 @anchor{extra signal information}
6100
6101 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6102 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6103 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6104 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6105 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6106 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6107 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6108 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6109 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6110 system header.
6111
6112 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6113 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6118 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6119 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6120 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6121 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6122 type = struct @{
6123 int si_signo;
6124 int si_errno;
6125 int si_code;
6126 union @{
6127 int _pad[28];
6128 struct @{...@} _kill;
6129 struct @{...@} _timer;
6130 struct @{...@} _rt;
6131 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6132 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6133 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6134 @} _sifields;
6135 @}
6136 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6137 type = struct @{
6138 void *si_addr;
6139 @}
6140 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6141 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6142 @end group
6143 @end smallexample
6144
6145 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6146
6147 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6148 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6149 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6150 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6151 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6152 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6153 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6154 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6155 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6156 information is displayed.
6157
6158 The usual output of a segfault is:
6159 @smallexample
6160 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6161 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6162 68 value = *(p + len);
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 While a bound violation is presented as:
6166 @smallexample
6167 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6168 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6169 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6170 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6171 68 value = *(p + len);
6172 @end smallexample
6173
6174 @node Thread Stops
6175 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6176
6177 @cindex stopped threads
6178 @cindex threads, stopped
6179
6180 @cindex continuing threads
6181 @cindex threads, continuing
6182
6183 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6184 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6185 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6186 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6187 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6188 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6189 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6190 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6191 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6192
6193 @menu
6194 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6195 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6196 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6197 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6198 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6199 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6200 @end menu
6201
6202 @node All-Stop Mode
6203 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6204
6205 @cindex all-stop mode
6206
6207 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6208 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6209 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6210 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6211 underfoot.
6212
6213 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6214 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6215 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6216
6217 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6218 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6219 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6220 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6221 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6222 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6223 stops.
6224
6225 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6226 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6227 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6228 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6229
6230 @cindex automatic thread selection
6231 @cindex switching threads automatically
6232 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6233 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6234 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6235 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6236 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6237 thread.
6238
6239 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6240 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6244 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6245 @cindex lock scheduler
6246 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6247 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6248 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6249 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6250 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6251 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6252 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6253 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6254 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6255 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6256 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6257 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6258 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6259 @code{on} in replay mode.
6260
6261 @item show scheduler-locking
6262 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6263 @end table
6264
6265 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6266 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6267 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6268 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6269 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6270 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6271 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6272 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6273 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6274 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6275 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6276 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6277 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6278 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6279
6280 @table @code
6281 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6282 @item set schedule-multiple
6283 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6284 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6285 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6286 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6287 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6288 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6289
6290 @item show schedule-multiple
6291 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6292 multiple processes.
6293 @end table
6294
6295 @node Non-Stop Mode
6296 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6297
6298 @cindex non-stop mode
6299
6300 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6301 @c with more details.
6302
6303 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6304 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6305 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6306 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6307 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6308 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6309
6310 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6311 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6312 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6313 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6314 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6315 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6316 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6317 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6318 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6319 independently and simultaneously.
6320
6321 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6322 or attach to your program:
6323
6324 @smallexample
6325 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6326 set pagination off
6327
6328 # Finally, turn it on!
6329 set non-stop on
6330 @end smallexample
6331
6332 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6333
6334 @table @code
6335 @kindex set non-stop
6336 @item set non-stop on
6337 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6338 @item set non-stop off
6339 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6340 @kindex show non-stop
6341 @item show non-stop
6342 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6343 @end table
6344
6345 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6346 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6347 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6348 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6349 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6350 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6351 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6352 default.
6353
6354 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6355 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6356 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6357
6358 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6359 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6360 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6361 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6362 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6363
6364 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6365 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6366 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6367 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6368 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6369
6370 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6371
6372 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6373 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6374 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6375 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6376 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6377 previously current thread.
6378
6379 @node Background Execution
6380 @subsection Background Execution
6381
6382 @cindex foreground execution
6383 @cindex background execution
6384 @cindex asynchronous execution
6385 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6386
6387 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6388 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6389 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6390 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6391 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6392 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6393
6394 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6395 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6396
6397 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6398 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6399 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6400 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6401 are:
6402
6403 @table @code
6404 @kindex run&
6405 @item run
6406 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6407
6408 @item attach
6409 @kindex attach&
6410 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6411
6412 @item step
6413 @kindex step&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6415
6416 @item stepi
6417 @kindex stepi&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6419
6420 @item next
6421 @kindex next&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6423
6424 @item nexti
6425 @kindex nexti&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6427
6428 @item continue
6429 @kindex continue&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6431
6432 @item finish
6433 @kindex finish&
6434 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6435
6436 @item until
6437 @kindex until&
6438 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6439
6440 @end table
6441
6442 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6443 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6444 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6445 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6446 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6447 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6448
6449 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6450 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6451
6452 @table @code
6453 @kindex interrupt
6454 @item interrupt
6455 @itemx interrupt -a
6456
6457 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6458 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6459 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6460 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6461 @end table
6462
6463 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6464 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6465
6466 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6467 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6468 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6469
6470 @table @code
6471 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6472 @cindex thread breakpoints
6473 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6474 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6475 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6476 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6477 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6478 specify some source line.
6479
6480 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6481 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6482 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6483 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6484 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6485
6486 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6487 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6488 program.
6489
6490 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6491 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6492 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6493
6494 @smallexample
6495 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 @end table
6499
6500 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6501 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6502 thread list. For example:
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 (@value{GDBP}) c
6506 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6507 @end smallexample
6508
6509 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6510 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6511 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6512 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6513 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6514 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6515 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6516 command.
6517
6518 @node Interrupted System Calls
6519 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6520
6521 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6522 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6523 @cindex premature return from system calls
6524 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6525 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6526 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6527 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6528 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6529 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6530 stop execution.
6531
6532 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6533 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6534 style anyways.
6535
6536 For example, do not write code like this:
6537
6538 @smallexample
6539 sleep (10);
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6543 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6544
6545 Instead, write this:
6546
6547 @smallexample
6548 int unslept = 10;
6549 while (unslept > 0)
6550 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6551 @end smallexample
6552
6553 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6554 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6555 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6556 @value{GDBN}.
6557
6558 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6559 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6560 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6561 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6562
6563 @node Observer Mode
6564 @subsection Observer Mode
6565
6566 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6567 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6568 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6569 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6570 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6571
6572 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6573 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6574 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6575 mode.
6576
6577 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6578 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6579 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6580 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6581 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6582
6583 @table @code
6584
6585 @kindex observer
6586 @item set observer on
6587 @itemx set observer off
6588 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6589 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6590 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6591 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6592
6593 @item show observer
6594 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6595
6596 @kindex may-write-registers
6597 @item set may-write-registers on
6598 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6599 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6600 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6601 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6602
6603 @item show may-write-registers
6604 Show the current permission to write registers.
6605
6606 @kindex may-write-memory
6607 @item set may-write-memory on
6608 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6609 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6610 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6611 defaults to @code{on}.
6612
6613 @item show may-write-memory
6614 Show the current permission to write memory.
6615
6616 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6617 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6618 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6619 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6620 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6621 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6622
6623 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6624 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6625
6626 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6627 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6628 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6629 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6630 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6631 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6632 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6633
6634 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6635 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6636
6637 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6639 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6640 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6641 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6642 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6643 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6644
6645 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6646 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6647
6648 @kindex may-interrupt
6649 @item set may-interrupt on
6650 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6651 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6652 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6653 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6654 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6655
6656 @item show may-interrupt
6657 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6658
6659 @end table
6660
6661 @node Reverse Execution
6662 @chapter Running programs backward
6663 @cindex reverse execution
6664 @cindex running programs backward
6665
6666 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6667 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6668 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6669 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6670
6671 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6672 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6673 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6674 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6675 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6676 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6677
6678 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6679 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6680 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6681 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6682 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6683 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6684 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6685 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6686 prior values@footnote{
6687 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6688 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6689 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6690
6691 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6692 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6693 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6694 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6695 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6696 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6697 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6698 }.
6699
6700 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6701 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6702
6703 @table @code
6704 @kindex reverse-continue
6705 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6706 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6707 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6708 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6709 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6710 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6711 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6712
6713 @kindex reverse-step
6714 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6715 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6716 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6717 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6718
6719 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6720 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6721 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6722 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6723 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6724 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6725
6726 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6727 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6728
6729 @kindex reverse-stepi
6730 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6731 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6732 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6733 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6734 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6735 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6736 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6737
6738 @kindex reverse-next
6739 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6740 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6741 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6742 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6743 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6744 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6745 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6746 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6747 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6748 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6749
6750 @kindex reverse-nexti
6751 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6752 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6753 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6754 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6755 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6756 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6757 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6758 frame) is reached.
6759
6760 @kindex reverse-finish
6761 @item reverse-finish
6762 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6763 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6764 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6765 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6766
6767 @kindex set exec-direction
6768 @item set exec-direction
6769 Set the direction of target execution.
6770 @item set exec-direction reverse
6771 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6772 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6773 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6774 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6775 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6776 @item set exec-direction forward
6777 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6778 This is the default.
6779 @end table
6780
6781
6782 @node Process Record and Replay
6783 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6784 @cindex process record and replay
6785 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6786
6787 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6788 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6789 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6790
6791 @cindex replay mode
6792 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6793 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6794 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6795 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6796 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6797 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6798 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6799 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6800 execution log.
6801
6802 @cindex record mode
6803 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6804 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6805 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6806 for future replay.
6807
6808 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6809 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6810 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6811 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6812 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6813 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6814
6815 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6816 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6817 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6818 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6819
6820 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6821 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6822
6823 @table @code
6824 @kindex target record
6825 @kindex target record-full
6826 @kindex target record-btrace
6827 @kindex record
6828 @kindex record full
6829 @kindex record btrace
6830 @kindex record btrace bts
6831 @kindex record btrace pt
6832 @kindex record bts
6833 @kindex record pt
6834 @kindex rec
6835 @kindex rec full
6836 @kindex rec btrace
6837 @kindex rec btrace bts
6838 @kindex rec btrace pt
6839 @kindex rec bts
6840 @kindex rec pt
6841 @item record @var{method}
6842 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6843 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6844 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6845 recording methods are available:
6846
6847 @table @code
6848 @item full
6849 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6850 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6851 execution.
6852
6853 @item btrace @var{format}
6854 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6855 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6856 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6857 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6858 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6859 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6860 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6861
6862 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6863 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6864 formats are available:
6865
6866 @table @code
6867 @item bts
6868 @cindex branch trace store
6869 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6870 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6871 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6872
6873 @item pt
6874 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6875 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6876 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6877 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6878
6879 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6880 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6881 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6882
6883 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6884 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6885 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6886 buffer-size with care.
6887 @end table
6888
6889 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6890 @end table
6891
6892 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6893 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6894 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6895 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6896
6897 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6898 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6899 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6900 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6901 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6902
6903 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6904 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6905 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6906 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6907 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6908 does not support these two modes.
6909
6910 @kindex record stop
6911 @kindex rec s
6912 @item record stop
6913 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6914 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6915 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6916
6917 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6918 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6919 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6920 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6921 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6922
6923 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6924 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6925 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6926 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6927 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6928
6929 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6930 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6931
6932 @kindex record goto
6933 @item record goto
6934 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6935 ways to specify the location to go to:
6936
6937 @table @code
6938 @item record goto begin
6939 @itemx record goto start
6940 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6941
6942 @item record goto end
6943 Go to the end of the execution log.
6944
6945 @item record goto @var{n}
6946 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6947 @end table
6948
6949 @kindex record save
6950 @item record save @var{filename}
6951 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6952 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6953 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6954
6955 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6956
6957 @kindex record restore
6958 @item record restore @var{filename}
6959 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6960 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6961
6962 @kindex set record full
6963 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6964 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6965 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6966 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6967
6968 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6969 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6970 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6971 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6972 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6973 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6974 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6975 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6976
6977 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6978 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6979 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6980
6981 @kindex show record full
6982 @item show record full insn-number-max
6983 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6984 recording method.
6985
6986 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6987 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6988 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6989 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6990 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6991 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6992 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6993 oldest one to be deleted.
6994
6995 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6996 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6997
6998 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6999 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7000
7001 @item set record full memory-query
7002 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7003 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7004 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7005 case.
7006
7007 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7008 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7009 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7010 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7011 results.
7012
7013 @item show record full memory-query
7014 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7015
7016 @kindex set record btrace
7017 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7018 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7019 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7020 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7021 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7022 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7023 You can use the following command for that:
7024
7025 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7026 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7027 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7028 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7029 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7030 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7031 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7032 position.
7033
7034 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7035 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7036 errata when decoding the trace.
7037
7038 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7039 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7040 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7041 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7042 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7043 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7044 which the trace was recorded.
7045
7046 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7047 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7048 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7049 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7050 disable the workarounds.
7051
7052 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7053 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7054 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7055 (default).
7056
7057 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7058 identifiers are currently supported:
7059
7060 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7061
7062 @item @code{intel}
7063 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7064
7065 @end multitable
7066
7067 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7068 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7069
7070 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7071 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7072 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7073
7074 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7075 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7076 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7077 supports.
7078
7079 @smallexample
7080 (gdb) info record
7081 Active record target: record-btrace
7082 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7083 Buffer size: 16kB.
7084 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7085 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7086 (gdb) info record
7087 Active record target: record-btrace
7088 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7089 Buffer size: 16kB.
7090 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7091 @end smallexample
7092
7093 @kindex show record btrace
7094 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7095 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7096
7097 @item show record btrace cpu
7098 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7099 workarounds.
7100
7101 @kindex set record btrace bts
7102 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7103 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7104 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7105 format. Default is 64KB.
7106
7107 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7108 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7109 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7110 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7111 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7112 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7113 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7114
7115 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7116 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7117
7118 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7119 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7120
7121 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7122 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7123 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7124
7125 @kindex set record btrace pt
7126 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7127 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7128 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7129 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7130
7131 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7132 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7133 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7134 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7135 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7136 actual buffer size for each thread.
7137
7138 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7139 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7140
7141 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7142 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7143
7144 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7145 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7146 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7147
7148 @kindex info record
7149 @item info record
7150 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7151 method:
7152
7153 @table @code
7154 @item full
7155 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7156 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7157
7158 @itemize @bullet
7159 @item
7160 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7161 @item
7162 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7163 @item
7164 Highest recorded instruction number.
7165 @item
7166 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7167 @item
7168 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7169 @item
7170 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7171 @end itemize
7172
7173 @item btrace
7174 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7175
7176 @itemize @bullet
7177 @item
7178 Recording format.
7179 @item
7180 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7181 @item
7182 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7183 instructions.
7184 @item
7185 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7186 @end itemize
7187
7188 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7189 @itemize @bullet
7190 @item
7191 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7192 @end itemize
7193
7194 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7195 @itemize @bullet
7196 @item
7197 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7198 @end itemize
7199 @end table
7200
7201 @kindex record delete
7202 @kindex rec del
7203 @item record delete
7204 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7205 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7206 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7207 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7208
7209 @kindex record instruction-history
7210 @kindex rec instruction-history
7211 @item record instruction-history
7212 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7213 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7214 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7215 are printed in execution order.
7216
7217 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7218 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7219 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7220
7221 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7222 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7223 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7224 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7225 @code{/p} modifier.
7226
7227 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7228 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7229 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7230
7231 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7232 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7233
7234 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7235 disassemble:
7236
7237 @table @code
7238 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7239 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7240 @var{insn}.
7241
7242 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7243 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7244 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7245 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7246 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7247 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7248
7249 @item record instruction-history
7250 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7251
7252 @item record instruction-history -
7253 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7254
7255 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7256 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7257 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7258 number @var{end} is included.
7259 @end table
7260
7261 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7262
7263 @kindex set record
7264 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7265 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7266 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7267 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7268 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7269
7270 @kindex show record
7271 @item show record instruction-history-size
7272 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7273 instruction-history} command.
7274
7275 @kindex record function-call-history
7276 @kindex rec function-call-history
7277 @item record function-call-history
7278 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7279 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7280 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7281 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7282 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7283 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7284 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7285 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7286 given together.
7287
7288 @smallexample
7289 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7290 1 void foo (void)
7291 2 @{
7292 3 @}
7293 4
7294 5 void bar (void)
7295 6 @{
7296 7 ...
7297 8 foo ();
7298 9 ...
7299 10 @}
7300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7301 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7302 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7303 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7304 @end smallexample
7305
7306 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7307 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7308 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7309 to print:
7310
7311 @table @code
7312 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7313 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7314
7315 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7316 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7317 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7318 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7319 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7320
7321 @item record function-call-history
7322 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7323
7324 @item record function-call-history -
7325 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7326
7327 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7328 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7329 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7330 @end table
7331
7332 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7333
7334 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7335 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7336 Define how many lines to print in the
7337 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7338 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7339
7340 @item show record function-call-history-size
7341 Show how many lines to print in the
7342 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7343 @end table
7344
7345
7346 @node Stack
7347 @chapter Examining the Stack
7348
7349 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7350 stopped and how it got there.
7351
7352 @cindex call stack
7353 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7354 is generated.
7355 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7356 the arguments of the call,
7357 and the local variables of the function being called.
7358 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7359 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7360 stack}.
7361
7362 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7363 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7364
7365 @cindex selected frame
7366 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7367 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7368 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7369 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7370 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7371 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7372
7373 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7374 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7375 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7376
7377 @menu
7378 * Frames:: Stack frames
7379 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7380 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7381 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7382 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7383 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7384
7385 @end menu
7386
7387 @node Frames
7388 @section Stack Frames
7389
7390 @cindex frame, definition
7391 @cindex stack frame
7392 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7393 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7394 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7395 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7396 which the function is executing.
7397
7398 @cindex initial frame
7399 @cindex outermost frame
7400 @cindex innermost frame
7401 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7402 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7403 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7404 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7405 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7406 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7407 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7408 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7409
7410 @cindex frame pointer
7411 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7412 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7413 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7414 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7415 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7416 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7417
7418 @cindex frame level
7419 @cindex frame number
7420 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7421 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7422 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7423 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7424 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7425 describe this number.
7426
7427 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7428 @c underflow problems.
7429 @cindex frameless execution
7430 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7431 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7432 @smallexample
7433 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7434 @end smallexample
7435 generates functions without a frame.)
7436 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7437 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7438 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7439 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7440 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7441 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7442 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7443
7444 @node Backtrace
7445 @section Backtraces
7446
7447 @cindex traceback
7448 @cindex call stack traces
7449 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7450 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7451 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7452 stack.
7453
7454 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7455 @kindex backtrace
7456 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7457 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7458 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7459 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7460 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7461 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7462
7463 @table @code
7464 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7465 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7466 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7467 be one of the following:
7468
7469 @table @code
7470 @item @var{n}
7471 @itemx @var{n}
7472 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7473 number.
7474
7475 @item -@var{n}
7476 @itemx -@var{n}
7477 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7478 number.
7479
7480 @item full
7481 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7482 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7483
7484 @item no-filters
7485 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7486 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7487 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7488 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7489 support.
7490
7491 @item hide
7492 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7493 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7494 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7495 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7496 @end table
7497 @end table
7498
7499 @kindex where
7500 @kindex info stack
7501 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7502 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7503
7504 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7505 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7506 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7507 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7508 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7509 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7510 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7511 multi-threaded program.
7512
7513 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7514 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7515 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7516 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7517 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7518 line number.
7519
7520 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7521 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7522
7523 @smallexample
7524 @group
7525 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7526 at builtin.c:993
7527 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7528 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7529 at macro.c:71
7530 (More stack frames follow...)
7531 @end group
7532 @end smallexample
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7536 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7537 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7538
7539 @noindent
7540 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7541 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7542 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7543 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7544 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7545
7546 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7547 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7548 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7549 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7550 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7551 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7552 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7553 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7554 such a backtrace might look like:
7555
7556 @smallexample
7557 @group
7558 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7559 at builtin.c:993
7560 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7561 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7562 at macro.c:71
7563 (More stack frames follow...)
7564 @end group
7565 @end smallexample
7566
7567 @noindent
7568 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7569 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7570
7571 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7572 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7573 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7574
7575 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7576 @cindex program entry point
7577 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7578 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7579 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7580 @code{main}@footnote{
7581 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7582 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7583 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7584 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7585 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7586 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7587
7588 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7589 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592 @item set backtrace past-main
7593 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7594 @kindex set backtrace
7595 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-main off
7598 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7599 default.
7600
7601 @item show backtrace past-main
7602 @kindex show backtrace
7603 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7604
7605 @item set backtrace past-entry
7606 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7607 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7608 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7609 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7610
7611 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7612 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7613 application. This is the default.
7614
7615 @item show backtrace past-entry
7616 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7617
7618 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7619 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7620 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7621 @cindex backtrace limit
7622 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7623 or zero means unlimited levels.
7624
7625 @item show backtrace limit
7626 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7627 @end table
7628
7629 You can control how file names are displayed.
7630
7631 @table @code
7632 @item set filename-display
7633 @itemx set filename-display relative
7634 @cindex filename-display
7635 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7636
7637 @item set filename-display basename
7638 Display only basename of a filename.
7639
7640 @item set filename-display absolute
7641 Display an absolute filename.
7642
7643 @item show filename-display
7644 Show the current way to display filenames.
7645 @end table
7646
7647 @node Selection
7648 @section Selecting a Frame
7649
7650 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7651 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7652 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7653 of the stack frame just selected.
7654
7655 @table @code
7656 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7657 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7658 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7659 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7660 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7661 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7662
7663 @table @code
7664 @kindex frame level
7665 @item @var{num}
7666 @item level @var{num}
7667 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7668 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7669 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7670 for @code{main}.
7671
7672 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7673 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7674 commands are equivalent:
7675
7676 @smallexample
7677 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7678 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7679 @end smallexample
7680
7681 @kindex frame address
7682 @item address @var{stack-address}
7683 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7684 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7685 @command{info frame}, for example:
7686
7687 @smallexample
7688 (gdb) info frame
7689 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7690 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7691 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7692 source language c++.
7693 Arglist at unknown address.
7694 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7695 @end smallexample
7696
7697 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7698 indicated by the line:
7699
7700 @smallexample
7701 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7702 @end smallexample
7703
7704 @kindex frame function
7705 @item function @var{function-name}
7706 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7707 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7708 most stack frame is selected.
7709
7710 @kindex frame view
7711 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7712 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7713 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7714 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7715
7716 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7717 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7718 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7719 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7720
7721 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7722 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7723 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7724 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7725
7726 @end table
7727
7728 @kindex up
7729 @item up @var{n}
7730 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7731 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7732 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7733
7734 @kindex down
7735 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7736 @item down @var{n}
7737 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7738 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7739 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7740 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7741 @end table
7742
7743 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7744 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7745 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7746 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7747
7748 @need 1000
7749 For example:
7750
7751 @smallexample
7752 @group
7753 (@value{GDBP}) up
7754 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7755 at env.c:10
7756 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7757 @end group
7758 @end smallexample
7759
7760 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7761 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7762 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7763 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7764 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7765 for details.
7766
7767 @table @code
7768 @kindex select-frame
7769 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7770 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7771 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7772 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7773 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7774 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7775 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7776
7777 @kindex down-silently
7778 @kindex up-silently
7779 @item up-silently @var{n}
7780 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7781 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7782 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7783 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7784 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7785 distracting.
7786 @end table
7787
7788 @node Frame Info
7789 @section Information About a Frame
7790
7791 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7792 stack frame.
7793
7794 @table @code
7795 @item frame
7796 @itemx f
7797 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7798 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7799 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7800 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7801 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7802
7803 @kindex info frame
7804 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7805 @item info frame
7806 @itemx info f
7807 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7808 including:
7809
7810 @itemize @bullet
7811 @item
7812 the address of the frame
7813 @item
7814 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7815 @item
7816 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7817 @item
7818 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7819 @item
7820 the address of the frame's arguments
7821 @item
7822 the address of the frame's local variables
7823 @item
7824 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7825 @item
7826 which registers were saved in the frame
7827 @end itemize
7828
7829 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7830 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7831 the usual conventions.
7832
7833 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7834 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7835 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7836 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7837 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7838 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7839
7840 @kindex info args
7841 @item info args [-q]
7842 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7843
7844 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7845 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
7846 have been printed.
7847
7848 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7849 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
7850 with the provided regexp(s).
7851
7852 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
7853 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7854
7855 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
7856 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7857 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7858 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7859 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7860 of special characters or quotes.
7861
7862 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
7863 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7864 @var{type_regexp}.
7865
7866 @item info locals [-q]
7867 @kindex info locals
7868 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7869 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7870 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7871
7872 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7873 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
7874 have been printed.
7875
7876 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7877 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
7878 with the provided regexp(s).
7879
7880 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
7881 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7882
7883 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
7884 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7885 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7886 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7887 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7888 of special characters or quotes.
7889
7890 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
7891 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7892 @var{type_regexp}.
7893
7894 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
7895 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
7896 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
7897 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
7898 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
7899 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
7900 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
7901 @smallexample
7902 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
7903 @end smallexample
7904 @noindent
7905 or the equivalent shorter form
7906 @smallexample
7907 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
7908 @end smallexample
7909
7910 @end table
7911
7912 @node Frame Apply
7913 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7914 @kindex frame apply
7915 @cindex apply command to several frames
7916 @table @code
7917 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7918 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7919 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7920
7921 @table @code
7922 @item @code{all}
7923 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7924
7925 @item @var{count}
7926 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7927 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7928
7929 @item @var{-count}
7930 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7931 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7932
7933 @item @code{level}
7934 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7935 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7936 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7937 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7938 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7939 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7940
7941 @end table
7942
7943 @end table
7944
7945 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7946 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7947 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7948 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7949
7950 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7951 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7952 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7953 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7954 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7955
7956 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7957 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7958 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7959 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7960
7961 @table @code
7962 @item -c
7963 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7964 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7965 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7966 @item -s
7967 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7968 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7969 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7970 are not printed.
7971 @item -q
7972 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7973 information.
7974 @end table
7975
7976 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7977 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7978 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7979 @code{#1 main} frame.
7980
7981 @smallexample
7982 @group
7983 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7984 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7985 No symbol "j" in current context.
7986 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7987 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7988 No symbol "j" in current context.
7989 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7990 $1 = 5
7991 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7992 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7993 $2 = 5
7994 (gdb)
7995 @end group
7996 @end smallexample
7997
7998 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7999 information before the command output:
8000
8001 @smallexample
8002 @group
8003 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8004 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8005 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8006 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8007 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8008 (gdb)
8009 @end group
8010 @end smallexample
8011
8012 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8013 @smallexample
8014 @group
8015 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8016 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8017 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8018 (gdb)
8019 @end group
8020 @end smallexample
8021
8022 @table @code
8023
8024 @kindex faas
8025 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8026 @item faas @var{command}
8027 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8028 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8029
8030 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8031 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8032 is, using:
8033 @smallexample
8034 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8035 @end smallexample
8036
8037 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8038 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8039 @end table
8040
8041
8042 @node Frame Filter Management
8043 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8044 @cindex managing frame filters
8045
8046 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8047 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8048
8049 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8050 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @kindex info frame-filter
8054 @item info frame-filter
8055 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8056 their name, priority and enabled status.
8057
8058 @kindex disable frame-filter
8059 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8060 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8061 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8062 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8063 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8064 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8065 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8066 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8067 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8068 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8069 may be enabled again later.
8070
8071 @kindex enable frame-filter
8072 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8073 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8074 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8075 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8076 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8077 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8078 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8079 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8080 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8081
8082 Example:
8083
8084 @smallexample
8085 (gdb) info frame-filter
8086
8087 global frame-filters:
8088 Priority Enabled Name
8089 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8090 100 Yes Reverse
8091
8092 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8093 Priority Enabled Name
8094 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8095
8096 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8097 Priority Enabled Name
8098 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8099
8100 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8101 (gdb) info frame-filter
8102
8103 global frame-filters:
8104 Priority Enabled Name
8105 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8106 100 Yes Reverse
8107
8108 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8109 Priority Enabled Name
8110 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8111
8112 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8113 Priority Enabled Name
8114 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8115
8116 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8117 (gdb) info frame-filter
8118
8119 global frame-filters:
8120 Priority Enabled Name
8121 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8122 100 Yes Reverse
8123
8124 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8125 Priority Enabled Name
8126 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8127
8128 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8129 Priority Enabled Name
8130 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8131 @end smallexample
8132
8133 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8134 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8135 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8136 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8137 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8138 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8139 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8140
8141 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8142 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8143 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8144 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8145 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8146 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8147 dictionary resides.
8148
8149 Example:
8150
8151 @smallexample
8152 (gdb) info frame-filter
8153
8154 global frame-filters:
8155 Priority Enabled Name
8156 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8157 100 Yes Reverse
8158
8159 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8160 Priority Enabled Name
8161 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8162
8163 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8164 Priority Enabled Name
8165 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8166
8167 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8168 (gdb) info frame-filter
8169
8170 global frame-filters:
8171 Priority Enabled Name
8172 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8173 50 Yes Reverse
8174
8175 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8176 Priority Enabled Name
8177 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8178
8179 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8180 Priority Enabled Name
8181 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8182 @end smallexample
8183 @end table
8184
8185 @node Source
8186 @chapter Examining Source Files
8187
8188 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8189 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8190 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8191 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8192 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8193 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8194 source files by explicit command.
8195
8196 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8197 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8198 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8199
8200 @menu
8201 * List:: Printing source lines
8202 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8203 * Edit:: Editing source files
8204 * Search:: Searching source files
8205 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8206 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8207 @end menu
8208
8209 @node List
8210 @section Printing Source Lines
8211
8212 @kindex list
8213 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8214 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8215 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8216 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8217 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8218
8219 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8220
8221 @table @code
8222 @item list @var{linenum}
8223 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8224 current source file.
8225
8226 @item list @var{function}
8227 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8228 @var{function}.
8229
8230 @item list
8231 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8232 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8233 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8234 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8235 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8236
8237 @item list -
8238 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8239 @end table
8240
8241 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8242 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8243 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8244
8245 @table @code
8246 @kindex set listsize
8247 @item set listsize @var{count}
8248 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8249 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8250 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8251 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8252
8253 @kindex show listsize
8254 @item show listsize
8255 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8256 @end table
8257
8258 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8259 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8260 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8261 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8262 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8263
8264 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8265 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8266 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8267 to specify some source line.
8268
8269 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8270
8271 @table @code
8272 @item list @var{location}
8273 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8274
8275 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8276 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8277 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8278 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8279 the same source file as the first location.
8280
8281 @item list ,@var{last}
8282 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8283
8284 @item list @var{first},
8285 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8286
8287 @item list +
8288 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8289
8290 @item list -
8291 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8292
8293 @item list
8294 As described in the preceding table.
8295 @end table
8296
8297 @node Specify Location
8298 @section Specifying a Location
8299 @cindex specifying location
8300 @cindex location
8301 @cindex source location
8302
8303 @menu
8304 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8305 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8306 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8307 @end menu
8308
8309 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8310 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8311 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8312 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8313 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8314
8315 @node Linespec Locations
8316 @subsection Linespec Locations
8317 @cindex linespec locations
8318
8319 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8320 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8321 specifying a linespec:
8322
8323 @table @code
8324 @item @var{linenum}
8325 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8326
8327 @item -@var{offset}
8328 @itemx +@var{offset}
8329 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8330 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8331 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8332 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8333 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8334 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8335 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8336 linespec.
8337
8338 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8339 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8340 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8341 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8342 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8343 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8344 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8345
8346 @item @var{function}
8347 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8348 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8349
8350 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8351 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8352 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8353 means in all packages.
8354
8355 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8356 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8357 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8358
8359 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8360 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8361 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8362 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8363
8364 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8365
8366 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8367 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8368
8369 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8370 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8371 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8372 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8373 functions in different source files.
8374
8375 @item @var{label}
8376 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8377 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8378 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8379 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8380
8381 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8382 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8383 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8384 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8385 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8386 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8387
8388 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8389 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8390 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8391 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8392 each one of those probes.
8393 @end table
8394
8395 @node Explicit Locations
8396 @subsection Explicit Locations
8397 @cindex explicit locations
8398
8399 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8400 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8401
8402 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8403 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8404 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8405 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8406 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8407
8408 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8409 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8410 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8411 the symbol table to know.
8412
8413 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8414 following table:
8415
8416 @table @code
8417 @item -source @var{filename}
8418 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8419 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8420 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8421 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8422 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8423
8424 @item -function @var{function}
8425 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8426 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8427 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8428 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8429
8430 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8431 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8432 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8433 means in all packages.
8434
8435 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8436 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8437 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8438 breakpoint on both symbols.
8439
8440 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8441
8442 @item -qualified
8443
8444 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8445 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8446
8447 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8448 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8449 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8450
8451 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8452 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8453 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8454
8455 @item -label @var{label}
8456 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8457 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8458 selected stack frame.
8459
8460 @item -line @var{number}
8461 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8462 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8463 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8464 relative to the current line.
8465 @end table
8466
8467 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8468 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8469
8470 @node Address Locations
8471 @subsection Address Locations
8472 @cindex address locations
8473
8474 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8475 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8476
8477 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8478 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8479 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8480 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8481 source files.
8482
8483 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8484 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8485 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8486 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8487 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8488 of @var{address}:
8489
8490 @table @code
8491 @item @var{expression}
8492 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8493
8494 @item @var{funcaddr}
8495 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8496 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8497 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8498 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8499 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8500 (although the Pascal form also works).
8501
8502 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8503 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8504
8505 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8506 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8507 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8508 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8509 functions with identical names in different source files.
8510 @end table
8511
8512 @node Edit
8513 @section Editing Source Files
8514 @cindex editing source files
8515
8516 @kindex edit
8517 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8518 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8519 The editing program of your choice
8520 is invoked with the current line set to
8521 the active line in the program.
8522 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8523 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8524
8525 @table @code
8526 @item edit @var{location}
8527 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8528 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8529 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8530 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8531 command most commonly used:
8532
8533 @table @code
8534 @item edit @var{number}
8535 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8536
8537 @item edit @var{function}
8538 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8539 @end table
8540
8541 @end table
8542
8543 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8544 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8545 @footnote{
8546 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8547 following command-line syntax:
8548 @smallexample
8549 ex +@var{number} file
8550 @end smallexample
8551 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8552 the file where to start editing.}.
8553 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8554 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8555 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8556 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8557 @smallexample
8558 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8559 export EDITOR
8560 gdb @dots{}
8561 @end smallexample
8562 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8563 @smallexample
8564 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8565 gdb @dots{}
8566 @end smallexample
8567
8568 @node Search
8569 @section Searching Source Files
8570 @cindex searching source files
8571
8572 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8573 regular expression.
8574
8575 @table @code
8576 @kindex search
8577 @kindex forward-search
8578 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8579 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8580 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8581 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8582 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8583 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8584 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8585 @code{fo}.
8586
8587 @kindex reverse-search
8588 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8589 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8590 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8591 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8592 this command as @code{rev}.
8593 @end table
8594
8595 @node Source Path
8596 @section Specifying Source Directories
8597
8598 @cindex source path
8599 @cindex directories for source files
8600 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8601 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8602 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8603 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8604 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8605 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8606 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8607
8608 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8609 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8610 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8611 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8612 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8613 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8614 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8615 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8616 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8617 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8618 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8619
8620 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8621 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8622 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8623 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8624 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8625 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8626
8627 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8628 source files.
8629
8630 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8631 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8632 each line is in the file.
8633
8634 @kindex directory
8635 @kindex dir
8636 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8637 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8638 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8639
8640 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8641 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8642
8643 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8644 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8645 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8646 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8647 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8648 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8649 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8650 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8651 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8652 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8653 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8654 name to look up the sources.
8655
8656 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8657 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8658 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8659 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8660 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8661 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8662 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8663 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8664
8665 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8666 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8667 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8668 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8669 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8670 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8671 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8672
8673 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8674 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8675 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8676 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8677 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8678 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8679 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8680 command.
8681
8682 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8683 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8684 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8685 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8686 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8687 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8688 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8689
8690 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8691 @cindex default source path substitution
8692 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8693 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8694 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8695 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8696 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8697 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8698 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8699 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8700 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8701 together.
8702
8703 @table @code
8704 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8705 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8706 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8707 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8708 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8709 part of absolute file names) or
8710 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8711 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8712
8713 @kindex cdir
8714 @kindex cwd
8715 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8716 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8717 @cindex compilation directory
8718 @cindex current directory
8719 @cindex working directory
8720 @cindex directory, current
8721 @cindex directory, compilation
8722 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8723 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8724 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8725 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8726 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8727 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8728
8729 @item directory
8730 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8731
8732 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8733 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8734
8735 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8736 @kindex set directories
8737 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8738 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8739
8740 @item show directories
8741 @kindex show directories
8742 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8743
8744 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8745 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8746 @kindex set substitute-path
8747 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8748 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8749 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8750
8751 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8752 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8753
8754 @smallexample
8755 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8756 @end smallexample
8757
8758 @noindent
8759 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8760 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8761 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8762
8763 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8764 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8765 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8766 the substitution.
8767
8768 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8769
8770 @smallexample
8771 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8772 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8773 @end smallexample
8774
8775 @noindent
8776 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8777 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8778 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8779 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8780
8781
8782 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8783 @kindex unset substitute-path
8784 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8785 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8786 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8787
8788 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8789
8790 @item show substitute-path [path]
8791 @kindex show substitute-path
8792 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8793 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8794
8795 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8796 rules.
8797
8798 @end table
8799
8800 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8801 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8802 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8803
8804 @enumerate
8805 @item
8806 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8807
8808 @item
8809 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8810 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8811 directories in one command.
8812 @end enumerate
8813
8814 @node Machine Code
8815 @section Source and Machine Code
8816 @cindex source line and its code address
8817
8818 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8819 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8820 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8821 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8822 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8823 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8824 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8825 well as hex.
8826
8827 @table @code
8828 @kindex info line
8829 @item info line
8830 @itemx info line @var{location}
8831 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8832 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8833 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8834 information about the current source line is printed.
8835 @end table
8836
8837 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8838 the object code for the first line of function
8839 @code{m4_changequote}:
8840
8841 @smallexample
8842 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8843 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8844 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8845 @end smallexample
8846
8847 @noindent
8848 @cindex code address and its source line
8849 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8850 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8851 @smallexample
8852 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8853 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8854 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8855 @end smallexample
8856
8857 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8858 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8859 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8860 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8861 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8862 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8863 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8864 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8865 Variables}).
8866
8867 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8868 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8869 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8870 line.
8871
8872 @table @code
8873 @kindex disassemble
8874 @cindex assembly instructions
8875 @cindex instructions, assembly
8876 @cindex machine instructions
8877 @cindex listing machine instructions
8878 @item disassemble
8879 @itemx disassemble /m
8880 @itemx disassemble /s
8881 @itemx disassemble /r
8882 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8883 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8884 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8885 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8886 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8887 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8888 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8889 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8890 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8891 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8892
8893 @table @code
8894 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8895 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8896 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8897 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8898 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8899 @end table
8900
8901 @noindent
8902 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8903 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8904
8905 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8906 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8907
8908 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8909 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8910 @end table
8911
8912 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8913 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8914
8915 @smallexample
8916 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8917 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8918 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8919 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8920 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8921 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8922 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8923 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8924 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8925 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8926 End of assembler dump.
8927 @end smallexample
8928
8929 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8930 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8931 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8932
8933 @smallexample
8934 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8935 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8936 5 @{
8937 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8938 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8939 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8940 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8941 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8942
8943 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8944 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8945 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8946
8947 7 return 0;
8948 8 @}
8949 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8950 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8951 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8952
8953 End of assembler dump.
8954 @end smallexample
8955
8956 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8957 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8958 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8959 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8960 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8961 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8962 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8963 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8964 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8965
8966 @file{foo.h}:
8967
8968 @smallexample
8969 int
8970 foo (int a)
8971 @{
8972 if (a < 0)
8973 return a * 2;
8974 if (a == 0)
8975 return 1;
8976 return a + 10;
8977 @}
8978 @end smallexample
8979
8980 @file{foo.c}:
8981
8982 @smallexample
8983 #include "foo.h"
8984 volatile int x, y;
8985 int
8986 main ()
8987 @{
8988 x = foo (y);
8989 return 0;
8990 @}
8991 @end smallexample
8992
8993 @smallexample
8994 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8995 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8996 5 @{
8997
8998 6 x = foo (y);
8999 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9000 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9001
9002 7 return 0;
9003 8 @}
9004 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9005 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9006 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9007 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9008
9009 End of assembler dump.
9010 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9011 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9012 foo.c:
9013 5 @{
9014 6 x = foo (y);
9015 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9016
9017 foo.h:
9018 4 if (a < 0)
9019 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9020 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9021
9022 6 if (a == 0)
9023 7 return 1;
9024 8 return a + 10;
9025 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9026 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9027 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9028 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9029
9030 foo.c:
9031 6 x = foo (y);
9032 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9033
9034 7 return 0;
9035 8 @}
9036 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9037 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9038
9039 foo.h:
9040 5 return a * 2;
9041 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9042 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9043 End of assembler dump.
9044 @end smallexample
9045
9046 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9047
9048 @smallexample
9049 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9050 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9051 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9052 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9053 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9054 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9055 End of assembler dump.
9056 @end smallexample
9057
9058 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9059 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9060 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9061 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9062
9063 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9064 mnemonics or other syntax.
9065
9066 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9067 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9068 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9069 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9070 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9071
9072 @table @code
9073 @kindex set disassembler-options
9074 @cindex disassembler options
9075 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9076 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9077 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9078 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9079 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9080 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9081 The default value is the empty string.
9082
9083 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9084 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9085 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9086 and S/390.
9087
9088 @kindex show disassembler-options
9089 @item show disassembler-options
9090 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9091 @end table
9092
9093 @table @code
9094 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9095 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9096 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9097 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9098 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9099 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9100
9101 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9102 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9103 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9104 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9105
9106 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9107 @item show disassembly-flavor
9108 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9109 @end table
9110
9111 @table @code
9112 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9113 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9114 @item set disassemble-next-line
9115 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9116 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9117 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9118 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9119 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9120 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9121 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9122 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9123 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9124 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9125 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9126 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9127 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9128 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9129 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9130 instruction.
9131 @end table
9132
9133
9134 @node Data
9135 @chapter Examining Data
9136
9137 @cindex printing data
9138 @cindex examining data
9139 @kindex print
9140 @kindex inspect
9141 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9142 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9143 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9144 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9145 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9146 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9147
9148 @table @code
9149 @item print @var{expr}
9150 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9151 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9152 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9153 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9154 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9155 Formats}.
9156
9157 @item print
9158 @itemx print /@var{f}
9159 @cindex reprint the last value
9160 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9161 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9162 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9163 @end table
9164
9165 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9166 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9167 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9168
9169 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9170 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9171 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9172 Table}.
9173
9174 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9175 @kindex explore
9176 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9177 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9178 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9179 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9180 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9181 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9182 embedded in the higher level data types.
9183
9184 @table @code
9185 @item explore @var{arg}
9186 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9187 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9191 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9192 C program as
9193
9194 @smallexample
9195 struct SimpleStruct
9196 @{
9197 int i;
9198 double d;
9199 @};
9200
9201 struct ComplexStruct
9202 @{
9203 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9204 int arr[10];
9205 @};
9206 @end smallexample
9207
9208 @noindent
9209 followed by variable declarations as
9210
9211 @smallexample
9212 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9213 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9214 @end smallexample
9215
9216 @noindent
9217 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9218 @code{explore} command as follows.
9219
9220 @smallexample
9221 (gdb) explore cs
9222 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9223 the following fields:
9224
9225 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9226 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9227
9228 Enter the field number of choice:
9229 @end smallexample
9230
9231 @noindent
9232 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9233 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9234 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9235 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9236 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9237 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9238 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9239 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9243 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9244 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9245 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9246
9247 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9248 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9249
9250 Press enter to return to parent value:
9251 @end smallexample
9252
9253 @noindent
9254 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9255 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9256 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9257 to explore.
9258
9259 @smallexample
9260 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9261 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9262
9263 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9264
9265 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9266
9267 Press enter to return to parent value:
9268 @end smallexample
9269
9270 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9271 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9272 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9273 level data structure).
9274
9275 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9276 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9277 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9278 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9279 same example as above, your can explore the type
9280 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9281 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9282
9283 @smallexample
9284 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9285 @end smallexample
9286
9287 @noindent
9288 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9289 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9290 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9291 example.
9292
9293 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9294 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9295 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9296 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9297 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9298
9299 @table @code
9300 @item explore value @var{expr}
9301 @cindex explore value
9302 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9303 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9304 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9305 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9306 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9307
9308 @item explore type @var{arg}
9309 @cindex explore type
9310 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9311 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9312 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9313 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9314 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9315 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9316 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9317 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9318 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9319 @end table
9320
9321 @menu
9322 * Expressions:: Expressions
9323 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9324 * Variables:: Program variables
9325 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9326 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9327 * Memory:: Examining memory
9328 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9329 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9330 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9331 * Value History:: Value history
9332 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9333 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9334 * Registers:: Registers
9335 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9336 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9337 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9338 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9339 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9340 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9341 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9342 character set than GDB does
9343 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9344 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9345 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9346 @end menu
9347
9348 @node Expressions
9349 @section Expressions
9350
9351 @cindex expressions
9352 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9353 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9354 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9355 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9356 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9357 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9358 @ref{Compilation}.
9359
9360 @cindex arrays in expressions
9361 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9362 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9363 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9364 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9365 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9366 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9367
9368 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9369 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9370 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9371 languages.
9372
9373 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9374 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9375
9376 @cindex casts, in expressions
9377 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9378 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9379 at that address in memory.
9380 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9381
9382 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9383 to programming languages:
9384
9385 @table @code
9386 @item @@
9387 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9388 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9389
9390 @item ::
9391 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9392 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9393
9394 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9395 @cindex type casting memory
9396 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9397 @cindex casts, to view memory
9398 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9399 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9400 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9401 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9402 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9403 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9404 @end table
9405
9406 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9407 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9408 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9409
9410 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9411 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9412 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9413 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9414 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9415 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9416 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9417
9418 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9419 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9420 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9421 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9422 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9423 as well.
9424
9425 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9426 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9427 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9428 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9429 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9430 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9431 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9432 choices.
9433
9434 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9435 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9436 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9437
9438 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9439 @smallexample
9440 @group
9441 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9442 [0] cancel
9443 [1] all
9444 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9445 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9446 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9447 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9448 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9449 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9450 > 2 4 6
9451 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9452 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9453 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9454 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9455 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9456 breakpoints.
9457 (@value{GDBP})
9458 @end group
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 @table @code
9462 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9463 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9464 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9465
9466 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9467 is ambiguous.
9468
9469 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9470 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9471 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9472 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9473 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9474 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9475 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9476 in the use of the menu.
9477
9478 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9479 when an ambiguity is detected.
9480
9481 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9482 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9483
9484 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9485 @item show multiple-symbols
9486 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9487 @end table
9488
9489 @node Variables
9490 @section Program Variables
9491
9492 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9493 in your program.
9494
9495 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9496 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9497
9498 @itemize @bullet
9499 @item
9500 global (or file-static)
9501 @end itemize
9502
9503 @noindent or
9504
9505 @itemize @bullet
9506 @item
9507 visible according to the scope rules of the
9508 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9509 @end itemize
9510
9511 @noindent This means that in the function
9512
9513 @smallexample
9514 foo (a)
9515 int a;
9516 @{
9517 bar (a);
9518 @{
9519 int b = test ();
9520 bar (b);
9521 @}
9522 @}
9523 @end smallexample
9524
9525 @noindent
9526 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9527 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9528 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9529 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9530
9531 @cindex variable name conflict
9532 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9533 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9534 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9535 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9536 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9537 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9538 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9539
9540 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9541 @ifnotinfo
9542 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9543 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9544 @end ifnotinfo
9545 @smallexample
9546 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9547 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9548 @end smallexample
9549
9550 @noindent
9551 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9552 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9553 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9554 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9555
9556 @smallexample
9557 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9558 @end smallexample
9559
9560 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9561 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9562 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9563 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9564 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9565
9566 @smallexample
9567 void
9568 foo (int a)
9569 @{
9570 if (a < 10)
9571 bar (a);
9572 else
9573 process (a); /* Stop here */
9574 @}
9575
9576 int
9577 bar (int a)
9578 @{
9579 foo (a + 5);
9580 @}
9581 @end smallexample
9582
9583 @noindent
9584 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9585 here is what you might see
9586 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9587
9588 @smallexample
9589 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9590 $1 = 10
9591 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9592 $2 = 5
9593 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9594 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9595 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9596 $3 = 5
9597 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9598 $4 = 0
9599 @end smallexample
9600
9601 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9602 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9603 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9604 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9605 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9606
9607 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9608 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9609 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9610 @code{some_global}.
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9614 $1 = 23
9615 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9616 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9617 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9618 $2 = 27
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @cindex wrong values
9622 @cindex variable values, wrong
9623 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9624 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9625 @quotation
9626 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9627 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9628 scope, and just before exit.
9629 @end quotation
9630 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9631 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9632 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9633 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9634 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9635 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9636 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9637 variable definitions may be gone.
9638
9639 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9640 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9641 when compiling.
9642
9643 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9644 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9645 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9646 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9647 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9648 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9649 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9650
9651 @smallexample
9652 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9653 @end smallexample
9654
9655 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9656 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9657 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9658 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9659 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9660
9661 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9662 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9663 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9664 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9665
9666 @cindex no debug info variables
9667 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9668 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9669 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9670 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9671 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9672 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9673 example, in a C program:
9674
9675 @smallexample
9676 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9677 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9678 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9679 $1 = 3.14
9680 @end smallexample
9681
9682 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9683 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9684 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9685 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9686 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9687
9688 @smallexample
9689 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9690 29 i++;
9691 (gdb) next
9692 30 e (i);
9693 (gdb) print i
9694 $1 = 31
9695 (gdb) print i@@entry
9696 $2 = 30
9697 @end smallexample
9698
9699 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9700 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9701 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9702 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9703 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9704 For program code
9705
9706 @smallexample
9707 char var0[] = "A";
9708 signed char var1[] = "A";
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 You get during debugging
9712 @smallexample
9713 (gdb) print var0
9714 $1 = "A"
9715 (gdb) print var1
9716 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9717 @end smallexample
9718
9719 @node Arrays
9720 @section Artificial Arrays
9721
9722 @cindex artificial array
9723 @cindex arrays
9724 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9725 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9726 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9727 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9728 program.
9729
9730 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9731 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9732 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9733 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9734 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9735 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9736 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9737 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9738 example. If a program says
9739
9740 @smallexample
9741 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9742 @end smallexample
9743
9744 @noindent
9745 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9746
9747 @smallexample
9748 p *array@@len
9749 @end smallexample
9750
9751 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9752 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9753 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9754 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9755 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9756
9757 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9758 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9759 The value need not be in memory:
9760 @smallexample
9761 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9762 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9763 @end smallexample
9764
9765 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9766 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9767 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9768 @smallexample
9769 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9770 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9771 @end smallexample
9772
9773 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9774 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9775 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9776 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9777 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9778 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9779 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9780 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9781 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9782 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9783
9784 @smallexample
9785 set $i = 0
9786 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9787 @key{RET}
9788 @key{RET}
9789 @dots{}
9790 @end smallexample
9791
9792 @node Output Formats
9793 @section Output Formats
9794
9795 @cindex formatted output
9796 @cindex output formats
9797 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9798 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9799 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9800 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9801 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9802
9803 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9804 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9805 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9806 letters supported are:
9807
9808 @table @code
9809 @item x
9810 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9811 hexadecimal.
9812
9813 @item d
9814 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9815
9816 @item u
9817 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9818
9819 @item o
9820 Print as integer in octal.
9821
9822 @item t
9823 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9824 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9825 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9826 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9827
9828 @item a
9829 @cindex unknown address, locating
9830 @cindex locate address
9831 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9832 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9833 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9834
9835 @smallexample
9836 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9837 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9838 @end smallexample
9839
9840 @noindent
9841 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9842 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9843
9844 @item c
9845 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9846 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9847 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9848 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9849
9850 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9851 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9852 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9853 data.
9854
9855 @item f
9856 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9857 using typical floating point syntax.
9858
9859 @item s
9860 @cindex printing strings
9861 @cindex printing byte arrays
9862 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9863 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9864 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9865 natural types.
9866
9867 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9868 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9869 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9870 array.
9871
9872 @item z
9873 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9874 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9875 to the size of the integer type.
9876
9877 @item r
9878 @cindex raw printing
9879 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9880 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9881 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9882 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9883 pretty-printer which might exist.
9884 @end table
9885
9886 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9887
9888 @smallexample
9889 p/x $pc
9890 @end smallexample
9891
9892 @noindent
9893 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9894 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9895
9896 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9897 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9898 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9899
9900 @node Memory
9901 @section Examining Memory
9902
9903 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9904 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9905
9906 @cindex examining memory
9907 @table @code
9908 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9909 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9910 @itemx x @var{addr}
9911 @itemx x
9912 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9913 @end table
9914
9915 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9916 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9917 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9918 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9919 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9920
9921 @table @r
9922 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9923 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9924 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9925 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9926 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9927 @c 4.1.2.
9928
9929 @item @var{f}, the display format
9930 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9931 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9932 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9933 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9934 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9935
9936 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9937 The unit size is any of
9938
9939 @table @code
9940 @item b
9941 Bytes.
9942 @item h
9943 Halfwords (two bytes).
9944 @item w
9945 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9946 @item g
9947 Giant words (eight bytes).
9948 @end table
9949
9950 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9951 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9952 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9953 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9954 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9955 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9956 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9957 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9958 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9959 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9960 be altered.
9961
9962 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9963 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9964 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9965 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9966 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9967 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9968 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9969 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9970 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9971 a value from memory).
9972 @end table
9973
9974 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9975 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9976 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9977 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9978 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9979
9980 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9981 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9982 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9983
9984 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9985 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9986 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9987 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9988 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9989
9990 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9991 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9992 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9993 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9994 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9995 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9996 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9997 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9998 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9999
10000 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10001 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10002 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10003 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10004 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10005 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10006
10007 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10008 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10009 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10010 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10011 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10012 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10013 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10014
10015 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10016 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10017
10018 @smallexample
10019 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10020 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10021 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10022 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10023 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10024 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10028 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10029 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10030 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10031 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10032 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10033 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10034 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10035 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10036
10037 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10038 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10039 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10040
10041 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10042 @cindex addressable memory unit
10043 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10044 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10045 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10046 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10047 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10048 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10049 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10050 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10051 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10052
10053 @cindex remote memory comparison
10054 @cindex target memory comparison
10055 @cindex verify remote memory image
10056 @cindex verify target memory image
10057 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10058 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10059 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10060 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10061 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10062 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10063
10064 @table @code
10065 @kindex compare-sections
10066 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10067 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10068 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10069 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10070 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10071 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10072
10073 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10074 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10075 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10076 @end table
10077
10078 @node Auto Display
10079 @section Automatic Display
10080 @cindex automatic display
10081 @cindex display of expressions
10082
10083 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10084 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10085 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10086 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10087 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10088 The automatic display looks like this:
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 2: foo = 38
10092 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 @noindent
10096 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10097 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10098 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10099 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10100 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10101 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10102
10103 @table @code
10104 @kindex display
10105 @item display @var{expr}
10106 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10107 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10108
10109 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10110
10111 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10112 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10113 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10114 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10115 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10116
10117 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10118 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10119 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10120 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10121 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10122 @end table
10123
10124 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10125 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10126 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10127
10128 @table @code
10129 @kindex delete display
10130 @kindex undisplay
10131 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10132 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10133 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10134 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10135 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10136 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10137 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10138
10139 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10140 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10141
10142 @kindex disable display
10143 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10144 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10145 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10146 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10147 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10148 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10149 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10150 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10151
10152 @kindex enable display
10153 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10154 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10155 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10156 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10157 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10158 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10159 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10160
10161 @item display
10162 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10163 done when your program stops.
10164
10165 @kindex info display
10166 @item info display
10167 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10168 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10169 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10170 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10171 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10172 @end table
10173
10174 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10175 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10176 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10177 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10178 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10179 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10180 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10181 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10182 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10183 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10184 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10185
10186 @node Print Settings
10187 @section Print Settings
10188
10189 @cindex format options
10190 @cindex print settings
10191 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10192 and symbols are printed.
10193
10194 @noindent
10195 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10196
10197 @table @code
10198 @kindex set print
10199 @item set print address
10200 @itemx set print address on
10201 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10202 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10203 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10204 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10205 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10206 @code{set print address on}:
10207
10208 @smallexample
10209 @group
10210 (@value{GDBP}) f
10211 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10212 at input.c:530
10213 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10214 @end group
10215 @end smallexample
10216
10217 @item set print address off
10218 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10219 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10220
10221 @smallexample
10222 @group
10223 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10224 (@value{GDBP}) f
10225 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10226 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10227 @end group
10228 @end smallexample
10229
10230 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10231 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10232 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10233 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10234
10235 @kindex show print
10236 @item show print address
10237 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10238 @end table
10239
10240 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10241 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10242 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10243 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10244 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10245 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10246 it prints a symbolic address:
10247
10248 @table @code
10249 @item set print symbol-filename on
10250 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10251 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10252 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10253 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10254
10255 @item set print symbol-filename off
10256 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10257 default.
10258
10259 @item show print symbol-filename
10260 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10261 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10262 @end table
10263
10264 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10265 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10266 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10267
10268 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10269 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10270
10271 @table @code
10272 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10273 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10274 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10275 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10276 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10277 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10278 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10279 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10280
10281 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10282 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10283 symbolic address.
10284 @end table
10285
10286 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10287 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10288 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10289 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10290 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10291 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10292 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10293 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10294
10295 @smallexample
10296 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10297 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10298 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10299 @end smallexample
10300
10301 @quotation
10302 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10303 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10304 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10305 @end quotation
10306
10307 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10308 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10309
10310 @table @code
10311 @item set print symbol on
10312 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10313 one exists.
10314
10315 @item set print symbol off
10316 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10317 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10318 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10319
10320 @item show print symbol
10321 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10322 address.
10323 @end table
10324
10325 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10326
10327 @table @code
10328 @item set print array
10329 @itemx set print array on
10330 @cindex pretty print arrays
10331 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10332 but uses more space. The default is off.
10333
10334 @item set print array off
10335 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10336
10337 @item show print array
10338 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10339 arrays.
10340
10341 @cindex print array indexes
10342 @item set print array-indexes
10343 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10344 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10345 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10346 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10347
10348 @item set print array-indexes off
10349 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10350
10351 @item show print array-indexes
10352 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10353 arrays.
10354
10355 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10356 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10357 @cindex number of array elements to print
10358 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10359 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10360 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10361 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10362 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10363 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10364 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10365 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10366
10367 @item show print elements
10368 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10369 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10370
10371 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10372 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10373 @cindex printing frame argument values
10374 @cindex print all frame argument values
10375 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10376 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10377 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10378 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10379 values are:
10380
10381 @table @code
10382 @item all
10383 The values of all arguments are printed.
10384
10385 @item scalars
10386 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10387 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10388 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10389 only scalar arguments are shown:
10390
10391 @smallexample
10392 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10393 at frame-args.c:23
10394 @end smallexample
10395
10396 @item none
10397 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10398 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10399
10400 @smallexample
10401 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10402 at frame-args.c:23
10403 @end smallexample
10404 @end table
10405
10406 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10407 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10408 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10409 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10410 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10411 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10412 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10413 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10414 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10415 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10416
10417 @item show print frame-arguments
10418 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10419
10420 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10421 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10422
10423 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10424 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10425 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10426 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10427 This is the default.
10428
10429 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10430 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10431
10432 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10433 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10434 @kindex set print entry-values
10435 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10436 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10437 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10438 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10439 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10440
10441 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10442 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10443 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10444 @code{no} setting.
10445
10446 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10447 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10448 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10449 this information.
10450
10451 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10452
10453 @table @code
10454 @item no
10455 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10456 point.
10457 @smallexample
10458 #0 equal (val=5)
10459 #0 different (val=6)
10460 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10461 #0 born (val=10)
10462 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10463 @end smallexample
10464
10465 @item only
10466 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10467 values are never printed.
10468 @smallexample
10469 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10470 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10471 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10472 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10473 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10474 @end smallexample
10475
10476 @item preferred
10477 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10478 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10479 value for such parameter.
10480 @smallexample
10481 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10482 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10483 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10484 #0 born (val=10)
10485 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10486 @end smallexample
10487
10488 @item if-needed
10489 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10490 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10491 parameter.
10492 @smallexample
10493 #0 equal (val=5)
10494 #0 different (val=6)
10495 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10496 #0 born (val=10)
10497 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10498 @end smallexample
10499
10500 @item both
10501 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10502 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10503 optimizations.
10504 @smallexample
10505 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10506 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10507 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10508 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10509 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10510 @end smallexample
10511
10512 @item compact
10513 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10514 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10515 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10516 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10517 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10518 @smallexample
10519 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10520 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10521 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10522 #0 born (val=10)
10523 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10524 @end smallexample
10525
10526 @item default
10527 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10528 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10529 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10530 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10531 @smallexample
10532 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10533 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10534 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10535 #0 born (val=10)
10536 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10537 @end smallexample
10538 @end table
10539
10540 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10541 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10542
10543 @item show print entry-values
10544 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10545 entry.
10546
10547 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10548 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10549 @cindex repeated array elements
10550 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10551 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10552 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10553 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10554 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10555 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10556 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10557 is 10.
10558
10559 @item show print repeats
10560 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10561 elements.
10562
10563 @item set print null-stop
10564 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10565 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10566 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10567 contain only short strings.
10568 The default is off.
10569
10570 @item show print null-stop
10571 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10572 @sc{null} character.
10573
10574 @item set print pretty on
10575 @cindex print structures in indented form
10576 @cindex indentation in structure display
10577 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10578 per line, like this:
10579
10580 @smallexample
10581 @group
10582 $1 = @{
10583 next = 0x0,
10584 flags = @{
10585 sweet = 1,
10586 sour = 1
10587 @},
10588 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10589 @}
10590 @end group
10591 @end smallexample
10592
10593 @item set print pretty off
10594 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10595
10596 @smallexample
10597 @group
10598 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10599 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10600 @end group
10601 @end smallexample
10602
10603 @noindent
10604 This is the default format.
10605
10606 @item show print pretty
10607 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10608
10609 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10610 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10611 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10612 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10613 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10614 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10615 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10616 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10617
10618 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10619 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10620 international character sets, and is the default.
10621
10622 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10623 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10624
10625 @item set print union on
10626 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10627 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10628 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10629
10630 @item set print union off
10631 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10632 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10633 instead.
10634
10635 @item show print union
10636 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10637 structures and other unions.
10638
10639 For example, given the declarations
10640
10641 @smallexample
10642 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10643 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10644 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10645 Bug_forms;
10646
10647 struct thing @{
10648 Species it;
10649 union @{
10650 Tree_forms tree;
10651 Bug_forms bug;
10652 @} form;
10653 @};
10654
10655 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10656 @end smallexample
10657
10658 @noindent
10659 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10660
10661 @smallexample
10662 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10663 @end smallexample
10664
10665 @noindent
10666 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10667
10668 @smallexample
10669 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10670 @end smallexample
10671
10672 @noindent
10673 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10674 and in Pascal.
10675 @end table
10676
10677 @need 1000
10678 @noindent
10679 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10680
10681 @table @code
10682 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10683 @item set print demangle
10684 @itemx set print demangle on
10685 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10686 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10687 linkage. The default is on.
10688
10689 @item show print demangle
10690 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10691
10692 @item set print asm-demangle
10693 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10694 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10695 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10696 The default is off.
10697
10698 @item show print asm-demangle
10699 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10700 or demangled form.
10701
10702 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10703 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10704 @kindex set demangle-style
10705 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10706 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10707 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10708
10709 @table @code
10710 @item auto
10711 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10712 This is the default.
10713
10714 @item gnu
10715 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10716
10717 @item hp
10718 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10719
10720 @item lucid
10721 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10722
10723 @item arm
10724 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10725 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10726 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10727 require further enhancement to permit that.
10728
10729 @end table
10730 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10731
10732 @item show demangle-style
10733 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10734
10735 @item set print object
10736 @itemx set print object on
10737 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10738 @cindex display derived types
10739 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10740 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10741 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10742 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10743 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10744 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10745 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10746
10747 @item set print object off
10748 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10749 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10750
10751 @item show print object
10752 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10753
10754 @item set print static-members
10755 @itemx set print static-members on
10756 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10757 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10758
10759 @item set print static-members off
10760 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10761
10762 @item show print static-members
10763 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10764
10765 @item set print pascal_static-members
10766 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10767 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10768 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10769 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10770
10771 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10772 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10773
10774 @item show print pascal_static-members
10775 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10776
10777 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10778 @item set print vtbl
10779 @itemx set print vtbl on
10780 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10781 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10782 @cindex VTBL display
10783 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10784 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10785 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10786
10787 @item set print vtbl off
10788 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10789
10790 @item show print vtbl
10791 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10792 @end table
10793
10794 @node Pretty Printing
10795 @section Pretty Printing
10796
10797 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10798 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10799 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10800
10801 @menu
10802 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10803 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10804 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10805 @end menu
10806
10807 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10808 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10809
10810 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10811 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10812 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10813
10814 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10815 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10816 pretty-printers with their names.
10817 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10818 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10819 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10820 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10821
10822 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10823 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10824 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10825 do anything special.
10826
10827 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10828
10829 @itemize @bullet
10830 @item
10831 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10832 all inferiors.
10833
10834 @item
10835 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10836 when debugging that program.
10837 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10838
10839 @item
10840 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10841 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10842 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10843 @end itemize
10844
10845 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10846 pretty-printers are selected,
10847
10848 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10849 for new types.
10850
10851 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10852 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10853
10854 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10855
10856 @smallexample
10857 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10858 $1 = @{
10859 static npos = 4294967295,
10860 _M_dataplus = @{
10861 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10862 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10863 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10864 @},
10865 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10866 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10867 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10868 @}
10869 @}
10870 @end smallexample
10871
10872 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10873
10874 @smallexample
10875 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10876 $2 = "abcd"
10877 @end smallexample
10878
10879 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10880 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10881 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10882
10883 @table @code
10884 @kindex info pretty-printer
10885 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10886 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10887 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10888
10889 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10890 whose pretty-printers to list.
10891 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10892 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10893 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10894 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10895 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10896
10897 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10898 to list.
10899
10900 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10901 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10902 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10903 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10904
10905 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10906 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10907 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10908 @end table
10909
10910 Example:
10911
10912 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10913 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10914 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10915 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10916
10917 @smallexample
10918 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10919 library1.so:
10920 foo
10921 library2.so:
10922 bar
10923 bar1
10924 bar2
10925 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10926 library2.so:
10927 bar
10928 bar1
10929 bar2
10930 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10931 1 printer disabled
10932 2 of 3 printers enabled
10933 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10934 library1.so:
10935 foo [disabled]
10936 library2.so:
10937 bar
10938 bar1
10939 bar2
10940 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10941 1 printer disabled
10942 1 of 3 printers enabled
10943 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10944 library1.so:
10945 foo [disabled]
10946 library2.so:
10947 bar
10948 bar1 [disabled]
10949 bar2
10950 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10951 1 printer disabled
10952 0 of 3 printers enabled
10953 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10954 library1.so:
10955 foo [disabled]
10956 library2.so:
10957 bar [disabled]
10958 bar1 [disabled]
10959 bar2
10960 @end smallexample
10961
10962 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10963 as can each individual subprinter.
10964
10965 @node Value History
10966 @section Value History
10967
10968 @cindex value history
10969 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10970 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10971 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10972 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10973 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10974 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10975 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10976 symbol table.
10977
10978 @cindex @code{$}
10979 @cindex @code{$$}
10980 @cindex history number
10981 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10982 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10983 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10984 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10985 history number.
10986
10987 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10988 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10989 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10990 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10991 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10992 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10993 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10994
10995 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10996 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10997
10998 @smallexample
10999 p *$
11000 @end smallexample
11001
11002 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
11003 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
11004
11005 @smallexample
11006 p *$.next
11007 @end smallexample
11008
11009 @noindent
11010 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
11011 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
11012
11013 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
11014 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
11015
11016 @smallexample
11017 print x
11018 set x=5
11019 @end smallexample
11020
11021 @noindent
11022 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11023 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11024
11025 @table @code
11026 @kindex show values
11027 @item show values
11028 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11029 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11030 values} does not change the history.
11031
11032 @item show values @var{n}
11033 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11034
11035 @item show values +
11036 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11037 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11038 @end table
11039
11040 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11041 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11042
11043 @node Convenience Vars
11044 @section Convenience Variables
11045
11046 @cindex convenience variables
11047 @cindex user-defined variables
11048 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11049 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11050 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11051 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11052 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11053
11054 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11055 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11056 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11057 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11058 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11059
11060 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11061 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11062 For example:
11063
11064 @smallexample
11065 set $foo = *object_ptr
11066 @end smallexample
11067
11068 @noindent
11069 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11070 @code{object_ptr}.
11071
11072 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11073 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11074 value with another assignment at any time.
11075
11076 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11077 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11078 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11079 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11080
11081 @table @code
11082 @kindex show convenience
11083 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11084 @item show convenience
11085 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11086 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11087 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11088
11089 @kindex init-if-undefined
11090 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11091 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11092 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11093 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11094 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11095 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11096 override default values used in a command script.
11097
11098 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11099 any side-effects do not occur.
11100 @end table
11101
11102 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11103 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11104 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11105
11106 @smallexample
11107 set $i = 0
11108 print bar[$i++]->contents
11109 @end smallexample
11110
11111 @noindent
11112 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11113
11114 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11115 values likely to be useful.
11116
11117 @table @code
11118 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11119 @item $_
11120 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11121 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11122 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11123 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11124 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11125 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11126 to the type of @code{$__}.
11127
11128 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11129 @item $__
11130 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11131 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11132 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11133
11134 @item $_exitcode
11135 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11136 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11137 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11138 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11139
11140 @item $_exitsignal
11141 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11142 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11143 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11144 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11145
11146 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11147 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11148 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11149 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11150 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11151
11152 @smallexample
11153 #include <signal.h>
11154
11155 int
11156 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11157 @{
11158 raise (SIGALRM);
11159 return 0;
11160 @}
11161 @end smallexample
11162
11163 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11164 or signalled would be:
11165
11166 @smallexample
11167 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11168 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11169 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11170 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11171 >echo The program has exited\n
11172 >else
11173 >echo The program has signalled\n
11174 >end
11175 >end
11176 (@value{GDBP}) run
11177 Starting program:
11178
11179 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11180 The program no longer exists.
11181 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11182 The program has signalled
11183 @end smallexample
11184
11185 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11186 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11187 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11188 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11189
11190 @smallexample
11191 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11192 The program has exited
11193 @end smallexample
11194
11195 @item $_exception
11196 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11197 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11198
11199 @item $_probe_argc
11200 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11201 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11202
11203 @item $_sdata
11204 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11205 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11206 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11207 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11208 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11209
11210 @item $_siginfo
11211 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11212 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11213 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11214 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11215 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11216
11217 @item $_tlb
11218 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11219 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11220 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11221 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11222 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11223 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11224
11225 @item $_inferior
11226 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11227 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11228
11229 @item $_thread
11230 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11231
11232 @item $_gthread
11233 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11234
11235 @end table
11236
11237 @node Convenience Funs
11238 @section Convenience Functions
11239
11240 @cindex convenience functions
11241 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11242 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11243 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11244 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11245 @value{GDBN}.
11246
11247 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11248 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11249
11250 @table @code
11251
11252 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11253 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11254 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11255 returns zero.
11256
11257 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11258 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11259 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11260 it is @code{void}:
11261
11262 @smallexample
11263 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11264 $1 = void
11265 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11266 $2 = 1
11267 (@value{GDBP}) run
11268 Starting program: ./a.out
11269 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11270 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11271 $3 = 0
11272 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11273 $4 = 0
11274 @end smallexample
11275
11276 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11277 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11278 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11279 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11280 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11281 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11282 anymore.
11283
11284 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11285 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11286
11287 @smallexample
11288 void
11289 foo (void)
11290 @{
11291 @}
11292 @end smallexample
11293
11294 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11295
11296 @smallexample
11297 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11298 $1 = void
11299 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11300 $2 = 1
11301 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11302 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11303 $3 = void
11304 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11305 $4 = 1
11306 @end smallexample
11307
11308 @end table
11309
11310 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11311 @code{Python} support.
11312
11313 @table @code
11314
11315 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11316 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11317 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11318 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11319 Otherwise it returns zero.
11320
11321 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11322 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11323 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11324 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11325 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11326 regular expression support.
11327
11328 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11329 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11330 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11331 Otherwise it returns zero.
11332
11333 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11334 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11335 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11336
11337 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11338 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11339 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11340 Otherwise it returns zero.
11341
11342 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11343 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11344 The default is 1.
11345
11346 Example:
11347
11348 @smallexample
11349 (gdb) backtrace
11350 #0 bottom_func ()
11351 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11352 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11353 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11354 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11355 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11356 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11357 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11358 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11359 $1 = 1
11360 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11361 $1 = 1
11362 @end smallexample
11363
11364 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11365 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11366 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11367 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11368
11369 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11370 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11371 The default is 1.
11372
11373 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11374 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11375 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11376 Otherwise it returns zero.
11377
11378 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11379 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11380 The default is 1.
11381
11382 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11383 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11384 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11385 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11386
11387 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11388 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11389 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11390 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11391
11392 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11393 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11394 The default is 1.
11395
11396 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11397 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11398 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11399 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11400
11401 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11402 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11403 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11404
11405 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11406 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11407 an enumerated type:
11408
11409 @smallexample
11410 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11411 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11412 @end smallexample
11413
11414 @end table
11415
11416 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11417 convenience functions.
11418
11419 @table @code
11420 @item help function
11421 @kindex help function
11422 @cindex show all convenience functions
11423 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11424 @end table
11425
11426 @node Registers
11427 @section Registers
11428
11429 @cindex registers
11430 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11431 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11432 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11433 your machine.
11434
11435 @table @code
11436 @kindex info registers
11437 @item info registers
11438 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11439 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11440
11441 @kindex info all-registers
11442 @cindex floating point registers
11443 @item info all-registers
11444 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11445 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11446
11447 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11448 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11449 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11450 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11451
11452 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11453 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11454 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11455 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11456 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11457 @end table
11458
11459 @anchor{standard registers}
11460 @cindex stack pointer register
11461 @cindex program counter register
11462 @cindex process status register
11463 @cindex frame pointer register
11464 @cindex standard registers
11465 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11466 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11467 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11468 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11469 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11470 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11471 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11472 you could print the program counter in hex with
11473
11474 @smallexample
11475 p/x $pc
11476 @end smallexample
11477
11478 @noindent
11479 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11480
11481 @smallexample
11482 x/i $pc
11483 @end smallexample
11484
11485 @noindent
11486 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11487 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11488 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11489 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11490 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11491 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11492 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11493
11494 @smallexample
11495 set $sp += 4
11496 @end smallexample
11497
11498 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11499 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11500 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11501 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11502 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11503 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11504 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11505
11506 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11507 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11508 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11509 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11510 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11511 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11512 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11513
11514 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11515 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11516 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11517 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11518 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11519 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11520 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11521 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11522 prints the data in both formats.
11523
11524 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11525 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11526 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11527 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11528 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11529 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11530 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11531
11532 @smallexample
11533 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11534 $1 = @{
11535 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11536 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11537 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11538 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11539 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11540 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11541 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11542 @}
11543 @end smallexample
11544
11545 @noindent
11546 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11547 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11548 value to a @code{struct} member:
11549
11550 @smallexample
11551 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11552 @end smallexample
11553
11554 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11555 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11556 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11557 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11558 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11559 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11560
11561 @cindex caller-saved registers
11562 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11563 @cindex volatile registers
11564 @cindex <not saved> values
11565 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11566 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11567 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11568 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11569 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11570 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11571 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11572 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11573 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11574 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11575 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11576 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11577 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11578 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11579 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11580 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11581 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11582 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11583 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11584 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11585 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11586 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11587 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11588
11589 @node Floating Point Hardware
11590 @section Floating Point Hardware
11591 @cindex floating point
11592
11593 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11594 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11595
11596 @table @code
11597 @kindex info float
11598 @item info float
11599 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11600 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11601 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11602 the ARM and x86 machines.
11603 @end table
11604
11605 @node Vector Unit
11606 @section Vector Unit
11607 @cindex vector unit
11608
11609 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11610 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11611
11612 @table @code
11613 @kindex info vector
11614 @item info vector
11615 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11616 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11617 @end table
11618
11619 @node OS Information
11620 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11621 @cindex OS information
11622
11623 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11624 you debug your program.
11625
11626 @cindex auxiliary vector
11627 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11628 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11629 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11630 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11631 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11632 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11633 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11634 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11635 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11636 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11637 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11638 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11639
11640 @table @code
11641 @kindex info auxv
11642 @item info auxv
11643 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11644 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11645 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11646 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11647 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11648 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11649 an unrecognized tag.
11650 @end table
11651
11652 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11653 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11654 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11655 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11656 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11657 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11658 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11659
11660 @table @code
11661 @kindex info os
11662 @item info os @var{infotype}
11663
11664 Display OS information of the requested type.
11665
11666 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11667
11668 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11669 @table @code
11670 @kindex info os cpus
11671 @item cpus
11672 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11673 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11674 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11675 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11676 kernel initialization.
11677
11678 @kindex info os files
11679 @item files
11680 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11681 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11682 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11683 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11684
11685 @kindex info os modules
11686 @item modules
11687 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11688 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11689 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11690 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11691 in memory.
11692
11693 @kindex info os msg
11694 @item msg
11695 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11696 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11697 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11698 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11699 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11700 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11701 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11702 the message queue was last changed.
11703
11704 @kindex info os processes
11705 @item processes
11706 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11707 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11708 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11709 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11710 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11711 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11712
11713 @kindex info os procgroups
11714 @item procgroups
11715 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11716 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11717 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11718 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11719 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11720 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11721 and the process group leader is listed first.
11722
11723 @kindex info os semaphores
11724 @item semaphores
11725 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11726 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11727 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11728 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11729 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11730
11731 @kindex info os shm
11732 @item shm
11733 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11734 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11735 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11736 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11737 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11738 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11739 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11740
11741 @kindex info os sockets
11742 @item sockets
11743 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11744 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11745 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11746 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11747 connection.
11748
11749 @kindex info os threads
11750 @item threads
11751 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11752 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11753 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11754 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11755 process is not listed.
11756 @end table
11757
11758 @item info os
11759 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11760 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11761 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11762 types, this command will report an error.
11763 @end table
11764
11765 @node Memory Region Attributes
11766 @section Memory Region Attributes
11767 @cindex memory region attributes
11768
11769 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11770 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11771 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11772 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11773 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11774 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11775 user can override the fetched regions.
11776
11777 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11778 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11779 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11780 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11781 all memory.
11782
11783 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11784 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11785
11786 @table @code
11787 @kindex mem
11788 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11789 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11790 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11791 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11792 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11793 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11794
11795 @item mem auto
11796 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11797 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11798
11799 @kindex delete mem
11800 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11801 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11802 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11803
11804 @kindex disable mem
11805 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11806 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11807 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11808 It may be enabled again later.
11809
11810 @kindex enable mem
11811 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11812 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11813
11814 @kindex info mem
11815 @item info mem
11816 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11817 for each region:
11818
11819 @table @emph
11820 @item Memory Region Number
11821 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11822 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11823 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11824
11825 @item Lo Address
11826 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11827
11828 @item Hi Address
11829 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11830
11831 @item Attributes
11832 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11833 @end table
11834 @end table
11835
11836
11837 @subsection Attributes
11838
11839 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11840 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11841 write accesses to a memory region.
11842
11843 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11844 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11845 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11846
11847 @table @code
11848 @item ro
11849 Memory is read only.
11850 @item wo
11851 Memory is write only.
11852 @item rw
11853 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11854 @end table
11855
11856 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11857 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11858 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11859 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11860 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11861
11862 @table @code
11863 @item 8
11864 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11865 @item 16
11866 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11867 @item 32
11868 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11869 @item 64
11870 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11871 @end table
11872
11873 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11874 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11875 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11876 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11877 @c
11878 @c @table @code
11879 @c @item hwbreak
11880 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11881 @c @item swbreak (default)
11882 @c @end table
11883
11884 @subsubsection Data Cache
11885 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11886 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11887 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11888 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11889 registers.
11890
11891 @table @code
11892 @item cache
11893 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11894 @item nocache
11895 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11896 @end table
11897
11898 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11899 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11900 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11901 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11902 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11903
11904 @table @code
11905 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11906 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11907 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11908 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11909 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11910 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11911 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11912 The default value is @code{on}.
11913 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11914 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11915 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11916 @end table
11917
11918
11919 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11920 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11921 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11922 @c
11923 @c @table @code
11924 @c @item verify
11925 @c @item noverify (default)
11926 @c @end table
11927
11928 @node Dump/Restore Files
11929 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11930 @cindex dump/restore files
11931 @cindex append data to a file
11932 @cindex dump data to a file
11933 @cindex restore data from a file
11934
11935 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11936 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11937 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11938 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11939 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11940 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11941 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11942
11943 @table @code
11944
11945 @kindex dump
11946 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11947 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11948 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11949 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11950
11951 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11952 @table @code
11953 @item binary
11954 Raw binary form.
11955 @item ihex
11956 Intel hex format.
11957 @item srec
11958 Motorola S-record format.
11959 @item tekhex
11960 Tektronix Hex format.
11961 @item verilog
11962 Verilog Hex format.
11963 @end table
11964
11965 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11966 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11967 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11968 form.
11969
11970 @kindex append
11971 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11972 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11973 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11974 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11975 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11976
11977 @kindex restore
11978 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11979 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11980 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11981 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11982 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11983
11984 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11985 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11986 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11987 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11988 from that location.
11989
11990 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11991 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11992 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11993 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11994
11995 @end table
11996
11997 @node Core File Generation
11998 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11999 @cindex dump core from inferior
12000
12001 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
12002 image of a running process and its process status (register values
12003 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
12004 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
12005 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
12006 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
12007 the post-mortem debugging mode.
12008
12009 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12010 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12011 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12012
12013 @table @code
12014 @kindex gcore
12015 @kindex generate-core-file
12016 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12017 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12018 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12019 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12020 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12021 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12022
12023 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12024 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12025
12026 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12027 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12028 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12029 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12030 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12031
12032 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12033 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12034 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12035 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12036 Enable or disable the use of the file
12037 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12038 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12039 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12040 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12041
12042 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12043 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12044 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12045 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12046 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12047 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12048 about the bits that can be set in the
12049 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12050 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12051
12052 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12053 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12054 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12055 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12056 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12057 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12058 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12059 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12060
12061 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12062 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12063 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12064 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12065 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12066 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12067 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12068
12069 The default value is @code{off}.
12070 @end table
12071
12072 @node Character Sets
12073 @section Character Sets
12074 @cindex character sets
12075 @cindex charset
12076 @cindex translating between character sets
12077 @cindex host character set
12078 @cindex target character set
12079
12080 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12081 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12082 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12083 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12084 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12085 @dfn{target character set}.
12086
12087 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12088 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12089 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12090 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12091 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12092 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12093 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12094 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12095 character and string literals in expressions.
12096
12097 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12098 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12099 target-charset} command, described below.
12100
12101 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12102 support:
12103
12104 @table @code
12105 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12106 @kindex set target-charset
12107 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12108 list of supported target character sets, type
12109 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12110
12111 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12112 @kindex set host-charset
12113 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12114
12115 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12116 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12117 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12118 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12119 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12120
12121 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12122 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12123 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12124
12125 @item set charset @var{charset}
12126 @kindex set charset
12127 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12128 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12129 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12130 for both host and target.
12131
12132 @item show charset
12133 @kindex show charset
12134 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12135
12136 @item show host-charset
12137 @kindex show host-charset
12138 Show the name of the current host character set.
12139
12140 @item show target-charset
12141 @kindex show target-charset
12142 Show the name of the current target character set.
12143
12144 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12145 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12146 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12147 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12148 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12149 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12150
12151 @item show target-wide-charset
12152 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12153 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12154 @end table
12155
12156 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12157 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12158 @file{charset-test.c}:
12159
12160 @smallexample
12161 #include <stdio.h>
12162
12163 char ascii_hello[]
12164 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12165 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12166 char ibm1047_hello[]
12167 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12168 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12169
12170 main ()
12171 @{
12172 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12173 @}
12174 @end smallexample
12175
12176 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12177 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12178 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12179
12180 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12181
12182 @smallexample
12183 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12184 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12185 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12186 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12187 @dots{}
12188 (@value{GDBP})
12189 @end smallexample
12190
12191 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12192 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12193 strings:
12194
12195 @smallexample
12196 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12197 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12198 (@value{GDBP})
12199 @end smallexample
12200
12201 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12202 initial character set:
12203 @smallexample
12204 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12205 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12206 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12207 (@value{GDBP})
12208 @end smallexample
12209
12210 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12211 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12212 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12213 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12214 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12215
12216 @smallexample
12217 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12218 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12219 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12220 $2 = 72 'H'
12221 (@value{GDBP})
12222 @end smallexample
12223
12224 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12225 literals you use in expressions:
12226
12227 @smallexample
12228 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12229 $3 = 43 '+'
12230 (@value{GDBP})
12231 @end smallexample
12232
12233 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12234 character.
12235
12236 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12237 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12238 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12239
12240 @smallexample
12241 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12242 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12243 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12244 $5 = 200 '\310'
12245 (@value{GDBP})
12246 @end smallexample
12247
12248 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12249 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12250
12251 @smallexample
12252 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12253 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12254 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12255 @end smallexample
12256
12257 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12258 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12259 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12260 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12261 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12262
12263 @smallexample
12264 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12265 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12266 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12267 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12268 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12269 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12270 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12271 $7 = 72 '\110'
12272 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12273 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12274 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12275 $9 = 200 'H'
12276 (@value{GDBP})
12277 @end smallexample
12278
12279 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12280 string literals you use in expressions:
12281
12282 @smallexample
12283 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12284 $10 = 78 '+'
12285 (@value{GDBP})
12286 @end smallexample
12287
12288 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12289 character.
12290
12291 @node Caching Target Data
12292 @section Caching Data of Targets
12293 @cindex caching data of targets
12294
12295 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12296 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12297 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12298 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12299 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12300 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12301 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12302 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12303 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12304 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12305 is executing.
12306 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12307 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12308 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12309 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12310 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12311 in the code segment.
12312 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12313 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12314
12315 @table @code
12316 @kindex set remotecache
12317 @item set remotecache on
12318 @itemx set remotecache off
12319 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12320 with old scripts.
12321
12322 @kindex show remotecache
12323 @item show remotecache
12324 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12325
12326 @kindex set stack-cache
12327 @item set stack-cache on
12328 @itemx set stack-cache off
12329 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12330 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12331
12332 @kindex show stack-cache
12333 @item show stack-cache
12334 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12335
12336 @kindex set code-cache
12337 @item set code-cache on
12338 @itemx set code-cache off
12339 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12340 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12341 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12342
12343 @kindex show code-cache
12344 @item show code-cache
12345 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12346 accesses.
12347
12348 @kindex info dcache
12349 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12350 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12351 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12352 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12353 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12354 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12355
12356 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12357 printed in hex.
12358
12359 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12360 @cindex dcache size
12361 @kindex set dcache size
12362 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12363
12364 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12365 @cindex dcache line-size
12366 @kindex set dcache line-size
12367 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12368 Must be a power of 2.
12369
12370 @item show dcache size
12371 @kindex show dcache size
12372 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12373
12374 @item show dcache line-size
12375 @kindex show dcache line-size
12376 Show default size of dcache lines.
12377
12378 @end table
12379
12380 @node Searching Memory
12381 @section Search Memory
12382 @cindex searching memory
12383
12384 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12385 @code{find} command.
12386
12387 @table @code
12388 @kindex find
12389 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12390 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12391 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12392 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12393 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12394 @end table
12395
12396 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12397 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12398
12399 @table @r
12400 @item @var{s}, search query size
12401 The size of each search query value.
12402
12403 @table @code
12404 @item b
12405 bytes
12406 @item h
12407 halfwords (two bytes)
12408 @item w
12409 words (four bytes)
12410 @item g
12411 giant words (eight bytes)
12412 @end table
12413
12414 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12415 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12416 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12417 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12418 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12419
12420 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12421 value's type in the current language.
12422 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12423 pattern as a mixture of types.
12424 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12425 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12426 which is typically four bytes.
12427
12428 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12429 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12430 @end table
12431
12432 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12433 (@code{"}).
12434 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12435 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12436
12437 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12438 number of matches found.
12439
12440 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12441 @samp{$_}.
12442 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12443
12444 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12445
12446 @smallexample
12447 void
12448 hello ()
12449 @{
12450 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12451 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12452 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12453 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12454 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12455 @}
12456 @end smallexample
12457
12458 @noindent
12459 you get during debugging:
12460
12461 @smallexample
12462 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12463 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12464 1 pattern found
12465 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12466 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12467 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12468 2 patterns found.
12469 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12470 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12471 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12472 2 patterns found.
12473 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12474 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12475 1 pattern found
12476 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12477 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12478 1 pattern found
12479 (gdb) print $numfound
12480 $1 = 1
12481 (gdb) print $_
12482 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12483 @end smallexample
12484
12485 @node Value Sizes
12486 @section Value Sizes
12487
12488 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12489 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12490 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12491 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12492 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12493
12494 @table @code
12495 @kindex set max-value-size
12496 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12497 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12498 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12499 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12500 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12501
12502 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12503 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12504
12505 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12506 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12507 currently 16 bytes.
12508
12509 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12510 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12511 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12512 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12513 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12514 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12515 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12516 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12517
12518 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12519
12520 @kindex show max-value-size
12521 @item show max-value-size
12522 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12523 allocate for the contents of a value.
12524 @end table
12525
12526 @node Optimized Code
12527 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12528 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12529 @cindex debugging optimized code
12530
12531 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12532 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12533 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12534 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12535 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12536 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12537 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12538
12539 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12540 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12541 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12542 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12543
12544 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12545 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12546 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12547 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12548 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12549 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12550
12551 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12552 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12553 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12554 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12555 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12556
12557 @menu
12558 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12559 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12560 @end menu
12561
12562 @node Inline Functions
12563 @section Inline Functions
12564 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12565
12566 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12567 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12568 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12569 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12570 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12571 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12572 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12573 @code{info frame} command.
12574
12575 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12576 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12577 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12578 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12579 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12580 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12581 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12582 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12583 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12584 local variables in the caller.
12585
12586 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12587 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12588 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12589 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12590 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12591 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12592 instructions are executed.
12593
12594 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12595 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12596 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12597 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12598
12599 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12600 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12601
12602 @itemize @bullet
12603 @item
12604 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12605 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12606 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12607 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12608 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12609 or inside the inlined function instead.
12610
12611 @item
12612 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12613 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12614 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12615 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12616
12617 @end itemize
12618
12619 @node Tail Call Frames
12620 @section Tail Call Frames
12621 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12622
12623 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12624 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12625 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12626 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12627 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12628
12629 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12630 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12631 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12632 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12633 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12634 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12635 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12636
12637 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12638 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12639 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12640 this information.
12641
12642 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12643 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12644
12645 @smallexample
12646 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12647 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12648 (gdb) info frame
12649 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12650 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12651 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12652 source language c++.
12653 Arglist at unknown address.
12654 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12655 @end smallexample
12656
12657 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12658 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12659 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12660 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12661 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12662 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12663
12664 @table @code
12665 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12666 @item set debug entry-values
12667 @kindex set debug entry-values
12668 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12669 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12670 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12671 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12672 result.
12673
12674 @item show debug entry-values
12675 @kindex show debug entry-values
12676 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12677 values at function entry and tail calls.
12678 @end table
12679
12680 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12681 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12682 reference by variable @code{x}):
12683
12684 @smallexample
12685 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12686 void (*x) (void) = c;
12687 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12688 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12689 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12690
12691 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12692 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12693 a () at t.c:3
12694 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12695 (gdb) bt
12696 #0 a () at t.c:3
12697 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12698 @end smallexample
12699
12700 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12701
12702 @smallexample
12703 int i;
12704 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12705 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12706 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12707 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12708 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12709 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12710 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12711 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12712
12713 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12714 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12715 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12716 (gdb) bt
12717 #0 f () at t.c:2
12718 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12719 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12720 @end smallexample
12721
12722 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12723 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12724
12725 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12726 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12727 @set ARROW @click{}
12728 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12729 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12730 @end ifset
12731 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12732 @set ARROW ->
12733 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12734 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12735 @end ifclear
12736
12737 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12738 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12739 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12740
12741 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12742 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12743 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12744 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12745 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12746 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12747
12748 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12749 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12750 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12751 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12752 omitted.
12753
12754 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12755 entry may fail:
12756
12757 @smallexample
12758 int v;
12759 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12760 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12761 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12762 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12763 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12764 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12765
12766 (gdb) bt
12767 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12768 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12769 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12770 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12771 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12772 @end smallexample
12773
12774 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12775 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12776 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12777 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12778 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12779
12780 @node Macros
12781 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12782
12783 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12784 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12785 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12786 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12787 where it was defined.
12788
12789 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12790 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12791 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12792 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12793
12794 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12795 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12796 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12797 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12798 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12799 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12800 see @ref{List}.
12801
12802 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12803 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12804 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12805
12806 @table @code
12807
12808 @kindex macro expand
12809 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12810 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12811 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12812 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12813 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12814 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12815 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12816 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12817 it can be any string of tokens.
12818
12819 @kindex macro exp1
12820 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12821 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12822 @cindex expand macro once
12823 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12824 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12825 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12826 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12827 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12828 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12829 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12830 can be any string of tokens.
12831
12832 @kindex info macro
12833 @cindex macro definition, showing
12834 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12835 @cindex macros, from debug info
12836 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12837 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12838 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12839 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12840 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12841 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12842
12843 @kindex info macros
12844 @item info macros @var{location}
12845 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12846 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12847 command-line where those definitions were established.
12848
12849 @kindex macro define
12850 @cindex user-defined macros
12851 @cindex defining macros interactively
12852 @cindex macros, user-defined
12853 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12854 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12855 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12856 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12857 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12858 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12859 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12860 @var{arglist}.
12861
12862 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12863 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12864 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12865 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12866 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12867
12868 @kindex macro undef
12869 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12870 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12871 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12872 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12873 in the program being debugged.
12874
12875 @kindex macro list
12876 @item macro list
12877 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12878 @end table
12879
12880 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12881 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12882 show our source files:
12883
12884 @smallexample
12885 $ cat sample.c
12886 #include <stdio.h>
12887 #include "sample.h"
12888
12889 #define M 42
12890 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12891
12892 main ()
12893 @{
12894 #define N 28
12895 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12896 #undef N
12897 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12898 #define N 1729
12899 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12900 @}
12901 $ cat sample.h
12902 #define Q <
12903 $
12904 @end smallexample
12905
12906 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12907 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12908 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12909 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12910 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12911 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12912 information.
12913
12914 @smallexample
12915 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12916 $
12917 @end smallexample
12918
12919 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12920
12921 @smallexample
12922 $ gdb -nw sample
12923 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12924 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12925 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12926 (@value{GDBP})
12927 @end smallexample
12928
12929 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12930 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12931 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12932
12933 @smallexample
12934 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12935 3
12936 4 #define M 42
12937 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12938 6
12939 7 main ()
12940 8 @{
12941 9 #define N 28
12942 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12943 11 #undef N
12944 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12945 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12946 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12947 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12948 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12949 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12950 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12951 #define Q <
12952 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12953 expands to: (42 + 1)
12954 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12955 expands to: once (M + 1)
12956 (@value{GDBP})
12957 @end smallexample
12958
12959 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12960 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12961 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12962 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12963
12964 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12965 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12966
12967 @smallexample
12968 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12969 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12970 (@value{GDBP}) run
12971 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12972
12973 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12974 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12975 (@value{GDBP})
12976 @end smallexample
12977
12978 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12979
12980 @smallexample
12981 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12982 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12983 #define N 28
12984 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12985 expands to: 28 < 42
12986 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12987 $1 = 1
12988 (@value{GDBP})
12989 @end smallexample
12990
12991 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12992 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12993 thereof) in force at each point:
12994
12995 @smallexample
12996 (@value{GDBP}) next
12997 Hello, world!
12998 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12999 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13000 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
13001 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
13002 (@value{GDBP}) next
13003 We're so creative.
13004 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13005 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13006 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
13007 #define N 1729
13008 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13009 expands to: 1729 < 42
13010 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13011 $2 = 0
13012 (@value{GDBP})
13013 @end smallexample
13014
13015 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13016 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13017 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13018 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13019
13020 @smallexample
13021 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13022 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13023 -D__STDC__=1
13024 (@value{GDBP})
13025 @end smallexample
13026
13027
13028 @node Tracepoints
13029 @chapter Tracepoints
13030 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13031 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13032
13033 @cindex tracepoints
13034 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13035 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13036 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13037 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13038 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13039 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13040 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13041
13042 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13043 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13044 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13045 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13046 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13047 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13048 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13049 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13050 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13051 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13052 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13053
13054 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13055 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13056 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13057 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13058 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13059 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13060 Packets}.
13061
13062 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13063 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13064 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13065
13066 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13067
13068 @menu
13069 * Set Tracepoints::
13070 * Analyze Collected Data::
13071 * Tracepoint Variables::
13072 * Trace Files::
13073 @end menu
13074
13075 @node Set Tracepoints
13076 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13077
13078 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13079 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13080 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13081 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13082 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13083 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13084 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13085
13086 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13087 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13088 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13089 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13090 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13091 tracepoint was hit.
13092
13093 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13094 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13095 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13096 either.
13097
13098 @cindex fast tracepoints
13099 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13100 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13101 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13102
13103 @cindex static tracepoints
13104 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13105 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13106 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13107 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13108 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13109 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13110 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13111 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13112 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13113 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13114 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13115 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13116 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13117 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13118 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13119 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13120 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13121 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13122 static tracepoint marker.
13123
13124 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13125 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13126
13127 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13128 conditions and actions.
13129
13130 @menu
13131 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13132 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13133 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13134 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13135 * Trace State Variables::
13136 * Tracepoint Actions::
13137 * Listing Tracepoints::
13138 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13139 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13140 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13141 @end menu
13142
13143 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13144 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13145
13146 @table @code
13147 @cindex set tracepoint
13148 @kindex trace
13149 @item trace @var{location}
13150 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13151 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13152 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13153 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13154 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13155 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13156 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13157 in tracing}).
13158 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13159 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13160 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13161 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13162 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13163 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13164 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13165 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13166 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13167 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13168 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13169 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13170
13171 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13172
13173 @smallexample
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13175
13176 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13177
13178 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13179
13180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13181
13182 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13183 @end smallexample
13184
13185 @noindent
13186 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13187
13188 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13189 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13190 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13191 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13192 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13193 information on tracepoint conditions.
13194
13195 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13196 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13197 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13198 @kindex ftrace
13199 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13200 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13201 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13202 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13203 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13204 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13205 message.
13206
13207 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13208 @code{trace}.
13209
13210 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13211 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13212 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13213 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13214 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13215 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13216 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13217 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13218
13219 @example
13220 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13221 @end example
13222
13223 @noindent
13224 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13225 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13226
13227 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13228 @cindex set static tracepoint
13229 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13230 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13231 @kindex strace
13232 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13233 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13234 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13235 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13236 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13237
13238 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13239 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13240 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13241 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13242 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13243 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13244 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13245 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13246 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13247 tracing engine:
13248
13249 @smallexample
13250 main ()
13251 @{
13252 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13253 @}
13254 @end smallexample
13255
13256 @noindent
13257 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13258 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13259
13260 @smallexample
13261 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13262 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13263 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13264 Data: "str %s"
13265 [etc...]
13266 @end smallexample
13267
13268 @noindent
13269 so you may probe the marker above with:
13270
13271 @smallexample
13272 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13273 @end smallexample
13274
13275 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13276 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13277 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13278 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13279 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13280 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13281 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13282 the @samp{Data:} field.
13283
13284 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13285 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13286 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13287
13288 @vindex $tpnum
13289 @cindex last tracepoint number
13290 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13291 @cindex tracepoint number
13292 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13293 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13294
13295 @kindex delete tracepoint
13296 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13297 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13298 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13299 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13300 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13301
13302 Examples:
13303
13304 @smallexample
13305 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13306
13307 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13308 @end smallexample
13309
13310 @noindent
13311 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13312 @end table
13313
13314 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13315 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13316
13317 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13318
13319 @table @code
13320 @kindex disable tracepoint
13321 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13322 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13323 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13324 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13325 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13326 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13327 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13328 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13329 next trace experiment.
13330
13331 @kindex enable tracepoint
13332 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13333 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13334 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13335 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13336 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13337 next time a trace experiment is run.
13338 @end table
13339
13340 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13341 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13342
13343 @table @code
13344 @kindex passcount
13345 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13346 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13347 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13348 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13349 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13350 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13351 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13352 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13353 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13354 user.
13355
13356 Examples:
13357
13358 @smallexample
13359 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13360 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13361
13362 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13363 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13364 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13365 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13366 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13367 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13368 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13369 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13370 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13371 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13372 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13373 @end smallexample
13374 @end table
13375
13376 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13377 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13378 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13379 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13380
13381 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13382 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13383 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13384 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13385 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13386 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13387 is true.
13388
13389 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13390 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13391 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13392 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13393 just as with breakpoints.
13394
13395 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13396 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13397 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13398 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13399 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13400 accesses, and so forth.
13401
13402 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13403 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13404 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13405 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13406 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13407 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13408 search through.
13409
13410 @smallexample
13411 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13412 @end smallexample
13413
13414 @node Trace State Variables
13415 @subsection Trace State Variables
13416 @cindex trace state variables
13417
13418 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13419 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13420 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13421 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13422 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13423 integers.
13424
13425 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13426 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13427 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13428 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13429
13430 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13431 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13432 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13433 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13434 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13435 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13436 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13437 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13438 variable with the same name.
13439
13440 @table @code
13441
13442 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13443 @kindex tvariable
13444 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13445 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13446 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13447 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13448 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13449 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13450 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13451 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13452 value. The default initial value is 0.
13453
13454 @item info tvariables
13455 @kindex info tvariables
13456 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13457 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13458 currently running.
13459
13460 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13461 @kindex delete tvariable
13462 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13463 are specified.
13464
13465 @end table
13466
13467 @node Tracepoint Actions
13468 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13469
13470 @table @code
13471 @kindex actions
13472 @cindex tracepoint actions
13473 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13474 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13475 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13476 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13477 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13478 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13479 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13480 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13481 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13482 @code{while-stepping}.
13483
13484 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13485 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13486 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13487
13488 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13489 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13490 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13491
13492 @smallexample
13493 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13494
13495 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13496
13497 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13498 @end smallexample
13499
13500 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13501 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13502 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13503 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13504 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13505 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13506 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13507 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13508
13509 @smallexample
13510 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13511 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13512 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13513 > collect bar,baz
13514 > collect $regs
13515 > while-stepping 12
13516 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13517 > end
13518 end
13519 @end smallexample
13520
13521 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13522 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13523 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13524 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13525 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13526 special arguments are supported:
13527
13528 @table @code
13529 @item $regs
13530 Collect all registers.
13531
13532 @item $args
13533 Collect all function arguments.
13534
13535 @item $locals
13536 Collect all local variables.
13537
13538 @item $_ret
13539 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13540 of a backtrace.
13541
13542 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13543 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13544 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13545 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13546 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13547 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13548
13549 @item $_probe_argc
13550 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13551 tracepoint is located.
13552 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13553
13554 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13555 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13556 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13557 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13558
13559 @item $_sdata
13560 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13561 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13562 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13563 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13564 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13565 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13566 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13567 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13568 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13569
13570 @smallexample
13571 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13572 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13573 @end smallexample
13574
13575 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13576 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13577 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13578 @value{GDBN}.
13579 @end table
13580
13581 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13582 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13583 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13584
13585 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13586 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13587 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13588 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13589 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13590 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13591 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13592 @samp{mystr}.
13593
13594 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13595 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13596
13597 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13598 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13599 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13600 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13601 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13602 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13603 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13604 action were used.
13605
13606 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13607 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13608 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13609 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13610 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13611 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13612
13613 @smallexample
13614 > while-stepping 12
13615 > collect $regs, myglobal
13616 > end
13617 >
13618 @end smallexample
13619
13620 @noindent
13621 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13622 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13623 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13624 @code{stepping}.
13625
13626 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13627 @kindex set default-collect
13628 @cindex default collection action
13629 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13630 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13631 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13632 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13633 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13634 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13635
13636 @item show default-collect
13637 @kindex show default-collect
13638 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13639 tracepoint hit.
13640
13641 @end table
13642
13643 @node Listing Tracepoints
13644 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13645
13646 @table @code
13647 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13648 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13649 @cindex information about tracepoints
13650 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13651 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13652 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13653 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13654 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13655 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13656
13657 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13658 tracing:
13659
13660 @itemize @bullet
13661 @item
13662 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13663
13664 @item
13665 the state about installed on target of each location
13666 @end itemize
13667
13668 @smallexample
13669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13670 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13671 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13672 while-stepping 20
13673 collect globfoo, $regs
13674 end
13675 collect globfoo2
13676 end
13677 pass count 1200
13678 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13679 collect $eip
13680 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13681 installed on target
13682 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13683 installed on target
13684 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13685 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13686 not installed on target
13687 (@value{GDBP})
13688 @end smallexample
13689
13690 @noindent
13691 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13692 @end table
13693
13694 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13695 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13696
13697 @table @code
13698 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13699 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13700 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13701 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13702 program.
13703
13704 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13705
13706 @table @emph
13707 @item Count
13708 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13709 stable identifier.
13710 @item ID
13711 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13712 @item Enabled or Disabled
13713 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13714 that are not enabled.
13715 @item Address
13716 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13717 @item What
13718 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13719 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13720 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13721 will be left blank.
13722 @end table
13723
13724 @noindent
13725 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13726
13727 @table @emph
13728 @item Data
13729 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13730 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13731 marker call.
13732 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13733 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13734 @end table
13735
13736 @smallexample
13737 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13738 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13739 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13740 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13741 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13742 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13743 Data: str %s
13744 (@value{GDBP})
13745 @end smallexample
13746 @end table
13747
13748 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13749 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13750
13751 @table @code
13752 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13753 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13754 @cindex collected data discarded
13755 @item tstart
13756 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13757 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13758 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13759 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13760 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13761 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13762 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13763 information, and so forth.
13764
13765 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13766 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13767 @item tstop
13768 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13769 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13770 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13771 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13772 needs to be stopped quickly.
13773
13774 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13775 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13776 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13777
13778 @kindex tstatus
13779 @cindex status of trace data collection
13780 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13781 @item tstatus
13782 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13783 collection.
13784 @end table
13785
13786 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13787
13788 @smallexample
13789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13791 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13792 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13793 > while-stepping 11
13794 > collect $regs
13795 > end
13796 > end
13797 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13798 [time passes @dots{}]
13799 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13800 @end smallexample
13801
13802 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13803 @cindex disconnected tracing
13804 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13805 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13806 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13807 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13808 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13809 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13810 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13811 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13812
13813 @table @code
13814 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13815 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13816 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13817 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13818 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13819 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13820 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13821 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13822
13823 @item show disconnected-tracing
13824 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13825 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13826
13827 @end table
13828
13829 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13830 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13831 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13832 it will continue after reconnection.
13833
13834 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13835 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13836 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13837 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13838 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13839 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13840 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13841 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13842 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13843 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13844
13845 @cindex circular trace buffer
13846 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13847 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13848 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13849 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13850 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13851 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13852 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13853 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13854 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13855 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13856 the next run.
13857
13858 @table @code
13859 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13860 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13861 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13862 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13863 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13864 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13865 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13866
13867 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13868 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13869 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13870 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13871 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13872 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13873
13874 @end table
13875
13876 @table @code
13877 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13878 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13879 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13880 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13881 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13882 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13883 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13884 likes. This is also the default.
13885
13886 @item show trace-buffer-size
13887 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13888 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13889 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13890 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13891 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13892 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13893 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13894 @end table
13895
13896 @table @code
13897 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13898 @kindex set trace-user
13899
13900 @item show trace-user
13901 @kindex show trace-user
13902
13903 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13904 @kindex set trace-notes
13905 Set the trace run's notes.
13906
13907 @item show trace-notes
13908 @kindex show trace-notes
13909 Show the trace run's notes.
13910
13911 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13912 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13913 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13914 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13915 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13916
13917 @item show trace-stop-notes
13918 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13919 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13920
13921 @end table
13922
13923 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13924 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13925
13926 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13927 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13928 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13929 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13930 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13931 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13932 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13933 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13934 mentioned here.
13935
13936 @itemize @bullet
13937
13938 @item
13939 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13940 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13941 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13942 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13943 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13944 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13945 cannot be collected either.
13946
13947 @item
13948 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13949 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13950 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13951 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13952 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13953 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13954 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13955 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13956 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13957 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13958
13959 @item
13960 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13961 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13962 in a misleading way.
13963
13964 @item
13965 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13966 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13967 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13968 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13969 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13970 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13971 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13972 by @code{ptr}.
13973
13974 @item
13975 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13976 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13977 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13978 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13979 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13980 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13981 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13982 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13983 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13984 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13985 invalid address.
13986
13987 @item
13988 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13989 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13990 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13991 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13992 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13993 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13994 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13995 it to zero.
13996
13997 @end itemize
13998
13999 @node Analyze Collected Data
14000 @section Using the Collected Data
14001
14002 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
14003 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
14004 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
14005 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
14006 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
14007 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
14008 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
14009 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14010 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14011 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14012 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14013 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14014 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14015 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14016 the buffer will fail.
14017
14018 @menu
14019 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14020 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14021 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14022 @end menu
14023
14024 @node tfind
14025 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14026
14027 @kindex tfind
14028 @cindex select trace snapshot
14029 @cindex find trace snapshot
14030 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14031 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14032 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14033 snapshot is selected.
14034
14035 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14036
14037 @table @code
14038 @item tfind start
14039 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14040 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14041
14042 @item tfind none
14043 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14044
14045 @item tfind end
14046 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14047
14048 @item tfind
14049 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14050 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14051
14052 @item tfind -
14053 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14054 retracing earlier steps.
14055
14056 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14057 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14058 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14059 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14060 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14061
14062 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14063 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14064 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14065 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14066 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14067
14068 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14069 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14070 addresses (exclusive).
14071
14072 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14073 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14074 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14075
14076 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14077 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14078 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14079 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14080 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14081 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14082 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14083 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14084 @end table
14085
14086 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14087 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14088 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14089 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14090 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14091 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14092 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14093 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14094 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14095 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14096 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14097 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14098 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14099 tracepoint as the current one.
14100
14101 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14102 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14103 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14104 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14105 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14106
14107 @smallexample
14108 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14109 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14110 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14111 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14112 > tfind
14113 > end
14114
14115 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14116 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14117 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14118 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14119 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14120 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14121 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14122 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14123 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14124 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14125 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14126 @end smallexample
14127
14128 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14129 the buffer:
14130
14131 @smallexample
14132 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14133 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14134 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14135 > tfind line
14136 > end
14137
14138 Frame 0, X = 1
14139 Frame 7, X = 2
14140 Frame 13, X = 255
14141 @end smallexample
14142
14143 @node tdump
14144 @subsection @code{tdump}
14145 @kindex tdump
14146 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14147 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14148
14149 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14150 the current trace snapshot.
14151
14152 @smallexample
14153 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14154 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14155 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14156 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14157 > end
14158
14159 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14160
14161 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14162 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14163 at gdb_test.c:444
14164 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14165
14166 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14167 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14168 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14169 d1 0x18 24
14170 d2 0x80 128
14171 d3 0x33 51
14172 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14173 d5 0x22 34
14174 d6 0xe0 224
14175 d7 0x380035 3670069
14176 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14177 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14178 a2 0x100 256
14179 a3 0x322000 3284992
14180 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14181 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14182 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14183 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14184 ps 0x0 0
14185 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14186 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14187 fpstatus 0x0 0
14188 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14189 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14190 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14191 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14192 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14193 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14194 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14195 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14196 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14197
14198 (@value{GDBP})
14199 @end smallexample
14200
14201 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14202 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14203 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14204 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14205
14206 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14207 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14208 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14209 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14210 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14211 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14212 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14213 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14214 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14215 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14216
14217 @node save tracepoints
14218 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14219 @kindex save tracepoints
14220 @kindex save-tracepoints
14221 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14222
14223 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14224 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14225 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14226 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14227 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14228 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14229
14230 @node Tracepoint Variables
14231 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14232 @cindex tracepoint variables
14233 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14234
14235 @table @code
14236 @vindex $trace_frame
14237 @item (int) $trace_frame
14238 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14239 snapshot is selected.
14240
14241 @vindex $tracepoint
14242 @item (int) $tracepoint
14243 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14244
14245 @vindex $trace_line
14246 @item (int) $trace_line
14247 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14248
14249 @vindex $trace_file
14250 @item (char []) $trace_file
14251 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14252
14253 @vindex $trace_func
14254 @item (char []) $trace_func
14255 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14256 @end table
14257
14258 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14259 use @code{output} instead.
14260
14261 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14262 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14263 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14264 which are managed by the target.
14265
14266 @smallexample
14267 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14268
14269 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14270 > output $trace_file
14271 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14272 > tfind
14273 > end
14274 @end smallexample
14275
14276 @node Trace Files
14277 @section Using Trace Files
14278 @cindex trace files
14279
14280 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14281 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14282 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14283 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14284 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14285
14286 @table @code
14287
14288 @kindex tsave
14289 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14290 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14291 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14292 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14293 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14294 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14295 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14296 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14297 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14298 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14299 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14300 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14301 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14302 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14303 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14304
14305 @kindex target tfile
14306 @kindex tfile
14307 @kindex target ctf
14308 @kindex ctf
14309 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14310 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14311 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14312 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14313 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14314 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14315 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14316 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14317 the host.
14318
14319 @smallexample
14320 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14321 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14322 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14323 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14324 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14325 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14326 i = 0
14327 a = 0
14328 b = 1 '\001'
14329 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14330 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14331 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14332 $1 = 1
14333 @end smallexample
14334
14335 @end table
14336
14337 @node Overlays
14338 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14339 @cindex overlays
14340
14341 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14342 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14343 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14344 use overlays.
14345
14346 @menu
14347 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14348 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14349 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14350 mapped by asking the inferior.
14351 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14352 @end menu
14353
14354 @node How Overlays Work
14355 @section How Overlays Work
14356 @cindex mapped overlays
14357 @cindex unmapped overlays
14358 @cindex load address, overlay's
14359 @cindex mapped address
14360 @cindex overlay area
14361
14362 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14363 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14364 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14365 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14366 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14367
14368 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14369 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14370 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14371 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14372 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14373 largest overlay as well.
14374
14375 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14376 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14377 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14378 there.
14379
14380 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14381 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14382 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14383
14384 @smallexample
14385 @group
14386 Data Instruction Larger
14387 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14388 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14389 | | | | | |
14390 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14391 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14392 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14393 | and heap | | | | | |
14394 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14395 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14396 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14397 | | | | | |
14398 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14399 address | | | | | |
14400 | overlay | <-' | | |
14401 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14402 | | <---. | | load address
14403 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14404 | | | |
14405 +-----------+ | |
14406 +-----------+
14407 | |
14408 +-----------+
14409
14410 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14411 @end group
14412 @end smallexample
14413
14414 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14415 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14416 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14417 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14418 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14419 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14420 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14421 program and the overlay area.
14422
14423 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14424 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14425 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14426 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14427 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14428 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14429 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14430
14431 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14432 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14433 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14434
14435 @itemize @bullet
14436
14437 @item
14438 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14439 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14440 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14441 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14442
14443 @item
14444 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14445 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14446 your program's performance.
14447
14448 @item
14449 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14450 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14451 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14452 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14453 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14454 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14455 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14456
14457 @item
14458 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14459 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14460 instruction and data spaces.
14461
14462 @end itemize
14463
14464 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14465 improved in many ways:
14466
14467 @itemize @bullet
14468
14469 @item
14470 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14471 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14472 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14473 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14474 area in the usual way.
14475
14476 @item
14477 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14478 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14479
14480 @item
14481 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14482 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14483 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14484 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14485 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14486 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14487 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14488
14489 @end itemize
14490
14491
14492 @node Overlay Commands
14493 @section Overlay Commands
14494
14495 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14496 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14497 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14498 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14499 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14500 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14501
14502 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14503 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14504
14505 @table @code
14506 @item overlay off
14507 @kindex overlay
14508 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14509 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14510 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14511 overlay support is disabled.
14512
14513 @item overlay manual
14514 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14515 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14516 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14517 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14518 commands described below.
14519
14520 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14521 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14522 @cindex map an overlay
14523 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14524 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14525 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14526 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14527 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14528 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14529
14530 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14531 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14532 @cindex unmap an overlay
14533 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14534 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14535 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14536 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14537
14538 @item overlay auto
14539 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14540 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14541 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14542 Overlay Debugging}.
14543
14544 @item overlay load-target
14545 @itemx overlay load
14546 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14547 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14548 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14549 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14550 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14551 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14552
14553 @item overlay list-overlays
14554 @itemx overlay list
14555 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14556 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14557 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14558
14559 @end table
14560
14561 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14562 of the function the address falls in:
14563
14564 @smallexample
14565 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14566 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14567 @end smallexample
14568 @noindent
14569 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14570 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14571 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14572 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14573
14574 @smallexample
14575 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14576 No sections are mapped.
14577 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14578 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14579 @end smallexample
14580 @noindent
14581 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14582 name normally:
14583
14584 @smallexample
14585 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14586 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14587 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14588 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14589 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14590 @end smallexample
14591
14592 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14593 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14594 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14595 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14596 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14597
14598 @itemize @bullet
14599 @item
14600 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14601 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14602 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14603 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14604 @item
14605 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14606 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14607 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14608 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14609 breakpoints properly.
14610 @end itemize
14611
14612
14613 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14614 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14615 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14616
14617 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14618 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14619 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14620 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14621 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14622 current state of the overlays.
14623
14624 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14625 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14626
14627 @table @asis
14628
14629 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14630 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14631
14632 @smallexample
14633 struct
14634 @{
14635 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14636 unsigned long vma;
14637
14638 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14639 unsigned long size;
14640
14641 /* The overlay's load address. */
14642 unsigned long lma;
14643
14644 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14645 zero otherwise. */
14646 unsigned long mapped;
14647 @}
14648 @end smallexample
14649
14650 @item @code{_novlys}:
14651 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14652 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14653
14654 @end table
14655
14656 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14657 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14658 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14659 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14660 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14661 currently mapped.
14662
14663 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14664 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14665 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14666 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14667 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14668 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14669 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14670 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14671 are not being executed.
14672
14673 @node Overlay Sample Program
14674 @section Overlay Sample Program
14675 @cindex overlay example program
14676
14677 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14678 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14679 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14680 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14681 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14682 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14683 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14684
14685 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14686 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14687 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14688 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14689
14690 @table @file
14691 @item overlays.c
14692 The main program file.
14693 @item ovlymgr.c
14694 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14695 @item foo.c
14696 @itemx bar.c
14697 @itemx baz.c
14698 @itemx grbx.c
14699 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14700 @item d10v.ld
14701 @itemx m32r.ld
14702 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14703 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14704 @end table
14705
14706 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14707 cross-compiler like this:
14708
14709 @smallexample
14710 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14711 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14712 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14713 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14714 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14715 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14716 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14717 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14718 @end smallexample
14719
14720 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14721 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14722 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14723
14724
14725 @node Languages
14726 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14727 @cindex languages
14728
14729 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14730 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14731 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14732 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14733 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14734 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14735
14736 @cindex working language
14737 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14738 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14739 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14740 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14741 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14742 language}.
14743
14744 @menu
14745 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14746 * Show:: Displaying the language
14747 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14748 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14749 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14750 @end menu
14751
14752 @node Setting
14753 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14754
14755 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14756 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14757 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14758 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14759 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14760 are printed, etc.
14761
14762 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14763 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14764 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14765 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14766 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14767 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14768 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14769 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14770 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14771 Displaying the Language}.
14772
14773 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14774 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14775 another language. In that case, make the
14776 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14777 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14778 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14779
14780 @menu
14781 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14782 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14783 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14784 @end menu
14785
14786 @node Filenames
14787 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14788
14789 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14790 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14791
14792 @table @file
14793 @item .ada
14794 @itemx .ads
14795 @itemx .adb
14796 @itemx .a
14797 Ada source file.
14798
14799 @item .c
14800 C source file
14801
14802 @item .C
14803 @itemx .cc
14804 @itemx .cp
14805 @itemx .cpp
14806 @itemx .cxx
14807 @itemx .c++
14808 C@t{++} source file
14809
14810 @item .d
14811 D source file
14812
14813 @item .m
14814 Objective-C source file
14815
14816 @item .f
14817 @itemx .F
14818 Fortran source file
14819
14820 @item .mod
14821 Modula-2 source file
14822
14823 @item .s
14824 @itemx .S
14825 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14826 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14827 @end table
14828
14829 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14830 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14831
14832 @node Manually
14833 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14834
14835 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14836 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14837 your program.
14838
14839 @kindex set language
14840 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14841 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14842 a language, such as
14843 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14844 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14845
14846 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14847 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14848 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14849 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14850 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14851 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14852 command such as:
14853
14854 @smallexample
14855 print a = b + c
14856 @end smallexample
14857
14858 @noindent
14859 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14860 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14861 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14862 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14863
14864 @node Automatically
14865 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14866
14867 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14868 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14869 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14870 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14871 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14872 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14873 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14874 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14875 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14876
14877 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14878 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14879 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14880 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14881 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14882
14883 @node Show
14884 @section Displaying the Language
14885
14886 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14887 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14888
14889 @table @code
14890 @item show language
14891 @anchor{show language}
14892 @kindex show language
14893 Display the current working language. This is the
14894 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14895 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14896
14897 @item info frame
14898 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14899 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14900 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14901 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14902 information listed here.
14903
14904 @item info source
14905 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14906 Display the source language of this source file.
14907 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14908 information listed here.
14909 @end table
14910
14911 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14912 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14913 with a language explicitly:
14914
14915 @table @code
14916 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14917 @kindex set extension-language
14918 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14919 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14920
14921 @item info extensions
14922 @kindex info extensions
14923 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14924 @end table
14925
14926 @node Checks
14927 @section Type and Range Checking
14928
14929 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14930 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14931 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14932 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14933 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14934 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14935 errors when your program is running.
14936
14937 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14938 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14939 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14940 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14941
14942 @menu
14943 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14944 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14945 @end menu
14946
14947 @cindex type checking
14948 @cindex checks, type
14949 @node Type Checking
14950 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14951
14952 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14953 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14954 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14955 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14956
14957 @smallexample
14958 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14959
14960 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14961 $1 = 2
14962 @exdent but
14963 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14964 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14965 @end smallexample
14966
14967 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14968 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14969
14970 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14971 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14972 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14973 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14974 expressions like the second example above.
14975
14976 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14977 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14978 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14979 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14980 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14981 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14982
14983 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14984
14985 @kindex set check type
14986 @kindex show check type
14987 @table @code
14988 @item set check type on
14989 @itemx set check type off
14990 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14991 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14992 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14993
14994 @item show check type
14995 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14996 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14997 @end table
14998
14999 @cindex range checking
15000 @cindex checks, range
15001 @node Range Checking
15002 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
15003
15004 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
15005 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
15006 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
15007 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
15008 not exceed the bounds of the array.
15009
15010 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15011 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15012 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15013 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15014
15015 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15016 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15017 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15018 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15019 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15020 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15021
15022 @smallexample
15023 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15024 @end smallexample
15025
15026 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15027 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15028 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15029
15030 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15031
15032 @kindex set check range
15033 @kindex show check range
15034 @table @code
15035 @item set check range auto
15036 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15037 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15038 each language.
15039
15040 @item set check range on
15041 @itemx set check range off
15042 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15043 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15044 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15045 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15046
15047 @item set check range warn
15048 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15049 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15050 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15051 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15052 systems).
15053
15054 @item show range
15055 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15056 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15057 @end table
15058
15059 @node Supported Languages
15060 @section Supported Languages
15061
15062 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15063 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15064 @c This is false ...
15065 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15066 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15067 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15068 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15069 language.
15070
15071 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15072 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15073 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15074 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15075 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15076 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15077 language reference or tutorial.
15078
15079 @menu
15080 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15081 * D:: D
15082 * Go:: Go
15083 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15084 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15085 * Fortran:: Fortran
15086 * Pascal:: Pascal
15087 * Rust:: Rust
15088 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15089 * Ada:: Ada
15090 @end menu
15091
15092 @node C
15093 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15094
15095 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15096 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15097
15098 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15099 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15100 together.
15101
15102 @cindex C@t{++}
15103 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15104 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15105 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15106 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15107 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15108 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15109 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15110
15111 @menu
15112 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15113 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15114 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15115 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15116 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15117 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15118 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15119 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15120 @end menu
15121
15122 @node C Operators
15123 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15124
15125 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15126
15127 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15128 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15129 often defined on groups of types.
15130
15131 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15132
15133 @itemize @bullet
15134
15135 @item
15136 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15137 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15138
15139 @item
15140 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15141 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15142
15143 @item
15144 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15145
15146 @item
15147 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15148
15149 @end itemize
15150
15151 @noindent
15152 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15153 in order of increasing precedence:
15154
15155 @table @code
15156 @item ,
15157 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15158 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15159 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15160
15161 @item =
15162 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15163 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15164
15165 @item @var{op}=
15166 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15167 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15168 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15169 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15170 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15171
15172 @item ?:
15173 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15174 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15175 should be of an integral type.
15176
15177 @item ||
15178 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15179
15180 @item &&
15181 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15182
15183 @item |
15184 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15185
15186 @item ^
15187 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15188
15189 @item &
15190 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15191
15192 @item ==@r{, }!=
15193 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15194 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15195
15196 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15197 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15198 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15199 and non-zero for true.
15200
15201 @item <<@r{, }>>
15202 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15203
15204 @item @@
15205 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15206
15207 @item +@r{, }-
15208 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15209 pointer types.
15210
15211 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15212 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15213 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15214 integral types.
15215
15216 @item ++@r{, }--
15217 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15218 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15219 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15220 operation takes place.
15221
15222 @item *
15223 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15224 @code{++}.
15225
15226 @item &
15227 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15228
15229 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15230 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15231 to examine the address
15232 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15233 stored.
15234
15235 @item -
15236 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15237 precedence as @code{++}.
15238
15239 @item !
15240 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15241 @code{++}.
15242
15243 @item ~
15244 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15245 @code{++}.
15246
15247
15248 @item .@r{, }->
15249 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15250 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15251 pointer based on the stored type information.
15252 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15253
15254 @item .*@r{, }->*
15255 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15256
15257 @item []
15258 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15259 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15260
15261 @item ()
15262 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15263
15264 @item ::
15265 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15266 and @code{class} types.
15267
15268 @item ::
15269 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15270 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15271 above.
15272 @end table
15273
15274 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15275 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15276 predefined meaning.
15277
15278 @node C Constants
15279 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15280
15281 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15282
15283 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15284 following ways:
15285
15286 @itemize @bullet
15287 @item
15288 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15289 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15290 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15291 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15292 @code{long} value.
15293
15294 @item
15295 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15296 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15297 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15298 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15299 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15300 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15301 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15302 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15303 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15304 constant.
15305
15306 @item
15307 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15308 integral equivalents.
15309
15310 @item
15311 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15312 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15313 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15314 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15315 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15316 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15317 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15318 @samp{\n} for newline.
15319
15320 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15321 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15322 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15323 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15324
15325 @item
15326 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15327 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15328 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15329 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15330 characters.
15331
15332 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15333 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15334 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15335
15336 @item
15337 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15338 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15339
15340 @item
15341 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15342 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15343 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15344 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15345 @end itemize
15346
15347 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15348 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15349
15350 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15351 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15352
15353 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15354 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15355 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15356 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15357 @quotation
15358 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15359 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15360 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15361 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15362 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15363 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15364 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15365 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15366 @end quotation
15367
15368 @enumerate
15369
15370 @cindex member functions
15371 @item
15372 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15373
15374 @smallexample
15375 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15376 @end smallexample
15377
15378 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15379 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15380 @item
15381 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15382 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15383 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15384 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15385 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15386
15387 @cindex call overloaded functions
15388 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15389 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15390 @item
15391 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15392 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15393 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15394 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15395 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15396 default arguments.
15397
15398 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15399 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15400 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15401 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15402 number of function arguments.
15403
15404 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15405 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15406 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15407
15408 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15409 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15410 @smallexample
15411 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15412 @end smallexample
15413
15414 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15415 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15416
15417 @cindex reference declarations
15418 @item
15419 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15420 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15421 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15422
15423 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15424 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15425 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15426 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15427 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15428
15429 @item
15430 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15431 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15432 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15433 necessary, for example in an expression like
15434 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15435 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15436 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15437
15438 @item
15439 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15440 specification.
15441 @end enumerate
15442
15443 @node C Defaults
15444 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15445
15446 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15447
15448 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15449 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15450 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15451 selects the working language.
15452
15453 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15454 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15455 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15456 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15457 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15458 for further details.
15459
15460 @node C Checks
15461 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15462
15463 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15464
15465 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15466 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15467 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15468 constants to pointers.
15469
15470 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15471 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15472 that is not itself an array.
15473
15474 @node Debugging C
15475 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15476
15477 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15478 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15479 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15480 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15481
15482 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15483 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15484 ,Expressions}.
15485
15486 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15487 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15488
15489 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15490
15491 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15492 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15493
15494 @table @code
15495 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15496 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15497 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15498 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15499 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15500 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15501
15502 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15503 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15504 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15505 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15506 classes.
15507 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15508
15509 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15510 @item catch throw
15511 @itemx catch rethrow
15512 @itemx catch catch
15513 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15514 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15515
15516 @cindex inheritance
15517 @item ptype @var{typename}
15518 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15519 @var{typename}.
15520 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15521
15522 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15523 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15524 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15525 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15526 multiple inheritance is in use.
15527
15528 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15529 @item demangle @var{name}
15530 Demangle @var{name}.
15531 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15532
15533 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15534 @item set print demangle
15535 @itemx show print demangle
15536 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15537 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15538 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15539 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15540 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15541
15542 @item set print object
15543 @itemx show print object
15544 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15545 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15546
15547 @item set print vtbl
15548 @itemx show print vtbl
15549 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15550 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15551 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15552 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15553
15554 @kindex set overload-resolution
15555 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15556 @item set overload-resolution on
15557 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15558 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15559 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15560 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15561 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15562 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15563
15564 @item set overload-resolution off
15565 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15566 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15567 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15568 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15569 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15570 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15571 argument types.
15572
15573 @kindex show overload-resolution
15574 @item show overload-resolution
15575 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15576
15577 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15578 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15579 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15580 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15581 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15582 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15583 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15584
15585 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15586
15587 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15588 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15589 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15590 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15591 for more detail.
15592
15593 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15594 function that returns a std::string:
15595
15596 @smallexample
15597 std::string function(int);
15598 @end smallexample
15599
15600 @noindent
15601 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15602 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15603
15604 @smallexample
15605 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15606 @end smallexample
15607
15608 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15609 tag. For example:
15610
15611 @smallexample
15612 (gdb) b function(int)
15613 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15614 (gdb) info breakpoints
15615 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15616 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15617 at main.cc:10
15618 @end smallexample
15619
15620 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15621 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15622 name, like:
15623
15624 @smallexample
15625 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15626 @end smallexample
15627 @end table
15628
15629 @node Decimal Floating Point
15630 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15631 @cindex decimal floating point format
15632
15633 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15634 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15635 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15636 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15637
15638 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15639 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15640 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15641 configured target.
15642
15643 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15644 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15645 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15646
15647 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15648 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15649 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15650
15651 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15652 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15653 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15654
15655 @node D
15656 @subsection D
15657
15658 @cindex D
15659 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15660 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15661 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15662
15663 @node Go
15664 @subsection Go
15665
15666 @cindex Go (programming language)
15667 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15668 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15669
15670 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15671
15672 @table @code
15673 @cindex current Go package
15674 @item The current Go package
15675 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15676 specifying global variables and functions.
15677
15678 For example, given the program:
15679
15680 @example
15681 package main
15682 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15683 func main () @{
15684 // ...
15685 @}
15686 @end example
15687
15688 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15689
15690 @example
15691 (gdb) p myglob
15692 (gdb) p main.myglob
15693 @end example
15694
15695 @cindex builtin Go types
15696 @item Builtin Go types
15697 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15698 as a string.
15699
15700 @cindex builtin Go functions
15701 @item Builtin Go functions
15702 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15703 function and handles it internally.
15704
15705 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15706 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15707 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15708 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15709 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15710 @end table
15711
15712 @node Objective-C
15713 @subsection Objective-C
15714
15715 @cindex Objective-C
15716 This section provides information about some commands and command
15717 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15718 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15719 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15720
15721 @menu
15722 * Method Names in Commands::
15723 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15724 @end menu
15725
15726 @node Method Names in Commands
15727 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15728
15729 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15730 names as line specifications:
15731
15732 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15733 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15734 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15735 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15736 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15737 @itemize
15738 @item @code{clear}
15739 @item @code{break}
15740 @item @code{info line}
15741 @item @code{jump}
15742 @item @code{list}
15743 @end itemize
15744
15745 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15746
15747 @smallexample
15748 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15749 @end smallexample
15750
15751 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15752 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15753 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15754 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15755 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15756 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15757 debugged, enter:
15758
15759 @smallexample
15760 break -[Fruit create]
15761 @end smallexample
15762
15763 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15764 enter:
15765
15766 @smallexample
15767 list +[NSText initialize]
15768 @end smallexample
15769
15770 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15771 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15772 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15773 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15774
15775 @smallexample
15776 break create
15777 @end smallexample
15778
15779 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15780 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15781 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15782 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15783 none apply.
15784
15785 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15786 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15787
15788 @smallexample
15789 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15790 @end smallexample
15791
15792 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15793 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15794 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15795 @kindex print-object
15796 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15797
15798 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15799
15800 @smallexample
15801 print -[@var{object} hash]
15802 @end smallexample
15803
15804 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15805 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15806 @noindent
15807 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15808 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15809 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15810 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15811 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15812 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15813
15814 @node OpenCL C
15815 @subsection OpenCL C
15816
15817 @cindex OpenCL C
15818 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15819
15820 @menu
15821 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15822 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15823 * OpenCL C Operators::
15824 @end menu
15825
15826 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15827 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15828
15829 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15830 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15831 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15832 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15833 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15834
15835 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15836 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15837
15838 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15839 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15840 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15841 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15842
15843 @node OpenCL C Operators
15844 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15845
15846 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15847 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15848 vector data types.
15849
15850 @node Fortran
15851 @subsection Fortran
15852 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15853
15854 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15855 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15856
15857 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15858 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15859 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15860 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15861 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15862 underscore.
15863
15864 @menu
15865 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15866 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15867 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15868 @end menu
15869
15870 @node Fortran Operators
15871 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15872
15873 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15874
15875 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15876 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15877 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15878
15879 @table @code
15880 @item **
15881 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15882 of the second one.
15883
15884 @item :
15885 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15886 represent a section of array.
15887
15888 @item %
15889 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15890 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15891 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15892 union type.
15893 @end table
15894
15895 @node Fortran Defaults
15896 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15897
15898 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15899
15900 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15901 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15902 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15903 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15904
15905 @node Special Fortran Commands
15906 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15907
15908 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15909
15910 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15911 such as displaying common blocks.
15912
15913 @table @code
15914 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15915 @kindex info common
15916 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15917 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15918 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15919 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15920 printed.
15921 @end table
15922
15923 @node Pascal
15924 @subsection Pascal
15925
15926 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15927 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15928 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15929 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15930 syntax.
15931
15932 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15933 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15934 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15935
15936 @node Rust
15937 @subsection Rust
15938
15939 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15940 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15941 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15942 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15943
15944 @itemize @bullet
15945 @item
15946 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15947 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15948 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15949
15950 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15951 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15952 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15953 @samp{B}.
15954
15955 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15956 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15957
15958 @item
15959 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15960 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15961 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15962 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15963 @samp{K::x::y}.
15964
15965 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15966 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15967 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15968 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15969 scope.
15970
15971 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15972 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15973
15974 @item
15975 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15976 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15977
15978 @item
15979 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15980
15981 @item
15982 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15983 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15984 never be destroyed.
15985
15986 @item
15987 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15988 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15989 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15990
15991 @item
15992 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15993 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15994 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15995 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15996 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15997 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15998 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15999 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
16000
16001 @item
16002 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
16003 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
16004 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
16005 @itemize @bullet
16006
16007 @item
16008 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
16009
16010 @item
16011 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16012
16013 @item
16014 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16015 type names.
16016
16017 @item
16018 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16019
16020 @item
16021 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16022 available in the crate.
16023 @end itemize
16024 @end itemize
16025
16026 @node Modula-2
16027 @subsection Modula-2
16028
16029 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16030
16031 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16032 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16033 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16034 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16035 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16036 table.
16037
16038 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16039 @menu
16040 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16041 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16042 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16043 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16044 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16045 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16046 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16047 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16048 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16049 @end menu
16050
16051 @node M2 Operators
16052 @subsubsection Operators
16053 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16054
16055 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16056 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16057 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16058 following definitions hold:
16059
16060 @itemize @bullet
16061
16062 @item
16063 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16064 their subranges.
16065
16066 @item
16067 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16068
16069 @item
16070 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16071
16072 @item
16073 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16074 @var{type}}.
16075
16076 @item
16077 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16078
16079 @item
16080 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16081
16082 @item
16083 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16084 @end itemize
16085
16086 @noindent
16087 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16088 increasing precedence:
16089
16090 @table @code
16091 @item ,
16092 Function argument or array index separator.
16093
16094 @item :=
16095 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16096 @var{value}.
16097
16098 @item <@r{, }>
16099 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16100 types.
16101
16102 @item <=@r{, }>=
16103 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16104 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16105 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16106
16107 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16108 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16109 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16110 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16111 comment character.
16112
16113 @item IN
16114 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16115 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16116
16117 @item OR
16118 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16119
16120 @item AND@r{, }&
16121 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16122
16123 @item @@
16124 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16125
16126 @item +@r{, }-
16127 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16128 and difference on set types.
16129
16130 @item *
16131 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16132 on set types.
16133
16134 @item /
16135 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16136 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16137
16138 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16139 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16140 precedence as @code{*}.
16141
16142 @item -
16143 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16144
16145 @item ^
16146 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16147
16148 @item NOT
16149 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16150 @code{^}.
16151
16152 @item .
16153 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16154 precedence as @code{^}.
16155
16156 @item []
16157 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16158
16159 @item ()
16160 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16161 as @code{^}.
16162
16163 @item ::@r{, }.
16164 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16165 @end table
16166
16167 @quotation
16168 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16169 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16170 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16171 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16172 @end quotation
16173
16174
16175 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16176 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16177 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16178
16179 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16180 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16181
16182 @table @var
16183
16184 @item a
16185 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16186
16187 @item c
16188 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16189
16190 @item i
16191 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16192
16193 @item m
16194 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16195 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16196 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16197
16198 @item n
16199 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16200
16201 @item r
16202 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16203
16204 @item t
16205 represents a type.
16206
16207 @item v
16208 represents a variable.
16209
16210 @item x
16211 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16212 explanation of the function for details.
16213 @end table
16214
16215 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16216
16217 @table @code
16218 @item ABS(@var{n})
16219 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16220
16221 @item CAP(@var{c})
16222 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16223 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16224
16225 @item CHR(@var{i})
16226 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16227
16228 @item DEC(@var{v})
16229 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16230
16231 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16232 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16233 new value.
16234
16235 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16236 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16237 set.
16238
16239 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16240 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16241
16242 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16243 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16244
16245 @item INC(@var{v})
16246 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16247
16248 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16249 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16250 new value.
16251
16252 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16253 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16254 there. Returns the new set.
16255
16256 @item MAX(@var{t})
16257 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16258
16259 @item MIN(@var{t})
16260 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16261
16262 @item ODD(@var{i})
16263 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16264
16265 @item ORD(@var{x})
16266 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16267 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16268 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16269 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16270
16271 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16272 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16273 variable or a type.
16274
16275 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16276 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16277
16278 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16279 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16280 variable or a type.
16281
16282 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16283 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16284 @end table
16285
16286 @quotation
16287 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16288 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16289 an error.
16290 @end quotation
16291
16292 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16293 @node M2 Constants
16294 @subsubsection Constants
16295
16296 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16297 ways:
16298
16299 @itemize @bullet
16300
16301 @item
16302 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16303 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16304 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16305 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16306
16307 @item
16308 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16309 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16310 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16311 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16312 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16313 digits.
16314
16315 @item
16316 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16317 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16318 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16319 followed by a @samp{C}.
16320
16321 @item
16322 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16323 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16324 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16325 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16326 sequences.
16327
16328 @item
16329 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16330
16331 @item
16332 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16333 @code{FALSE}.
16334
16335 @item
16336 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16337
16338 @item
16339 Set constants are not yet supported.
16340 @end itemize
16341
16342 @node M2 Types
16343 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16344 @cindex Modula-2 types
16345
16346 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16347 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16348 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16349 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16350 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16351 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16352
16353 The first example contains the following section of code:
16354
16355 @smallexample
16356 VAR
16357 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16358 r: [20..40] ;
16359 @end smallexample
16360
16361 @noindent
16362 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16363 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16364
16365 @smallexample
16366 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16367 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16368 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16369 SET OF CHAR
16370 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16371 21
16372 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16373 [20..40]
16374 @end smallexample
16375
16376 @noindent
16377 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16378
16379 @smallexample
16380 VAR
16381 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16382 @end smallexample
16383
16384 @noindent
16385 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16386
16387 @smallexample
16388 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16389 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16390 @end smallexample
16391
16392 @noindent
16393 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16394 expressions using the debugger.
16395
16396 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16397 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16398
16399 @smallexample
16400 VAR
16401 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16402 @end smallexample
16403
16404 @smallexample
16405 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16406 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16407 @end smallexample
16408
16409 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16410 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16411 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16412 above.
16413
16414 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16415
16416 @smallexample
16417 TYPE
16418 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16419 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16420 VAR
16421 s: t ;
16422 BEGIN
16423 s := blue ;
16424 @end smallexample
16425
16426 @noindent
16427 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16428 and value of a variable.
16429
16430 @smallexample
16431 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16432 $1 = blue
16433 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16434 type = [blue..yellow]
16435 @end smallexample
16436
16437 @noindent
16438 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16439 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16440 their @code{C} counterparts.
16441
16442 @smallexample
16443 VAR
16444 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16445 BEGIN
16446 s[1] := 1 ;
16447 @end smallexample
16448
16449 @smallexample
16450 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16451 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16452 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16453 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16454 @end smallexample
16455
16456 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16457 pointer types as shown in this example:
16458
16459 @smallexample
16460 VAR
16461 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16462 BEGIN
16463 NEW(s) ;
16464 s^[1] := 1 ;
16465 @end smallexample
16466
16467 @noindent
16468 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16469
16470 @smallexample
16471 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16472 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16473 @end smallexample
16474
16475 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16476 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16477 types:
16478
16479 @smallexample
16480 TYPE
16481 foo = RECORD
16482 f1: CARDINAL ;
16483 f2: CHAR ;
16484 f3: myarray ;
16485 END ;
16486
16487 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16488 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16489 VAR
16490 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16491 @end smallexample
16492
16493 @noindent
16494 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16495 below.
16496
16497 @smallexample
16498 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16499 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16500 f1 : CARDINAL;
16501 f2 : CHAR;
16502 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16503 END
16504 @end smallexample
16505
16506 @node M2 Defaults
16507 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16508 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16509
16510 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16511 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16512 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16513 selected the working language.
16514
16515 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16516 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16517 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16518 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16519
16520 @node Deviations
16521 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16522 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16523
16524 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16525 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16526
16527 @itemize @bullet
16528 @item
16529 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16530 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16531 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16532 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16533 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16534 returned a pointer.)
16535
16536 @item
16537 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16538 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16539 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16540 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16541
16542 @item
16543 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16544 argument.
16545
16546 @item
16547 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16548 @end itemize
16549
16550 @node M2 Checks
16551 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16552 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16553
16554 @quotation
16555 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16556 range checking.
16557 @end quotation
16558 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16559
16560 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16561
16562 @itemize @bullet
16563 @item
16564 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16565 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16566
16567 @item
16568 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16569 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16570 @end itemize
16571
16572 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16573 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16574
16575 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16576 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16577
16578 @node M2 Scope
16579 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16580 @cindex scope
16581 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16582 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16583 @ifinfo
16584 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16585 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16586 @end ifinfo
16587 @ifnotinfo
16588 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16589 @end ifnotinfo
16590
16591 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16592 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16593 similar syntax:
16594
16595 @smallexample
16596
16597 @var{module} . @var{id}
16598 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16599 @end smallexample
16600
16601 @noindent
16602 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16603 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16604 identifier within your program, except another module.
16605
16606 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16607 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16608 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16609 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16610
16611 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16612 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16613 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16614 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16615 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16616 @var{module}.
16617
16618 @node GDB/M2
16619 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16620
16621 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16622 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16623 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16624 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16625 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16626 analogue in Modula-2.
16627
16628 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16629 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16630 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16631 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16632 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16633 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16634
16635 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16636 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16637 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16638
16639 @node Ada
16640 @subsection Ada
16641 @cindex Ada
16642
16643 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16644 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16645 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16646 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16647 to be difficult.
16648
16649
16650 @cindex expressions in Ada
16651 @menu
16652 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16653 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16654 in @value{GDBN}.
16655 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16656 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16657 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16658 subprograms.
16659 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16660 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16661 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16662 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16663 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16664 Profile
16665 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16666 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16667 @end menu
16668
16669 @node Ada Mode Intro
16670 @subsubsection Introduction
16671 @cindex Ada mode, general
16672
16673 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16674 syntax, with some extensions.
16675 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16676
16677 @itemize @bullet
16678 @item
16679 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16680 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16681 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16682 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16683
16684 @item
16685 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16686 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16687
16688 @item
16689 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16690 @end itemize
16691
16692 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16693 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16694 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16695 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16696 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16697
16698 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16699 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16700 was translated from an Ada source file.
16701
16702 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16703 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16704 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16705 middle (to allow based literals).
16706
16707 @node Omissions from Ada
16708 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16709 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16710
16711 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16712
16713 @itemize @bullet
16714 @item
16715 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16716
16717 @itemize @minus
16718 @item
16719 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16720 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16721
16722 @item
16723 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16724
16725 @item
16726 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16727
16728 @item
16729 @t{'Tag}.
16730
16731 @item
16732 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16733 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16734
16735 @item
16736 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16737 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16738
16739 @item
16740 @t{'Address}.
16741 @end itemize
16742
16743 @item
16744 The names in
16745 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16746 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16747 not currently available.
16748
16749 @item
16750 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16751 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16752 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16753 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16754 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16755 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16756 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16757 indeterminate values.
16758
16759 @item
16760 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16761 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16762 are not implemented.
16763
16764 @item
16765 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16766 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16767 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16768 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16769 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16770
16771 @smallexample
16772 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16773 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16774 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16775 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16776 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16777 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16778 @end smallexample
16779
16780 Changing a
16781 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16782 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16783 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16784 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16785 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16786 declared to have a type such as:
16787
16788 @smallexample
16789 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16790 Id : Integer;
16791 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16792 end record;
16793 @end smallexample
16794
16795 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16796 assignments:
16797
16798 @smallexample
16799 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16800 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16801 @end smallexample
16802
16803 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16804 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16805 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16806 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16807 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16808 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16809 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16810 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16811
16812 @item
16813 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16814
16815 @item
16816 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16817 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16818 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16819 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16820 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16821 the proper resolution.
16822
16823 @item
16824 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16825
16826 @item
16827 Entry calls are not implemented.
16828
16829 @item
16830 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16831 formats are not supported.
16832
16833 @item
16834 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16835
16836 @item
16837 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16838 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16839 context.
16840 Should your program
16841 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16842 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16843 @end itemize
16844
16845 @node Additions to Ada
16846 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16847 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16848
16849 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16850 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16851
16852 @itemize @bullet
16853 @item
16854 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16855 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16856 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16857 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16858 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16859 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16860 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16861 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16862
16863 @item
16864 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16865 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16866 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16867
16868 @item
16869 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16870 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16871
16872 @item
16873 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16874 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16875 @end itemize
16876
16877 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16878 additions specific to Ada:
16879
16880 @itemize @bullet
16881 @item
16882 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16883 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16884
16885 @smallexample
16886 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16887 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16888 @end smallexample
16889
16890 @item
16891 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16892 the value of its right-hand operand.
16893 This allows, for example,
16894 complex conditional breaks:
16895
16896 @smallexample
16897 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16898 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16899 @end smallexample
16900
16901 @item
16902 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16903 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16904 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16905 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16906 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16907 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16908 in strings. For example,
16909 @smallexample
16910 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16911 @end smallexample
16912 @noindent
16913 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16914 after each period.
16915
16916 @item
16917 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16918 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16919 to write
16920
16921 @smallexample
16922 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16923 @end smallexample
16924
16925 @item
16926 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16927 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16928 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16929 of 3 might print as
16930
16931 @smallexample
16932 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16933 @end smallexample
16934
16935 @noindent
16936 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16937 clause.
16938
16939 @item
16940 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16941 multi-character subsequence of
16942 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16943 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16944 in place of @t{a'length}.
16945
16946 @item
16947 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16948 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16949 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16950 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16951 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16952 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16953 For example,
16954 @smallexample
16955 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16956 @end smallexample
16957
16958 @item
16959 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16960 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16961 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16962 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16963 object.
16964
16965 @end itemize
16966
16967 @node Overloading support for Ada
16968 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16969 @cindex overloading, Ada
16970
16971 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16972 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16973 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16974 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16975 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16976 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16977
16978 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16979 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16980 use, for instance:
16981
16982 @smallexample
16983 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16984 Multiple matches for f
16985 [0] cancel
16986 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16987 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16988 >
16989 @end smallexample
16990
16991 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16992 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16993 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16994
16995 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16996 case:
16997
16998 @table @code
16999
17000 @kindex set ada print-signatures
17001 @item set ada print-signatures
17002 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
17003 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
17004 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17005
17006 @kindex show ada print-signatures
17007 @item show ada print-signatures
17008 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
17009 overloads selection menu.
17010 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17011
17012 @end table
17013
17014 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17015 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17016
17017 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17018 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17019 before reaching the main procedure.
17020 As defined in the Ada Reference
17021 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17022 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17023 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17024 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17025
17026 @node Ada Exceptions
17027 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17028
17029 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17030
17031 @table @code
17032 @kindex info exceptions
17033 @item info exceptions
17034 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17035 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17036 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17037 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17038 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17039 @end table
17040
17041 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17042 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17043 argument.
17044
17045 @smallexample
17046 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17047 All defined Ada exceptions:
17048 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17049 program_error: 0x613d20
17050 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17051 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17052 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17053 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17054 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17055 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17056 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17057 @end smallexample
17058
17059 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17060 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17061
17062 @node Ada Tasks
17063 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17064 @cindex Ada, tasking
17065
17066 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17067 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17068
17069 @table @code
17070 @kindex info tasks
17071 @item info tasks
17072 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17073
17074
17075 @smallexample
17076 @iftex
17077 @leftskip=0.5cm
17078 @end iftex
17079 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17080 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17081 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17082 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17083 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17084 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17085
17086 @end smallexample
17087
17088 @noindent
17089 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17090 task currently being inspected.
17091
17092 @table @asis
17093 @item ID
17094 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17095
17096 @item TID
17097 The Ada task ID.
17098
17099 @item P-ID
17100 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17101
17102 @item Pri
17103 The base priority of the task.
17104
17105 @item State
17106 Current state of the task.
17107
17108 @table @code
17109 @item Unactivated
17110 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17111 executing.
17112
17113 @item Runnable
17114 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17115 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17116
17117 @item Terminated
17118 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17119 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17120 terminated themselves.
17121
17122 @item Child Activation Wait
17123 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17124
17125 @item Accept Statement
17126 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17127
17128 @item Waiting on entry call
17129 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17130
17131 @item Async Select Wait
17132 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17133 select statement.
17134
17135 @item Delay Sleep
17136 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17137 alternative open.
17138
17139 @item Child Termination Wait
17140 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17141 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17142 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17143
17144 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17145 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17146 finish terminating.
17147
17148 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17149 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17150 @end table
17151
17152 @item Name
17153 Name of the task in the program.
17154
17155 @end table
17156
17157 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17158 @item info task @var{taskno}
17159 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17160 the following example:
17161 @smallexample
17162 @iftex
17163 @leftskip=0.5cm
17164 @end iftex
17165 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17166 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17167 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17168 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17169 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17170 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17171 Name: task_1
17172 Thread: 0
17173 LWP: 0x1fac
17174 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17175 Base Priority: 15
17176 State: Runnable
17177 @end smallexample
17178
17179 @item task
17180 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17181 @cindex current Ada task ID
17182 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17183
17184 @smallexample
17185 @iftex
17186 @leftskip=0.5cm
17187 @end iftex
17188 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17189 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17190 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17191 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17192 (@value{GDBP}) task
17193 [Current task is 2]
17194 @end smallexample
17195
17196 @item task @var{taskno}
17197 @cindex Ada task switching
17198 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17199 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17200 from the current task to the given task.
17201
17202 @smallexample
17203 @iftex
17204 @leftskip=0.5cm
17205 @end iftex
17206 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17207 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17208 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17209 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17210 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17211 [Switching to task 1]
17212 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17213 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17214 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17215 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17216 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17217 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17218 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17219 @end smallexample
17220
17221 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17222 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17223 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17224 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17225 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17226 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17227 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17228 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17229 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17230
17231 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17232 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17233 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17234 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17235 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17236
17237 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17238 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17239 program.
17240
17241 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17242 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17243 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17244
17245 For example,
17246
17247 @smallexample
17248 @iftex
17249 @leftskip=0.5cm
17250 @end iftex
17251 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17252 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17253 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17254 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17255 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17256 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17257 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17258 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17259 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17260 Continuing.
17261 task # 1 running
17262 task # 2 running
17263
17264 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17265 15 flush;
17266 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17267 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17268 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17269 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17270 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17271 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17272 @end smallexample
17273 @end table
17274
17275 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17276 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17277 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17278
17279 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17280 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17281 the platform being used.
17282 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17283 switching is not supported.
17284
17285 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17286 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17287 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17288 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17289 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17290 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17291
17292 @node Ravenscar Profile
17293 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17294 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17295
17296 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17297 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17298 requirements.
17299
17300 @table @code
17301 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17302 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17303 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17304 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17305 Profile. This is the default.
17306
17307 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17308 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17309 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17310 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17311 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17312 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17313 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17314
17315 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17316 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17317 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17318 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17319
17320 @end table
17321
17322 @node Ada Settings
17323 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17324 @cindex Ada settings
17325
17326 @table @code
17327 @kindex set varsize-limit
17328 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17329 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17330 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17331 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17332 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17333 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17334 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17335
17336 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17337 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17338 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17339 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17340 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17341 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17342 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17343 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17344 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17345 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17346 size is less than @var{size}.
17347
17348 @kindex show varsize-limit
17349 @item show varsize-limit
17350 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17351 @end table
17352
17353 @node Ada Glitches
17354 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17355 @cindex Ada, problems
17356
17357 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17358 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17359 @value{GDBN},
17360 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17361 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17362
17363 @itemize @bullet
17364 @item
17365 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17366 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17367
17368 @item
17369 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17370 argument lists are treated as positional).
17371
17372 @item
17373 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17374
17375 @item
17376 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17377 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17378 the host machine.
17379
17380 @item
17381 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17382 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17383 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17384 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17385 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17386 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17387 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17388 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17389 you can usually resolve the confusion
17390 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17391 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17392 @end itemize
17393
17394 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17395 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17396 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17397 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17398 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17399 enabled.
17400
17401 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17402 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17403 @table @code
17404
17405 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17406 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17407 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17408 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17409 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17410 This is the default.
17411
17412 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17413 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17414 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17415 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17416 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17417 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17418 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17419
17420 @end table
17421
17422 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17423 @cindex GNAT encoding
17424 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17425 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17426 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17427 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17428 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17429 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17430
17431 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17432 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17433 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17434 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17435 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17436 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17437 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17438 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17439
17440 @table @code
17441
17442 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17443 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17444 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17445 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17446
17447 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17448 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17449 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17450
17451 @end table
17452
17453 @node Unsupported Languages
17454 @section Unsupported Languages
17455
17456 @cindex unsupported languages
17457 @cindex minimal language
17458 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17459 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17460 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17461 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17462 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17463 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17464
17465 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17466 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17467 language.
17468
17469 @node Symbols
17470 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17471
17472 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17473 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17474 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17475 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17476 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17477 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17478 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17479
17480 @cindex symbol names
17481 @cindex names of symbols
17482 @cindex quoting names
17483 @anchor{quoting names}
17484 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17485 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17486 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17487 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17488 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17489 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17490 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17491 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17492
17493 @smallexample
17494 p 'foo.c'::x
17495 @end smallexample
17496
17497 @noindent
17498 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17499
17500 @table @code
17501 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17502 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17503 @kindex set case-sensitive
17504 @item set case-sensitive on
17505 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17506 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17507 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17508 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17509 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17510 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17511 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17512 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17513 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17514 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17515 case-insensitive matches.
17516
17517 @kindex show case-sensitive
17518 @item show case-sensitive
17519 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17520 lookups.
17521
17522 @kindex set print type methods
17523 @item set print type methods
17524 @itemx set print type methods on
17525 @itemx set print type methods off
17526 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17527 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17528 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17529 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17530 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17531 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17532
17533 @kindex show print type methods
17534 @item show print type methods
17535 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17536 classes.
17537
17538 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17539 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17540 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17541 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17542 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17543 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17544 types defined in classes.
17545
17546 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17547 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17548 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17549 printing classes.
17550
17551 @kindex set print type typedefs
17552 @item set print type typedefs
17553 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17554 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17555
17556 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17557 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17558 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17559 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17560 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17561 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17562 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17563 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17564 types.
17565
17566 @kindex show print type typedefs
17567 @item show print type typedefs
17568 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17569 printing classes.
17570
17571 @kindex info address
17572 @cindex address of a symbol
17573 @item info address @var{symbol}
17574 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17575 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17576 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17577 is always stored.
17578
17579 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17580 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17581 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17582
17583 @kindex info symbol
17584 @cindex symbol from address
17585 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17586 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17587 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17588 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17589 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17590
17591 @smallexample
17592 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17593 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17594 @end smallexample
17595
17596 @noindent
17597 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17598 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17599
17600 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17601 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17602
17603 @smallexample
17604 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17605 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17606 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17607 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17608 @end smallexample
17609
17610 @kindex demangle
17611 @cindex demangle
17612 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17613 Demangle @var{name}.
17614 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17615 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17616
17617 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17618 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17619
17620 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17621 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17622
17623 @kindex whatis
17624 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17625 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17626 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17627 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17628
17629 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17630 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17631 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17632
17633 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17634 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17635 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17636 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17637 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17638 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17639 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17640 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17641 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17642
17643 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17644 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17645 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17646 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17647 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17648 unroll it.
17649
17650 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17651 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17652 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17653
17654 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17655 Available flags are:
17656
17657 @table @code
17658 @item r
17659 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17660 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17661 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17662
17663 @item m
17664 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17665
17666 @item M
17667 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17668 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17669
17670 @item t
17671 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17672 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17673 names are substituted when printing other types.
17674
17675 @item T
17676 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17677 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17678
17679 @item o
17680 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17681 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17682
17683 For example, given the following declarations:
17684
17685 @smallexample
17686 struct tuv
17687 @{
17688 int a1;
17689 char *a2;
17690 int a3;
17691 @};
17692
17693 struct xyz
17694 @{
17695 int f1;
17696 char f2;
17697 void *f3;
17698 struct tuv f4;
17699 @};
17700
17701 union qwe
17702 @{
17703 struct tuv fff1;
17704 struct xyz fff2;
17705 @};
17706
17707 struct tyu
17708 @{
17709 int a1 : 1;
17710 int a2 : 3;
17711 int a3 : 23;
17712 char a4 : 2;
17713 int64_t a5;
17714 int a6 : 5;
17715 int64_t a7 : 3;
17716 @};
17717 @end smallexample
17718
17719 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17720
17721 @smallexample
17722 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17723 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17724 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17725 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17726 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17727 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17728
17729 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17730 @}
17731 @end smallexample
17732
17733 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17734 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17735 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17736 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17737 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17738 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17739 its fields.
17740
17741 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17742
17743 @smallexample
17744 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17745 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17746 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17747 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17748 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17749 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17750 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17751
17752 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17753 @} fff1;
17754 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17755 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17756 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17757 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17758 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17759 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17760 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17761 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17762 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17763 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17764
17765 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17766 @} f4;
17767
17768 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17769 @} fff2;
17770
17771 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17772 @}
17773 @end smallexample
17774
17775 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17776 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17777 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17778 of these structures' fields.
17779
17780 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17781 bitfields:
17782
17783 @smallexample
17784 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17785 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17786 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17787 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17788 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17789 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17790 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17791 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17792 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17793 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17794 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17795
17796 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17797 @}
17798 @end smallexample
17799
17800 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17801 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17802 @end table
17803
17804 @kindex ptype
17805 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17806 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17807 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17808 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17809
17810 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17811 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17812 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17813 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17814 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17815 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17816 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17817 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17818
17819 For example, for this variable declaration:
17820
17821 @smallexample
17822 typedef double real_t;
17823 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17824 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17825 complex_t var;
17826 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17827 @end smallexample
17828
17829 @noindent
17830 the two commands give this output:
17831
17832 @smallexample
17833 @group
17834 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17835 type = complex_t
17836 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17837 type = struct complex @{
17838 real_t real;
17839 double imag;
17840 @}
17841 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17842 type = struct complex
17843 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17844 type = struct complex
17845 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17846 type = struct complex @{
17847 real_t real;
17848 double imag;
17849 @}
17850 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17851 type = real_t *
17852 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17853 type = double *
17854 @end group
17855 @end smallexample
17856
17857 @noindent
17858 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17859 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17860
17861 @cindex incomplete type
17862 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17863 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17864 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17865 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17866 given these declarations:
17867
17868 @smallexample
17869 struct foo;
17870 struct foo *fooptr;
17871 @end smallexample
17872
17873 @noindent
17874 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17875
17876 @smallexample
17877 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17878 $1 = <incomplete type>
17879 @end smallexample
17880
17881 @noindent
17882 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17883 completely specified.
17884
17885 @cindex unknown type
17886 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17887 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17888 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17889 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17890 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17891 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17892 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17893 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17894
17895 @smallexample
17896 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17897 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17898 @end smallexample
17899
17900 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17901 of such variables.
17902
17903 @kindex info types
17904 @item info types @var{regexp}
17905 @itemx info types
17906 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17907 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17908 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17909 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17910 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17911 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17912 name is @code{value}.
17913
17914 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
17915 to print the type description according to the
17916 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
17917 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
17918 language of the type, other values mean to use
17919 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
17920
17921 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17922 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17923 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17924
17925 @kindex info type-printers
17926 @item info type-printers
17927 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17928 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17929 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17930 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17931 type printers.
17932
17933 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17934
17935 @kindex enable type-printer
17936 @kindex disable type-printer
17937 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17938 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17939 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17940
17941 @kindex info scope
17942 @cindex local variables
17943 @item info scope @var{location}
17944 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17945 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17946 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17947 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17948 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17949
17950 @smallexample
17951 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17952 Scope for command_line_handler:
17953 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17954 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17955 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17956 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17957 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17958 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17959 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17960 @end smallexample
17961
17962 @noindent
17963 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17964 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17965 collect}.
17966
17967 @kindex info source
17968 @item info source
17969 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17970 the function containing the current point of execution:
17971 @itemize @bullet
17972 @item
17973 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17974 @item
17975 the directory it was compiled in,
17976 @item
17977 its length, in lines,
17978 @item
17979 which programming language it is written in,
17980 @item
17981 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17982 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17983 @item
17984 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17985 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17986 @item
17987 whether the debugging information includes information about
17988 preprocessor macros.
17989 @end itemize
17990
17991
17992 @kindex info sources
17993 @item info sources
17994 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17995 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17996 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17997
17998 @kindex info functions
17999 @item info functions [-q]
18000 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
18001 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
18002 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
18003 number.
18004
18005 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18006 to print the function name and type according to the
18007 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18008 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18009 language of the function, other values mean to use
18010 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18011
18012 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18013 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
18014 have been printed.
18015
18016 @item info functions [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18017 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
18018 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
18019
18020 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
18021 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18022 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18023 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18024 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18025 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18026 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18027
18028 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18029 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18030 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18031 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18032 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18033 of special characters or quotes.
18034 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18035 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18036 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18037 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18038 int.
18039
18040 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18041 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18042 @var{type_regexp}.
18043
18044
18045 @kindex info variables
18046 @item info variables [-q]
18047 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18048 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18049 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18050 their respective source line numbers.
18051
18052 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18053 to print the variable name and type according to the
18054 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18055 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18056 language of the variable, other values mean to use
18057 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18058
18059 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18060 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18061 have been printed.
18062
18063 @item info variables [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18064 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18065 with the provided regexp(s).
18066
18067 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18068 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18069
18070 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18071 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18072 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18073 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18074 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18075 of special characters or quotes.
18076
18077 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18078 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18079 @var{type_regexp}.
18080
18081 @kindex info classes
18082 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18083 @item info classes
18084 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18085 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18086 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18087 expression.
18088
18089 @kindex info selectors
18090 @item info selectors
18091 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18092 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18093 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18094 expression.
18095
18096 @ignore
18097 This was never implemented.
18098 @kindex info methods
18099 @item info methods
18100 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18101 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18102 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18103 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18104 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18105 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18106 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18107 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18108 @end ignore
18109
18110 @cindex opaque data types
18111 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18112 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18113 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18114 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18115 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18116 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18117 another source file. The default is on.
18118
18119 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18120 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18121
18122 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18123 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18124 is printed as follows:
18125 @smallexample
18126 @{<no data fields>@}
18127 @end smallexample
18128
18129 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18130 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18131 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18132
18133 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18134 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18135 @item set print symbol-loading
18136 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18137 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18138 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18139 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18140 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18141 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18142 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18143 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18144 can be annoying.
18145 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18146 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18147 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18148 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18149
18150 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18151 @item show print symbol-loading
18152 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18153 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18154
18155 @kindex maint print symbols
18156 @cindex symbol dump
18157 @kindex maint print psymbols
18158 @cindex partial symbol dump
18159 @kindex maint print msymbols
18160 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18161 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18162 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18163 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18164 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18165 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18166 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18167 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18168 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18169 that objfile.
18170 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18171 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18172 @code{main}.
18173 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18174 source file.
18175
18176 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18177 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18178 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18179 tables.
18180 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18181 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18182 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18183 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18184 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18185 ``ELF symbols''.
18186
18187 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18188 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18189
18190 @kindex maint info symtabs
18191 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18192 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18193 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18194 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18195 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18196 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18197 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18198
18199 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18200 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18201 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18202 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18203 structure in more detail. For example:
18204
18205 @smallexample
18206 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18207 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18208 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18209 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18210 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18211 readin no
18212 fullname (null)
18213 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18214 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18215 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18216 dependencies (none)
18217 @}
18218 @}
18219 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18220 (@value{GDBP})
18221 @end smallexample
18222 @noindent
18223 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18224 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18225 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18226 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18227 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18228
18229 @smallexample
18230 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18231 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18232 line 1574.
18233 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18234 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18235 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18236 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18237 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18238 dirname (null)
18239 fullname (null)
18240 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18241 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18242 debugformat DWARF 2
18243 @}
18244 @}
18245 (@value{GDBP})
18246 @end smallexample
18247
18248 @kindex maint info line-table
18249 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18250 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18251 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18252
18253 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18254 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18255 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18256
18257 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18258 @cindex symbol cache size
18259 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18260 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18261 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18262 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18263 with different sizes.
18264
18265 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18266 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18267 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18268
18269 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18270 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18271 @item maint print symbol-cache
18272 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18273 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18274
18275 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18276 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18277 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18278 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18279 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18280
18281 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18282 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18283 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18284 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18285 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18286 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18287
18288 @end table
18289
18290 @node Altering
18291 @chapter Altering Execution
18292
18293 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18294 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18295 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18296 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18297 program.
18298
18299 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18300 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18301 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18302
18303 @menu
18304 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18305 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18306 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18307 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18308 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18309 * Patching:: Patching your program
18310 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18311 @end menu
18312
18313 @node Assignment
18314 @section Assignment to Variables
18315
18316 @cindex assignment
18317 @cindex setting variables
18318 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18319 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18320
18321 @smallexample
18322 print x=4
18323 @end smallexample
18324
18325 @noindent
18326 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18327 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18328 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18329 information on operators in supported languages.
18330
18331 @kindex set variable
18332 @cindex variables, setting
18333 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18334 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18335 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18336 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18337 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18338
18339 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18340 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18341 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18342 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18343 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18344 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18345 command @code{set width}:
18346
18347 @smallexample
18348 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18349 type = double
18350 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18351 $4 = 13
18352 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18353 Invalid syntax in expression.
18354 @end smallexample
18355
18356 @noindent
18357 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18358 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18359
18360 @smallexample
18361 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18362 @end smallexample
18363
18364 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18365 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18366 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18367 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18368 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18369 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18370
18371 @smallexample
18372 @group
18373 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18374 type = double
18375 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18376 $1 = 1
18377 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18378 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18379 $2 = 1
18380 (@value{GDBP}) r
18381 The program being debugged has been started already.
18382 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18383 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18384 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18385 Invalid bfd target.
18386 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18387 The current BFD target is "=4".
18388 @end group
18389 @end smallexample
18390
18391 @noindent
18392 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18393 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18394 @code{g}, use
18395
18396 @smallexample
18397 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18398 @end smallexample
18399
18400 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18401 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18402 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18403 same length or shorter.
18404 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18405 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18406
18407 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18408 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18409 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18410 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18411 and representation in memory), and
18412
18413 @smallexample
18414 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 @noindent
18418 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18419
18420 @node Jumping
18421 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18422
18423 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18424 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18425 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18426
18427 @table @code
18428 @kindex jump
18429 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18430 @item jump @var{location}
18431 @itemx j @var{location}
18432 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18433 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18434 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18435 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18436 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18437
18438 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18439 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18440 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18441 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18442 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18443 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18444 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18445 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18446 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18447 @end table
18448
18449 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18450 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18451 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18452 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18453 example,
18454
18455 @smallexample
18456 set $pc = 0x485
18457 @end smallexample
18458
18459 @noindent
18460 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18461 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18462 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18463
18464 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18465 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18466 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18467 detail.
18468
18469 @c @group
18470 @node Signaling
18471 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18472 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18473
18474 @table @code
18475 @kindex signal
18476 @item signal @var{signal}
18477 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18478 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18479 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18480 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18481
18482 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18483 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18484 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18485 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18486 signal.
18487
18488 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18489 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18490 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18491 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18492 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18493 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18494 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18495 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18496
18497 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18498 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18499 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18500 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18501 passes the signal directly to your program.
18502
18503 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18504 after executing the command.
18505
18506 @kindex queue-signal
18507 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18508 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18509 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18510 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18511 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18512 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18513 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18514 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18515 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18516
18517 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18518 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18519 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18520 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18521 @code{continue} command.
18522
18523 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18524 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18525 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18526 (@pxref{Signals}).
18527 @end table
18528 @c @end group
18529
18530 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18531 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18532
18533 @node Returning
18534 @section Returning from a Function
18535
18536 @table @code
18537 @cindex returning from a function
18538 @kindex return
18539 @item return
18540 @itemx return @var{expression}
18541 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18542 command. If you give an
18543 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18544 value.
18545 @end table
18546
18547 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18548 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18549 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18550 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18551
18552 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18553 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18554 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18555 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18556 of functions.
18557
18558 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18559 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18560 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18561 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18562 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18563
18564 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18565 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18566 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18567 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18568 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18569 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18570 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18571 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18572 assignment into the right register(s).
18573
18574 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18575 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18576 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18577 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18578 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18579 into a @code{long long int}:
18580
18581 @smallexample
18582 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18583 29 return 31;
18584 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18585 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18586 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18587 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18588 (@value{GDBP})
18589 @end smallexample
18590
18591 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18592 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18593 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18594 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18595 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18596 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18597 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18598 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18599
18600 @smallexample
18601 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18602 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18603 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18604 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18605 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18606 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18607 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18608 (@value{GDBP})
18609 @end smallexample
18610
18611 @node Calling
18612 @section Calling Program Functions
18613
18614 @table @code
18615 @cindex calling functions
18616 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18617 @item print @var{expr}
18618 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18619 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18620 debugged.
18621
18622 @kindex call
18623 @item call @var{expr}
18624 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18625 returned values.
18626
18627 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18628 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18629 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18630 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18631 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18632 value history.
18633 @end table
18634
18635 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18636 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18637 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18638 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18639
18640 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18641 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18642 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18643 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18644 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18645 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18646 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18647 in that case is controlled by the
18648 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18649
18650 @table @code
18651 @item set unwindonsignal
18652 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18653 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18654 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18655 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18656 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18657 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18658 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18659 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18660 received.
18661
18662 @item show unwindonsignal
18663 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18664 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18665 @value{GDBN}.
18666
18667 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18668 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18669 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18670 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18671 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18672 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18673 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18674 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18675 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18676 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18677
18678 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18679 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18680 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18681 @value{GDBN}.
18682
18683 @end table
18684
18685 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18686
18687 @cindex no debug info functions
18688 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18689 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18690 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18691 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18692 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18693 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18694
18695 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18696 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18697 declared return type. For example:
18698
18699 @smallexample
18700 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18701 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18702 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18703 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18704 @end smallexample
18705
18706 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18707 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18708 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18709 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18710
18711 @smallexample
18712 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18713 @end smallexample
18714
18715 @noindent
18716 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18717
18718 @smallexample
18719 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18720 @end smallexample
18721
18722 @noindent
18723 these calls are equivalent:
18724
18725 @smallexample
18726 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18727 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18728 @end smallexample
18729
18730 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18731 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18732 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18733 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18734 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18735 float parameters, and no debug info:
18736
18737 @smallexample
18738 float
18739 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18740 float v1, v2;
18741 @{
18742 return v1 * v2;
18743 @}
18744 @end smallexample
18745
18746 @noindent
18747 you call it like this:
18748
18749 @smallexample
18750 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18751 @end smallexample
18752
18753 @node Patching
18754 @section Patching Programs
18755
18756 @cindex patching binaries
18757 @cindex writing into executables
18758 @cindex writing into corefiles
18759
18760 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18761 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18762 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18763 patching your program's binary.
18764
18765 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18766 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18767 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18768 repairs.
18769
18770 @table @code
18771 @kindex set write
18772 @item set write on
18773 @itemx set write off
18774 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18775 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18776 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18777
18778 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18779 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18780 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18781
18782 @item show write
18783 @kindex show write
18784 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18785 as well as reading.
18786 @end table
18787
18788 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18789 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18790 @cindex injecting code
18791 @cindex writing into executables
18792 @cindex compiling code
18793
18794 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18795 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18796 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18797 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18798
18799 @table @code
18800 @kindex compile code
18801 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18802 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18803 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18804 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18805 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18806 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18807 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18808 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18809 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18810 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18811 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18812 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18813
18814 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18815 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18816 E.g.:
18817
18818 @smallexample
18819 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18820 @end smallexample
18821
18822 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18823 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18824 from actual source code. E.g.:
18825
18826 @smallexample
18827 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18828 @end smallexample
18829
18830 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18831 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18832 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18833 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18834 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18835 editor.
18836
18837 @smallexample
18838 compile code
18839 >printf ("hello\n");
18840 >printf ("world\n");
18841 >end
18842 @end smallexample
18843
18844 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18845 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18846 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18847 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18848 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18849 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18850 inferior symbols otherwise.
18851
18852 @kindex compile file
18853 @item compile file @var{filename}
18854 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18855 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18856
18857 @smallexample
18858 compile file /home/user/example.c
18859 @end smallexample
18860 @end table
18861
18862 @table @code
18863 @item compile print @var{expr}
18864 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18865 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18866 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18867 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18868 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18869 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18870 Formats}.
18871
18872 @item compile print
18873 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18874 @cindex reprint the last value
18875 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18876 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18877 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18878 multiple-line editor.
18879 @end table
18880
18881 @noindent
18882 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18883
18884 @table @code
18885 @anchor{set debug compile}
18886 @item set debug compile
18887 @cindex compile command debugging info
18888 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18889 injecting the code. The default is off.
18890
18891 @item show debug compile
18892 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18893 compiling and injecting the code.
18894
18895 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18896 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18897 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18898 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18899 The default is off.
18900
18901 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18902 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18903 C@t{++} type conversion.
18904 @end table
18905
18906 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18907
18908 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18909 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18910 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18911 injecting process.
18912
18913 @noindent
18914 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18915
18916 @table @asis
18917 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18918 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18919 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18920 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18921
18922 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18923 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18924 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18925 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18926 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18927 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18928 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18929 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18930
18931 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18932 @end table
18933
18934 @noindent
18935 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18936
18937 @table @code
18938 @item set compile-args
18939 @cindex compile command options override
18940 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18941 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18942 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18943 compilation.
18944
18945 @item show compile-args
18946 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18947 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18948 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18949 @end table
18950
18951 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18952
18953 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18954 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18955 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18956
18957 @table @asis
18958 @item C code examples and caveats
18959 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18960 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18961 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18962 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18963 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18964
18965 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18966 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18967 much like any other normal debugging session.
18968
18969 @smallexample
18970 void function1 (void)
18971 @{
18972 int i = 42;
18973 printf ("function 1\n");
18974 @}
18975
18976 void function2 (void)
18977 @{
18978 int j = 12;
18979 function1 ();
18980 @}
18981
18982 int main(void)
18983 @{
18984 int k = 6;
18985 int *p;
18986 function2 ();
18987 return 0;
18988 @}
18989 @end smallexample
18990
18991 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18992 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18993 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18994
18995 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18996 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18997 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18998 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18999 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
19000
19001 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
19002 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
19003 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
19004 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
19005 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
19006 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
19007 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
19008 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
19009 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
19010 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
19011
19012 @smallexample
19013 compile code k = 3;
19014 @end smallexample
19015
19016 @noindent
19017 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
19018 something else in the example program changes it, or another
19019 @code{compile} command changes it.
19020
19021 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
19022 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
19023 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
19024 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
19025 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
19026
19027 @smallexample
19028 compile code j = 3;
19029 @end smallexample
19030
19031 @noindent
19032 will result in a compilation error message.
19033
19034 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19035 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19036 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19037
19038 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19039 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19040 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19041 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19042
19043 @smallexample
19044 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19045 @end smallexample
19046
19047 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19048 command has completed:
19049
19050 @smallexample
19051 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19052 @end smallexample
19053
19054 @noindent
19055 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19056 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19057 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19058 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19059 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19060
19061 @smallexample
19062 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19063 @end smallexample
19064
19065 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19066 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19067 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19068 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19069 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19070 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19071 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19072 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19073
19074 @smallexample
19075 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19076 @end smallexample
19077
19078 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19079 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19080 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19081 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19082 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19083 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19084 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19085
19086 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19087 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19088 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19089 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19090 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19091 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19092
19093 @smallexample
19094 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19095 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19096 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19097 Compilation failed.
19098 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19099 42
19100 @end smallexample
19101
19102 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19103 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19104 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19105 will print to the console.
19106 @end table
19107
19108 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19109
19110 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19111 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19112 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19113 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19114 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19115 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19116 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19117 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19118
19119
19120 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19121 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19122 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19123 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19124 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19125 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19126 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19127
19128 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19129 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19130 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19131 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19132 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19133 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19134 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19135
19136 @table @code
19137 @item set compile-gcc
19138 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19139 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19140 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19141 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19142 default.
19143
19144 @item show compile-gcc
19145 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19146 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19147 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19148 @end table
19149
19150 @node GDB Files
19151 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19152
19153 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19154 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19155 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19156 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19157
19158 @menu
19159 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19160 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19161 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19162 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19163 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19164 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19165 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19166 @end menu
19167
19168 @node Files
19169 @section Commands to Specify Files
19170
19171 @cindex symbol table
19172 @cindex core dump file
19173
19174 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19175 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19176 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19177 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19178
19179 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19180 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19181 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19182 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19183 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19184 new files are useful.
19185
19186 @table @code
19187 @cindex executable file
19188 @kindex file
19189 @item file @var{filename}
19190 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19191 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19192 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19193 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19194 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19195 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19196 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19197 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19198
19199 @cindex unlinked object files
19200 @cindex patching object files
19201 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19202 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19203 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19204 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19205 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19206 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19207 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19208 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19209
19210 @item file
19211 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19212 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19213
19214 @kindex exec-file
19215 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19216 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19217 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19218 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19219 discard information on the executable file.
19220
19221 @kindex symbol-file
19222 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19223 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19224 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19225 table and program to run from the same file.
19226
19227 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19228 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19229 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19230 enabled.
19231
19232 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19233 program's symbol table.
19234
19235 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19236 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19237 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19238 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19239 @value{GDBN}.
19240
19241 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19242 executing it once.
19243
19244 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19245 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19246 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19247 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19248 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19249 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19250 optimized code.
19251
19252 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19253 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19254 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19255 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19256 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19257
19258 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19259 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19260 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19261 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19262 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19263 Warnings and Messages}.)
19264
19265 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19266 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19267 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19268 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19269 in stabs format.
19270
19271 @kindex readnow
19272 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19273 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19274 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19275 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19276 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19277 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19278 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19279 entire symbol table available.
19280
19281 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19282 @cindex never read symbols
19283 @cindex symbols, never read
19284 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19285 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19286 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19287 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19288 @xref{--readnever}.
19289
19290 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19291 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19292 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19293 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19294 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19295 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19296 @c files.
19297
19298 @kindex core-file
19299 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19300 @itemx core
19301 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19302 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19303 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19304 executable file itself for other parts.
19305
19306 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19307 to be used.
19308
19309 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19310 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19311 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19312 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19313 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19314
19315 @kindex add-symbol-file
19316 @cindex dynamic linking
19317 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19318 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19319 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19320 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19321 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19322 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19323 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19324 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19325 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19326 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19327 can be given as an expression.
19328
19329 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19330 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19331 specified explicitly.
19332
19333 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19334 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19335 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19336 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19337
19338 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19339
19340 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19341 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19342 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19343 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19344 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19345 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19346 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19347 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19348 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19349
19350 @itemize @bullet
19351 @item
19352 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19353 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19354 @item
19355 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19356 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19357 @item
19358 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19359 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19360 @end itemize
19361
19362 @noindent
19363 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19364 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19365 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19366 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19367 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19368 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19369 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19370 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19371 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19372 way.
19373
19374 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19375
19376 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19377 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19378 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19379 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19380 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19381 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19382
19383 @smallexample
19384 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19385 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19386 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19387 (y or n) y
19388 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19389 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19390 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19391 (gdb)
19392 @end smallexample
19393
19394
19395 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19396
19397 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19398 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19399 @cindex load symbols from memory
19400 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19401 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19402 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19403 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19404 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19405 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19406 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19407 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19408 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19409
19410 @kindex section
19411 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19412 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19413 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19414 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19415 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19416 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19417 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19418 their addresses.
19419
19420 @kindex info files
19421 @kindex info target
19422 @item info files
19423 @itemx info target
19424 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19425 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19426 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19427 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19428 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19429 current ones.
19430
19431 @kindex maint info sections
19432 @item maint info sections
19433 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19434 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19435 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19436 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19437 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19438 may be arbitrarily combined):
19439
19440 @table @code
19441 @item ALLOBJ
19442 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19443 @item @var{sections}
19444 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19445 @item @var{section-flags}
19446 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19447 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19448 @table @code
19449 @item ALLOC
19450 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19451 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19452 @item LOAD
19453 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19454 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19455 @item RELOC
19456 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19457 @item READONLY
19458 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19459 @item CODE
19460 Section contains executable code only.
19461 @item DATA
19462 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19463 @item ROM
19464 Section will reside in ROM.
19465 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19466 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19467 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19468 Section is not empty.
19469 @item NEVER_LOAD
19470 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19471 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19472 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19473 COFF shared library information.
19474 @item IS_COMMON
19475 Section contains common symbols.
19476 @end table
19477 @end table
19478 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19479 @cindex read-only sections
19480 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19481 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19482 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19483 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19484 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19485 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19486 enhancement to debugging performance.
19487
19488 The default is off.
19489
19490 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19491 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19492 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19493 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19494
19495 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19496 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19497 @end table
19498
19499 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19500 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19501 name and remembers it that way.
19502
19503 @cindex shared libraries
19504 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19505 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19506 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19507 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19508
19509 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19510 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19511
19512 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19513 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19514 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19515 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19516 debugging a core file).
19517
19518 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19519 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19520 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19521
19522 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19523 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19524 particularly large or there are many of them.
19525
19526 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19527 commands:
19528
19529 @table @code
19530 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19531 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19532 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19533 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19534 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19535 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19536 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19537 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19538
19539 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19540 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19541 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19542 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19543 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19544 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19545 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19546 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19547 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19548
19549 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19550 @item show auto-solib-add
19551 Display the current autoloading mode.
19552 @end table
19553
19554 @cindex load shared library
19555 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19556 command:
19557
19558 @table @code
19559 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19560 @kindex info share
19561 @item info share @var{regex}
19562 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19563 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19564 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19565 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19566
19567 @kindex info dll
19568 @item info dll @var{regex}
19569 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19570
19571 @kindex sharedlibrary
19572 @kindex share
19573 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19574 @itemx share @var{regex}
19575 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19576 Unix regular expression.
19577 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19578 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19579 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19580 loaded.
19581
19582 @item nosharedlibrary
19583 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19584 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19585 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19586 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19587 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19588 discarded.
19589 @end table
19590
19591 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19592 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19593 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19594 Catchpoints}).
19595
19596 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19597 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19598 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19599 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19600
19601 @table @code
19602 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19603 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19604 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19605 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19606 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19607 shared library.
19608
19609 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19610 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19611 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19612 library events happen.
19613 @end table
19614
19615 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19616 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19617 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19618 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19619 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19620 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19621 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19622 not.
19623
19624 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19625 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19626 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19627 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19628 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19629
19630 @table @code
19631 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19632 @cindex system root, alternate
19633 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19634 @kindex set sysroot
19635 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19636 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19637 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19638 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19639 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19640 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19641 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19642 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19643 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19644 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19645 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19646 @var{path}.
19647
19648 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19649 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19650 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19651 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19652 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19653 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19654 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19655 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19656 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19657 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19658 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19659 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19660 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19661 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19662
19663 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19664 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19665 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19666 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19667 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19668
19669 @smallexample
19670 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19671 @end smallexample
19672
19673 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19674 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19675 system:
19676
19677 @smallexample
19678 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19679 @end smallexample
19680
19681 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19682 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19683 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19684 colons:
19685
19686 @smallexample
19687 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19688 @end smallexample
19689
19690 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19691 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19692 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19693 @samp{z}):
19694
19695 @smallexample
19696 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19697 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19698 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19699 @end smallexample
19700
19701 @noindent
19702 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19703 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19704 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19705
19706 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19707 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19708
19709 @smallexample
19710 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19711 @end smallexample
19712
19713 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19714 if you don't want or need to.
19715
19716 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19717 sysroot}.
19718
19719 @cindex default system root
19720 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19721 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19722 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19723 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19724 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19725 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19726 location.
19727
19728 @kindex show sysroot
19729 @item show sysroot
19730 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19731
19732 @kindex set solib-search-path
19733 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19734 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19735 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19736 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19737 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19738 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19739 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19740 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19741 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19742 of shared library symbols.
19743
19744 @kindex show solib-search-path
19745 @item show solib-search-path
19746 Display the current shared library search path.
19747
19748 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19749 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19750 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19751 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19752 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19753
19754 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19755 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19756 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19757 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19758 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19759 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19760 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19761 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19762 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19763 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19764 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19765 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19766 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19767 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19768 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19769 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19770 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19771 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19772 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19773 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19774 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19775 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19776
19777 @table @code
19778 @item unix
19779 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19780 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19781 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19782 the forward slash.
19783
19784 @item dos-based
19785 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19786 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19787 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19788 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19789 considered directory separators.
19790
19791 @item auto
19792 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19793 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19794 This is the default.
19795 @end table
19796 @end table
19797
19798 @cindex file name canonicalization
19799 @cindex base name differences
19800 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19801 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19802 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19803 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19804 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19805 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19806 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19807 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19808 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19809 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19810 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19811 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19812 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19813 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19814 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19815
19816 @table @code
19817 @item set basenames-may-differ
19818 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19819 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19820
19821 @item show basenames-may-differ
19822 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19823 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19824 @end table
19825
19826 @node File Caching
19827 @section File Caching
19828 @cindex caching of opened files
19829 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19830
19831 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19832 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19833 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19834 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19835
19836 @table @code
19837 @kindex maint info bfds
19838 @item maint info bfds
19839 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19840 @value{GDBN}.
19841
19842 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19843 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19844 @kindex bfd caching
19845 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19846 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19847 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19848 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19849 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19850 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19851 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19852 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19853 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19854
19855 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19856 @kindex bfd caching
19857 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19858 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19859
19860 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19861 @kindex bfd caching
19862 @item show debug bfd-cache
19863 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19864 @end table
19865
19866 @node Separate Debug Files
19867 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19868 @cindex separate debugging information files
19869 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19870 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19871 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19872 @cindex global debugging information directories
19873 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19874 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19875
19876 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19877 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19878 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19879 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19880 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19881 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19882 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19883
19884 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19885 file:
19886
19887 @itemize @bullet
19888 @item
19889 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19890 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19891 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19892 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19893 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19894 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19895 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19896 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19897
19898 @item
19899 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19900 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19901 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19902 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19903 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19904 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19905 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19906 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19907 below.
19908 @end itemize
19909
19910 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19911 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19912
19913 @itemize @bullet
19914 @item
19915 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19916 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19917 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19918 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19919 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19920
19921 @item
19922 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19923 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19924 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19925 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19926 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19927 hex characters, not 10.)
19928 @end itemize
19929
19930 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19931 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19932 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19933 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19934 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19935 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19936
19937 @itemize @minus
19938 @item
19939 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19940 @item
19941 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19942 @item
19943 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19944 @item
19945 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19946 @end itemize
19947
19948 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19949 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19950 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19951 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19952 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19953
19954 @table @code
19955
19956 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19957 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19958 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19959 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19960 concatenating them by a path separator.
19961
19962 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19963 @item show debug-file-directory
19964 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19965 information files.
19966
19967 @end table
19968
19969 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19970 @cindex debug link sections
19971 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19972 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19973
19974 @itemize
19975 @item
19976 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19977 a zero byte,
19978 @item
19979 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19980 boundary within the section, and
19981 @item
19982 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19983 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19984 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19985 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19986 @end itemize
19987
19988 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19989 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19990 described above.
19991
19992 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19993 @cindex build ID sections
19994 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19995 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19996 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19997 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19998 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19999 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
20000 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
20001 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
20002 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
20003
20004 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
20005 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
20006 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
20007 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
20008 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
20009 in an ordinary executable.
20010
20011 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
20012 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
20013 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
20014 following commands:
20015
20016 @smallexample
20017 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
20018 @kbd{strip -g foo}
20019 @end smallexample
20020
20021 @noindent
20022 These commands remove the debugging
20023 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
20024 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
20025 two files:
20026
20027 @itemize @bullet
20028 @item
20029 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20030 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20031
20032 @smallexample
20033 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20034 @end smallexample
20035
20036 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20037 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20038 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20039 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20040
20041 @item
20042 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20043 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20044 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20045 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20046 @end itemize
20047
20048 @noindent
20049
20050 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20051 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20052 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20053
20054 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20055 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20056 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20057 @c different ways!
20058 @ifhtml
20059 @display
20060 @html
20061 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20062 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20063 @end html
20064 @end display
20065 @end ifhtml
20066 @ifnothtml
20067 @display
20068 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20069 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20070 @end display
20071 @end ifnothtml
20072
20073 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20074 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20075 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20076 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20077 CRC.
20078
20079 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20080 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20081 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20082 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20083 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20084
20085 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20086 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20087 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20088 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20089 @code{0xffffffff}.
20090
20091 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20092 @smallexample
20093 unsigned long
20094 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20095 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20096 @{
20097 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20098 @{
20099 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20100 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20101 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20102 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20103 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20104 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20105 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20106 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20107 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20108 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20109 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20110 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20111 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20112 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20113 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20114 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20115 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20116 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20117 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20118 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20119 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20120 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20121 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20122 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20123 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20124 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20125 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20126 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20127 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20128 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20129 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20130 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20131 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20132 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20133 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20134 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20135 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20136 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20137 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20138 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20139 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20140 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20141 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20142 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20143 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20144 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20145 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20146 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20147 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20148 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20149 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20150 0x2d02ef8d
20151 @};
20152 unsigned char *end;
20153
20154 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20155 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20156 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20157 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20158 @}
20159 @end smallexample
20160
20161 @noindent
20162 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20163
20164 @node MiniDebugInfo
20165 @section Debugging information in a special section
20166 @cindex separate debug sections
20167 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20168
20169 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20170 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20171 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20172 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20173
20174 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20175 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20176 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20177 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20178 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20179 debugging information might be included in the section.
20180
20181 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20182 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20183 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20184
20185 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20186 standard utilities:
20187
20188 @smallexample
20189 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20190 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20191 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20192 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20193
20194 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20195 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20196 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20197 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20198 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20199 | sort > funcsyms
20200
20201 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20202 # table.
20203 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20204
20205 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20206 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20207
20208 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20209 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20210 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20211 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20212
20213 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20214 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20215
20216 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20217 # original binary.
20218 xz mini_debuginfo
20219 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20220 @end smallexample
20221
20222 @node Index Files
20223 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20224 @cindex index files
20225 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20226
20227 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20228 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20229 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20230 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20231 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20232 startup.
20233
20234 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20235 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20236 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20237
20238 @smallexample
20239 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20240 @end smallexample
20241
20242 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20243
20244 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20245 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20246
20247 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20248 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20249 using @command{objcopy}.
20250
20251 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20252
20253 @table @code
20254 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20255 @kindex save gdb-index
20256 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20257 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20258 default creates it produces a single file
20259 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20260 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20261 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20262 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20263 given @var{directory}.
20264 @end table
20265
20266 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20267 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20268
20269 @smallexample
20270 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20271 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20272 @end smallexample
20273
20274 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20275
20276 @smallexample
20277 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20278 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20279 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20280 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20281 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20282 @end smallexample
20283
20284 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20285 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20286 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20287 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20288 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20289 The default is @code{off}.
20290 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20291 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20292
20293 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20294 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20295
20296 @smallexample
20297 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20298 @end smallexample
20299
20300 Instead you must do, for example,
20301
20302 @smallexample
20303 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20304 @end smallexample
20305
20306 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20307 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20308 currently work for programs using Ada.
20309
20310 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20311
20312 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20313 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20314 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20315 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20316
20317 @table @code
20318
20319 @item set index-cache on
20320 @itemx set index-cache off
20321 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20322
20323 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20324 @itemx show index-cache directory
20325 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20326
20327 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20328 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20329 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20330 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20331 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20332 differ according to local convention.
20333
20334 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20335 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20336
20337 @item show index-cache stats
20338 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20339
20340 @end table
20341
20342 @node Symbol Errors
20343 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20344
20345 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20346 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20347 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20348 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20349 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20350 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20351 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20352 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20353 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20354 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20355 Messages}).
20356
20357 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20358
20359 @table @code
20360 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20361
20362 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20363 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20364 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20365 in its outer scope blocks.
20366
20367 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20368 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20369 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20370 function.
20371
20372 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20373
20374 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20375 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20376 do so.
20377
20378 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20379 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20380 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20381 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20382 Messages}.)
20383
20384 @item bad block start address patched
20385
20386 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20387 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20388 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20389
20390 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20391 starting on the previous source line.
20392
20393 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20394
20395 @cindex foo
20396 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20397 larger than the size of the string table.
20398
20399 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20400 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20401 with this name.
20402
20403 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20404
20405 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20406 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20407 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20408
20409 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20410 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20411 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20412 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20413 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20414 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20415
20416 @item stub type has NULL name
20417
20418 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20419
20420 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20421 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20422 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20423 it.
20424
20425 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20426
20427 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20428
20429 @end table
20430
20431 @node Data Files
20432 @section GDB Data Files
20433
20434 @cindex prefix for data files
20435 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20436 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20437
20438 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20439 is currently using.
20440
20441 @table @code
20442 @kindex set data-directory
20443 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20444 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20445 to @var{directory}.
20446
20447 @kindex show data-directory
20448 @item show data-directory
20449 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20450 @end table
20451
20452 @cindex default data directory
20453 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20454 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20455 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20456 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20457 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20458 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20459 location.
20460
20461 The data directory may also be specified with the
20462 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20463 @xref{Mode Options}.
20464
20465 @node Targets
20466 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20467
20468 @cindex debugging target
20469 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20470
20471 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20472 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20473 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20474 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20475 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20476 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20477 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20478 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20479
20480 @cindex target architecture
20481 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20482 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20483 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20484 command.
20485
20486 @table @code
20487 @kindex set architecture
20488 @kindex show architecture
20489 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20490 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20491 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20492 supported architectures.
20493
20494 @item show architecture
20495 Show the current target architecture.
20496
20497 @item set processor
20498 @itemx processor
20499 @kindex set processor
20500 @kindex show processor
20501 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20502 and @code{show architecture}.
20503 @end table
20504
20505 @menu
20506 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20507 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20508 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20509 @end menu
20510
20511 @node Active Targets
20512 @section Active Targets
20513
20514 @cindex stacking targets
20515 @cindex active targets
20516 @cindex multiple targets
20517
20518 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20519 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20520 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20521 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20522 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20523 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20524 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20525 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20526 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20527
20528 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20529 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20530 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20531 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20532
20533 @node Target Commands
20534 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20535
20536 @table @code
20537 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20538 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20539 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20540 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20541 protocol of the target machine.
20542
20543 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20544 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20545 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20546
20547 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20548 after executing the command.
20549
20550 @kindex help target
20551 @item help target
20552 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20553 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20554 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20555
20556 @item help target @var{name}
20557 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20558 select it.
20559
20560 @kindex set gnutarget
20561 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20562 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20563 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20564 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20565 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20566 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20567
20568 @quotation
20569 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20570 you must know the actual BFD name.
20571 @end quotation
20572
20573 @noindent
20574 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20575
20576 @kindex show gnutarget
20577 @item show gnutarget
20578 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20579 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20580 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20581 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20582 @end table
20583
20584 @cindex common targets
20585 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20586 configuration):
20587
20588 @table @code
20589 @kindex target
20590 @item target exec @var{program}
20591 @cindex executable file target
20592 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20593 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20594
20595 @item target core @var{filename}
20596 @cindex core dump file target
20597 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20598 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20599
20600 @item target remote @var{medium}
20601 @cindex remote target
20602 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20603 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20604 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20605
20606 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20607 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20608
20609 @smallexample
20610 target remote /dev/ttya
20611 @end smallexample
20612
20613 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20614 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20615 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20616 clobbered by the download.
20617
20618 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20619 @cindex built-in simulator target
20620 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20621 In general,
20622 @smallexample
20623 target sim
20624 load
20625 run
20626 @end smallexample
20627 @noindent
20628 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20629 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20630 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20631 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20632 Processors}.
20633
20634 @item target native
20635 @cindex native target
20636 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20637 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20638 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20639 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20640
20641 @end table
20642
20643 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20644 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20645
20646 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20647 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20648 various aspects of this process.
20649
20650 @table @code
20651
20652 @item set hash
20653 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20654 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20655 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20656 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20657 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20658 monitor.
20659
20660 @item show hash
20661 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20662 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20663
20664 @item set debug monitor
20665 @kindex set debug monitor
20666 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20667 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20668 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20669
20670 @item show debug monitor
20671 @kindex show debug monitor
20672 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20673 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20674 @end table
20675
20676 @table @code
20677
20678 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20679 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20680 @anchor{load}
20681 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20682 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20683 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20684 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20685 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20686 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20687
20688 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20689 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20690 target is @dots{}}''
20691
20692 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20693 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20694 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20695 specifies a fixed address.
20696 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20697
20698 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20699 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20700 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20701
20702 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20703 load programs into flash memory.
20704
20705 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20706 @end table
20707
20708 @table @code
20709
20710 @kindex flash-erase
20711 @item flash-erase
20712 @anchor{flash-erase}
20713
20714 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20715
20716 @end table
20717
20718 @node Byte Order
20719 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20720
20721 @cindex choosing target byte order
20722 @cindex target byte order
20723
20724 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20725 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20726 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20727 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20728 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20729 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20730
20731 @table @code
20732 @kindex set endian
20733 @item set endian big
20734 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20735
20736 @item set endian little
20737 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20738
20739 @item set endian auto
20740 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20741 executable.
20742
20743 @item show endian
20744 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20745
20746 @end table
20747
20748 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20749 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20750 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20751 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20752 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20753 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20754 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20755 and @code{big} otherwise.
20756
20757 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20758 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20759 target system.
20760
20761
20762 @node Remote Debugging
20763 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20764 @cindex remote debugging
20765
20766 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20767 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20768 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20769 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20770 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20771
20772 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20773 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20774 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20775 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20776 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20777 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20778
20779 Other remote targets may be available in your
20780 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20781
20782 @menu
20783 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20784 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20785 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20786 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20787 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20788 @end menu
20789
20790 @node Connecting
20791 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20792 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20793 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20794 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20795 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20796 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20797 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20798
20799 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20800 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20801 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20802 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20803
20804 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20805
20806 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20807 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20808 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20809 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20810
20811 @table @asis
20812
20813 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20814 @item Result of detach or program exit
20815 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20816 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20817 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20818
20819 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20820 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20821 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20822 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20823
20824 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20825 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20826 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20827 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20828
20829 @item Specifying the program to debug
20830 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20831 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20832 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20833 target.
20834
20835 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20836 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20837 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20838
20839 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20840 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20841 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20842 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20843
20844 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20845 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20846 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20847 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20848 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20849 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20850 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20851 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20852 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20853
20854 @item The @code{run} command
20855 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20856 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20857 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20858 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20859 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20860
20861 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20862 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20863 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20864 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20865 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20866
20867 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20868 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20869 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20870 @code{target remote} mode.
20871
20872 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20873 @item Attaching
20874 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20875 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20876 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20877
20878 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20879 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20880 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20881 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20882 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20883
20884 @end table
20885
20886 @anchor{Host and target files}
20887 @subsection Host and Target Files
20888 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20889 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20890
20891 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20892 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20893 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20894 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20895 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20896
20897 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20898 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20899 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20900 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20901 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20902
20903 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20904 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20905 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20906 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20907 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20908 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20909 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20910 target libraries.
20911
20912 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20913 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20914 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20915 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20916 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20917 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20918 programs.
20919
20920 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20921 @cindex remote connection commands
20922 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
20923 local Unix domain socket, or
20924 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20925 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20926 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20927 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20928 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20929 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20930
20931 @table @code
20932
20933 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20934 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20935 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20936 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20937 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20938
20939 @smallexample
20940 target remote /dev/ttyb
20941 @end smallexample
20942
20943 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20944 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20945 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20946 @code{target} command.
20947
20948 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
20949 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
20950 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
20951 @cindex Unix domain socket
20952 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
20953 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
20954
20955 @smallexample
20956 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
20957 @end smallexample
20958
20959 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
20960 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
20961 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
20962 of connection.
20963 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
20964 Unix domain sockets.
20965
20966 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20967 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20968 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20969 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20970 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20971 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20972 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20973 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20974 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20975 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20976 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20977 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20978 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20979 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20980 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20981 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20982 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20983 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20984 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20985 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20986 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20987 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20988
20989 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20990 @code{manyfarms}:
20991
20992 @smallexample
20993 target remote manyfarms:2828
20994 @end smallexample
20995
20996 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20997 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20998 square bracket syntax:
20999
21000 @smallexample
21001 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
21002 @end smallexample
21003
21004 @noindent
21005 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
21006
21007 @smallexample
21008 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
21009 @end smallexample
21010
21011 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
21012 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
21013 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
21014 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
21015 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
21016 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
21017
21018 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
21019 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
21020 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
21021 port 1234 on your local machine:
21022
21023 @smallexample
21024 target remote :1234
21025 @end smallexample
21026 @noindent
21027
21028 Note that the colon is still required here.
21029
21030 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21031 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21032 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21033 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21034 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21035 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21036 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21037 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21038 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21039 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21040 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21041 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21042 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21043
21044 @smallexample
21045 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21046 @end smallexample
21047
21048 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21049 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21050 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21051 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21052
21053 @item target remote | @var{command}
21054 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21055 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21056 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21057 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21058 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21059 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21060 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21061 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21062 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21063
21064 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21065 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21066 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21067
21068 @end table
21069
21070 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21071 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21072 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21073 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21074 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21075 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21076 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21077
21078 @smallexample
21079 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21080 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21081 @end smallexample
21082
21083 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21084 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21085 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21086 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21087
21088 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21089 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21090
21091 @table @code
21092 @kindex detach (remote)
21093 @item detach
21094 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21095 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21096 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21097 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21098 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21099 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21100 still connected to the target.
21101
21102 @kindex disconnect
21103 @item disconnect
21104 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21105 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21106 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21107 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21108 another target.
21109
21110 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21111 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21112 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21113 @kindex monitor
21114 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21115 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21116 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21117 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21118 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21119 and implement.
21120 @end table
21121
21122 @node File Transfer
21123 @section Sending files to a remote system
21124 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21125 @cindex file transfer
21126 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21127
21128 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21129 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21130 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21131 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21132 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21133 the only way to upload or download files.
21134
21135 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21136
21137 @table @code
21138 @kindex remote put
21139 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21140 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21141 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21142
21143 @kindex remote get
21144 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21145 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21146 on the host system.
21147
21148 @kindex remote delete
21149 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21150 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21151
21152 @end table
21153
21154 @node Server
21155 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21156
21157 @kindex gdbserver
21158 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21159 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21160 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21161 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21162 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21163
21164 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21165 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21166 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21167 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21168 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21169 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21170 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21171 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21172 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21173 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21174 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21175 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21176 choice for debugging.
21177
21178 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21179 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21180 protocol.
21181
21182 @quotation
21183 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21184 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21185 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21186 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21187 @code{gdbserver}.
21188 @end quotation
21189
21190 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21191 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21192 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21193 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21194
21195 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21196 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21197 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21198 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21199 system does all the symbol handling.
21200
21201 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21202 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21203 syntax is:
21204
21205 @smallexample
21206 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21207 @end smallexample
21208
21209 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21210 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21211 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21212 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21213 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21214 @file{/dev/com1}:
21215
21216 @smallexample
21217 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21218 @end smallexample
21219
21220 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21221 with it.
21222
21223 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21224
21225 @smallexample
21226 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21227 @end smallexample
21228
21229 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21230 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21231 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21232 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21233 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21234 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21235 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21236 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21237 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21238 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21239 @code{target remote} command.
21240
21241 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21242 with ssh:
21243
21244 @smallexample
21245 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21246 @end smallexample
21247
21248 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21249 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21250 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21251 You could elide it if you want to.
21252
21253 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21254 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21255 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21256 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21257
21258 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21259 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21260 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21261 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21262
21263 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21264 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21265
21266 @smallexample
21267 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21268 @end smallexample
21269
21270 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21271 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21272
21273 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21274 @value{GDBN} attach command
21275 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21276
21277 @pindex pidof
21278 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21279 @code{pidof} utility:
21280
21281 @smallexample
21282 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21283 @end smallexample
21284
21285 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21286 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21287 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21288
21289 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21290
21291 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21292 port.
21293
21294 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21295 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21296 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21297 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21298 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21299 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21300 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21301 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21302
21303 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21304 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21305 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21306
21307 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21308 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21309 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21310 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21311 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21312 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21313 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21314 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21315 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21316 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21317 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21318 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21319
21320 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21321 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21322
21323 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21324 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21325 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21326 program. For more information,
21327 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21328
21329 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21330 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21331 status information about the debugging process.
21332 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21333 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21334 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21335 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21336
21337 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21338 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21339 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21340 Possible options are:
21341
21342 @table @code
21343 @item none
21344 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21345 @item all
21346 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21347 @item timestamps
21348 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21349 @end table
21350
21351 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21352 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21353
21354 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21355 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21356 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21357 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21358 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21359
21360 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21361 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21362 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21363 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21364
21365 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21366 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21367 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21368 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21369
21370 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21371 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21372 environment:
21373
21374 @smallexample
21375 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21376 @end smallexample
21377
21378 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21379 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21380
21381 @smallexample
21382 $ gdbserver --selftest
21383 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21384 @end smallexample
21385
21386 These tests are disabled in release.
21387 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21388
21389 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21390 @itemize
21391
21392 @item
21393 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21394
21395 @item
21396 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21397 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21398 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21399 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21400 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21401 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21402
21403 @item
21404 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21405 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21406 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21407 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21408 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21409 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21410 program is already on the target.
21411
21412 @end itemize
21413
21414 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21415 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21416 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21417
21418 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21419 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21420 Here are the available commands.
21421
21422 @table @code
21423 @item monitor help
21424 List the available monitor commands.
21425
21426 @item monitor set debug 0
21427 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21428 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21429
21430 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21431 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21432 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21433 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21434
21435 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21436 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21437 Possible options are:
21438
21439 @table @code
21440 @item none
21441 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21442 @item all
21443 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21444 @item timestamps
21445 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21446 @end table
21447
21448 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21449 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21450
21451 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21452 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21453 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21454 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21455 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21456 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21457
21458 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21459 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21460
21461 @item monitor exit
21462 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21463 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21464 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21465 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21466 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21467
21468 @end table
21469
21470 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21471 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21472
21473 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21474 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21475
21476 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21477 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21478 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21479 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21480 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21481 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21482 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21483 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21484 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21485 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21486 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21487 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21488
21489 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21490
21491 @table @code
21492 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21493
21494 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21495 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21496 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21497
21498 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21499
21500 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21501 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21502 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21503 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21504 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21505 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21506
21507 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21508
21509 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21510 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21511 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21512 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21513 command for that. For example:
21514
21515 @smallexample
21516 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21517 @end smallexample
21518
21519 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21520 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21521 @end table
21522
21523 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21524 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21525 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21526 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21527 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21528 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21529 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21530 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21531 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21532 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21533
21534 @smallexample
21535 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21536 @end smallexample
21537
21538 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21539
21540 @smallexample
21541 $ gdb myprogram
21542 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21543 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21544 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21545 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21546 @end smallexample
21547
21548 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21549 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21550 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21551 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21552 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21553 tracing.
21554
21555 @node Remote Configuration
21556 @section Remote Configuration
21557
21558 @kindex set remote
21559 @kindex show remote
21560 This section documents the configuration options available when
21561 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21562 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21563 system-call-allowed}.
21564
21565 @table @code
21566 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21567 @cindex address size for remote targets
21568 @cindex bits in remote address
21569 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21570 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21571 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21572 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21573
21574 @item show remoteaddresssize
21575 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21576
21577 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21578 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21579 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21580 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21581 remote targets.
21582
21583 @item show serial baud
21584 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21585
21586 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21587 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21588 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21589
21590 @item show serial parity
21591 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21592
21593 @item set remotebreak
21594 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21595 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21596 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21597 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21598 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21599 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21600 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21601 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21602
21603 @item show remotebreak
21604 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21605 interrupt the remote program.
21606
21607 @item set remoteflow on
21608 @itemx set remoteflow off
21609 @kindex set remoteflow
21610 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21611 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21612
21613 @item show remoteflow
21614 @kindex show remoteflow
21615 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21616
21617 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21618 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21619 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21620 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21621 @code{ascii}.
21622
21623 @item show remotelogbase
21624 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21625 protocol.
21626
21627 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21628 @cindex record serial communications on file
21629 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21630 default is not to record at all.
21631
21632 @item show remotelogfile.
21633 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21634 serial communications.
21635
21636 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21637 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21638 @cindex remote timeout
21639 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21640 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21641
21642 @item show remotetimeout
21643 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21644 responses.
21645
21646 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21647 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21648 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21649 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21650 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21651 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21652 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21653 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21654 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21655 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21656
21657 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21658 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21659 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21660 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21661
21662 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21663 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21664 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21665 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21666 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21667 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21668 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21669 length.
21670
21671 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21672 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21673 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21674
21675 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21676 @itemx show remote exec-file
21677 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21678 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21679 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21680 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21681 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21682 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21683
21684 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21685 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21686 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21687 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21688 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21689 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21690 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21691 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21692 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21693 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21694
21695 @item show interrupt-sequence
21696 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21697 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21698 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21699 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21700
21701 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21702 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21703 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21704 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21705 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21706 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21707
21708 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21709 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21710 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21711
21712 @kindex set tcp
21713 @kindex show tcp
21714 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21715 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21716 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21717 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21718 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21719 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21720 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21721 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21722 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21723
21724 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21725 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21726
21727 @item show tcp auto-retry
21728 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21729
21730 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21731 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21732 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21733 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21734 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21735 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21736 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21737 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21738 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21739 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21740 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21741
21742 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21743 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21744 @end table
21745
21746 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21747 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21748 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21749 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21750 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21751 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21752 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21753 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21754 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21755
21756 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21757 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21758 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21759 @value{GDBN} developers.
21760
21761 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21762 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21763 are:
21764
21765 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21766 @item Command Name
21767 @tab Remote Packet
21768 @tab Related Features
21769
21770 @item @code{fetch-register}
21771 @tab @code{p}
21772 @tab @code{info registers}
21773
21774 @item @code{set-register}
21775 @tab @code{P}
21776 @tab @code{set}
21777
21778 @item @code{binary-download}
21779 @tab @code{X}
21780 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21781
21782 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21783 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21784 @tab @code{info auxv}
21785
21786 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21787 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21788 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21789
21790 @item @code{attach}
21791 @tab @code{vAttach}
21792 @tab @code{attach}
21793
21794 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21795 @tab @code{vCont}
21796 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21797
21798 @item @code{run}
21799 @tab @code{vRun}
21800 @tab @code{run}
21801
21802 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21803 @tab @code{Z0}
21804 @tab @code{break}
21805
21806 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21807 @tab @code{Z1}
21808 @tab @code{hbreak}
21809
21810 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21811 @tab @code{Z2}
21812 @tab @code{watch}
21813
21814 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21815 @tab @code{Z3}
21816 @tab @code{rwatch}
21817
21818 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21819 @tab @code{Z4}
21820 @tab @code{awatch}
21821
21822 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21823 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21824 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21825
21826 @item @code{target-features}
21827 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21828 @tab @code{set architecture}
21829
21830 @item @code{library-info}
21831 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21832 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21833
21834 @item @code{memory-map}
21835 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21836 @tab @code{info mem}
21837
21838 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21839 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21840 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21841
21842 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21843 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21844 @tab @code{info spu}
21845
21846 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21847 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21848 @tab @code{info spu}
21849
21850 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21851 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21852 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21853
21854 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21855 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21856 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21857
21858 @item @code{threads}
21859 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21860 @tab @code{info threads}
21861
21862 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21863 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21864 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21865
21866 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21867 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21868 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21869
21870 @item @code{search-memory}
21871 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21872 @tab @code{find}
21873
21874 @item @code{supported-packets}
21875 @tab @code{qSupported}
21876 @tab Remote communications parameters
21877
21878 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21879 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21880 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21881
21882 @item @code{pass-signals}
21883 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21884 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21885
21886 @item @code{program-signals}
21887 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21888 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21889
21890 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21891 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21892 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21893
21894 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21895 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21896 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21897
21898 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21899 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21900 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21901
21902 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21903 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21904 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21905
21906 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21907 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21908 @tab @code{remote delete}
21909
21910 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21911 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21912 @tab Host I/O
21913
21914 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21915 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21916 @tab Host I/O
21917
21918 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21919 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21920 @tab Host I/O
21921
21922 @item @code{noack-packet}
21923 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21924 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21925
21926 @item @code{osdata}
21927 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21928 @tab @code{info os}
21929
21930 @item @code{query-attached}
21931 @tab @code{qAttached}
21932 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21933
21934 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21935 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21936 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21937
21938 @item @code{trace-status}
21939 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21940 @tab @code{tstatus}
21941
21942 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21943 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21944 @tab Traceframe info
21945
21946 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21947 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21948 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21949
21950 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21951 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21952 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21953
21954 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21955 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21956 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21957
21958 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21959 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21960 @tab @code{set environment}
21961
21962 @item @code{environment-unset}
21963 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21964 @tab @code{unset environment}
21965
21966 @item @code{environment-reset}
21967 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21968 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21969
21970 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21971 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21972 @tab @code{set cwd}
21973
21974 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21975 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21976 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21977
21978 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21979 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21980 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21981
21982 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21983 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21984 @tab @code{break}
21985
21986 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21987 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21988 @tab @code{hbreak}
21989
21990 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21991 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21992 @tab @code{fork}
21993
21994 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21995 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21996 @tab @code{vfork}
21997
21998 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21999 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
22000 @tab @code{exec}
22001
22002 @item @code{thread-events}
22003 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
22004 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22005
22006 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
22007 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
22008 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22009
22010 @end multitable
22011
22012 @node Remote Stub
22013 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
22014
22015 @cindex debugging stub, example
22016 @cindex remote stub, example
22017 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
22018 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
22019 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
22020 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
22021 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
22022 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
22023 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
22024 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
22025
22026 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
22027 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
22028 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22029 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22030 program, you need:
22031
22032 @enumerate
22033 @item
22034 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22035 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22036 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22037
22038 @item
22039 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22040 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22041
22042 @item
22043 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22044 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22045 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22046 documentation.
22047 @end enumerate
22048
22049 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22050 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22051 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22052
22053 @table @emph
22054 @item On the host,
22055 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22056 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22057 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22058
22059 @item On the target,
22060 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22061 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22062 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22063
22064 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22065 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22066 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22067 @end table
22068
22069 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22070 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22071 @sc{sparc} boards.
22072
22073 @cindex remote serial stub list
22074 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22075
22076 @table @code
22077
22078 @item i386-stub.c
22079 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22080 @cindex Intel
22081 @cindex i386
22082 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22083
22084 @item m68k-stub.c
22085 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22086 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22087 @cindex m680x0
22088 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22089
22090 @item sh-stub.c
22091 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22092 @cindex Renesas
22093 @cindex SH
22094 For Renesas SH architectures.
22095
22096 @item sparc-stub.c
22097 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22098 @cindex Sparc
22099 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22100
22101 @item sparcl-stub.c
22102 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22103 @cindex Fujitsu
22104 @cindex SparcLite
22105 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22106
22107 @end table
22108
22109 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22110 recently added stubs.
22111
22112 @menu
22113 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22114 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22115 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22116 @end menu
22117
22118 @node Stub Contents
22119 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22120
22121 @cindex remote serial stub
22122 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22123 subroutines:
22124
22125 @table @code
22126 @item set_debug_traps
22127 @findex set_debug_traps
22128 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22129 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22130 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22131 program's startup code.
22132
22133 @item handle_exception
22134 @findex handle_exception
22135 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22136 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22137 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22138 run when a trap is triggered.
22139
22140 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22141 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22142 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22143 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22144 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22145 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22146 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22147 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22148 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22149 machine.
22150
22151 @item breakpoint
22152 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22153 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22154 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22155 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22156 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22157 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22158 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22159 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22160 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22161 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22162 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22163
22164 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22165 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22166 start of your debugging session.
22167 @end table
22168
22169 @node Bootstrapping
22170 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22171
22172 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22173 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22174 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22175 debugging target machine.
22176
22177 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22178 serial port.
22179
22180 @table @code
22181 @item int getDebugChar()
22182 @findex getDebugChar
22183 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22184 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22185 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22186
22187 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22188 @findex putDebugChar
22189 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22190 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22191 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22192 @end table
22193
22194 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22195 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22196 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22197 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22198 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22199 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22200 remote system to stop.
22201
22202 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22203 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22204 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22205 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22206
22207 Other routines you need to supply are:
22208
22209 @table @code
22210 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22211 @findex exceptionHandler
22212 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22213 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22214 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22215 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22216 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22217 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22218 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22219 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22220 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22221 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22222 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22223 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22224 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22225
22226 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22227 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22228 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22229 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22230 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22231
22232 @item void flush_i_cache()
22233 @findex flush_i_cache
22234 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22235 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22236 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22237
22238 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22239 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22240 @end table
22241
22242 @noindent
22243 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22244
22245 @table @code
22246 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22247 @findex memset
22248 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22249 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22250 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22251 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22252 @end table
22253
22254 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22255 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22256 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22257 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22258
22259
22260 @node Debug Session
22261 @subsection Putting it All Together
22262
22263 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22264 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22265 steps.
22266
22267 @enumerate
22268 @item
22269 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22270 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22271 @display
22272 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22273 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22274 @end display
22275
22276 @item
22277 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22278 procedure is called:
22279
22280 @smallexample
22281 set_debug_traps();
22282 breakpoint();
22283 @end smallexample
22284
22285 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22286 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22287 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22288 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22289 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22290 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22291 progress.
22292
22293 @item
22294 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22295 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22296
22297 @smallexample
22298 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22299 @end smallexample
22300
22301 @noindent
22302 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22303 function in your program, that function is called when
22304 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22305 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22306 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22307
22308 @item
22309 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22310 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22311
22312 @item
22313 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22314 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22315
22316 @item
22317 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22318 @c document that. FIXME.
22319 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22320 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22321
22322 @item
22323 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22324 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22325
22326 @end enumerate
22327
22328 @node Configurations
22329 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22330
22331 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22332 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22333 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22334
22335 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22336 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22337 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22338 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22339 are quite different from each other.
22340
22341 @menu
22342 * Native::
22343 * Embedded OS::
22344 * Embedded Processors::
22345 * Architectures::
22346 @end menu
22347
22348 @node Native
22349 @section Native
22350
22351 This section describes details specific to particular native
22352 configurations.
22353
22354 @menu
22355 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22356 * Process Information:: Process information
22357 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22358 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22359 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22360 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22361 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
22362 @end menu
22363
22364 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22365 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22366
22367 @cindex libkvm
22368 @cindex kernel memory image
22369 @cindex kernel crash dump
22370
22371 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22372 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22373 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22374 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22375 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22376 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22377 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22378 @code{kvm} target:
22379
22380 @smallexample
22381 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22382 @end smallexample
22383
22384 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22385 argument:
22386
22387 @smallexample
22388 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22389 @end smallexample
22390
22391 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22392 available:
22393
22394 @table @code
22395 @kindex kvm
22396 @item kvm pcb
22397 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22398
22399 @item kvm proc
22400 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22401 modern FreeBSD systems.
22402 @end table
22403
22404 @node Process Information
22405 @subsection Process Information
22406 @cindex /proc
22407 @cindex examine process image
22408 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22409
22410 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22411 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22412 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22413 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22414 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22415 any process running on your system.
22416
22417 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22418 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22419 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22420 systems.
22421
22422 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22423 information.
22424
22425 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22426 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22427 information available from a live process. Process information is
22428 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22429 systems.
22430
22431 @table @code
22432 @kindex info proc
22433 @cindex process ID
22434 @item info proc
22435 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22436 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22437 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22438 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22439 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22440 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22441 executable file's absolute file name.
22442
22443 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22444 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22445 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22446 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22447 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22448 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22449
22450 @item info proc cmdline
22451 @cindex info proc cmdline
22452 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22453 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22454
22455 @item info proc cwd
22456 @cindex info proc cwd
22457 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22458 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22459
22460 @item info proc exe
22461 @cindex info proc exe
22462 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22463 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22464
22465 @item info proc files
22466 @cindex info proc files
22467 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22468 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22469 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22470 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22471 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22472 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22473 FreeBSD.
22474
22475 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22476 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22477
22478 @smallexample
22479 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22480 process 22136
22481 Open files:
22482
22483 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22484 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22485 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22486 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22487 root dir - r-------- /
22488 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22489 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22490 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22491 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22492 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22493 @end smallexample
22494
22495 @item info proc mappings
22496 @cindex memory address space mappings
22497 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22498 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22499 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22500 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22501 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22502
22503 @item info proc stat
22504 @itemx info proc status
22505 @cindex process detailed status information
22506 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22507 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22508 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22509 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22510 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22511
22512 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22513 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22514
22515 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22516 proc status}.
22517
22518 @item info proc all
22519 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22520 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22521
22522 @ignore
22523 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22524 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22525 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22526 @kindex info proc times
22527 @item info proc times
22528 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22529 its children.
22530
22531 @kindex info proc id
22532 @item info proc id
22533 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22534 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22535 @end ignore
22536
22537 @item set procfs-trace
22538 @kindex set procfs-trace
22539 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22540 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22541
22542 @item show procfs-trace
22543 @kindex show procfs-trace
22544 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22545
22546 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22547 @kindex set procfs-file
22548 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22549 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22550 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22551 standard output.
22552
22553 @item show procfs-file
22554 @kindex show procfs-file
22555 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22556
22557 @item proc-trace-entry
22558 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22559 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22560 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22561 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22562 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22563 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22564 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22565 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22566 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22567
22568 @item info pidlist
22569 @kindex info pidlist
22570 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22571 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22572 processes and all the threads within each process.
22573
22574 @item info meminfo
22575 @kindex info meminfo
22576 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22577 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22578 @end table
22579
22580 @node DJGPP Native
22581 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22582 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22583 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22584 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22585
22586 @cindex DPMI
22587 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22588 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22589 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22590 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22591
22592 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22593 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22594 subsection describes those commands.
22595
22596 @table @code
22597 @kindex info dos
22598 @item info dos
22599 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22600 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22601
22602 @kindex sysinfo
22603 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22604 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22605 @item info dos sysinfo
22606 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22607 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22608 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22609
22610 @cindex GDT
22611 @cindex LDT
22612 @cindex IDT
22613 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22614 @cindex descriptor tables display
22615 @item info dos gdt
22616 @itemx info dos ldt
22617 @itemx info dos idt
22618 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22619 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22620 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22621 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22622 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22623 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22624 rights.
22625
22626 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22627 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22628 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22629 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22630 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22631
22632 @cindex garbled pointers
22633 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22634 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22635 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22636 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22637 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22638 debugged program's data segment:
22639
22640 @smallexample
22641 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22642 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22643 @end smallexample
22644
22645 @noindent
22646 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22647 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22648
22649 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22650 @item info dos pde
22651 @itemx info dos pte
22652 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22653 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22654 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22655 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22656 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22657 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22658 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22659 that is currently in use.
22660
22661 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22662 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22663 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22664 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22665 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22666 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22667 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22668
22669 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22670 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22671 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22672 controller.
22673
22674 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22675
22676 @cindex physical address from linear address
22677 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22678 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22679 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22680 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22681 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22682 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22683 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22684
22685 @smallexample
22686 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22687 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22688 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22689 @end smallexample
22690
22691 @noindent
22692 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22693 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22694 attributes of that page.
22695
22696 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22697 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22698 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22699 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22700 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22701 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22702
22703 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22704 transfer buffer:
22705
22706 @smallexample
22707 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22708 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22709 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22710 @end smallexample
22711
22712 @noindent
22713 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22714 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22715 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22716 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22717 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22718
22719 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22720 @end table
22721
22722 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22723 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22724 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22725 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22726
22727 @table @code
22728 @kindex set com1base
22729 @kindex set com1irq
22730 @kindex set com2base
22731 @kindex set com2irq
22732 @kindex set com3base
22733 @kindex set com3irq
22734 @kindex set com4base
22735 @kindex set com4irq
22736 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22737 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22738 port.
22739
22740 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22741 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22742 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22743
22744 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22745 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22746 other 3 COM ports.
22747
22748 @kindex show com1base
22749 @kindex show com1irq
22750 @kindex show com2base
22751 @kindex show com2irq
22752 @kindex show com3base
22753 @kindex show com3irq
22754 @kindex show com4base
22755 @kindex show com4irq
22756 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22757 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22758 lines used by the COM ports.
22759
22760 @item info serial
22761 @kindex info serial
22762 @cindex DOS serial port status
22763 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22764 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22765 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22766 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22767 @end table
22768
22769
22770 @node Cygwin Native
22771 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22772 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22773 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22774 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22775
22776 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22777 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22778
22779 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22780 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22781 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22782 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22783 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22784 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22785 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22786 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22787
22788 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22789 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22790 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22791
22792 @table @code
22793 @kindex info w32
22794 @item info w32
22795 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22796 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22797
22798 @item info w32 selector
22799 This command displays information returned by
22800 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22801 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22802 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22803 Without argument, this command displays information
22804 about the six segment registers.
22805
22806 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22807 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22808 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22809 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22810
22811 @kindex signal-event
22812 @item signal-event @var{id}
22813 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22814 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22815
22816 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22817 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22818 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22819 (for x86_64 versions):
22820
22821 @itemize @minus
22822 @item
22823 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22824 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22825 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22826
22827 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22828 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22829 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22830 to attach.
22831
22832 @item
22833 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22834 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22835 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22836 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22837 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22838 @end itemize
22839
22840 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22841 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22842 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22843 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22844 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22845 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22846 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22847 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22848 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22849 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22850 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22851
22852 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22853 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22854 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22855 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22856
22857 @kindex set new-console
22858 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22859 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22860 be started in a new console on next start.
22861 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22862 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22863
22864 @kindex show new-console
22865 @item show new-console
22866 Displays whether a new console is used
22867 when the debuggee is started.
22868
22869 @kindex set new-group
22870 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22871 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22872 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22873 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22874 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22875
22876 @kindex show new-group
22877 @item show new-group
22878 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22879
22880 @kindex set debugevents
22881 @item set debugevents
22882 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22883 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22884 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22885 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22886 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22887
22888 @kindex set debugexec
22889 @item set debugexec
22890 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22891 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22892
22893 @kindex set debugexceptions
22894 @item set debugexceptions
22895 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22896 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22897
22898 @kindex set debugmemory
22899 @item set debugmemory
22900 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22901 and writes by the debugger.
22902
22903 @kindex set shell
22904 @item set shell
22905 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22906 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22907
22908 @kindex show shell
22909 @item show shell
22910 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22911
22912 @end table
22913
22914 @menu
22915 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22916 @end menu
22917
22918 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22919 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22920 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22921 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22922
22923 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22924 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22925 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22926 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22927 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22928 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22929 ``minimal symbols''.
22930
22931 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22932 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22933 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22934 program run once to completion.
22935
22936 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22937
22938 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22939 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22940 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22941 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22942 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22943 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22944 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22945 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22946 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22947
22948 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22949 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22950 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22951 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22952 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22953 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22954
22955 @smallexample
22956 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22957 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22958
22959 Non-debugging symbols:
22960 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22961 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22962 @end smallexample
22963
22964 @smallexample
22965 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22966 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22967
22968 Non-debugging symbols:
22969 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22970 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22971 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22972 [etc...]
22973 @end smallexample
22974
22975 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22976
22977 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22978 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22979 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22980 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22981 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22982 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22983 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22984
22985 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22986 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22987 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22988 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22989 problem:
22990
22991 @smallexample
22992 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22993 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22994 @end smallexample
22995
22996 @smallexample
22997 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22998 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22999 @end smallexample
23000
23001 And two possible solutions:
23002
23003 @smallexample
23004 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
23005 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23006 @end smallexample
23007
23008 @smallexample
23009 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
23010 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
23011 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
23012 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
23013 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
23014 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23015 @end smallexample
23016
23017 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
23018 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
23019 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
23020 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
23021 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
23022
23023 @smallexample
23024 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
23025 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
23026 @end smallexample
23027
23028 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
23029 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23030 safe.
23031
23032 @node Hurd Native
23033 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23034 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23035
23036 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23037 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23038
23039 @table @code
23040 @item set signals
23041 @itemx set sigs
23042 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23043 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23044 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23045 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23046 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23047 @code{signals}.
23048
23049 @item show signals
23050 @itemx show sigs
23051 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23052 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23053 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23054
23055 @item set signal-thread
23056 @itemx set sigthread
23057 @kindex set signal-thread
23058 @kindex set sigthread
23059 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23060 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23061 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23062 signal-thread}.
23063
23064 @item show signal-thread
23065 @itemx show sigthread
23066 @kindex show signal-thread
23067 @kindex show sigthread
23068 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23069 delivered a signal.
23070
23071 @item set stopped
23072 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23073 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23074 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23075 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23076
23077 @item show stopped
23078 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23079 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23080 stopped.
23081
23082 @item set exceptions
23083 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23084 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23085 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23086 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23087 trapping on.
23088
23089 @item show exceptions
23090 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23091 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23092
23093 @item set task pause
23094 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23095 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23096 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23097 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23098 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23099 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23100 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23101 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23102 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23103
23104 @item show task pause
23105 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23106 Show the current state of task suspension.
23107
23108 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23109 @cindex task suspend count
23110 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23111 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23112 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23113
23114 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23115 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23116
23117 @item set task exception-port
23118 @itemx set task excp
23119 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23120 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23121 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23122 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23123
23124 @item set noninvasive
23125 @cindex noninvasive task options
23126 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23127 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23128 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23129 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23130
23131 @item info send-rights
23132 @itemx info receive-rights
23133 @itemx info port-rights
23134 @itemx info port-sets
23135 @itemx info dead-names
23136 @itemx info ports
23137 @itemx info psets
23138 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23139 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23140 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23141 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23142 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23143 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23144 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23145 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23146 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23147
23148 @item set thread pause
23149 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23150 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23151 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23152 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23153 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23154 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23155 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23156 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23157 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23158 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23159 only the current thread.
23160
23161 @item show thread pause
23162 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23163 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23164
23165 @item set thread run
23166 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23167
23168 @item show thread run
23169 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23170
23171 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23172 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23173 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23174 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23175 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23176 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23177 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23178
23179 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23180 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23181 detaching.
23182
23183 @item set thread exception-port
23184 @itemx set thread excp
23185 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23186 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23187 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23188
23189 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23190 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23191 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23192 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23193
23194 @item set thread default
23195 @itemx show thread default
23196 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23197 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23198 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23199 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23200 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23201 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23202 the non-default commands.
23203 @end table
23204
23205 @node Darwin
23206 @subsection Darwin
23207 @cindex Darwin
23208
23209 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23210
23211 @table @code
23212 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23213 @kindex set debug darwin
23214 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23215 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23216
23217 @item show debug darwin
23218 @kindex show debug darwin
23219 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23220
23221 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23222 @kindex set debug mach-o
23223 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23224 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23225 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23226 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23227 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23228 usage.
23229
23230 @item show debug mach-o
23231 @kindex show debug mach-o
23232 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23233
23234 @item set mach-exceptions on
23235 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23236 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23237 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23238 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23239 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23240 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23241
23242 @item show mach-exceptions
23243 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23244 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23245 @end table
23246
23247 @node FreeBSD
23248 @subsection FreeBSD
23249 @cindex FreeBSD
23250
23251 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
23252 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
23253 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
23254 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
23255 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
23256 are also caught.
23257
23258 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
23259 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
23260 both variants:
23261
23262 @smallexample
23263 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
23264 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
23265 (@value{GDBP})
23266 @end smallexample
23267
23268
23269 @node Embedded OS
23270 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23271
23272 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23273 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23274 architectures.
23275
23276 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23277 various real-time operating systems.
23278
23279 @node Embedded Processors
23280 @section Embedded Processors
23281
23282 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23283 configurations.
23284
23285 @cindex send command to simulator
23286 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23287 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23288
23289 @table @code
23290 @item sim @var{command}
23291 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23292 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23293 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23294 acceptable commands.
23295 @end table
23296
23297
23298 @menu
23299 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23300 * ARM:: ARM
23301 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23302 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23303 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23304 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23305 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23306 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23307 * CRIS:: CRIS
23308 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23309 @end menu
23310
23311 @node ARC
23312 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23313 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23314 @cindex ARC specific commands
23315 @cindex ARC600
23316 @cindex ARC700
23317 @cindex ARC EM
23318 @cindex ARC HS
23319
23320 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23321
23322 @table @code
23323 @item set debug arc
23324 @kindex set debug arc
23325 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23326 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23327
23328 @item show debug arc
23329 @kindex show debug arc
23330 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23331
23332 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23333 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23334 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23335
23336 @end table
23337
23338 @node ARM
23339 @subsection ARM
23340
23341 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23342
23343 @table @code
23344 @item set arm disassembler
23345 @kindex set arm
23346 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23347 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23348
23349 @item show arm disassembler
23350 @kindex show arm
23351 Show the current disassembly style.
23352
23353 @item set arm apcs32
23354 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23355 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23356
23357 @item show arm apcs32
23358 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23359
23360 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23361 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23362 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23363
23364 @table @code
23365 @item auto
23366 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23367 @item softfpa
23368 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23369 processors.
23370 @item fpa
23371 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23372 @item softvfp
23373 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23374 @item vfp
23375 VFP co-processor.
23376 @end table
23377
23378 @item show arm fpu
23379 Show the current type of the FPU.
23380
23381 @item set arm abi
23382 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23383
23384 @item show arm abi
23385 Show the currently used ABI.
23386
23387 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23388 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23389 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23390 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23391 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23392 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23393 register).
23394
23395 @item show arm fallback-mode
23396 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23397
23398 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23399 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23400 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23401 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23402 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23403
23404 @item show arm force-mode
23405 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23406
23407 @item set debug arm
23408 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23409 target support subsystem.
23410
23411 @item show debug arm
23412 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23413 @end table
23414
23415 @table @code
23416 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23417 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23418
23419 @table @code
23420 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23421 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23422 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23423 The default value is @code{all}.
23424
23425 @table @code
23426 @item none
23427 @item demon
23428 @item angel
23429 @item redboot
23430 @item all
23431 @end table
23432 @end table
23433 @end table
23434
23435 @node M68K
23436 @subsection M68k
23437
23438 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23439
23440 @node MicroBlaze
23441 @subsection MicroBlaze
23442 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23443 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23444
23445 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23446 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23447 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23448 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23449 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23450 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23451 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23452 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23453 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23454 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23455 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23456
23457 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23458
23459 @table @code
23460 @item target remote :1234
23461 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23462 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23463
23464 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23465 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23466 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23467
23468 @item load
23469 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23470
23471 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23472 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23473
23474 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23475 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23476 @end table
23477
23478 @node MIPS Embedded
23479 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23480
23481 @noindent
23482 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23483
23484 @table @code
23485 @item set mipsfpu double
23486 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23487 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23488 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23489 @itemx show mipsfpu
23490 @kindex set mipsfpu
23491 @kindex show mipsfpu
23492 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23493 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23494 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23495 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23496 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23497 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23498 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23499 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23500 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23501 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23502 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23503 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23504 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23505
23506 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23507 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23508 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23509
23510 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23511 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23512 @end table
23513
23514 @node OpenRISC 1000
23515 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23516 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23517
23518 @noindent
23519 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23520 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23521 FPGA's.
23522
23523 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23524 a target:
23525
23526 @table @code
23527
23528 @kindex target sim
23529 @item target sim
23530
23531 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23532 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23533 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23534 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23535
23536 Example: @code{target sim}
23537
23538 @item set debug or1k
23539 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23540 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23541
23542 @item show debug or1k
23543 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23544 @end table
23545
23546 @node PowerPC Embedded
23547 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23548
23549 @cindex DVC register
23550 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23551 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23552
23553 @smallexample
23554 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23555 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23556 @end smallexample
23557
23558 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23559 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23560 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23561 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23562 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23563 or newer.
23564
23565 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23566 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23567 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23568 watching variables of scalar types.
23569
23570 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23571 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23572
23573 @smallexample
23574 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23575 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23576 @end smallexample
23577
23578 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23579 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23580
23581 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23582 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23583 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23584 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23585 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23586 use the @code{break-range} command.
23587
23588 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23589
23590 @table @code
23591 @kindex break-range
23592 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23593 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23594 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23595 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23596 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23597 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23598 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23599 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23600 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23601
23602 @kindex set powerpc
23603 @item set powerpc soft-float
23604 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23605 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23606 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23607 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23608
23609 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23610 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23611 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23612 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23613 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23614 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23615 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23616 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23617
23618 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23619 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23620 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23621 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23622 address of its first byte.
23623
23624 @end table
23625
23626 @node AVR
23627 @subsection Atmel AVR
23628 @cindex AVR
23629
23630 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23631 following AVR-specific commands:
23632
23633 @table @code
23634 @item info io_registers
23635 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23636 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23637 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23638 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23639 @end table
23640
23641 @node CRIS
23642 @subsection CRIS
23643 @cindex CRIS
23644
23645 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23646 following CRIS-specific commands:
23647
23648 @table @code
23649 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23650 @cindex CRIS version
23651 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23652 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23653 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23654
23655 @item show cris-version
23656 Show the current CRIS version.
23657
23658 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23659 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23660 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23661 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23662 @code{R59}.
23663
23664 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23665 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23666
23667 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23668 @cindex CRIS mode
23669 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23670 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23671 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23672
23673 @item show cris-mode
23674 Show the current CRIS mode.
23675 @end table
23676
23677 @node Super-H
23678 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23679 @cindex Super-H
23680
23681 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23682 commands:
23683
23684 @table @code
23685 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23686 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23687 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23688 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23689 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23690 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23691 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23692 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23693 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23694 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23695 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23696 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23697
23698 @item show sh calling-convention
23699 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23700 Show the current calling convention setting.
23701
23702 @end table
23703
23704
23705 @node Architectures
23706 @section Architectures
23707
23708 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23709 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23710
23711 @menu
23712 * AArch64::
23713 * i386::
23714 * Alpha::
23715 * MIPS::
23716 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23717 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23718 * PowerPC::
23719 * Nios II::
23720 * Sparc64::
23721 * S12Z::
23722 @end menu
23723
23724 @node AArch64
23725 @subsection AArch64
23726 @cindex AArch64 support
23727
23728 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23729 following special commands:
23730
23731 @table @code
23732 @item set debug aarch64
23733 @kindex set debug aarch64
23734 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23735 messages are to be displayed.
23736
23737 @item show debug aarch64
23738 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23739
23740 @end table
23741
23742 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23743 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23744
23745 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23746 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23747 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23748 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23749 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23750 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23751
23752 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23753 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23754 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23755 target process.
23756
23757
23758 @node i386
23759 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23760
23761 @table @code
23762 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23763 @kindex set struct-convention
23764 @cindex struct return convention
23765 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23766 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23767 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23768 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23769 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23770 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23771 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23772 be returned in a register.
23773
23774 @item show struct-convention
23775 @kindex show struct-convention
23776 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23777 from functions.
23778 @end table
23779
23780
23781 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23782 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23783
23784 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23785 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23786 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23787 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23788 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23789 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23790 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23791
23792 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23793 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23794 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23795 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23796 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23797 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23798
23799 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23800 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23801 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23802
23803 @smallexample
23804 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23805 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23806 @end smallexample
23807
23808 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23809 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23810 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23811 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23812 the pointer.
23813
23814 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23815 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23816 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23817 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23818 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23819
23820 @table @code
23821 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23822 @kindex show mpx bound
23823 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23824
23825 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23826 @kindex set mpx bound
23827 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23828 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23829 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23830 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23831 @end table
23832
23833 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23834 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23835 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23836 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23837
23838 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23839 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23840 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23841 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23842 function.
23843
23844 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23845 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23846 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23847 continuing the execution. For example:
23848
23849 @smallexample
23850 $ break *upper
23851 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23852 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23853 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23854 $ print $bnd0
23855 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23856 @end smallexample
23857
23858 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23859 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23860 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23861
23862 @node Alpha
23863 @subsection Alpha
23864
23865 See the following section.
23866
23867 @node MIPS
23868 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23869
23870 @cindex stack on Alpha
23871 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23872 @cindex Alpha stack
23873 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23874 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23875 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23876 find the beginning of a function.
23877
23878 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23879 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23880 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23881 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23882 commands:
23883
23884 @table @code
23885 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23886 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23887 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23888 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23889 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23890 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23891 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23892 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23893
23894 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23895 Display the current limit.
23896 @end table
23897
23898 @noindent
23899 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23900 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23901
23902 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23903 programs:
23904
23905 @table @code
23906 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23907 @kindex set mips abi
23908 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23909 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23910 values of @var{arg} are:
23911
23912 @table @samp
23913 @item auto
23914 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23915 default).
23916 @item o32
23917 @item o64
23918 @item n32
23919 @item n64
23920 @item eabi32
23921 @item eabi64
23922 @end table
23923
23924 @item show mips abi
23925 @kindex show mips abi
23926 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23927
23928 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23929 @kindex set mips compression
23930 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23931 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23932 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23933 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23934 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23935 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23936 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23937 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23938 provided by the executable.
23939
23940 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23941 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23942 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23943 identified as such.
23944
23945 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23946 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23947 implicitly from an executable.
23948
23949 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23950 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23951 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23952 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23953 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23954
23955 @item show mips compression
23956 @kindex show mips compression
23957 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23958 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23959
23960 @item set mipsfpu
23961 @itemx show mipsfpu
23962 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23963
23964 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23965 @kindex set mips mask-address
23966 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23967 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23968 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23969 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23970 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23971
23972 @item show mips mask-address
23973 @kindex show mips mask-address
23974 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23975 not.
23976
23977 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23978 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23979 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23980 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23981 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23982 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23983
23984 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23985 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23986 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23987
23988 @item set debug mips
23989 @kindex set debug mips
23990 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23991 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23992
23993 @item show debug mips
23994 @kindex show debug mips
23995 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23996 @end table
23997
23998
23999 @node HPPA
24000 @subsection HPPA
24001 @cindex HPPA support
24002
24003 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
24004 following special commands:
24005
24006 @table @code
24007 @item set debug hppa
24008 @kindex set debug hppa
24009 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
24010 messages are to be displayed.
24011
24012 @item show debug hppa
24013 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
24014
24015 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
24016 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
24017 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
24018 given @var{address}.
24019
24020 @end table
24021
24022
24023 @node SPU
24024 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24025 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
24026 @cindex SPU
24027
24028 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
24029 it provides the following special commands:
24030
24031 @table @code
24032 @item info spu event
24033 @kindex info spu
24034 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
24035 and pending event status.
24036
24037 @item info spu signal
24038 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
24039 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
24040 notification channels.
24041
24042 @item info spu mailbox
24043 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
24044 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
24045 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
24046
24047 @item info spu dma
24048 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24049 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24050 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24051
24052 @item info spu proxydma
24053 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24054 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24055 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24056
24057 @end table
24058
24059 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24060 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24061 special commands:
24062
24063 @table @code
24064 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24065 @kindex set spu
24066 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24067 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24068 function. The default is @code{off}.
24069
24070 @item show spu stop-on-load
24071 @kindex show spu
24072 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24073
24074 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24075 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24076 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24077 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24078 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24079 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24080
24081 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24082 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24083
24084 @end table
24085
24086 @node PowerPC
24087 @subsection PowerPC
24088 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24089
24090 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24091 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24092 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24093 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24094 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24095
24096 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24097 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24098 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24099
24100 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24101 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24102
24103 @node Nios II
24104 @subsection Nios II
24105 @cindex Nios II architecture
24106
24107 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24108 it provides the following special commands:
24109
24110 @table @code
24111
24112 @item set debug nios2
24113 @kindex set debug nios2
24114 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24115 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24116
24117 @item show debug nios2
24118 @kindex show debug nios2
24119 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24120 @end table
24121
24122 @node Sparc64
24123 @subsection Sparc64
24124 @cindex Sparc64 support
24125 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24126 @subsubsection ADI Support
24127
24128 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24129 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24130 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24131 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24132 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24133 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24134 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24135 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24136 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24137 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24138 signal.
24139
24140 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24141 ADI-enabled.
24142
24143 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24144 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24145
24146
24147 @table @code
24148 @kindex adi examine
24149 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24150
24151 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24152 cacheline.
24153
24154 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24155 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24156 block size, to display.
24157
24158 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24159 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24160
24161 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24162
24163 @smallexample
24164 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24165 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24166 @end smallexample
24167
24168 @kindex adi assign
24169 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24170
24171 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24172 to an address.
24173
24174 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24175 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24176 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24177
24178 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24179 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24180
24181 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24182
24183 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24184 variable "shmaddr":
24185
24186 @smallexample
24187 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24188 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24189 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24190 @end smallexample
24191
24192 @end table
24193
24194 @node S12Z
24195 @subsection S12Z
24196 @cindex S12Z support
24197
24198 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24199 it provides the following special command:
24200
24201 @table @code
24202 @item maint info bdccsr
24203 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24204 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24205 BDCCSR register.
24206 @end table
24207
24208
24209 @node Controlling GDB
24210 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24211
24212 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24213 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24214 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24215 described here.
24216
24217 @menu
24218 * Prompt:: Prompt
24219 * Editing:: Command editing
24220 * Command History:: Command history
24221 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24222 * Output Styling:: Output styling
24223 * Numbers:: Numbers
24224 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24225 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24226 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24227 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24228 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24229 @end menu
24230
24231 @node Prompt
24232 @section Prompt
24233
24234 @cindex prompt
24235
24236 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24237 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24238 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24239 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24240 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24241 which one you are talking to.
24242
24243 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24244 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24245 or a prompt that does not.
24246
24247 @table @code
24248 @kindex set prompt
24249 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24250 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24251
24252 @kindex show prompt
24253 @item show prompt
24254 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24255 @end table
24256
24257 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24258 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24259 are:
24260
24261 @table @code
24262 @kindex set extended-prompt
24263 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24264 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24265 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24266 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24267 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24268 is displayed.
24269
24270 For example:
24271
24272 @smallexample
24273 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24274 @end smallexample
24275
24276 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24277 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24278
24279 @kindex show extended-prompt
24280 @item show extended-prompt
24281 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24282 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24283 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24284 @end table
24285
24286 @node Editing
24287 @section Command Editing
24288 @cindex readline
24289 @cindex command line editing
24290
24291 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24292 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24293 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24294 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24295 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24296 debugging sessions.
24297
24298 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24299 command @code{set}.
24300
24301 @table @code
24302 @kindex set editing
24303 @cindex editing
24304 @item set editing
24305 @itemx set editing on
24306 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24307
24308 @item set editing off
24309 Disable command line editing.
24310
24311 @kindex show editing
24312 @item show editing
24313 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24314 @end table
24315
24316 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24317 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24318 @end ifset
24319 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24320 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24321 @end ifclear
24322 for more details about the Readline
24323 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24324 encouraged to read that chapter.
24325
24326 @node Command History
24327 @section Command History
24328 @cindex command history
24329
24330 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24331 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24332 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24333 history facility.
24334
24335 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24336 package, to provide the history facility.
24337 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24338 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24339 @end ifset
24340 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24341 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24342 @end ifclear
24343 for the detailed description of the History library.
24344
24345 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24346 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24347 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24348 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24349 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24350 pressed on a line by itself.
24351
24352 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24353 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24354 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24355 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24356
24357 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24358 history.
24359
24360 @table @code
24361 @cindex history substitution
24362 @cindex history file
24363 @kindex set history filename
24364 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24365 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24366 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24367 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24368 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24369 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24370 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24371 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24372 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24373 is not set.
24374
24375 @cindex save command history
24376 @kindex set history save
24377 @item set history save
24378 @itemx set history save on
24379 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24380 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24381
24382 @item set history save off
24383 Stop recording command history in a file.
24384
24385 @cindex history size
24386 @kindex set history size
24387 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24388 @item set history size @var{size}
24389 @itemx set history size unlimited
24390 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24391 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24392 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24393 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24394 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24395 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24396
24397 @cindex remove duplicate history
24398 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24399 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24400 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24401 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24402 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24403 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24404 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24405 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24406 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24407
24408 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24409 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24410
24411 @end table
24412
24413 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24414 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24415 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24416 @end ifset
24417 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24418 @xref{Event Designators},
24419 @end ifclear
24420 for more details.
24421
24422 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24423 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24424 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24425 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24426 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24427 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24428 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24429 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24430
24431 The commands to control history expansion are:
24432
24433 @table @code
24434 @item set history expansion on
24435 @itemx set history expansion
24436 @kindex set history expansion
24437 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24438
24439 @item set history expansion off
24440 Disable history expansion.
24441
24442 @c @group
24443 @kindex show history
24444 @item show history
24445 @itemx show history filename
24446 @itemx show history save
24447 @itemx show history size
24448 @itemx show history expansion
24449 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24450 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24451 @c @end group
24452 @end table
24453
24454 @table @code
24455 @kindex show commands
24456 @cindex show last commands
24457 @cindex display command history
24458 @item show commands
24459 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24460
24461 @item show commands @var{n}
24462 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24463
24464 @item show commands +
24465 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24466 @end table
24467
24468 @node Screen Size
24469 @section Screen Size
24470 @cindex size of screen
24471 @cindex screen size
24472 @cindex pagination
24473 @cindex page size
24474 @cindex pauses in output
24475
24476 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24477 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24478 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24479 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24480 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24481 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24482 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24483 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24484 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24485 following line.
24486
24487 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24488 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24489 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24490 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24491 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24492 width} commands:
24493
24494 @table @code
24495 @kindex set height
24496 @kindex set width
24497 @kindex show width
24498 @kindex show height
24499 @item set height @var{lpp}
24500 @itemx set height unlimited
24501 @itemx show height
24502 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24503 @itemx set width unlimited
24504 @itemx show width
24505 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24506 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24507 commands display the current settings.
24508
24509 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24510 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24511 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24512 buffer.
24513
24514 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24515 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24516
24517 @item set pagination on
24518 @itemx set pagination off
24519 @kindex set pagination
24520 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24521 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24522 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24523 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24524
24525 @item show pagination
24526 @kindex show pagination
24527 Show the current pagination mode.
24528 @end table
24529
24530 @node Output Styling
24531 @section Output Styling
24532 @cindex styling
24533 @cindex colors
24534
24535 @kindex set style
24536 @kindex show style
24537 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
24538 enabled by default on most systems. Various style settings are
24539 available; and styles can also be disabled entirely.
24540
24541 @table @code
24542 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
24543 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
24544 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
24545
24546 @item show style enabled
24547 Show the current state of styling.
24548 @end table
24549
24550 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
24551 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
24552 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
24553 intensity.
24554
24555 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
24556 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
24557
24558 @table @code
24559 @item set style filename background @var{color}
24560 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24561 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24562 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{vlue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24563 and@samp{white}.
24564
24565 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
24566 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24567 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24568 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{vlue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24569 and@samp{white}.
24570
24571 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
24572 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
24573 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
24574 @end table
24575
24576 The style-able objects are:
24577 @table @code
24578 @item filename
24579 Control the styling of file names.
24580
24581 @item function
24582 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
24583 @code{set style function} family of commands.
24584
24585 @item variable
24586 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
24587 @code{set style variable} family of commands.
24588
24589 @item address
24590 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
24591 @code{set style address} family of commands.
24592 @end table
24593
24594 @node Numbers
24595 @section Numbers
24596 @cindex number representation
24597 @cindex entering numbers
24598
24599 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24600 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24601 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24602 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24603 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24604 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24605 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24606 both input and output with the commands described below.
24607
24608 @table @code
24609 @kindex set input-radix
24610 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24611 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24612 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24613 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24614 example, any of
24615
24616 @smallexample
24617 set input-radix 012
24618 set input-radix 10.
24619 set input-radix 0xa
24620 @end smallexample
24621
24622 @noindent
24623 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24624 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24625 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24626 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24627 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24628 change the radix.
24629
24630 @kindex set output-radix
24631 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24632 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24633 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24634 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24635
24636 @kindex show input-radix
24637 @item show input-radix
24638 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24639
24640 @kindex show output-radix
24641 @item show output-radix
24642 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24643
24644 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24645 @itemx show radix
24646 @kindex set radix
24647 @kindex show radix
24648 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24649 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24650 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24651 default value of 10.
24652
24653 @end table
24654
24655 @node ABI
24656 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24657
24658 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24659 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24660 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24661 current ABI.
24662
24663 @cindex OS ABI
24664 @kindex set osabi
24665 @kindex show osabi
24666 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24667
24668 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24669 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24670 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24671 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24672 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24673 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24674 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24675 platform provides.
24676
24677 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24678 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24679 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24680 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24681
24682 @table @code
24683 @item show osabi
24684 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24685
24686 @item set osabi
24687 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24688
24689 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24690 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24691 @end table
24692
24693 @cindex float promotion
24694
24695 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24696 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24697 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24698 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24699 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24700 @code{double} and then passed.
24701
24702 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24703 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24704 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24705
24706 @table @code
24707 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24708 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24709 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24710 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24711 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24712
24713 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24714 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24715 functions.
24716
24717 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24718 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24719 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24720 @end table
24721
24722 @kindex set cp-abi
24723 @kindex show cp-abi
24724 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24725 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24726 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24727 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24728 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24729 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24730 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24731 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24732 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24733 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24734 ``auto''.
24735
24736 @table @code
24737 @item show cp-abi
24738 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24739
24740 @item set cp-abi
24741 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24742
24743 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24744 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24745 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24746 @end table
24747
24748 @node Auto-loading
24749 @section Automatically loading associated files
24750 @cindex auto-loading
24751
24752 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24753 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24754 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24755 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24756 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24757 sources).
24758
24759 @menu
24760 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24761 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24762
24763 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24764 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24765 @end menu
24766
24767 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24768 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24769 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24770
24771 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24772 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24773 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24774
24775 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24776 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24777
24778 @table @code
24779 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24780 @kindex set auto-load off
24781 @item set auto-load off
24782 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24783 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24784 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24785 @smallexample
24786 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24787 @end smallexample
24788
24789 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24790 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24791 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24792 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24793 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24794 @code{set auto-load no}.
24795
24796 @anchor{show auto-load}
24797 @kindex show auto-load
24798 @item show auto-load
24799 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24800 or disabled.
24801
24802 @smallexample
24803 (gdb) show auto-load
24804 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24805 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24806 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24807 is on.
24808 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24809 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24810 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24811 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24812 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24813 @end smallexample
24814
24815 @anchor{info auto-load}
24816 @kindex info auto-load
24817 @item info auto-load
24818 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24819 not.
24820
24821 @smallexample
24822 (gdb) info auto-load
24823 gdb-scripts:
24824 Loaded Script
24825 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24826 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24827 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24828 loaded.
24829 python-scripts:
24830 Loaded Script
24831 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24832 @end smallexample
24833 @end table
24834
24835 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24836
24837 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24838 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24839 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24840 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24841 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24842 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24843 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24844 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24845 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24846 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24847 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24848 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24849 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24850 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24851 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24852 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24853 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24854 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24855 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24856 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24857 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24858 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24859 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24860 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24861 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24862 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24863 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24864 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24865 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24866 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24867 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24868 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24869 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24870 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24871 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24872 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24873 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24874 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24875 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24876 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24877 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24878 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24879 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24880 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24881 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24882 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24883 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24884 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24885 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24886 @end multitable
24887
24888 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24889 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24890 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24891
24892 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24893 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24894 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24895
24896 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24897 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24898
24899 @table @code
24900 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24901 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24902 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24903 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24904 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24905
24906 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24907 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24908 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24909 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24910 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24911
24912 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24913 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24914 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24915 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24916 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24917 @end table
24918
24919 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24920 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24921 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24922
24923 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24924
24925 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24926 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24927
24928 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24929 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24930 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24931 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24932 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24933 library.
24934
24935 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24936 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24937
24938 @table @code
24939 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24940 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24941 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24942 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24943
24944 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24945 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24946 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24947 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24948 enabled or disabled.
24949
24950 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24951 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24952 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24953 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24954 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24955 @end table
24956
24957 @node Auto-loading safe path
24958 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24959 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24960
24961 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24962 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24963 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24964 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24965 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24966
24967 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24968 get loaded:
24969
24970 @smallexample
24971 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24972 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24973 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24974 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24975 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24976 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24977 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24978 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24979 @end smallexample
24980
24981 @noindent
24982 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24983 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24984
24985 @smallexample
24986 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24987 @end smallexample
24988
24989 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24990
24991 @table @code
24992 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24993 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24994 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24995 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24996 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24997 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24998 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24999 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25000 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
25001 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
25002
25003 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25004 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25005 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25006
25007 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
25008 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
25009 @item show auto-load safe-path
25010 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
25011 scripts.
25012
25013 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
25014 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
25015 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
25016 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
25017 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
25018 by the host platform path separator in use.
25019 @end table
25020
25021 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
25022 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
25023 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25024 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
25025 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
25026
25027 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
25028 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
25029 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
25030 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
25031 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
25032 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
25033 init file in the current directory
25034 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
25035
25036 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
25037 example, you could use one of the following ways:
25038
25039 @table @asis
25040 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
25041 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
25042 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
25043 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
25044
25045 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
25046 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
25047 @value{GDBN} session.
25048
25049 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
25050 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25051 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
25052 from trusted sources.
25053
25054 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
25055 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
25056 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
25057 trusted sources.
25058 @end table
25059
25060 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
25061 also suppresses any such warning messages:
25062
25063 @table @asis
25064 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
25065 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25066
25067 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
25068 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
25069 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
25070 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
25071 @end table
25072
25073 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
25074 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
25075 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
25076 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
25077 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
25078 recommended to be entered.
25079
25080 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
25081 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
25082 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
25083
25084 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
25085 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
25086 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
25087 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
25088 be printed.
25089
25090 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25091 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
25092 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
25093
25094 @smallexample
25095 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
25096 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
25097 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
25098 for objfile "/tmp/true".
25099 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
25100 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
25101 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
25102 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
25103 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
25104 @end smallexample
25105
25106 @table @code
25107 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
25108 @kindex set debug auto-load
25109 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
25110 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
25111
25112 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
25113 @kindex show debug auto-load
25114 @item show debug auto-load
25115 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25116 on or off.
25117 @end table
25118
25119 @node Messages/Warnings
25120 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25121
25122 @cindex verbose operation
25123 @cindex optional warnings
25124 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25125 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25126 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25127 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25128
25129 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25130 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25131 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25132
25133 @table @code
25134 @kindex set verbose
25135 @item set verbose on
25136 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25137
25138 @item set verbose off
25139 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25140
25141 @kindex show verbose
25142 @item show verbose
25143 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25144 @end table
25145
25146 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25147 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25148 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25149 Symbol Files}).
25150
25151 @table @code
25152
25153 @kindex set complaints
25154 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25155 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25156 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25157 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25158 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25159
25160 @kindex show complaints
25161 @item show complaints
25162 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25163
25164 @end table
25165
25166 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25167 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25168 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25169 you try to run a program which is already running:
25170
25171 @smallexample
25172 (@value{GDBP}) run
25173 The program being debugged has been started already.
25174 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25175 @end smallexample
25176
25177 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25178 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25179
25180 @table @code
25181
25182 @kindex set confirm
25183 @cindex flinching
25184 @cindex confirmation
25185 @cindex stupid questions
25186 @item set confirm off
25187 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25188 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25189 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25190
25191 @item set confirm on
25192 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25193
25194 @kindex show confirm
25195 @item show confirm
25196 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25197
25198 @end table
25199
25200 @cindex command tracing
25201 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25202 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25203 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25204 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25205
25206 @table @code
25207 @kindex set trace-commands
25208 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25209 @item set trace-commands on
25210 Enable command tracing.
25211 @item set trace-commands off
25212 Disable command tracing.
25213 @item show trace-commands
25214 Display the current state of command tracing.
25215 @end table
25216
25217 @node Debugging Output
25218 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25219 @cindex optional debugging messages
25220
25221 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25222 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25223 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25224 section documents those commands.
25225
25226 @table @code
25227 @kindex set exec-done-display
25228 @item set exec-done-display
25229 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25230 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25231 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25232 @kindex show exec-done-display
25233 @item show exec-done-display
25234 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25235 notification.
25236 @kindex set debug
25237 @cindex ARM AArch64
25238 @item set debug aarch64
25239 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25240 The default is off.
25241 @kindex show debug
25242 @item show debug aarch64
25243 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25244 ARM AArch64.
25245 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25246 @cindex architecture debugging info
25247 @item set debug arch
25248 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25249 @item show debug arch
25250 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25251 @item set debug aix-solib
25252 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25253 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25254 support module. The default is off.
25255 @item show debug aix-thread
25256 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25257 @item set debug aix-thread
25258 @cindex AIX threads
25259 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25260 module.
25261 @item show debug aix-thread
25262 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25263 @item set debug check-physname
25264 @cindex physname
25265 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25266 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25267 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25268 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25269 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25270 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25271 @item show debug check-physname
25272 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25273 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25274 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25275 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25276 exported symbols. The default is off.
25277 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25278 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25279 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25280 @item set debug dwarf-die
25281 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25282 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25283 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25284 A value of zero turns off the display.
25285 @item show debug dwarf-die
25286 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25287 @item set debug dwarf-line
25288 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25289 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25290 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25291 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25292 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25293 @item show debug dwarf-line
25294 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25295 @item set debug dwarf-read
25296 @cindex DWARF Reading
25297 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25298 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25299 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25300 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25301 @item show debug dwarf-read
25302 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25303 @item set debug displaced
25304 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25305 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25306 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25307 @item show debug displaced
25308 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25309 related to displaced stepping.
25310 @item set debug event
25311 @cindex event debugging info
25312 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25313 default is off.
25314 @item show debug event
25315 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25316 info.
25317 @item set debug expression
25318 @cindex expression debugging info
25319 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25320 expression parsing. The default is off.
25321 @item show debug expression
25322 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25323 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25324 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25325 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25326 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25327 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25328 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25329 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25330 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25331 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25332 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25333 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25334 @item set debug frame
25335 @cindex frame debugging info
25336 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25337 default is off.
25338 @item show debug frame
25339 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25340 info.
25341 @item set debug gnu-nat
25342 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25343 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25344 @item show debug gnu-nat
25345 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25346 @item set debug infrun
25347 @cindex inferior debugging info
25348 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25349 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25350 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25351 @item show debug infrun
25352 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25353 @item set debug jit
25354 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25355 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25356 @item show debug jit
25357 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25358 @item set debug lin-lwp
25359 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25360 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25361 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25362 @item show debug lin-lwp
25363 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25364 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25365 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25366 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25367 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25368 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25369 @item set debug mach-o
25370 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25371 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25372 processing. The default is off.
25373 @item show debug mach-o
25374 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25375 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25376 @item set debug notification
25377 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25378 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25379 The default is off.
25380 @item show debug notification
25381 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25382 @item set debug observer
25383 @cindex observer debugging info
25384 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25385 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25386 @item show debug observer
25387 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25388 @item set debug overload
25389 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25390 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25391 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25392 is off.
25393 @item show debug overload
25394 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25395 debugging info.
25396 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25397 @cindex debug expression parser
25398 @item set debug parser
25399 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25400 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25401 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25402 details. The default is off.
25403 @item show debug parser
25404 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25405 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25406 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25407 @cindex debug remote protocol
25408 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25409 @cindex display remote packets
25410 @item set debug remote
25411 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25412 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25413 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25414 @item show debug remote
25415 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25416
25417 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25418 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25419 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25420 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25421
25422 @item set debug serial
25423 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25424 default is off.
25425 @item show debug serial
25426 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25427 info.
25428 @item set debug solib-frv
25429 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25430 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25431 @item show debug solib-frv
25432 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25433 messages.
25434 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25435 @cindex symbol lookup
25436 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25437 The default is 0 (off).
25438 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25439 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25440 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25441 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25442 @item set debug symfile
25443 @cindex symbol file functions
25444 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25445 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25446 @item show debug symfile
25447 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25448 @item set debug symtab-create
25449 @cindex symbol table creation
25450 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25451 The default is 0 (off).
25452 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25453 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25454 @item show debug symtab-create
25455 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25456 @item set debug target
25457 @cindex target debugging info
25458 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25459 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25460 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25461 value of large memory transfers.
25462 @item show debug target
25463 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25464 info.
25465 @item set debug timestamp
25466 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25467 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25468 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25469 message.
25470 @item show debug timestamp
25471 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25472 debugging info.
25473 @item set debug varobj
25474 @cindex variable object debugging info
25475 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25476 info. The default is off.
25477 @item show debug varobj
25478 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25479 debugging info.
25480 @item set debug xml
25481 @cindex XML parser debugging
25482 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25483 @item show debug xml
25484 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25485 @end table
25486
25487 @node Other Misc Settings
25488 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25489 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25490
25491 @table @code
25492 @kindex set interactive-mode
25493 @item set interactive-mode
25494 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25495 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25496 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25497 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25498 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25499 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25500 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25501 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25502
25503 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25504 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25505 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25506 inside a cygwin window.
25507
25508 @kindex show interactive-mode
25509 @item show interactive-mode
25510 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25511 @end table
25512
25513 @node Extending GDB
25514 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25515 @cindex extending GDB
25516
25517 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25518 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25519 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25520 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25521 being debugged.
25522
25523 @menu
25524 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25525 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25526 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25527 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25528 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25529 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25530 @end menu
25531
25532 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25533 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25534 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25535 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25536 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25537 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25538
25539 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25540 setting:
25541
25542 @table @code
25543 @kindex set script-extension
25544 @kindex show script-extension
25545 @item set script-extension off
25546 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25547
25548 @item set script-extension soft
25549 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25550 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25551 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25552 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25553
25554 @item set script-extension strict
25555 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25556 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25557 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25558
25559 @item show script-extension
25560 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25561
25562 @end table
25563
25564 @node Sequences
25565 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25566
25567 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25568 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25569 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25570 files.
25571
25572 @menu
25573 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25574 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25575 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25576 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25577 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25578 @end menu
25579
25580 @node Define
25581 @subsection User-defined Commands
25582
25583 @cindex user-defined command
25584 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25585 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25586 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25587 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25588 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25589 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25590
25591 @smallexample
25592 define adder
25593 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25594 end
25595 @end smallexample
25596
25597 @noindent
25598 To execute the command use:
25599
25600 @smallexample
25601 adder 1 2 3
25602 @end smallexample
25603
25604 @noindent
25605 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25606 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25607 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25608 functions calls.
25609
25610 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25611 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25612 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25613 been passed.
25614
25615 @smallexample
25616 define adder
25617 if $argc == 2
25618 print $arg0 + $arg1
25619 end
25620 if $argc == 3
25621 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25622 end
25623 end
25624 @end smallexample
25625
25626 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25627 to process a variable number of arguments:
25628
25629 @smallexample
25630 define adder
25631 set $i = 0
25632 set $sum = 0
25633 while $i < $argc
25634 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25635 set $i = $i + 1
25636 end
25637 print $sum
25638 end
25639 @end smallexample
25640
25641 @table @code
25642
25643 @kindex define
25644 @item define @var{commandname}
25645 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25646 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25647 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25648 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25649 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25650 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25651
25652 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25653 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25654 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25655
25656 @kindex document
25657 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25658 @item document @var{commandname}
25659 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25660 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25661 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25662 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25663 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25664 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25665
25666 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25667 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25668 does not change the documentation.
25669
25670 @kindex dont-repeat
25671 @cindex don't repeat command
25672 @item dont-repeat
25673 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25674 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25675 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25676
25677 @kindex help user-defined
25678 @item help user-defined
25679 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25680 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25681 included (if any).
25682
25683 @kindex show user
25684 @item show user
25685 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25686 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25687 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25688 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25689 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25690
25691 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25692 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25693 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25694 @item show max-user-call-depth
25695 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25696 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25697 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25698 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25699 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25700 @end table
25701
25702 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25703 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25704
25705 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25706 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25707 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25708
25709 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25710 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25711 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25712 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25713
25714 @node Hooks
25715 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25716 @cindex command hooks
25717 @cindex hooks, for commands
25718 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25719
25720 @kindex hook
25721 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25722 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25723 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25724 before that command.
25725
25726 @cindex hooks, post-command
25727 @kindex hookpost
25728 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25729 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25730 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25731 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25732 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25733
25734 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25735 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25736
25737 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25738 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25739
25740 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25741 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25742 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25743 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25744 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25745
25746 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25747 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25748 you could define:
25749
25750 @smallexample
25751 define hook-stop
25752 handle SIGALRM nopass
25753 end
25754
25755 define hook-run
25756 handle SIGALRM pass
25757 end
25758
25759 define hook-continue
25760 handle SIGALRM pass
25761 end
25762 @end smallexample
25763
25764 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25765 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25766 you could define:
25767
25768 @smallexample
25769 define hook-echo
25770 echo <<<---
25771 end
25772
25773 define hookpost-echo
25774 echo --->>>\n
25775 end
25776
25777 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25778 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25779 (@value{GDBP})
25780
25781 @end smallexample
25782
25783 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25784 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25785 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25786 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25787 @c or not?
25788 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25789 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25790 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25791
25792 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25793 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25794 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25795
25796 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25797 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25798
25799 @node Command Files
25800 @subsection Command Files
25801
25802 @cindex command files
25803 @cindex scripting commands
25804 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25805 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25806 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25807 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25808 terminal.
25809
25810 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25811 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25812 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25813 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25814 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25815
25816 @table @code
25817 @kindex source
25818 @cindex execute commands from a file
25819 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25820 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25821 @end table
25822
25823 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25824 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25825 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25826 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25827 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25828
25829 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25830 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25831 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25832 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25833 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25834 is not relevant to scripts.
25835
25836 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25837 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25838 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25839 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25840 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25841 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25842 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25843 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25844 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25845 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25846 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25847 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25848 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25849 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25850
25851 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25852 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25853 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25854
25855 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25856 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25857 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25858 when called from command files.
25859
25860 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25861 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25862 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25863 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25864 the next command.
25865
25866 @smallexample
25867 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25868 @end smallexample
25869
25870 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25871 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25872 would be directed to @file{log}.
25873
25874 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25875 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25876 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25877 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25878 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25879 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25880 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25881 conditionally, etc.
25882
25883 @table @code
25884 @kindex if
25885 @kindex else
25886 @item if
25887 @itemx else
25888 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25889 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25890 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25891 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25892 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25893 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25894 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25895
25896 @kindex while
25897 @item while
25898 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25899 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25900 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25901 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25902 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25903 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25904
25905 @kindex loop_break
25906 @item loop_break
25907 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25908 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25909 line.
25910
25911 @kindex loop_continue
25912 @item loop_continue
25913 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25914 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25915 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25916 the controlling expression.
25917
25918 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25919 @item end
25920 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25921 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25922 @end table
25923
25924
25925 @node Output
25926 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25927
25928 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25929 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25930 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25931 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25932 want.
25933
25934 @table @code
25935 @kindex echo
25936 @item echo @var{text}
25937 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25938 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25939 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25940 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25941 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25942 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25943 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25944 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25945 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25946 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25947 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25948
25949 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25950 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25951
25952 @smallexample
25953 echo This is some text\n\
25954 which is continued\n\
25955 onto several lines.\n
25956 @end smallexample
25957
25958 produces the same output as
25959
25960 @smallexample
25961 echo This is some text\n
25962 echo which is continued\n
25963 echo onto several lines.\n
25964 @end smallexample
25965
25966 @kindex output
25967 @item output @var{expression}
25968 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25969 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25970 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25971 on expressions.
25972
25973 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25974 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25975 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25976 Formats}, for more information.
25977
25978 @kindex printf
25979 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25980 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25981 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25982 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25983 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25984 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25985 executing the code below:
25986
25987 @smallexample
25988 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25989 @end smallexample
25990
25991 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25992 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25993 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25994 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25995 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25996 printed.
25997
25998 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25999
26000 @smallexample
26001 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
26002 @end smallexample
26003
26004 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
26005 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
26006 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
26007
26008 @itemize @bullet
26009 @item
26010 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
26011
26012 @item
26013 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
26014 width.
26015
26016 @item
26017 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
26018 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
26019
26020 @item
26021 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
26022 supported.
26023
26024 @item
26025 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
26026
26027 @item
26028 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
26029 @end itemize
26030
26031 @noindent
26032 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
26033 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
26034 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
26035 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
26036
26037 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
26038 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
26039 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
26040 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
26041 supported.
26042
26043 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
26044 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
26045 together with a floating point specifier.
26046 letters:
26047
26048 @itemize @bullet
26049 @item
26050 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
26051
26052 @item
26053 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
26054
26055 @item
26056 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
26057 @end itemize
26058
26059 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
26060 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
26061 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
26062
26063 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
26064 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
26065
26066 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
26067 @smallexample
26068 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
26069 @end smallexample
26070
26071 @anchor{eval}
26072 @kindex eval
26073 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26074 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26075 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
26076
26077 @end table
26078
26079 @node Auto-loading sequences
26080 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
26081 @cindex native script auto-loading
26082
26083 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26084 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
26085 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
26086 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
26087
26088 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26089 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26090
26091 @table @code
26092 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
26093 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
26094 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
26095 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
26096
26097 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
26098 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
26099 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
26100 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
26101 disabled.
26102
26103 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
26104 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
26105 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
26106 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
26107 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
26108 auto-loaded.
26109 @end table
26110
26111 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
26112 matching names are printed.
26113
26114 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
26115 @include python.texi
26116
26117 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26118 @include guile.texi
26119
26120 @node Auto-loading extensions
26121 @section Auto-loading extensions
26122 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26123
26124 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26125 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26126 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26127 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26128 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26129
26130 @menu
26131 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26132 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26133 * Which flavor to choose?::
26134 @end menu
26135
26136 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26137 debugging commands and features.
26138
26139 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26140 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26141 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26142 for more information.
26143 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26144 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26145
26146 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26147 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26148
26149 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26150 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26151 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26152 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26153 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26154
26155 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26156 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26157 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26158 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26159
26160 @table @code
26161 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26162 GDB's own command language
26163 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26164 Python
26165 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26166 Guile
26167 @end table
26168
26169 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26170 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26171 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26172 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26173 script in the specified extension language.
26174
26175 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26176 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26177
26178 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26179 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26180
26181 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26182 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26183 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26184 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26185 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26186 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26187
26188 @table @code
26189 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26190 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26191 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26192 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26193 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26194 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26195
26196 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26197 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26198
26199 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26200 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26201 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26202 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26203
26204 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26205 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26206 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26207 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26208 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26209 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26210 platform.
26211
26212 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26213 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26214 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26215
26216 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26217 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26218 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26219 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26220
26221 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26222 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26223 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26224 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26225 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26226 @end table
26227
26228 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26229 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26230 @var{objfile} is opened.
26231 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26232 is evaluated more than once.
26233
26234 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26235 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26236 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26237
26238 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26239 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26240 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26241 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26242 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26243 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26244 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26245
26246 The following entries are supported:
26247
26248 @table @code
26249 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26250 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26251 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26252 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26253 @end table
26254
26255 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26256
26257 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26258 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26259 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26260 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26261 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26262
26263 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26264 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26265
26266 @example
26267 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26268 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26269 asm("\
26270 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26271 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26272 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26273 .popsection \n\
26274 ");
26275 @end example
26276
26277 @noindent
26278 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26279 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26280
26281 @example
26282 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26283 @end example
26284
26285 The script name may include directories if desired.
26286
26287 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26288 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26289
26290 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26291 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26292 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26293 will remove duplicates.
26294
26295 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26296
26297 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26298 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26299 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26300 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26301 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26302 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26303 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26304 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26305 on its name.
26306
26307 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26308 testsuite.
26309
26310 @example
26311 #include "symcat.h"
26312 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26313 asm(
26314 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26315 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26316 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26317 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26318 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26319 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26320 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26321 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26322 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26323 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26324 ".byte 0\n"
26325 ".popsection\n"
26326 );
26327 @end example
26328
26329 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26330 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26331 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26332 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26333
26334 @node Which flavor to choose?
26335 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26336
26337 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26338 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26339
26340 @noindent
26341 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26342
26343 @itemize @bullet
26344 @item
26345 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26346
26347 @item
26348 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26349
26350 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26351 in the source search path.
26352 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26353 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26354
26355 @item
26356 Doesn't require source code additions.
26357 @end itemize
26358
26359 @noindent
26360 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26361
26362 @itemize @bullet
26363 @item
26364 Works with static linking.
26365
26366 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26367 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26368 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26369 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26370 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26371
26372 @item
26373 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26374
26375 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26376 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26377
26378 @item
26379 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26380
26381 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26382 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26383 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26384 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26385 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26386 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26387 @end itemize
26388
26389 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26390 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26391
26392 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26393 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26394 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26395
26396 @subsection Python comes first
26397
26398 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26399 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26400 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26401 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26402 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26403 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26404 pretty-printed form of a value).
26405 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26406 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26407 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26408
26409 @node Aliases
26410 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26411 @cindex aliases for commands
26412
26413 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26414 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26415 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26416 that involves less typing.
26417
26418 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26419 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26420 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26421
26422 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26423 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26424 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26425
26426 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26427
26428 @table @code
26429
26430 @kindex alias
26431 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26432
26433 @end table
26434
26435 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26436 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26437 underscores.
26438
26439 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26440 that is being aliased.
26441
26442 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26443 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26444 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26445
26446 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26447 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26448
26449 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26450 of a command so that there is less to type.
26451 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26452 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26453 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26454 The following will accomplish this.
26455
26456 @smallexample
26457 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26458 @end smallexample
26459
26460 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26461 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26462 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26463 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26464
26465 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26466 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26467 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26468 of a command.
26469
26470 @smallexample
26471 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26472 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26473 (gdb) set p elms 20
26474 (gdb) show p elms
26475 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26476 @end smallexample
26477
26478 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26479 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26480 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26481
26482 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26483 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26484
26485 @smallexample
26486 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26487 @end smallexample
26488
26489 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26490 alias for a more complex command.
26491 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26492
26493 @smallexample
26494 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26495 (gdb) spe 20
26496 @end smallexample
26497
26498 @node Interpreters
26499 @chapter Command Interpreters
26500 @cindex command interpreters
26501
26502 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26503 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26504 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26505
26506 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26507 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26508 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26509 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26510
26511 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26512 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26513 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26514 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26515
26516 @table @code
26517 @item console
26518 @cindex console interpreter
26519 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26520 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26521 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26522
26523 @item mi
26524 @cindex mi interpreter
26525 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26526 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26527 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26528 Interface}.
26529
26530 @item mi2
26531 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26532 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26533
26534 @item mi1
26535 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26536 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26537
26538 @end table
26539
26540 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26541
26542 @kindex interpreter-exec
26543 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26544 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26545 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26546
26547 @smallexample
26548 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26549 @end smallexample
26550
26551 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26552 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26553
26554 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26555 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26556 permanently.
26557
26558 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26559
26560 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26561 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26562 device (usually a tty).
26563
26564 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26565 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26566 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26567 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26568 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26569 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26570 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26571 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26572 the separate MI interpreter.
26573
26574 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26575 @code{new-ui} command:
26576
26577 @kindex new-ui
26578 @cindex new user interface
26579 @smallexample
26580 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26581 @end smallexample
26582
26583 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26584 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26585 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26586 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26587 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26588 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26589
26590 @smallexample
26591 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26592 @end smallexample
26593
26594 @noindent
26595 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26596
26597 @node TUI
26598 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26599 @cindex TUI
26600 @cindex Text User Interface
26601
26602 @menu
26603 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26604 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26605 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26606 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26607 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26608 @end menu
26609
26610 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26611 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26612 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26613 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26614 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26615 is available.
26616
26617 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26618 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26619 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26620 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26621 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26622 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26623
26624 @node TUI Overview
26625 @section TUI Overview
26626
26627 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26628
26629 @table @emph
26630 @item command
26631 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26632 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26633 managed using readline.
26634
26635 @item source
26636 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26637 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26638
26639 @item assembly
26640 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26641
26642 @item register
26643 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26644 when their values change.
26645 @end table
26646
26647 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26648 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26649 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26650 indicates the breakpoint type:
26651
26652 @table @code
26653 @item B
26654 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26655
26656 @item b
26657 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26658
26659 @item H
26660 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26661
26662 @item h
26663 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26664 @end table
26665
26666 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26667
26668 @table @code
26669 @item +
26670 Breakpoint is enabled.
26671
26672 @item -
26673 Breakpoint is disabled.
26674 @end table
26675
26676 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26677 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26678 changes.
26679
26680 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26681 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26682 layouts:
26683
26684 @itemize @bullet
26685 @item
26686 source only,
26687
26688 @item
26689 assembly only,
26690
26691 @item
26692 source and assembly,
26693
26694 @item
26695 source and registers, or
26696
26697 @item
26698 assembly and registers.
26699 @end itemize
26700
26701 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26702
26703 @table @emph
26704 @item target
26705 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26706 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26707
26708 @item process
26709 Gives the current process or thread number.
26710 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26711
26712 @item function
26713 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26714 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26715 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26716 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26717
26718 @item line
26719 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26720 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26721
26722 @item pc
26723 Indicates the current program counter address.
26724 @end table
26725
26726 @node TUI Keys
26727 @section TUI Key Bindings
26728 @cindex TUI key bindings
26729
26730 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26731 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26732 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26733 @end ifset
26734 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26735 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26736 @end ifclear
26737 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26738 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26739
26740 @table @kbd
26741 @kindex C-x C-a
26742 @item C-x C-a
26743 @kindex C-x a
26744 @itemx C-x a
26745 @kindex C-x A
26746 @itemx C-x A
26747 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26748 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26749 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26750 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26751 The screen is then refreshed.
26752
26753 @kindex C-x 1
26754 @item C-x 1
26755 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26756 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26757 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26758
26759 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26760
26761 @kindex C-x 2
26762 @item C-x 2
26763 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26764 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26765 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26766 previous layout and the new one.
26767
26768 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26769
26770 @kindex C-x o
26771 @item C-x o
26772 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26773 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26774 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26775
26776 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26777
26778 @kindex C-x s
26779 @item C-x s
26780 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26781 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26782 @end table
26783
26784 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26785
26786 @table @asis
26787 @kindex PgUp
26788 @item @key{PgUp}
26789 Scroll the active window one page up.
26790
26791 @kindex PgDn
26792 @item @key{PgDn}
26793 Scroll the active window one page down.
26794
26795 @kindex Up
26796 @item @key{Up}
26797 Scroll the active window one line up.
26798
26799 @kindex Down
26800 @item @key{Down}
26801 Scroll the active window one line down.
26802
26803 @kindex Left
26804 @item @key{Left}
26805 Scroll the active window one column left.
26806
26807 @kindex Right
26808 @item @key{Right}
26809 Scroll the active window one column right.
26810
26811 @kindex C-L
26812 @item @kbd{C-L}
26813 Refresh the screen.
26814 @end table
26815
26816 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26817 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26818 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26819 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26820 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26821
26822 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26823 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26824 @cindex TUI single key mode
26825
26826 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26827 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26828 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26829
26830 @table @kbd
26831 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26832 @item c
26833 continue
26834
26835 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26836 @item d
26837 down
26838
26839 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26840 @item f
26841 finish
26842
26843 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26844 @item n
26845 next
26846
26847 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26848 @item o
26849 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26850
26851 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26852 @item q
26853 exit the SingleKey mode.
26854
26855 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26856 @item r
26857 run
26858
26859 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26860 @item s
26861 step
26862
26863 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26864 @item i
26865 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26866
26867 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26868 @item u
26869 up
26870
26871 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26872 @item v
26873 info locals
26874
26875 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26876 @item w
26877 where
26878 @end table
26879
26880 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26881 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26882 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26883 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26884 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26885 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26886
26887
26888 @node TUI Commands
26889 @section TUI-specific Commands
26890 @cindex TUI commands
26891
26892 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26893 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26894 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26895 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26896
26897 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26898 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26899 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26900 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26901 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26902
26903 @table @code
26904 @item tui enable
26905 @kindex tui enable
26906 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26907 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26908 otherwise a default layout is used.
26909
26910 @item tui disable
26911 @kindex tui disable
26912 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26913
26914 @item info win
26915 @kindex info win
26916 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26917
26918 @item layout @var{name}
26919 @kindex layout
26920 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26921 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26922 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26923
26924 @table @code
26925 @item next
26926 Display the next layout.
26927
26928 @item prev
26929 Display the previous layout.
26930
26931 @item src
26932 Display the source and command windows.
26933
26934 @item asm
26935 Display the assembly and command windows.
26936
26937 @item split
26938 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26939
26940 @item regs
26941 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26942 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26943 register, assembler, and command windows.
26944 @end table
26945
26946 @item focus @var{name}
26947 @kindex focus
26948 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26949 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26950
26951 @table @code
26952 @item next
26953 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26954
26955 @item prev
26956 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26957
26958 @item src
26959 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26960
26961 @item asm
26962 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26963
26964 @item regs
26965 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26966
26967 @item cmd
26968 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26969 @end table
26970
26971 @item refresh
26972 @kindex refresh
26973 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26974
26975 @item tui reg @var{group}
26976 @kindex tui reg
26977 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26978 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26979 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26980 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26981 following groups are available on most targets:
26982 @table @code
26983 @item next
26984 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26985 through all of the available register groups.
26986
26987 @item prev
26988 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26989 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26990 @var{next}.
26991
26992 @item general
26993 Display the general registers.
26994 @item float
26995 Display the floating point registers.
26996 @item system
26997 Display the system registers.
26998 @item vector
26999 Display the vector registers.
27000 @item all
27001 Display all registers.
27002 @end table
27003
27004 @item update
27005 @kindex update
27006 Update the source window and the current execution point.
27007
27008 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
27009 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
27010 @kindex winheight
27011 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
27012 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
27013 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
27014 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
27015 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
27016 @end table
27017
27018 @node TUI Configuration
27019 @section TUI Configuration Variables
27020 @cindex TUI configuration variables
27021
27022 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
27023
27024 @table @code
27025 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
27026 @kindex set tui border-kind
27027 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
27028 The possible values are the following:
27029 @table @code
27030 @item space
27031 Use a space character to draw the border.
27032
27033 @item ascii
27034 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
27035
27036 @item acs
27037 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
27038 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
27039 @end table
27040
27041 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
27042 @kindex set tui border-mode
27043 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
27044 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
27045 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
27046 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
27047 @table @code
27048 @item normal
27049 Use normal attributes to display the border.
27050
27051 @item standout
27052 Use standout mode.
27053
27054 @item reverse
27055 Use reverse video mode.
27056
27057 @item half
27058 Use half bright mode.
27059
27060 @item half-standout
27061 Use half bright and standout mode.
27062
27063 @item bold
27064 Use extra bright or bold mode.
27065
27066 @item bold-standout
27067 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
27068 @end table
27069
27070 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
27071 @kindex set tui tab-width
27072 @kindex tabset
27073 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
27074 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
27075 assembly windows.
27076 @end table
27077
27078 @node Emacs
27079 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
27080
27081 @cindex Emacs
27082 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
27083 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
27084 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
27085 @value{GDBN}.
27086
27087 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
27088 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
27089 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
27090 created Emacs buffer.
27091 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
27092
27093 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
27094 things:
27095
27096 @itemize @bullet
27097 @item
27098 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
27099 the GUD buffer.
27100
27101 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
27102 and output done by the program you are debugging.
27103
27104 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
27105 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
27106 in this way.
27107
27108 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
27109 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
27110 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
27111 stop.
27112
27113 @item
27114 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
27115
27116 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27117 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27118 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27119 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27120 and the source.
27121
27122 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27123 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27124 @end itemize
27125
27126 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27127 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27128 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27129 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27130
27131 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27132 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27133 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27134 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27135 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27136 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27137 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27138 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27139 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27140
27141 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27142 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27143 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27144 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27145
27146 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27147 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27148 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27149 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27150 one you want.
27151
27152 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27153 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27154
27155 @table @kbd
27156 @item C-h m
27157 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27158
27159 @item C-c C-s
27160 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27161 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27162
27163 @item C-c C-n
27164 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27165 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27166 to show the current file and location.
27167
27168 @item C-c C-i
27169 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27170 display window accordingly.
27171
27172 @item C-c C-f
27173 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27174 @code{finish} command.
27175
27176 @item C-c C-r
27177 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27178 command.
27179
27180 @item C-c <
27181 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27182 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27183 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27184
27185 @item C-c >
27186 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27187 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27188 @end table
27189
27190 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27191 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27192
27193 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27194 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27195 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27196 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27197 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27198 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27199 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27200
27201 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27202 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27203 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27204 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27205 frame.
27206
27207 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27208 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27209 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27210 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27211 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27212 to correspond properly with the code.
27213
27214 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27215 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27216 Emacs Manual}).
27217
27218 @node GDB/MI
27219 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27220
27221 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27222
27223 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27224 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27225 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27226 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27227 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27228 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27229
27230 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27231 in the form of a reference manual.
27232
27233 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27234 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27235 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27236
27237 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27238
27239 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27240 This chapter uses the following notation:
27241
27242 @itemize @bullet
27243 @item
27244 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27245
27246 @item
27247 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27248 it may or may not be given.
27249
27250 @item
27251 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27252 may repeat zero or more times.
27253
27254 @item
27255 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27256 may repeat one or more times.
27257
27258 @item
27259 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27260 @end itemize
27261
27262 @ignore
27263 @heading Dependencies
27264 @end ignore
27265
27266 @menu
27267 * GDB/MI General Design::
27268 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27269 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27270 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27271 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27272 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27273 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27274 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27275 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27276 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27277 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27278 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27279 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27280 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27281 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27282 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27283 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27284 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27285 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27286 @ignore
27287 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27288 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27289 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27290 @end ignore
27291 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27292 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27293 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27294 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27295 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27296 @end menu
27297
27298 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27299 @node GDB/MI General Design
27300 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27301 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27302
27303 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27304 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27305 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27306 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27307 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27308 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27309 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27310 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27311 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27312 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27313
27314 The important examples of notifications are:
27315 @itemize @bullet
27316
27317 @item
27318 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27319 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27320 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27321 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27322 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27323 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27324 command itself was successfully executed.
27325
27326 @item
27327 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27328 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27329 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27330 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27331 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27332 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27333
27334 @item
27335 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27336 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27337 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27338 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27339 orthogonal frontend design.
27340
27341 @end itemize
27342
27343 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27344 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27345 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27346 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27347 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27348 the user interface.
27349
27350
27351 @menu
27352 * Context management::
27353 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27354 * Thread groups::
27355 @end menu
27356
27357 @node Context management
27358 @subsection Context management
27359
27360 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27361
27362 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27363 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27364 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27365 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27366 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27367 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27368 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27369 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27370 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27371
27372 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27373 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27374 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27375 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27376 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27377 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27378 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27379 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27380 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27381 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27382 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27383
27384 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27385 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27386 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27387 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27388 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27389 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27390 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27391 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27392 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27393 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27394
27395 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27396 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27397 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27398 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27399 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27400 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27401 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27402 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27403 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27404 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27405 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27406 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27407 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27408 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27409 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27410 @samp{--frame} options.
27411
27412 @subsubsection Language
27413
27414 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27415 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27416 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27417 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27418 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27419 For instance:
27420
27421 @smallexample
27422 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27423 ^done,value="4"
27424 (gdb)
27425 @end smallexample
27426
27427 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27428 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27429 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27430
27431 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27432 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27433
27434 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27435 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27436 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27437 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27438 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27439 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27440 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27441 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27442 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27443
27444 @table @code
27445 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27446 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27447 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27448
27449 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27450 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27451 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27452
27453 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27454 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27455 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27456 MI commands even while the target is running.
27457
27458 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27459 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27460 @end table
27461
27462 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27463 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27464 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27465 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27466 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27467 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27468
27469 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27470 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27471 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27472 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27473 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27474 are running.
27475
27476 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27477 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27478 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27479 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27480 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27481 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27482 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27483 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27484 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27485 @samp{--thread} option).
27486
27487 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27488 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27489 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27490 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27491
27492 @node Thread groups
27493 @subsection Thread groups
27494 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27495 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27496 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27497 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27498 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27499
27500 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27501 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27502 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27503 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27504 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27505 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27506 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27507 into processes.
27508
27509 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27510 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27511 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27512 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27513 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27514 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27515 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27516 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27517 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27518 the members of specific thread group.
27519
27520 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27521 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27522 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27523 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27524 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27525 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27526 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27527 after attaching to that thread group.
27528
27529 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27530 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27531 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27532 such thread groups.
27533
27534 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27535 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27536 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27537
27538 @menu
27539 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27540 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27541 @end menu
27542
27543 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27544 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27545
27546 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27547 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27548 @table @code
27549 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27550 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27551
27552 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27553 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27554 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27555
27556 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27557 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27558 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27559
27560 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27561 "any sequence of digits"
27562
27563 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27564 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27565
27566 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27567 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27568
27569 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27570 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27571
27572 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27573 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27574 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27575
27576 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27577 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27578
27579 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27580 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27581 @end table
27582
27583 @noindent
27584 Notes:
27585
27586 @itemize @bullet
27587 @item
27588 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27589 output is described below.
27590
27591 @item
27592 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27593 finishes.
27594
27595 @item
27596 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27597 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27598 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27599 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27600 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27601 @end itemize
27602
27603 Pragmatics:
27604
27605 @itemize @bullet
27606 @item
27607 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27608
27609 @item
27610 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27611 @end itemize
27612
27613 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27614 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27615
27616 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27617 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27618 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27619 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27620 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27621 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27622
27623 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27624 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27625 @var{token}.
27626
27627 @table @code
27628 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27629 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27630
27631 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27632 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27633
27634 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27635 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27636
27637 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27638 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27639
27640 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27641 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27642
27643 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27644 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27645
27646 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27647 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27648
27649 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27650 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27651
27652 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27653 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27654
27655 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27656 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27657 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27658
27659 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27660 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27661
27662 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27663 @code{ @var{string} }
27664
27665 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27666 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27667
27668 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27669 @code{@var{c-string}}
27670
27671 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27672 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27673
27674 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27675 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27676 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27677
27678 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27679 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27680
27681 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27682 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27683
27684 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27685 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27686
27687 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27688 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27689
27690 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27691 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27692
27693 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27694 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27695 @end table
27696
27697 @noindent
27698 Notes:
27699
27700 @itemize @bullet
27701 @item
27702 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27703
27704 @item
27705 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27706 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27707 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27708 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27709 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27710 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27711 prior command.
27712
27713 @item
27714 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27715 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27716 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27717 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27718
27719 @item
27720 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27721 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27722 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27723 @samp{*}.
27724
27725 @item
27726 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27727 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27728 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27729 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27730
27731 @item
27732 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27733 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27734 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27735 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27736
27737 @item
27738 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27739 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27740 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27741
27742 @item
27743 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27744 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27745 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27746 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27747
27748 @item
27749 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27750 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27751 @var{values}.
27752
27753
27754 @end itemize
27755
27756 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27757 details about the various output records.
27758
27759 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27760 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27761 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27762
27763 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27764 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27765
27766 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27767 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27768 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27769 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27770 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27771 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27772
27773 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27774 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27775 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27776
27777 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27778 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27779 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27780 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27781
27782 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27783 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27784
27785 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27786 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27787 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27788 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27789 might change.
27790
27791 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27792 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27793 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27794 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27795
27796 @itemize @bullet
27797 @item
27798 New MI commands may be added.
27799
27800 @item
27801 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27802
27803 @item
27804 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27805 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27806
27807 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27808 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27809
27810 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27811 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27812 @end itemize
27813
27814 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27815 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27816 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27817 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27818 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27819
27820 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27821 @c version?
27822
27823 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27824 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27825 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27826 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27827 @cindex mailing lists
27828
27829 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27830 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27831 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27832
27833 @menu
27834 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27835 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27836 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27837 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27838 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27839 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27840 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27841 @end menu
27842
27843 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27844 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27845
27846 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27847 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27848 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27849 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27850
27851 @table @code
27852 @findex ^done
27853 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27854 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27855 values.
27856
27857 @item "^running"
27858 @findex ^running
27859 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27860 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27861 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27862 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27863 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27864 which threads are resumed.
27865
27866 @item "^connected"
27867 @findex ^connected
27868 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27869
27870 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27871 @findex ^error
27872 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27873 the corresponding error message.
27874
27875 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27876 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27877 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27878
27879 @table @samp
27880 @item "undefined-command"
27881 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27882 @end table
27883
27884 @item "^exit"
27885 @findex ^exit
27886 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27887
27888 @end table
27889
27890 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27891 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27892
27893 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27894 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27895 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27896 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27897 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27898
27899 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27900 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27901 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27902 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27903 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27904
27905 @table @code
27906 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27907 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27908 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27909
27910 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27911 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27912 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27913 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27914
27915 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27916 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27917 internals.
27918 @end table
27919
27920 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27921 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27922
27923 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27924 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27925 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27926 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27927 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27928 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27929
27930 The following is the list of possible async records:
27931
27932 @table @code
27933
27934 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27935 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27936 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27937 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27938 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27939 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27940 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27941 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27942 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27943 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27944 it run freely.
27945
27946 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27947 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27948 following values:
27949
27950 @table @code
27951 @item breakpoint-hit
27952 A breakpoint was reached.
27953 @item watchpoint-trigger
27954 A watchpoint was triggered.
27955 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27956 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27957 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27958 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27959 @item function-finished
27960 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27961 @item location-reached
27962 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27963 @item watchpoint-scope
27964 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27965 @item end-stepping-range
27966 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27967 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27968 @item exited-signalled
27969 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27970 @item exited
27971 The inferior exited.
27972 @item exited-normally
27973 The inferior exited normally.
27974 @item signal-received
27975 A signal was received by the inferior.
27976 @item solib-event
27977 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27978 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27979 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27980 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27981 @item fork
27982 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27983 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27984 @item vfork
27985 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27986 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27987 @item syscall-entry
27988 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27989 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27990 @item syscall-return
27991 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27992 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27993 @item exec
27994 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27995 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27996 @end table
27997
27998 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27999 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
28000 Depending on whether all-stop
28001 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
28002 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
28003 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
28004 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
28005 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
28006 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
28007 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
28008 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
28009 if such information is not available.
28010
28011 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
28012 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
28013 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
28014 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
28015 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
28016 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
28017 cannot be used in any way.
28018
28019 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
28020 A thread group became associated with a running program,
28021 either because the program was just started or the thread group
28022 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
28023 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
28024 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
28025
28026 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
28027 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
28028 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
28029 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
28030 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
28031 only when the inferior exited with some code.
28032
28033 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28034 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28035 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
28036 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
28037 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
28038
28039 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
28040 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
28041 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
28042 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
28043 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
28044 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
28045 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
28046 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
28047 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
28048
28049 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
28050 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
28051
28052 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
28053 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
28054 that thread.
28055
28056 @item =library-loaded,...
28057 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
28058 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
28059 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
28060 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
28061 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
28062 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
28063 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
28064 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
28065 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
28066 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
28067 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
28068 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
28069 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
28070 to this library.
28071
28072 @item =library-unloaded,...
28073 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
28074 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
28075 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
28076 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
28077 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
28078 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
28079 thread groups.
28080
28081 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
28082 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
28083 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
28084 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
28085 frame is @var{tpnum}.
28086
28087 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
28088 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
28089 initial value @var{initial}.
28090
28091 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
28092 @itemx =tsv-deleted
28093 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
28094 trace state variables are deleted.
28095
28096 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
28097 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
28098 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
28099 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
28100 value of trace state variable is known.
28101
28102 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
28103 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
28104 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
28105 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
28106 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
28107 user.
28108
28109 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
28110 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
28111 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
28112
28113 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
28114 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
28115
28116 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28117 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28118 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28119 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28120 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28121
28122 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28123 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28124 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28125 for existing method and format values.
28126
28127 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28128 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28129 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28130 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28131 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28132 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28133
28134 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28135 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28136 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28137 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28138 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28139 executable code.
28140 @end table
28141
28142 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28143 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28144
28145 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28146 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28147 following fields:
28148
28149 @table @code
28150 @item number
28151 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
28152 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
28153 @samp{1.2}.
28154
28155 @item type
28156 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28157 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28158
28159 @item catch-type
28160 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28161 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28162
28163 @item disp
28164 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28165 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28166 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28167
28168 @item enabled
28169 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28170 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28171 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28172
28173 @item addr
28174 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28175 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28176 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28177 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28178 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28179
28180 @item func
28181 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28182 If not known, this field is not present.
28183
28184 @item filename
28185 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28186 If not known, this field is not present.
28187
28188 @item fullname
28189 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28190 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28191
28192 @item line
28193 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28194 If not known, this field is not present.
28195
28196 @item at
28197 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28198 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28199 by a symbol name.
28200
28201 @item pending
28202 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28203 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28204
28205 @item evaluated-by
28206 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28207 @samp{target}.
28208
28209 @item thread
28210 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28211 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28212
28213 @item task
28214 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28215 field will hold the task identifier.
28216
28217 @item cond
28218 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28219
28220 @item ignore
28221 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28222
28223 @item enable
28224 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28225
28226 @item traceframe-usage
28227 FIXME.
28228
28229 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28230 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28231
28232 @item mask
28233 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28234
28235 @item pass
28236 A tracepoint's pass count.
28237
28238 @item original-location
28239 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28240 This field is optional.
28241
28242 @item times
28243 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28244
28245 @item installed
28246 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28247 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28248 is not.
28249
28250 @item what
28251 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28252
28253 @end table
28254
28255 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28256 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28257
28258 @smallexample
28259 -> -break-insert main
28260 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28261 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28262 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28263 times="0"@}
28264 <- (gdb)
28265 @end smallexample
28266
28267 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28268 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28269
28270 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28271 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28272 fields:
28273
28274 @table @code
28275 @item level
28276 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28277 zero. This field is always present.
28278
28279 @item func
28280 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28281 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28282
28283 @item addr
28284 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28285
28286 @item file
28287 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28288 address. This field may be absent.
28289
28290 @item line
28291 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28292 may be absent.
28293
28294 @item from
28295 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28296 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28297
28298 @end table
28299
28300 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28301 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28302
28303 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28304 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28305 stated otherwise.
28306
28307 @table @code
28308 @item id
28309 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28310
28311 @item target-id
28312 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28313
28314 @item details
28315 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28316 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28317 frontend. This field is optional.
28318
28319 @item name
28320 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28321 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28322 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28323 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28324 field is omitted.
28325
28326 @item state
28327 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28328 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28329
28330 @item frame
28331 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28332 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28333 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28334
28335 @item core
28336 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28337 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28338 @end table
28339
28340 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28341 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28342
28343 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28344 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28345 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28346 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28347 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28348 the @code{exception-message} field.
28349
28350 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28351 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28352 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28353 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28354
28355 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28356 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28357 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28358 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28359
28360 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28361 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28362
28363 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28364
28365 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28366 information of the breakpoint.
28367
28368 @smallexample
28369 -> -break-insert main
28370 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28371 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28372 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28373 times="0"@}
28374 <- (gdb)
28375 @end smallexample
28376
28377 @subheading Program Execution
28378
28379 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28380 reason that execution stopped.
28381
28382 @smallexample
28383 -> -exec-run
28384 <- ^running
28385 <- (gdb)
28386 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28387 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28388 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28389 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28390 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28391 <- (gdb)
28392 -> -exec-continue
28393 <- ^running
28394 <- (gdb)
28395 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28396 <- (gdb)
28397 @end smallexample
28398
28399 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28400
28401 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28402
28403 @smallexample
28404 -> (gdb)
28405 <- -gdb-exit
28406 <- ^exit
28407 @end smallexample
28408
28409 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28410 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28411 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28412 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28413 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28414 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28415
28416 @subheading A Bad Command
28417
28418 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28419
28420 @smallexample
28421 -> -rubbish
28422 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28423 <- (gdb)
28424 @end smallexample
28425
28426
28427 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28428 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28429 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28430
28431 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28432 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28433
28434 @subheading Motivation
28435
28436 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28437
28438 @subheading Introduction
28439
28440 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28441
28442 @subheading Commands
28443
28444 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28445
28446 @subsubheading Synopsis
28447
28448 @smallexample
28449 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28450 @end smallexample
28451
28452 @subsubheading Result
28453
28454 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28455
28456 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28457
28458 @subsubheading Example
28459
28460 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28461 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28462
28463
28464 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28465 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28466 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28467
28468 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28469 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28470 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28471 breakpoints.
28472
28473 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28474 @findex -break-after
28475
28476 @subsubheading Synopsis
28477
28478 @smallexample
28479 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28480 @end smallexample
28481
28482 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28483 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28484 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28485 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28486
28487 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28488
28489 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28490
28491 @subsubheading Example
28492
28493 @smallexample
28494 (gdb)
28495 -break-insert main
28496 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28497 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28498 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28499 times="0"@}
28500 (gdb)
28501 -break-after 1 3
28502 ~
28503 ^done
28504 (gdb)
28505 -break-list
28506 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28507 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28508 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28509 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28510 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28511 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28512 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28513 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28514 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28515 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28516 (gdb)
28517 @end smallexample
28518
28519 @ignore
28520 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28521 @findex -break-catch
28522 @end ignore
28523
28524 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28525 @findex -break-commands
28526
28527 @subsubheading Synopsis
28528
28529 @smallexample
28530 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28531 @end smallexample
28532
28533 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28534 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28535 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28536 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28537 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28538 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28539
28540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28541
28542 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28543
28544 @subsubheading Example
28545
28546 @smallexample
28547 (gdb)
28548 -break-insert main
28549 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28550 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28551 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28552 times="0"@}
28553 (gdb)
28554 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28555 ^done
28556 (gdb)
28557 @end smallexample
28558
28559 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28560 @findex -break-condition
28561
28562 @subsubheading Synopsis
28563
28564 @smallexample
28565 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28566 @end smallexample
28567
28568 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28569 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28570 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28571 command below).
28572
28573 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28574
28575 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28576
28577 @subsubheading Example
28578
28579 @smallexample
28580 (gdb)
28581 -break-condition 1 1
28582 ^done
28583 (gdb)
28584 -break-list
28585 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28586 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28587 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28588 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28589 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28590 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28591 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28592 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28593 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28594 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28595 (gdb)
28596 @end smallexample
28597
28598 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28599 @findex -break-delete
28600
28601 @subsubheading Synopsis
28602
28603 @smallexample
28604 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28605 @end smallexample
28606
28607 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28608 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28609
28610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28611
28612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28613
28614 @subsubheading Example
28615
28616 @smallexample
28617 (gdb)
28618 -break-delete 1
28619 ^done
28620 (gdb)
28621 -break-list
28622 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28623 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28624 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28625 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28626 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28627 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28628 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28629 body=[]@}
28630 (gdb)
28631 @end smallexample
28632
28633 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28634 @findex -break-disable
28635
28636 @subsubheading Synopsis
28637
28638 @smallexample
28639 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28640 @end smallexample
28641
28642 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28643 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28644
28645 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28646
28647 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28648
28649 @subsubheading Example
28650
28651 @smallexample
28652 (gdb)
28653 -break-disable 2
28654 ^done
28655 (gdb)
28656 -break-list
28657 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28658 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28659 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28660 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28661 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28662 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28663 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28664 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28665 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28666 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28667 (gdb)
28668 @end smallexample
28669
28670 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28671 @findex -break-enable
28672
28673 @subsubheading Synopsis
28674
28675 @smallexample
28676 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28677 @end smallexample
28678
28679 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28680
28681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28682
28683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28684
28685 @subsubheading Example
28686
28687 @smallexample
28688 (gdb)
28689 -break-enable 2
28690 ^done
28691 (gdb)
28692 -break-list
28693 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28694 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28695 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28696 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28697 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28698 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28699 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28700 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28701 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28702 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28703 (gdb)
28704 @end smallexample
28705
28706 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28707 @findex -break-info
28708
28709 @subsubheading Synopsis
28710
28711 @smallexample
28712 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28713 @end smallexample
28714
28715 @c REDUNDANT???
28716 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28717
28718 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28719 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28720 table.
28721
28722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28723
28724 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28725
28726 @subsubheading Example
28727 N.A.
28728
28729 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28730 @findex -break-insert
28731 @anchor{-break-insert}
28732
28733 @subsubheading Synopsis
28734
28735 @smallexample
28736 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28737 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28738 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28739 @end smallexample
28740
28741 @noindent
28742 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28743
28744 @table @var
28745 @item linespec location
28746 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28747
28748 @item explicit location
28749 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28750 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28751 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28752
28753 @table @samp
28754 @item --source @var{filename}
28755 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28756 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28757
28758 @item --function @var{function}
28759 The name of a function or method.
28760
28761 @item --label @var{label}
28762 The name of a label.
28763
28764 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28765 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28766 @end table
28767
28768 @item address location
28769 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28770 @end table
28771
28772 @noindent
28773 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28774
28775 @table @samp
28776 @item -t
28777 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28778 @item -h
28779 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28780 @item -f
28781 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28782 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28783 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28784 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28785 cannot be parsed.
28786 @item -d
28787 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28788 @item -a
28789 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28790 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28791 @item -c @var{condition}
28792 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28793 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28794 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28795 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28796 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28797 @var{thread-id}.
28798 @end table
28799
28800 @subsubheading Result
28801
28802 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28803 resulting breakpoint.
28804
28805 Note: this format is open to change.
28806 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28807
28808 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28809
28810 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28811 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28812
28813 @subsubheading Example
28814
28815 @smallexample
28816 (gdb)
28817 -break-insert main
28818 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28819 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28820 times="0"@}
28821 (gdb)
28822 -break-insert -t foo
28823 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28824 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28825 times="0"@}
28826 (gdb)
28827 -break-list
28828 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28829 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28830 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28831 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28832 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28833 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28834 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28835 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28836 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28837 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28838 times="0"@},
28839 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28840 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28841 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28842 times="0"@}]@}
28843 (gdb)
28844 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28845 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28846 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28847 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28848 @c times="0"@}
28849 @c (gdb)
28850 @end smallexample
28851
28852 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28853 @findex -dprintf-insert
28854
28855 @subsubheading Synopsis
28856
28857 @smallexample
28858 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28859 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28860 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28861 [ @var{argument} ]
28862 @end smallexample
28863
28864 @noindent
28865 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28866 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28867
28868 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28869
28870 @table @samp
28871 @item -t
28872 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28873 @item -f
28874 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28875 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28876 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28877 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28878 cannot be parsed.
28879 @item -d
28880 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28881 @item -c @var{condition}
28882 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28883 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28884 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28885 to @var{ignore-count}.
28886 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28887 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28888 @var{thread-id}.
28889 @end table
28890
28891 @subsubheading Result
28892
28893 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28894 resulting breakpoint.
28895
28896 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28897
28898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28899
28900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28901
28902 @subsubheading Example
28903
28904 @smallexample
28905 (gdb)
28906 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28907 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28908 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28909 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28910 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28911 original-location="foo"@}
28912 (gdb)
28913 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28914 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28915 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28916 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28917 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28918 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28919 (gdb)
28920 @end smallexample
28921
28922 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28923 @findex -break-list
28924
28925 @subsubheading Synopsis
28926
28927 @smallexample
28928 -break-list
28929 @end smallexample
28930
28931 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28932
28933 @table @samp
28934 @item Number
28935 number of the breakpoint
28936 @item Type
28937 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28938 @item Disposition
28939 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28940 or @samp{nokeep}
28941 @item Enabled
28942 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28943 @item Address
28944 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28945 @item What
28946 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28947 name, line number
28948 @item Thread-groups
28949 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28950 @item Times
28951 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28952 @end table
28953
28954 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28955 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28956
28957 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28958
28959 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28960
28961 @subsubheading Example
28962
28963 @smallexample
28964 (gdb)
28965 -break-list
28966 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28967 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28968 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28969 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28970 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28971 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28972 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28973 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28974 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28975 times="0"@},
28976 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28977 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28978 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28979 (gdb)
28980 @end smallexample
28981
28982 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28983
28984 @smallexample
28985 (gdb)
28986 -break-list
28987 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28988 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28989 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28990 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28991 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28992 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28993 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28994 body=[]@}
28995 (gdb)
28996 @end smallexample
28997
28998 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28999 @findex -break-passcount
29000
29001 @subsubheading Synopsis
29002
29003 @smallexample
29004 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29005 @end smallexample
29006
29007 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29008 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29009 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29010 command @samp{passcount}.
29011
29012 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29013 @findex -break-watch
29014
29015 @subsubheading Synopsis
29016
29017 @smallexample
29018 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
29019 @end smallexample
29020
29021 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
29022 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
29023 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
29024 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
29025 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
29026 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
29027 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
29028 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
29029
29030 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
29031 breakpoints inserted.
29032
29033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29034
29035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
29036 @samp{rwatch}.
29037
29038 @subsubheading Example
29039
29040 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
29041
29042 @smallexample
29043 (gdb)
29044 -break-watch x
29045 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
29046 (gdb)
29047 -exec-continue
29048 ^running
29049 (gdb)
29050 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
29051 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
29052 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29053 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29054 (gdb)
29055 @end smallexample
29056
29057 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
29058 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
29059 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
29060
29061 @smallexample
29062 (gdb)
29063 -break-watch C
29064 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
29065 (gdb)
29066 -exec-continue
29067 ^running
29068 (gdb)
29069 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
29070 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29071 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29072 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29073 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29074 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29075 (gdb)
29076 -exec-continue
29077 ^running
29078 (gdb)
29079 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
29080 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29081 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29082 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29083 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29084 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29085 (gdb)
29086 @end smallexample
29087
29088 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
29089 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
29090 deleted.
29091
29092 @smallexample
29093 (gdb)
29094 -break-watch C
29095 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
29096 (gdb)
29097 -break-list
29098 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29099 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29100 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29101 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29102 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29103 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29104 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29105 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29106 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29107 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29108 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29109 times="1"@},
29110 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29111 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29112 (gdb)
29113 -exec-continue
29114 ^running
29115 (gdb)
29116 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29117 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29118 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29119 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29120 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29121 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29122 (gdb)
29123 -break-list
29124 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29125 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29126 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29127 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29128 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29129 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29130 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29131 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29132 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29133 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29134 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29135 times="1"@},
29136 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29137 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29138 (gdb)
29139 -exec-continue
29140 ^running
29141 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29142 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29143 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29144 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29145 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29146 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29147 (gdb)
29148 -break-list
29149 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29150 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29151 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29152 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29153 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29154 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29155 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29156 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29157 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29158 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29159 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29160 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
29161 (gdb)
29162 @end smallexample
29163
29164
29165 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29166 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29167 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29168
29169 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29170 catchpoints.
29171
29172 @menu
29173 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29174 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29175 @end menu
29176
29177 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29178 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29179
29180 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29181 @findex -catch-load
29182
29183 @subsubheading Synopsis
29184
29185 @smallexample
29186 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29187 @end smallexample
29188
29189 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
29190 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29191 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
29192 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29193 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
29194
29195
29196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29197
29198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
29199
29200 @subsubheading Example
29201
29202 @smallexample
29203 -catch-load -t foo.so
29204 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29205 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
29206 (gdb)
29207 @end smallexample
29208
29209
29210 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
29211 @findex -catch-unload
29212
29213 @subsubheading Synopsis
29214
29215 @smallexample
29216 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29217 @end smallexample
29218
29219 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29220 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29221 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29222 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29223 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29224
29225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29226
29227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29228
29229 @subsubheading Example
29230
29231 @smallexample
29232 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29233 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29234 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29235 (gdb)
29236 @end smallexample
29237
29238 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29239 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29240
29241 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29242 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29243
29244 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29245 @findex -catch-assert
29246
29247 @subsubheading Synopsis
29248
29249 @smallexample
29250 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29251 @end smallexample
29252
29253 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29254
29255 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29256
29257 @table @samp
29258 @item -c @var{condition}
29259 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29260 @item -d
29261 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29262 @item -t
29263 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29264 @end table
29265
29266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29267
29268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29269
29270 @subsubheading Example
29271
29272 @smallexample
29273 -catch-assert
29274 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29275 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29276 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29277 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29278 (gdb)
29279 @end smallexample
29280
29281 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29282 @findex -catch-exception
29283
29284 @subsubheading Synopsis
29285
29286 @smallexample
29287 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29288 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29289 @end smallexample
29290
29291 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29292 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29293 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29294 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29295 catchpoints.
29296
29297 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29298
29299 @table @samp
29300 @item -c @var{condition}
29301 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29302 @item -d
29303 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29304 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29305 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29306 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29307 @item -t
29308 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29309 @item -u
29310 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29311 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29312 @end table
29313
29314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29315
29316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29317 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29318
29319 @subsubheading Example
29320
29321 @smallexample
29322 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29323 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29324 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29325 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29326 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29327 (gdb)
29328 @end smallexample
29329
29330 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29331 @findex -catch-handlers
29332
29333 @subsubheading Synopsis
29334
29335 @smallexample
29336 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29337 [ -t ]
29338 @end smallexample
29339
29340 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29341 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29342 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29343 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29344 catchpoints.
29345
29346 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29347
29348 @table @samp
29349 @item -c @var{condition}
29350 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29351 @item -d
29352 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29353 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29354 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29355 @item -t
29356 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29357 @end table
29358
29359 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29360
29361 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29362
29363 @subsubheading Example
29364
29365 @smallexample
29366 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29367 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29368 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29369 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29370 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29371 (gdb)
29372 @end smallexample
29373
29374 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29375 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29376 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29377
29378 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29379 @findex -exec-arguments
29380
29381
29382 @subsubheading Synopsis
29383
29384 @smallexample
29385 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29386 @end smallexample
29387
29388 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29389 @samp{-exec-run}.
29390
29391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29392
29393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29394
29395 @subsubheading Example
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 (gdb)
29399 -exec-arguments -v word
29400 ^done
29401 (gdb)
29402 @end smallexample
29403
29404
29405 @ignore
29406 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29407 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29408
29409 @subsubheading Synopsis
29410
29411 @smallexample
29412 -exec-show-arguments
29413 @end smallexample
29414
29415 Print the arguments of the program.
29416
29417 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29418
29419 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29420
29421 @subsubheading Example
29422 N.A.
29423 @end ignore
29424
29425
29426 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29427 @findex -environment-cd
29428
29429 @subsubheading Synopsis
29430
29431 @smallexample
29432 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29433 @end smallexample
29434
29435 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29436
29437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29438
29439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29440
29441 @subsubheading Example
29442
29443 @smallexample
29444 (gdb)
29445 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29446 ^done
29447 (gdb)
29448 @end smallexample
29449
29450
29451 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29452 @findex -environment-directory
29453
29454 @subsubheading Synopsis
29455
29456 @smallexample
29457 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29458 @end smallexample
29459
29460 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29461 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29462 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29463 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29464 occurs as normal.
29465 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29466 multiple directories in a single command
29467 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29468 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29469 If blanks are needed as
29470 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29471 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29472 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29473 character must not be used
29474 in any directory name.
29475 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29476
29477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29478
29479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29480
29481 @subsubheading Example
29482
29483 @smallexample
29484 (gdb)
29485 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29486 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29487 (gdb)
29488 -environment-directory ""
29489 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29490 (gdb)
29491 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29492 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29493 (gdb)
29494 -environment-directory -r
29495 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29496 (gdb)
29497 @end smallexample
29498
29499
29500 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29501 @findex -environment-path
29502
29503 @subsubheading Synopsis
29504
29505 @smallexample
29506 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29507 @end smallexample
29508
29509 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29510 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29511 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29512 supplied in addition to the
29513 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29514 occurs as normal.
29515 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29516 multiple directories in a single command
29517 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29518 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29519 If blanks are needed as
29520 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29521 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29522 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29523 character must not be used
29524 in any directory name.
29525 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29526
29527
29528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29529
29530 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29531
29532 @subsubheading Example
29533
29534 @smallexample
29535 (gdb)
29536 -environment-path
29537 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29538 (gdb)
29539 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29540 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29541 (gdb)
29542 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29543 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29544 (gdb)
29545 @end smallexample
29546
29547
29548 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29549 @findex -environment-pwd
29550
29551 @subsubheading Synopsis
29552
29553 @smallexample
29554 -environment-pwd
29555 @end smallexample
29556
29557 Show the current working directory.
29558
29559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29560
29561 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29562
29563 @subsubheading Example
29564
29565 @smallexample
29566 (gdb)
29567 -environment-pwd
29568 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29569 (gdb)
29570 @end smallexample
29571
29572 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29573 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29574 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29575
29576
29577 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29578 @findex -thread-info
29579
29580 @subsubheading Synopsis
29581
29582 @smallexample
29583 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29584 @end smallexample
29585
29586 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29587 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29588 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29589 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29590 current thread.
29591
29592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29593
29594 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29595 about all threads.
29596
29597 @subsubheading Result
29598
29599 The result contains the following attributes:
29600
29601 @table @samp
29602 @item threads
29603 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29604 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29605
29606 @item current-thread-id
29607 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29608 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29609 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29610 the command.
29611
29612 @end table
29613
29614 @subsubheading Example
29615
29616 @smallexample
29617 -thread-info
29618 ^done,threads=[
29619 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29620 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29621 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29622 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29623 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29624 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29625 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29626 state="running"@}],
29627 current-thread-id="1"
29628 (gdb)
29629 @end smallexample
29630
29631 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29632 @findex -thread-list-ids
29633
29634 @subsubheading Synopsis
29635
29636 @smallexample
29637 -thread-list-ids
29638 @end smallexample
29639
29640 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29641 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29642 threads.
29643
29644 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29645 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29646
29647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29648
29649 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29650
29651 @subsubheading Example
29652
29653 @smallexample
29654 (gdb)
29655 -thread-list-ids
29656 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29657 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29658 (gdb)
29659 @end smallexample
29660
29661
29662 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29663 @findex -thread-select
29664
29665 @subsubheading Synopsis
29666
29667 @smallexample
29668 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29669 @end smallexample
29670
29671 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29672 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29673 topmost frame for that thread.
29674
29675 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29676 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29677
29678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29679
29680 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29681
29682 @subsubheading Example
29683
29684 @smallexample
29685 (gdb)
29686 -exec-next
29687 ^running
29688 (gdb)
29689 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29690 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29691 (gdb)
29692 -thread-list-ids
29693 ^done,
29694 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29695 number-of-threads="3"
29696 (gdb)
29697 -thread-select 3
29698 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29699 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29700 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29701 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29702 (gdb)
29703 @end smallexample
29704
29705 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29706 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29707 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29708
29709 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29710 @findex -ada-task-info
29711
29712 @subsubheading Synopsis
29713
29714 @smallexample
29715 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29716 @end smallexample
29717
29718 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29719 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29720
29721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29722
29723 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29724 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29725
29726 @subsubheading Result
29727
29728 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29729 defined for each Ada task:
29730
29731 @table @samp
29732 @item current
29733 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29734
29735 @item id
29736 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29737
29738 @item task-id
29739 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29740
29741 @item thread-id
29742 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29743 task.
29744
29745 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29746 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29747 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29748
29749 @item parent-id
29750 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29751 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29752
29753 @item priority
29754 The base priority of the task.
29755
29756 @item state
29757 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29758 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29759
29760 @item name
29761 The name of the task.
29762
29763 @end table
29764
29765 @subsubheading Example
29766
29767 @smallexample
29768 -ada-task-info
29769 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29770 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29771 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29772 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29773 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29774 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29775 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29776 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29777 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29778 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29779 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29780 (gdb)
29781 @end smallexample
29782
29783 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29784 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29785 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29786
29787 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29788 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29789 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29790 other cases.
29791
29792 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29793 @findex -exec-continue
29794
29795 @subsubheading Synopsis
29796
29797 @smallexample
29798 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29799 @end smallexample
29800
29801 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29802 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29803 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29804 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29805 @itemize @bullet
29806 @item
29807 breakpoints or watchpoints
29808 @item
29809 signals or exceptions
29810 @item
29811 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29812 @item
29813 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29814 @end itemize
29815 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29816 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29817 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29818 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29819 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29820 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29821
29822 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29823
29824 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29825
29826 @subsubheading Example
29827
29828 @smallexample
29829 -exec-continue
29830 ^running
29831 (gdb)
29832 @@Hello world
29833 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29834 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29835 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29836 (gdb)
29837 @end smallexample
29838
29839
29840 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29841 @findex -exec-finish
29842
29843 @subsubheading Synopsis
29844
29845 @smallexample
29846 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29847 @end smallexample
29848
29849 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29850 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29851 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29852 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29853 function was called.
29854
29855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29856
29857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29858
29859 @subsubheading Example
29860
29861 Function returning @code{void}.
29862
29863 @smallexample
29864 -exec-finish
29865 ^running
29866 (gdb)
29867 @@hello from foo
29868 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29869 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29870 (gdb)
29871 @end smallexample
29872
29873 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29874 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29875 value itself.
29876
29877 @smallexample
29878 -exec-finish
29879 ^running
29880 (gdb)
29881 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29882 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29883 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29884 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29885 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29886 (gdb)
29887 @end smallexample
29888
29889
29890 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29891 @findex -exec-interrupt
29892
29893 @subsubheading Synopsis
29894
29895 @smallexample
29896 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29897 @end smallexample
29898
29899 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29900 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29901 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29902 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29903 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29904
29905 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29906 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29907 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29908 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29909
29910 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29911 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29912 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29913 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29914
29915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29916
29917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29918
29919 @subsubheading Example
29920
29921 @smallexample
29922 (gdb)
29923 111-exec-continue
29924 111^running
29925
29926 (gdb)
29927 222-exec-interrupt
29928 222^done
29929 (gdb)
29930 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29931 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29932 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29933 (gdb)
29934
29935 (gdb)
29936 -exec-interrupt
29937 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29938 (gdb)
29939 @end smallexample
29940
29941 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29942 @findex -exec-jump
29943
29944 @subsubheading Synopsis
29945
29946 @smallexample
29947 -exec-jump @var{location}
29948 @end smallexample
29949
29950 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29951 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29952 different forms of @var{location}.
29953
29954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29955
29956 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29957
29958 @subsubheading Example
29959
29960 @smallexample
29961 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29962 *running,thread-id="all"
29963 ^running
29964 @end smallexample
29965
29966
29967 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29968 @findex -exec-next
29969
29970 @subsubheading Synopsis
29971
29972 @smallexample
29973 -exec-next [--reverse]
29974 @end smallexample
29975
29976 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29977 of the next source line is reached.
29978
29979 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29980 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29981 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29982 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29983 source line where the function was called.
29984
29985
29986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29987
29988 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29989
29990 @subsubheading Example
29991
29992 @smallexample
29993 -exec-next
29994 ^running
29995 (gdb)
29996 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29997 (gdb)
29998 @end smallexample
29999
30000
30001 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
30002 @findex -exec-next-instruction
30003
30004 @subsubheading Synopsis
30005
30006 @smallexample
30007 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
30008 @end smallexample
30009
30010 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
30011 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
30012 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
30013 printed as well.
30014
30015 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30016 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
30017 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
30018 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
30019 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
30020
30021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30022
30023 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
30024
30025 @subsubheading Example
30026
30027 @smallexample
30028 (gdb)
30029 -exec-next-instruction
30030 ^running
30031
30032 (gdb)
30033 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30034 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
30035 (gdb)
30036 @end smallexample
30037
30038
30039 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
30040 @findex -exec-return
30041
30042 @subsubheading Synopsis
30043
30044 @smallexample
30045 -exec-return
30046 @end smallexample
30047
30048 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
30049 Displays the new current frame.
30050
30051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30052
30053 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
30054
30055 @subsubheading Example
30056
30057 @smallexample
30058 (gdb)
30059 200-break-insert callee4
30060 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
30061 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
30062 (gdb)
30063 000-exec-run
30064 000^running
30065 (gdb)
30066 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30067 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30068 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30069 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30070 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30071 (gdb)
30072 205-break-delete
30073 205^done
30074 (gdb)
30075 111-exec-return
30076 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
30077 args=[@{name="strarg",
30078 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30079 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30080 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30081 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30082 (gdb)
30083 @end smallexample
30084
30085
30086 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
30087 @findex -exec-run
30088
30089 @subsubheading Synopsis
30090
30091 @smallexample
30092 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
30093 @end smallexample
30094
30095 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
30096 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
30097 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
30098 the program has exited exceptionally.
30099
30100 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
30101 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
30102 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
30103 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
30104 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
30105
30106 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
30107 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
30108 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
30109 (@pxref{Starting}).
30110
30111 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30112
30113 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
30114
30115 @subsubheading Examples
30116
30117 @smallexample
30118 (gdb)
30119 -break-insert main
30120 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30121 (gdb)
30122 -exec-run
30123 ^running
30124 (gdb)
30125 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30126 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30127 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30128 (gdb)
30129 @end smallexample
30130
30131 @noindent
30132 Program exited normally:
30133
30134 @smallexample
30135 (gdb)
30136 -exec-run
30137 ^running
30138 (gdb)
30139 x = 55
30140 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30141 (gdb)
30142 @end smallexample
30143
30144 @noindent
30145 Program exited exceptionally:
30146
30147 @smallexample
30148 (gdb)
30149 -exec-run
30150 ^running
30151 (gdb)
30152 x = 55
30153 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
30154 (gdb)
30155 @end smallexample
30156
30157 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
30158 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
30159
30160 @smallexample
30161 (gdb)
30162 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
30163 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
30164 @end smallexample
30165
30166
30167 @c @subheading -exec-signal
30168
30169
30170 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
30171 @findex -exec-step
30172
30173 @subsubheading Synopsis
30174
30175 @smallexample
30176 -exec-step [--reverse]
30177 @end smallexample
30178
30179 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30180 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
30181 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
30182 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
30183 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
30184 previously executed source line.
30185
30186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30187
30188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
30189
30190 @subsubheading Example
30191
30192 Stepping into a function:
30193
30194 @smallexample
30195 -exec-step
30196 ^running
30197 (gdb)
30198 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30199 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
30200 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
30201 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30202 (gdb)
30203 @end smallexample
30204
30205 Regular stepping:
30206
30207 @smallexample
30208 -exec-step
30209 ^running
30210 (gdb)
30211 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30212 (gdb)
30213 @end smallexample
30214
30215
30216 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30217 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30218
30219 @subsubheading Synopsis
30220
30221 @smallexample
30222 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30223 @end smallexample
30224
30225 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30226 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30227 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30228 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30229 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30230 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30231 as well.
30232
30233 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30234
30235 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30236
30237 @subsubheading Example
30238
30239 @smallexample
30240 (gdb)
30241 -exec-step-instruction
30242 ^running
30243
30244 (gdb)
30245 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30246 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30247 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30248 (gdb)
30249 -exec-step-instruction
30250 ^running
30251
30252 (gdb)
30253 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30254 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30255 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30256 (gdb)
30257 @end smallexample
30258
30259
30260 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30261 @findex -exec-until
30262
30263 @subsubheading Synopsis
30264
30265 @smallexample
30266 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30267 @end smallexample
30268
30269 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30270 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30271 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30272 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30273
30274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30275
30276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30277
30278 @subsubheading Example
30279
30280 @smallexample
30281 (gdb)
30282 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30283 ^running
30284 (gdb)
30285 x = 55
30286 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30287 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30288 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30289 (gdb)
30290 @end smallexample
30291
30292 @ignore
30293 @subheading -file-clear
30294 Is this going away????
30295 @end ignore
30296
30297 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30298 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30299 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30300
30301 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30302 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30303
30304 @smallexample
30305 -enable-frame-filters
30306 @end smallexample
30307
30308 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30309 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30310 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30311 request that this functionality be enabled.
30312
30313 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30314
30315 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30316 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30317
30318 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30319 @findex -stack-info-frame
30320
30321 @subsubheading Synopsis
30322
30323 @smallexample
30324 -stack-info-frame
30325 @end smallexample
30326
30327 Get info on the selected frame.
30328
30329 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30330
30331 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30332 (without arguments).
30333
30334 @subsubheading Example
30335
30336 @smallexample
30337 (gdb)
30338 -stack-info-frame
30339 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30340 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30341 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30342 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30343 (gdb)
30344 @end smallexample
30345
30346 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30347 @findex -stack-info-depth
30348
30349 @subsubheading Synopsis
30350
30351 @smallexample
30352 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30353 @end smallexample
30354
30355 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30356 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30357
30358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30359
30360 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30361
30362 @subsubheading Example
30363
30364 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30365
30366 @smallexample
30367 (gdb)
30368 -stack-info-depth
30369 ^done,depth="12"
30370 (gdb)
30371 -stack-info-depth 4
30372 ^done,depth="4"
30373 (gdb)
30374 -stack-info-depth 12
30375 ^done,depth="12"
30376 (gdb)
30377 -stack-info-depth 11
30378 ^done,depth="11"
30379 (gdb)
30380 -stack-info-depth 13
30381 ^done,depth="12"
30382 (gdb)
30383 @end smallexample
30384
30385 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30386 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30387 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30388
30389 @subsubheading Synopsis
30390
30391 @smallexample
30392 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30393 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30394 @end smallexample
30395
30396 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30397 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30398 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30399 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30400 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30401 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30402 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30403 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30404
30405 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30406 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30407 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30408 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30409 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30410 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30411
30412 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30413 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30414 are still displayed, however.
30415
30416 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30417 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30418
30419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30420
30421 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30422 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30423 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30424
30425 @subsubheading Example
30426
30427 @smallexample
30428 (gdb)
30429 -stack-list-frames
30430 ^done,
30431 stack=[
30432 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30433 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30434 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30435 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30436 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30437 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30438 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30439 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30440 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30441 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30442 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30443 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30444 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30445 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30446 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30447 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30448 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30449 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30450 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30451 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30452 (gdb)
30453 -stack-list-arguments 0
30454 ^done,
30455 stack-args=[
30456 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30457 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30458 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30459 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30460 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30461 (gdb)
30462 -stack-list-arguments 1
30463 ^done,
30464 stack-args=[
30465 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30466 frame=@{level="1",
30467 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30468 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30469 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30470 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30471 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30472 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30473 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30474 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30475 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30476 (gdb)
30477 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30478 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30479 (gdb)
30480 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30481 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30482 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30483 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30484 (gdb)
30485 @end smallexample
30486
30487 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30488
30489
30490 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30491 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30492 @findex -stack-list-frames
30493
30494 @subsubheading Synopsis
30495
30496 @smallexample
30497 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30498 @end smallexample
30499
30500 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30501 following info:
30502
30503 @table @samp
30504 @item @var{level}
30505 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30506 @item @var{addr}
30507 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30508 @item @var{func}
30509 Function name.
30510 @item @var{file}
30511 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30512 @item @var{fullname}
30513 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30514 @item @var{line}
30515 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30516 @item @var{from}
30517 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30518 if the frame's function is not known.
30519 @item @var{arch}
30520 Frame's architecture.
30521 @end table
30522
30523 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30524 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30525 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30526 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30527 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30528 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30529 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30530 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30531 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30532
30533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30534
30535 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30536
30537 @subsubheading Example
30538
30539 Full stack backtrace:
30540
30541 @smallexample
30542 (gdb)
30543 -stack-list-frames
30544 ^done,stack=
30545 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30546 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30547 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30548 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30549 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30550 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30551 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30552 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30553 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30554 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30555 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30556 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30557 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30558 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30559 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30560 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30561 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30562 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30563 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30564 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30565 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30566 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30567 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30568 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30569 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30570 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30571 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30572 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30573 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30574 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30575 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30576 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30577 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30578 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30579 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30580 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30581 (gdb)
30582 @end smallexample
30583
30584 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30585
30586 @smallexample
30587 (gdb)
30588 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30589 ^done,stack=
30590 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30591 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30592 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30593 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30594 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30595 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30596 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30597 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30598 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30599 (gdb)
30600 @end smallexample
30601
30602 Show a single frame:
30603
30604 @smallexample
30605 (gdb)
30606 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30607 ^done,stack=
30608 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30609 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30610 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30611 (gdb)
30612 @end smallexample
30613
30614
30615 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30616 @findex -stack-list-locals
30617 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30618
30619 @subsubheading Synopsis
30620
30621 @smallexample
30622 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30623 @end smallexample
30624
30625 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30626 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30627 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30628 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30629 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30630 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30631 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30632 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30633 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30634 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30635
30636 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30637 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30638 variables are still displayed, however.
30639
30640 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30641 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30642
30643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30644
30645 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30646
30647 @subsubheading Example
30648
30649 @smallexample
30650 (gdb)
30651 -stack-list-locals 0
30652 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30653 (gdb)
30654 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30655 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30656 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30657 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30658 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30659 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30660 (gdb)
30661 @end smallexample
30662
30663 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30664 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30665 @findex -stack-list-variables
30666
30667 @subsubheading Synopsis
30668
30669 @smallexample
30670 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30671 @end smallexample
30672
30673 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30674 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30675 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30676 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30677 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30678 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30679 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30680
30681 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30682 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30683 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30684
30685 @subsubheading Example
30686
30687 @smallexample
30688 (gdb)
30689 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30690 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30691 (gdb)
30692 @end smallexample
30693
30694
30695 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30696 @findex -stack-select-frame
30697
30698 @subsubheading Synopsis
30699
30700 @smallexample
30701 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30702 @end smallexample
30703
30704 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30705 the stack.
30706
30707 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30708 option to every command.
30709
30710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30711
30712 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30713 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30714
30715 @subsubheading Example
30716
30717 @smallexample
30718 (gdb)
30719 -stack-select-frame 2
30720 ^done
30721 (gdb)
30722 @end smallexample
30723
30724 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30725 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30726 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30727
30728 @ignore
30729
30730 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30731
30732 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30733 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30734 used by @code{Insight}.
30735
30736 The two main reasons for that are:
30737
30738 @enumerate 1
30739 @item
30740 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30741
30742 @item
30743 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30744 now).
30745 @end enumerate
30746
30747 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30748 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30749 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30750 hints about their use.
30751
30752 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30753 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30754 least, the following operations:
30755
30756 @itemize @bullet
30757 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30758 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30759 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30760 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30761 @end itemize
30762
30763 @end ignore
30764
30765 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30766
30767 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30768
30769 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30770 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30771 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30772 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30773 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30774 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30775 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30776 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30777 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30778 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30779 object, or to change display format.
30780
30781 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30782 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30783 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30784 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30785 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30786 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30787 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30788 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30789 child will be created.
30790
30791 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30792 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30793 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30794 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30795 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30796
30797 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30798 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30799 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30800 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30801 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30802 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30803 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30804 variables that frontend has created.
30805
30806 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30807 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30808 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30809 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30810 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30811 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30812 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30813 implicitly updated.
30814
30815 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30816 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30817 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30818 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30819 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30820 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30821 frame. Consider this example:
30822
30823 @smallexample
30824 void do_work(...)
30825 @{
30826 struct work_state state;
30827
30828 if (...)
30829 do_work(...);
30830 @}
30831 @end smallexample
30832
30833 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30834 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30835 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30836 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30837 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30838
30839 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30840 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30841 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30842 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30843 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30844 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30845
30846 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30847 access this functionality:
30848
30849 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30850 @item @strong{Operation}
30851 @tab @strong{Description}
30852
30853 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30854 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30855 @item @code{-var-create}
30856 @tab create a variable object
30857 @item @code{-var-delete}
30858 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30859 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30860 @tab set the display format of this variable
30861 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30862 @tab show the display format of this variable
30863 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30864 @tab tells how many children this object has
30865 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30866 @tab return a list of the object's children
30867 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30868 @tab show the type of this variable object
30869 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30870 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30871 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30872 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30873 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30874 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30875 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30876 @tab get the value of this variable
30877 @item @code{-var-assign}
30878 @tab set the value of this variable
30879 @item @code{-var-update}
30880 @tab update the variable and its children
30881 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30882 @tab set frozeness attribute
30883 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30884 @tab set range of children to display on update
30885 @end multitable
30886
30887 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30888 how it can be used.
30889
30890 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30891
30892 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30893 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30894
30895 @smallexample
30896 -enable-pretty-printing
30897 @end smallexample
30898
30899 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30900 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30901 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30902 request that this functionality be enabled.
30903
30904 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30905
30906 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30907 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30908
30909 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30910 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30911
30912 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30913 @findex -var-create
30914
30915 @subsubheading Synopsis
30916
30917 @smallexample
30918 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30919 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30920 @end smallexample
30921
30922 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30923 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30924 register.
30925
30926 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30927 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30928 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30929 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30930 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30931
30932 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30933 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30934 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30935 object must be created.
30936
30937 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30938 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30939
30940 @itemize @bullet
30941 @item
30942 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30943
30944 @item
30945 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30946
30947 @item
30948 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30949 @end itemize
30950
30951 @cindex dynamic varobj
30952 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30953 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30954 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30955 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30956 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30957 compatibility for existing clients.
30958
30959 @subsubheading Result
30960
30961 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30962 are:
30963
30964 @table @samp
30965 @item name
30966 The name of the varobj.
30967
30968 @item numchild
30969 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30970 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30971 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30972
30973 @item value
30974 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30975 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30976 will not be interesting.
30977
30978 @item type
30979 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30980 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30981 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30982 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30983 @emph{declared} one.
30984
30985 @item thread-id
30986 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30987 thread's global identifier.
30988
30989 @item has_more
30990 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30991 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30992
30993 @item dynamic
30994 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30995 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30996 then this attribute will not be present.
30997
30998 @item displayhint
30999 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31000 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31001 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31002 @end table
31003
31004 Typical output will look like this:
31005
31006 @smallexample
31007 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
31008 has_more="@var{has_more}"
31009 @end smallexample
31010
31011
31012 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
31013 @findex -var-delete
31014
31015 @subsubheading Synopsis
31016
31017 @smallexample
31018 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
31019 @end smallexample
31020
31021 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
31022 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
31023
31024 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
31025
31026
31027 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
31028 @findex -var-set-format
31029
31030 @subsubheading Synopsis
31031
31032 @smallexample
31033 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
31034 @end smallexample
31035
31036 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
31037 @var{format-spec}.
31038
31039 @anchor{-var-set-format}
31040 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
31041
31042 @smallexample
31043 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
31044 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
31045 @end smallexample
31046
31047 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
31048 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
31049 for pointers, etc.).
31050
31051 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
31052 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
31053 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
31054 zero-hexadecimal format.
31055
31056 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
31057 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
31058
31059 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
31060 @findex -var-show-format
31061
31062 @subsubheading Synopsis
31063
31064 @smallexample
31065 -var-show-format @var{name}
31066 @end smallexample
31067
31068 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
31069
31070 @smallexample
31071 @var{format} @expansion{}
31072 @var{format-spec}
31073 @end smallexample
31074
31075
31076 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
31077 @findex -var-info-num-children
31078
31079 @subsubheading Synopsis
31080
31081 @smallexample
31082 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
31083 @end smallexample
31084
31085 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
31086
31087 @smallexample
31088 numchild=@var{n}
31089 @end smallexample
31090
31091 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
31092 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
31093 be available.
31094
31095
31096 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
31097 @findex -var-list-children
31098
31099 @subsubheading Synopsis
31100
31101 @smallexample
31102 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
31103 @end smallexample
31104 @anchor{-var-list-children}
31105
31106 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
31107 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
31108 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
31109 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
31110 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
31111 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
31112 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
31113 and unions.
31114
31115 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
31116 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
31117 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
31118 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
31119 reported.
31120
31121 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
31122 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
31123 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
31124 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
31125 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
31126 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
31127 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
31128 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
31129 the visible items.
31130
31131 For each child the following results are returned:
31132
31133 @table @var
31134
31135 @item name
31136 Name of the variable object created for this child.
31137
31138 @item exp
31139 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
31140 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
31141
31142 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
31143 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
31144
31145 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
31146 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
31147 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
31148 type and value are not present.
31149
31150 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
31151 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
31152 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
31153
31154 @item numchild
31155 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
31156 0.
31157
31158 @item type
31159 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
31160 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31161 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31162 @emph{declared} one.
31163
31164 @item value
31165 If values were requested, this is the value.
31166
31167 @item thread-id
31168 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
31169 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
31170
31171 @item frozen
31172 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31173
31174 @item displayhint
31175 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31176 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31177 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31178
31179 @item dynamic
31180 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31181 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31182 then this attribute will not be present.
31183
31184 @end table
31185
31186 The result may have its own attributes:
31187
31188 @table @samp
31189 @item displayhint
31190 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31191 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31192 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31193
31194 @item has_more
31195 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31196 remaining after the end of the selected range.
31197 @end table
31198
31199 @subsubheading Example
31200
31201 @smallexample
31202 (gdb)
31203 -var-list-children n
31204 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31205 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31206 (gdb)
31207 -var-list-children --all-values n
31208 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31209 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31210 @end smallexample
31211
31212
31213 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31214 @findex -var-info-type
31215
31216 @subsubheading Synopsis
31217
31218 @smallexample
31219 -var-info-type @var{name}
31220 @end smallexample
31221
31222 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31223 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31224 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31225
31226 @smallexample
31227 type=@var{typename}
31228 @end smallexample
31229
31230
31231 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31232 @findex -var-info-expression
31233
31234 @subsubheading Synopsis
31235
31236 @smallexample
31237 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31238 @end smallexample
31239
31240 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31241 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31242 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31243
31244 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31245 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31246
31247 @smallexample
31248 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31249 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31250 @end smallexample
31251
31252 @noindent
31253 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31254 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31255
31256 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31257 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31258 is of limited use.
31259
31260 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31261 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31262
31263 @subsubheading Synopsis
31264
31265 @smallexample
31266 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31267 @end smallexample
31268
31269 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31270 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31271 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31272 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31273 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31274 watchpoint from a variable object.
31275
31276 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31277 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31278
31279 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31280 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31281 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31282 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31283 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31284 @smallexample
31285 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31286 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31287 @end smallexample
31288
31289 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31290 @findex -var-show-attributes
31291
31292 @subsubheading Synopsis
31293
31294 @smallexample
31295 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31296 @end smallexample
31297
31298 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31299
31300 @smallexample
31301 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31302 @end smallexample
31303
31304 @noindent
31305 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31306
31307 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31308 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31309
31310 @subsubheading Synopsis
31311
31312 @smallexample
31313 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31314 @end smallexample
31315
31316 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31317 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31318 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31319 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31320 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31321 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31322 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31323
31324 @smallexample
31325 value=@var{value}
31326 @end smallexample
31327
31328 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31329 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31330
31331 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31332 @findex -var-assign
31333
31334 @subsubheading Synopsis
31335
31336 @smallexample
31337 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31338 @end smallexample
31339
31340 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31341 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31342 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31343 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31344
31345 @subsubheading Example
31346
31347 @smallexample
31348 (gdb)
31349 -var-assign var1 3
31350 ^done,value="3"
31351 (gdb)
31352 -var-update *
31353 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31354 (gdb)
31355 @end smallexample
31356
31357 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31358 @findex -var-update
31359
31360 @subsubheading Synopsis
31361
31362 @smallexample
31363 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31364 @end smallexample
31365
31366 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31367 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31368 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31369 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31370 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31371 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31372 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31373 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31374 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31375 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31376 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31377 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31378 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31379
31380 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31381 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31382 diagnostic.
31383
31384 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31385 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31386
31387 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31388 @samp{changelist}.
31389
31390 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31391
31392 @table @samp
31393 @item name
31394 The name of the varobj.
31395
31396 @item value
31397 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31398 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31399
31400 @item in_scope
31401 @anchor{-var-update}
31402 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31403
31404 @table @code
31405 @item "true"
31406 The variable object's current value is valid.
31407
31408 @item "false"
31409 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31410 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31411 scope.
31412
31413 @item "invalid"
31414 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31415 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31416 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31417 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31418 objects.
31419 @end table
31420
31421 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31422 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31423
31424 @item type_changed
31425 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31426 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31427 be @samp{false}.
31428
31429 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31430 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31431 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31432 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31433 unset.
31434
31435 @item new_type
31436 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31437 hold the new type.
31438
31439 @item new_num_children
31440 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31441 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31442
31443 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31444 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31445 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31446 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31447 children which may be available.
31448
31449 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31450 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31451 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31452 only happen at the end of the update range).
31453
31454 @item displayhint
31455 The display hint, if any.
31456
31457 @item has_more
31458 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31459 available outside the varobj's update range.
31460
31461 @item dynamic
31462 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31463 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31464 then this attribute will not be present.
31465
31466 @item new_children
31467 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31468 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31469 be listed in this attribute.
31470 @end table
31471
31472 @subsubheading Example
31473
31474 @smallexample
31475 (gdb)
31476 -var-assign var1 3
31477 ^done,value="3"
31478 (gdb)
31479 -var-update --all-values var1
31480 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31481 type_changed="false"@}]
31482 (gdb)
31483 @end smallexample
31484
31485 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31486 @findex -var-set-frozen
31487 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31488
31489 @subsubheading Synopsis
31490
31491 @smallexample
31492 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31493 @end smallexample
31494
31495 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31496 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31497 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31498 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31499 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31500 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31501 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31502 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31503 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31504 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31505 @code{-var-update} does.
31506
31507 @subsubheading Example
31508
31509 @smallexample
31510 (gdb)
31511 -var-set-frozen V 1
31512 ^done
31513 (gdb)
31514 @end smallexample
31515
31516 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31517 @findex -var-set-update-range
31518 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31519
31520 @subsubheading Synopsis
31521
31522 @smallexample
31523 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31524 @end smallexample
31525
31526 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31527 @code{-var-update}.
31528
31529 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31530 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31531 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31532 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31533
31534 @subsubheading Example
31535
31536 @smallexample
31537 (gdb)
31538 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31539 ^done
31540 @end smallexample
31541
31542 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31543 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31544 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31545
31546 @subsubheading Synopsis
31547
31548 @smallexample
31549 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31550 @end smallexample
31551
31552 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31553
31554 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31555 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31556
31557 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31558 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31559 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31560 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31561 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31562 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31563 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31564
31565 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31566 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31567 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31568 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31569
31570 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31571 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31572 can be used to check this.
31573
31574 @subsubheading Example
31575
31576 Resetting the visualizer:
31577
31578 @smallexample
31579 (gdb)
31580 -var-set-visualizer V None
31581 ^done
31582 @end smallexample
31583
31584 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31585
31586 @smallexample
31587 (gdb)
31588 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31589 ^done
31590 @end smallexample
31591
31592 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31593 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31594
31595 @smallexample
31596 (gdb)
31597 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31598 ^done
31599 @end smallexample
31600
31601 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31602 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31603 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31604
31605 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31606 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31607 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31608 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31609
31610 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31611 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31612
31613 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31614 @c @subheading -data-assign
31615 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31616 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31617 @c set variable
31618 @c @subsubheading Example
31619 @c N.A.
31620
31621 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31622 @findex -data-disassemble
31623
31624 @subsubheading Synopsis
31625
31626 @smallexample
31627 -data-disassemble
31628 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31629 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31630 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31631 -- @var{mode}
31632 @end smallexample
31633
31634 @noindent
31635 Where:
31636
31637 @table @samp
31638 @item @var{start-addr}
31639 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31640 @item @var{end-addr}
31641 is the end address
31642 @item @var{addr}
31643 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31644 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31645 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31646 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31647 @item @var{filename}
31648 is the name of the file to disassemble
31649 @item @var{linenum}
31650 is the line number to disassemble around
31651 @item @var{lines}
31652 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31653 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31654 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31655 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31656 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31657 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31658 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31659 are displayed.
31660 @item @var{mode}
31661 is one of:
31662 @itemize @bullet
31663 @item 0 disassembly only
31664 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31665 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31666 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31667 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31668 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31669 @end itemize
31670
31671 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31672 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31673 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31674 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31675 @end table
31676
31677 @subsubheading Result
31678
31679 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31680 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31681 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31682
31683 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31684 following fields:
31685
31686 @table @code
31687 @item address
31688 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31689
31690 @item func-name
31691 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31692
31693 @item offset
31694 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31695
31696 @item inst
31697 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31698
31699 @item opcodes
31700 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31701 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31702
31703 @end table
31704
31705 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31706 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31707
31708 @table @code
31709 @item line
31710 The line number within @samp{file}.
31711
31712 @item file
31713 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31714 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31715 used.
31716
31717 @item fullname
31718 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31719 using the source file search path
31720 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31721 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31722
31723 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31724 present in the debug information.
31725
31726 @item line_asm_insn
31727 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31728 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31729 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31730 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31731 @samp{opcodes}.
31732
31733 @end table
31734
31735 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31736 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31737 adjust its format.
31738
31739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31740
31741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31742
31743 @subsubheading Example
31744
31745 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31746
31747 @smallexample
31748 (gdb)
31749 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31750 ^done,
31751 asm_insns=[
31752 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31753 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31754 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31755 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31756 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31757 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31758 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31759 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31760 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31761 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31762 (gdb)
31763 @end smallexample
31764
31765 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31766 @code{main}.
31767
31768 @smallexample
31769 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31770 ^done,asm_insns=[
31771 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31772 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31773 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31774 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31775 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31776 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31777 [@dots{}]
31778 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31779 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31780 (gdb)
31781 @end smallexample
31782
31783 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31784
31785 @smallexample
31786 (gdb)
31787 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31788 ^done,asm_insns=[
31789 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31790 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31791 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31792 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31793 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31794 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31795 (gdb)
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31799
31800 @smallexample
31801 (gdb)
31802 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31803 ^done,asm_insns=[
31804 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31805 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31806 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31807 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31808 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31809 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31810 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31811 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31812 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31813 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31814 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31815 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31816 (gdb)
31817 @end smallexample
31818
31819
31820 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31821 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31822
31823 @subsubheading Synopsis
31824
31825 @smallexample
31826 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31827 @end smallexample
31828
31829 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31830 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31831 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31832
31833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31834
31835 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31836 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31837 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31838
31839 @subsubheading Example
31840
31841 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31842 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31843 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31844 output.
31845
31846 @smallexample
31847 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31848 211^done,value="1"
31849 (gdb)
31850 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31851 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31852 (gdb)
31853 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31854 411^done,value="4"
31855 (gdb)
31856 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31857 511^done,value="4"
31858 (gdb)
31859 @end smallexample
31860
31861
31862 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31863 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31864
31865 @subsubheading Synopsis
31866
31867 @smallexample
31868 -data-list-changed-registers
31869 @end smallexample
31870
31871 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31872
31873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31874
31875 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31876 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31877
31878 @subsubheading Example
31879
31880 On a PPC MBX board:
31881
31882 @smallexample
31883 (gdb)
31884 -exec-continue
31885 ^running
31886
31887 (gdb)
31888 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31889 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31890 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31891 (gdb)
31892 -data-list-changed-registers
31893 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31894 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31895 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31896 (gdb)
31897 @end smallexample
31898
31899
31900 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31901 @findex -data-list-register-names
31902
31903 @subsubheading Synopsis
31904
31905 @smallexample
31906 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31907 @end smallexample
31908
31909 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31910 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31911 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31912 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31913 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31914 include empty register names.
31915
31916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31917
31918 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31919 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31920 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31921
31922 @subsubheading Example
31923
31924 For the PPC MBX board:
31925 @smallexample
31926 (gdb)
31927 -data-list-register-names
31928 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31929 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31930 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31931 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31932 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31933 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31934 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31935 (gdb)
31936 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31937 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31938 (gdb)
31939 @end smallexample
31940
31941 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31942 @findex -data-list-register-values
31943
31944 @subsubheading Synopsis
31945
31946 @smallexample
31947 -data-list-register-values
31948 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31949 @end smallexample
31950
31951 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31952 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31953 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31954 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31955 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31956 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31957
31958 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31959
31960 @table @code
31961 @item x
31962 Hexadecimal
31963 @item o
31964 Octal
31965 @item t
31966 Binary
31967 @item d
31968 Decimal
31969 @item r
31970 Raw
31971 @item N
31972 Natural
31973 @end table
31974
31975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31976
31977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31978 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31979
31980 @subsubheading Example
31981
31982 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31983 don't appear in the actual output):
31984
31985 @smallexample
31986 (gdb)
31987 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31988 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31989 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31990 (gdb)
31991 -data-list-register-values x
31992 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31993 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31994 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31995 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31996 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31997 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31998 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31999 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
32000 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
32001 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32002 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
32003 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
32004 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
32005 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
32006 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
32007 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
32008 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
32009 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
32010 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
32011 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
32012 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
32013 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
32014 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
32015 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
32016 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
32017 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
32018 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
32019 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
32020 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
32021 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
32022 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
32023 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
32024 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32025 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
32026 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
32027 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
32028 (gdb)
32029 @end smallexample
32030
32031
32032 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
32033 @findex -data-read-memory
32034
32035 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
32036
32037 @subsubheading Synopsis
32038
32039 @smallexample
32040 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
32041 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
32042 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
32043 @end smallexample
32044
32045 @noindent
32046 where:
32047
32048 @table @samp
32049 @item @var{address}
32050 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
32051 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32052 quoted using the C convention.
32053
32054 @item @var{word-format}
32055 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
32056 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
32057 ,Output Formats}).
32058
32059 @item @var{word-size}
32060 The size of each memory word in bytes.
32061
32062 @item @var{nr-rows}
32063 The number of rows in the output table.
32064
32065 @item @var{nr-cols}
32066 The number of columns in the output table.
32067
32068 @item @var{aschar}
32069 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
32070 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
32071 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
32072 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
32073
32074 @item @var{byte-offset}
32075 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
32076 @end table
32077
32078 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
32079 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
32080 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
32081 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
32082 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
32083 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
32084 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
32085 @samp{addr}.
32086
32087 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
32088 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
32089 @samp{prev-page}.
32090
32091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32092
32093 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
32094 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
32095
32096 @subsubheading Example
32097
32098 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
32099 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
32100 word. Display each word in hex.
32101
32102 @smallexample
32103 (gdb)
32104 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
32105 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
32106 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
32107 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
32108 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
32109 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
32110 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
32111 (gdb)
32112 @end smallexample
32113
32114 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
32115 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
32116
32117 @smallexample
32118 (gdb)
32119 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
32120 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
32121 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
32122 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
32123 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
32124 (gdb)
32125 @end smallexample
32126
32127 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
32128 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
32129 used as the non-printable character.
32130
32131 @smallexample
32132 (gdb)
32133 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
32134 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
32135 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
32136 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
32137 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32138 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32139 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32140 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32141 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
32142 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
32143 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
32144 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
32145 (gdb)
32146 @end smallexample
32147
32148 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
32149 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
32150
32151 @subsubheading Synopsis
32152
32153 @smallexample
32154 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
32155 @var{address} @var{count}
32156 @end smallexample
32157
32158 @noindent
32159 where:
32160
32161 @table @samp
32162 @item @var{address}
32163 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32164 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32165 quoted using the C convention.
32166
32167 @item @var{count}
32168 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
32169 literal.
32170
32171 @item @var{offset}
32172 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
32173 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
32174 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
32175 arithmetics itself.
32176
32177 @end table
32178
32179 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32180 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32181 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32182 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32183 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32184 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32185
32186 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
32187 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
32188 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32189 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
32190 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32191 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32192 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32193 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32194
32195 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32196 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32197 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32198 and has the following fields:
32199
32200 @table @code
32201 @item begin
32202 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32203
32204 @item end
32205 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32206
32207 @item offset
32208 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32209 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32210
32211 @item contents
32212 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32213
32214 @end table
32215
32216
32217
32218 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32219
32220 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32221
32222 @subsubheading Example
32223
32224 @smallexample
32225 (gdb)
32226 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32227 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32228 end="0xbffff15e",
32229 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32230 (gdb)
32231 @end smallexample
32232
32233
32234 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32235 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32236
32237 @subsubheading Synopsis
32238
32239 @smallexample
32240 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32241 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32242 @end smallexample
32243
32244 @noindent
32245 where:
32246
32247 @table @samp
32248 @item @var{address}
32249 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32250 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32251 be quoted using the C convention.
32252
32253 @item @var{contents}
32254 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32255 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32256
32257 @item @var{count}
32258 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32259 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32260 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32261 @var{count} memory units.
32262
32263 @end table
32264
32265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32266
32267 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32268
32269 @subsubheading Example
32270
32271 @smallexample
32272 (gdb)
32273 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32274 ^done
32275 (gdb)
32276 @end smallexample
32277
32278 @smallexample
32279 (gdb)
32280 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32281 ^done
32282 (gdb)
32283 @end smallexample
32284
32285 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32286 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32287 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32288
32289 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32290 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32291
32292 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32293 @findex -trace-find
32294
32295 @subsubheading Synopsis
32296
32297 @smallexample
32298 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32299 @end smallexample
32300
32301 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32302 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32303 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32304
32305 @table @samp
32306
32307 @item none
32308 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32309
32310 @item frame-number
32311 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32312 that index.
32313
32314 @item tracepoint-number
32315 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32316 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32317
32318 @item pc
32319 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32320 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32321 address.
32322
32323 @item pc-inside-range
32324 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32325 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32326 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32327
32328 @item pc-outside-range
32329 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32330 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32331 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32332
32333 @item line
32334 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32335 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32336 the specified location.
32337
32338 @end table
32339
32340 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32341 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32342
32343 @table @samp
32344 @item found
32345 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32346 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32347
32348 @item traceframe
32349 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32350 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32351
32352 @item tracepoint
32353 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32354 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32355
32356 @item frame
32357 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32358 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32359 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32360
32361 @end table
32362
32363 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32364
32365 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32366
32367 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32368 @findex -trace-define-variable
32369
32370 @subsubheading Synopsis
32371
32372 @smallexample
32373 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32374 @end smallexample
32375
32376 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32377 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32378 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32379 with the @samp{$} character.
32380
32381 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32382
32383 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32384
32385 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32386 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32387
32388 @subsubheading Synopsis
32389
32390 @smallexample
32391 -trace-frame-collected
32392 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32393 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32394 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32395 [--memory-contents]
32396 @end smallexample
32397
32398 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32399 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32400 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32401 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32402 See the output description table below for more details.
32403
32404 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32405 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32406 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32407 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32408 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32409
32410 For instance, if the actions were
32411 @smallexample
32412 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32413 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32414 @end smallexample
32415
32416 @noindent
32417 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32418 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32419 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32420 objects would be computed expressions.
32421
32422 An example output would be:
32423
32424 @smallexample
32425 (gdb)
32426 -trace-frame-collected
32427 ^done,
32428 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32429 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32430 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32431 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32432 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32433 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32434 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32435 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32436 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32437 ...
32438 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32439 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32440 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32441 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32442 (gdb)
32443 @end smallexample
32444
32445 Where:
32446
32447 @table @code
32448 @item explicit-variables
32449 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32450 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32451 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32452 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32453 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32454 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32455 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32456 arrays, structures and unions.
32457
32458 @item computed-expressions
32459 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32460 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32461 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32462 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32463
32464 @item registers
32465 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32466 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32467 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32468 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32469 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32470
32471 @item tvars
32472 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32473 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32474 current value are returned.
32475
32476 @item memory
32477 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32478 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32479 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32480
32481 @table @code
32482 @item address
32483 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32484
32485 @item length
32486 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32487
32488 @item contents
32489 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32490 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32491
32492 @end table
32493
32494 @end table
32495
32496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32497
32498 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32499
32500 @subsubheading Example
32501
32502 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32503 @findex -trace-list-variables
32504
32505 @subsubheading Synopsis
32506
32507 @smallexample
32508 -trace-list-variables
32509 @end smallexample
32510
32511 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32512 table has the following fields:
32513
32514 @table @samp
32515 @item name
32516 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32517
32518 @item initial
32519 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32520 field is always present.
32521
32522 @item current
32523 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32524 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32525 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32526 presently running.
32527
32528 @end table
32529
32530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32531
32532 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32533
32534 @subsubheading Example
32535
32536 @smallexample
32537 (gdb)
32538 -trace-list-variables
32539 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32540 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32541 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32542 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32543 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32544 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32545 (gdb)
32546 @end smallexample
32547
32548 @subheading -trace-save
32549 @findex -trace-save
32550
32551 @subsubheading Synopsis
32552
32553 @smallexample
32554 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32555 @end smallexample
32556
32557 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32558 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32559 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32560 to perform the save.
32561
32562 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32563 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32564 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32565
32566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32567
32568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32569
32570
32571 @subheading -trace-start
32572 @findex -trace-start
32573
32574 @subsubheading Synopsis
32575
32576 @smallexample
32577 -trace-start
32578 @end smallexample
32579
32580 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32581 have any fields.
32582
32583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32584
32585 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32586
32587 @subheading -trace-status
32588 @findex -trace-status
32589
32590 @subsubheading Synopsis
32591
32592 @smallexample
32593 -trace-status
32594 @end smallexample
32595
32596 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32597 the following fields:
32598
32599 @table @samp
32600
32601 @item supported
32602 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32603 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32604 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32605 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32606 started. This field is always present.
32607
32608 @item running
32609 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32610 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32611 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32612
32613 @item stop-reason
32614 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32615 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32616 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32617 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32618 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32619 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32620 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32621 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32622 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32623
32624 @item stopping-tracepoint
32625 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32626 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32627 @samp{passcount}.
32628
32629 @item frames
32630 @itemx frames-created
32631 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32632 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32633 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32634 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32635
32636 @item buffer-size
32637 @itemx buffer-free
32638 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32639 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32640
32641 @item circular
32642 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32643 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32644 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32645 and may fill up.
32646
32647 @item disconnected
32648 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32649 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32650 that the trace run will stop.
32651
32652 @item trace-file
32653 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32654 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32655
32656 @end table
32657
32658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32659
32660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32661
32662 @subheading -trace-stop
32663 @findex -trace-stop
32664
32665 @subsubheading Synopsis
32666
32667 @smallexample
32668 -trace-stop
32669 @end smallexample
32670
32671 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32672 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32673 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32674
32675 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32676
32677 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32678
32679
32680 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32681 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32682 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32683
32684
32685 @ignore
32686 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32687 @findex -symbol-info-address
32688
32689 @subsubheading Synopsis
32690
32691 @smallexample
32692 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32693 @end smallexample
32694
32695 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32696
32697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32698
32699 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32700
32701 @subsubheading Example
32702 N.A.
32703
32704
32705 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32706 @findex -symbol-info-file
32707
32708 @subsubheading Synopsis
32709
32710 @smallexample
32711 -symbol-info-file
32712 @end smallexample
32713
32714 Show the file for the symbol.
32715
32716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32717
32718 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32719 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32720
32721 @subsubheading Example
32722 N.A.
32723
32724
32725 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32726 @findex -symbol-info-function
32727
32728 @subsubheading Synopsis
32729
32730 @smallexample
32731 -symbol-info-function
32732 @end smallexample
32733
32734 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32735
32736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32737
32738 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32739
32740 @subsubheading Example
32741 N.A.
32742
32743
32744 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32745 @findex -symbol-info-line
32746
32747 @subsubheading Synopsis
32748
32749 @smallexample
32750 -symbol-info-line
32751 @end smallexample
32752
32753 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32754
32755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32756
32757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32758 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32759
32760 @subsubheading Example
32761 N.A.
32762
32763
32764 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32765 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32766
32767 @subsubheading Synopsis
32768
32769 @smallexample
32770 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32771 @end smallexample
32772
32773 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32774
32775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32776
32777 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32778
32779 @subsubheading Example
32780 N.A.
32781
32782
32783 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32784 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32785
32786 @subsubheading Synopsis
32787
32788 @smallexample
32789 -symbol-list-functions
32790 @end smallexample
32791
32792 List the functions in the executable.
32793
32794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32795
32796 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32797 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32798
32799 @subsubheading Example
32800 N.A.
32801 @end ignore
32802
32803
32804 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32805 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32806
32807 @subsubheading Synopsis
32808
32809 @smallexample
32810 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32811 @end smallexample
32812
32813 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32814 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32815 ascending PC order.
32816
32817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32818
32819 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32820
32821 @subsubheading Example
32822 @smallexample
32823 (gdb)
32824 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32825 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32826 (gdb)
32827 @end smallexample
32828
32829
32830 @ignore
32831 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32832 @findex -symbol-list-types
32833
32834 @subsubheading Synopsis
32835
32836 @smallexample
32837 -symbol-list-types
32838 @end smallexample
32839
32840 List all the type names.
32841
32842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32843
32844 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32845 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32846
32847 @subsubheading Example
32848 N.A.
32849
32850
32851 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32852 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32853
32854 @subsubheading Synopsis
32855
32856 @smallexample
32857 -symbol-list-variables
32858 @end smallexample
32859
32860 List all the global and static variable names.
32861
32862 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32863
32864 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32865
32866 @subsubheading Example
32867 N.A.
32868
32869
32870 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32871 @findex -symbol-locate
32872
32873 @subsubheading Synopsis
32874
32875 @smallexample
32876 -symbol-locate
32877 @end smallexample
32878
32879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32880
32881 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32882
32883 @subsubheading Example
32884 N.A.
32885
32886
32887 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32888 @findex -symbol-type
32889
32890 @subsubheading Synopsis
32891
32892 @smallexample
32893 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32894 @end smallexample
32895
32896 Show type of @var{variable}.
32897
32898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32899
32900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32901 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32902
32903 @subsubheading Example
32904 N.A.
32905 @end ignore
32906
32907
32908 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32909 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32910 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32911
32912 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32913 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32914
32915 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32916 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32917
32918 @subsubheading Synopsis
32919
32920 @smallexample
32921 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32922 @end smallexample
32923
32924 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32925 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32926 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32927 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32928 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32929 notification.
32930
32931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32932
32933 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32934
32935 @subsubheading Example
32936
32937 @smallexample
32938 (gdb)
32939 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32940 ^done
32941 (gdb)
32942 @end smallexample
32943
32944
32945 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32946 @findex -file-exec-file
32947
32948 @subsubheading Synopsis
32949
32950 @smallexample
32951 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32952 @end smallexample
32953
32954 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32955 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32956 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32957 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32958 notification.
32959
32960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32961
32962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32963
32964 @subsubheading Example
32965
32966 @smallexample
32967 (gdb)
32968 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32969 ^done
32970 (gdb)
32971 @end smallexample
32972
32973
32974 @ignore
32975 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32976 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32977
32978 @subsubheading Synopsis
32979
32980 @smallexample
32981 -file-list-exec-sections
32982 @end smallexample
32983
32984 List the sections of the current executable file.
32985
32986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32987
32988 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32989 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32990 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32991
32992 @subsubheading Example
32993 N.A.
32994 @end ignore
32995
32996
32997 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32998 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32999
33000 @subsubheading Synopsis
33001
33002 @smallexample
33003 -file-list-exec-source-file
33004 @end smallexample
33005
33006 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
33007 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
33008 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
33009 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
33010
33011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33012
33013 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
33014
33015 @subsubheading Example
33016
33017 @smallexample
33018 (gdb)
33019 123-file-list-exec-source-file
33020 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
33021 (gdb)
33022 @end smallexample
33023
33024
33025 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
33026 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
33027
33028 @subsubheading Synopsis
33029
33030 @smallexample
33031 -file-list-exec-source-files
33032 @end smallexample
33033
33034 List the source files for the current executable.
33035
33036 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
33037 name) of a source file.
33038
33039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33040
33041 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
33042 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
33043
33044 @subsubheading Example
33045 @smallexample
33046 (gdb)
33047 -file-list-exec-source-files
33048 ^done,files=[
33049 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
33050 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
33051 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
33052 (gdb)
33053 @end smallexample
33054
33055 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
33056 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
33057
33058 @subsubheading Synopsis
33059
33060 @smallexample
33061 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
33062 @end smallexample
33063
33064 List the shared libraries in the program.
33065 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
33066 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33067
33068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33069
33070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
33071 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
33072 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
33073 library. Each range has the following fields:
33074
33075 @table @samp
33076 @item from
33077 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
33078 @item to
33079 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
33080 @end table
33081
33082 @subsubheading Example
33083 @smallexample
33084 (gdb)
33085 -file-list-exec-source-files
33086 ^done,shared-libraries=[
33087 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
33088 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
33089 (gdb)
33090 @end smallexample
33091
33092
33093 @ignore
33094 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
33095 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
33096
33097 @subsubheading Synopsis
33098
33099 @smallexample
33100 -file-list-symbol-files
33101 @end smallexample
33102
33103 List symbol files.
33104
33105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33106
33107 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
33108
33109 @subsubheading Example
33110 N.A.
33111 @end ignore
33112
33113
33114 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
33115 @findex -file-symbol-file
33116
33117 @subsubheading Synopsis
33118
33119 @smallexample
33120 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
33121 @end smallexample
33122
33123 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
33124 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
33125 produced, except for a completion notification.
33126
33127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33128
33129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
33130
33131 @subsubheading Example
33132
33133 @smallexample
33134 (gdb)
33135 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33136 ^done
33137 (gdb)
33138 @end smallexample
33139
33140 @ignore
33141 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33142 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
33143 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
33144
33145 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
33146
33147 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
33148
33149 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
33150
33151 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
33152
33153 @c @subheading -overlay-map
33154
33155 @c @subheading -overlay-off
33156
33157 @c @subheading -overlay-on
33158
33159 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
33160
33161 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33162 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
33163 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
33164
33165 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
33166
33167 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33168
33169 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33170
33171 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33172 @end ignore
33173
33174
33175 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33176 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33177 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33178
33179
33180 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33181 @findex -target-attach
33182
33183 @subsubheading Synopsis
33184
33185 @smallexample
33186 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33187 @end smallexample
33188
33189 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33190 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33191 group, the id previously returned by
33192 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33193
33194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33195
33196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33197
33198 @subsubheading Example
33199 @smallexample
33200 (gdb)
33201 -target-attach 34
33202 =thread-created,id="1"
33203 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33204 ^done
33205 (gdb)
33206 @end smallexample
33207
33208 @ignore
33209 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33210 @findex -target-compare-sections
33211
33212 @subsubheading Synopsis
33213
33214 @smallexample
33215 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33216 @end smallexample
33217
33218 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33219 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33220
33221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33222
33223 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33224
33225 @subsubheading Example
33226 N.A.
33227 @end ignore
33228
33229
33230 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33231 @findex -target-detach
33232
33233 @subsubheading Synopsis
33234
33235 @smallexample
33236 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33237 @end smallexample
33238
33239 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33240 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33241 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33242
33243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33244
33245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33246
33247 @subsubheading Example
33248
33249 @smallexample
33250 (gdb)
33251 -target-detach
33252 ^done
33253 (gdb)
33254 @end smallexample
33255
33256
33257 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33258 @findex -target-disconnect
33259
33260 @subsubheading Synopsis
33261
33262 @smallexample
33263 -target-disconnect
33264 @end smallexample
33265
33266 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33267 generally not resumed.
33268
33269 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33270
33271 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33272
33273 @subsubheading Example
33274
33275 @smallexample
33276 (gdb)
33277 -target-disconnect
33278 ^done
33279 (gdb)
33280 @end smallexample
33281
33282
33283 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33284 @findex -target-download
33285
33286 @subsubheading Synopsis
33287
33288 @smallexample
33289 -target-download
33290 @end smallexample
33291
33292 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33293 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33294
33295 @table @samp
33296 @item section
33297 The name of the section.
33298 @item section-sent
33299 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33300 @item section-size
33301 The size of the section.
33302 @item total-sent
33303 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33304 @item total-size
33305 The size of the overall executable to download.
33306 @end table
33307
33308 @noindent
33309 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33310 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33311
33312 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33313 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33314
33315 @table @samp
33316 @item section
33317 The name of the section.
33318 @item section-size
33319 The size of the section.
33320 @item total-size
33321 The size of the overall executable to download.
33322 @end table
33323
33324 @noindent
33325 At the end, a summary is printed.
33326
33327 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33328
33329 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33330
33331 @subsubheading Example
33332
33333 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33334 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33335
33336 @smallexample
33337 (gdb)
33338 -target-download
33339 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33340 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33341 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33342 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33343 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33344 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33345 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33346 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33347 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33348 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33349 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33350 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33351 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33352 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33353 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33354 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33355 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33356 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33357 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33358 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33359 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33360 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33361 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33362 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33363 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33364 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33365 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33366 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33367 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33368 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33369 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33370 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33371 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33372 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33373 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33374 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33375 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33376 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33377 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33378 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33379 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33380 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33381 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33382 write-rate="429"
33383 (gdb)
33384 @end smallexample
33385
33386
33387 @ignore
33388 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33389 @findex -target-exec-status
33390
33391 @subsubheading Synopsis
33392
33393 @smallexample
33394 -target-exec-status
33395 @end smallexample
33396
33397 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33398 not, for instance).
33399
33400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33401
33402 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33403
33404 @subsubheading Example
33405 N.A.
33406
33407
33408 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33409 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33410
33411 @subsubheading Synopsis
33412
33413 @smallexample
33414 -target-list-available-targets
33415 @end smallexample
33416
33417 List the possible targets to connect to.
33418
33419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33420
33421 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33422
33423 @subsubheading Example
33424 N.A.
33425
33426
33427 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33428 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33429
33430 @subsubheading Synopsis
33431
33432 @smallexample
33433 -target-list-current-targets
33434 @end smallexample
33435
33436 Describe the current target.
33437
33438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33439
33440 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33441 other things).
33442
33443 @subsubheading Example
33444 N.A.
33445
33446
33447 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33448 @findex -target-list-parameters
33449
33450 @subsubheading Synopsis
33451
33452 @smallexample
33453 -target-list-parameters
33454 @end smallexample
33455
33456 @c ????
33457 @end ignore
33458
33459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33460
33461 No equivalent.
33462
33463 @subsubheading Example
33464 N.A.
33465
33466 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33467 @findex -target-flash-erase
33468
33469 @subsubheading Synopsis
33470
33471 @smallexample
33472 -target-flash-erase
33473 @end smallexample
33474
33475 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33476
33477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33478
33479 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33480 addresses and memory region sizes.
33481
33482 @smallexample
33483 (gdb)
33484 -target-flash-erase
33485 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33486 (gdb)
33487 @end smallexample
33488
33489 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33490 @findex -target-select
33491
33492 @subsubheading Synopsis
33493
33494 @smallexample
33495 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33496 @end smallexample
33497
33498 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33499
33500 @table @samp
33501 @item @var{type}
33502 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33503 @item @var{parameters}
33504 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33505 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33506 @end table
33507
33508 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33509 which the target program is, in the following form:
33510
33511 @smallexample
33512 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33513 args=[@var{arg list}]
33514 @end smallexample
33515
33516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33517
33518 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33519
33520 @subsubheading Example
33521
33522 @smallexample
33523 (gdb)
33524 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33525 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33526 (gdb)
33527 @end smallexample
33528
33529 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33530 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33531 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33532
33533
33534 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33535 @findex -target-file-put
33536
33537 @subsubheading Synopsis
33538
33539 @smallexample
33540 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33541 @end smallexample
33542
33543 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33544 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33545
33546 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33547
33548 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33549
33550 @subsubheading Example
33551
33552 @smallexample
33553 (gdb)
33554 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33555 ^done
33556 (gdb)
33557 @end smallexample
33558
33559
33560 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33561 @findex -target-file-get
33562
33563 @subsubheading Synopsis
33564
33565 @smallexample
33566 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33567 @end smallexample
33568
33569 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33570 on the host system.
33571
33572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33573
33574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33575
33576 @subsubheading Example
33577
33578 @smallexample
33579 (gdb)
33580 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33581 ^done
33582 (gdb)
33583 @end smallexample
33584
33585
33586 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33587 @findex -target-file-delete
33588
33589 @subsubheading Synopsis
33590
33591 @smallexample
33592 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33593 @end smallexample
33594
33595 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33596
33597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33598
33599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33600
33601 @subsubheading Example
33602
33603 @smallexample
33604 (gdb)
33605 -target-file-delete remotefile
33606 ^done
33607 (gdb)
33608 @end smallexample
33609
33610
33611 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33612 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33613 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33614
33615 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33616 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33617
33618 @subsubheading Synopsis
33619
33620 @smallexample
33621 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33622 @end smallexample
33623
33624 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33625 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33626 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33627
33628 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33629
33630 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33631
33632 @subsubheading Result
33633
33634 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33635 defined for each exception:
33636
33637 @table @samp
33638 @item name
33639 The name of the exception.
33640
33641 @item address
33642 The address of the exception.
33643
33644 @end table
33645
33646 @subsubheading Example
33647
33648 @smallexample
33649 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33650 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33651 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33652 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33653 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33654 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33655 @end smallexample
33656
33657 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33658
33659 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33660 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33661 Catchpoint Commands}.
33662
33663
33664 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33665 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33666 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33667
33668 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33669 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33670 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33671 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33672
33673 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33674 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33675 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33676
33677 @subsubheading Synopsis
33678
33679 @smallexample
33680 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33681 @end smallexample
33682
33683 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33684
33685 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33686 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33687 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33688 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33689 dash.
33690
33691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33692
33693 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33694
33695 @subsubheading Result
33696
33697 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33698
33699 @table @samp
33700 @item exists
33701 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33702 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33703
33704 @end table
33705
33706 @subsubheading Example
33707
33708 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33709
33710 @smallexample
33711 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33712 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33713 @end smallexample
33714
33715 @noindent
33716 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33717 to the debugger:
33718
33719 @smallexample
33720 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33721 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33722 @end smallexample
33723
33724 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33725 @findex -list-features
33726 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33727
33728 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33729 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33730 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33731 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33732 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33733 startup.
33734
33735 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33736 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33737 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33738 is given below.
33739
33740 Example output:
33741
33742 @smallexample
33743 (gdb) -list-features
33744 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33745 @end smallexample
33746
33747 The current list of features is:
33748
33749 @ftable @samp
33750 @item frozen-varobjs
33751 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33752 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33753 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33754 @item pending-breakpoints
33755 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33756 command.
33757 @item python
33758 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33759 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33760 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33761 @item thread-info
33762 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33763 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33764 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33765 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33766 @item breakpoint-notifications
33767 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33768 CLI will be announced via async records.
33769 @item ada-task-info
33770 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33771 @item language-option
33772 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33773 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33774 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33775 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33776 @item undefined-command-error-code
33777 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33778 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33779 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33780 @item exec-run-start-option
33781 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33782 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33783 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33784 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33785 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33786 @end ftable
33787
33788 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33789 @findex -list-target-features
33790
33791 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33792 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33793 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33794 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33795 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33796 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33797 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33798 Example output:
33799
33800 @smallexample
33801 (gdb) -list-target-features
33802 ^done,result=["async"]
33803 @end smallexample
33804
33805 The current list of features is:
33806
33807 @table @samp
33808 @item async
33809 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33810 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33811 while the target is running.
33812
33813 @item reverse
33814 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33815 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33816
33817 @end table
33818
33819 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33820 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33821 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33822
33823 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33824
33825 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33826 @findex -gdb-exit
33827
33828 @subsubheading Synopsis
33829
33830 @smallexample
33831 -gdb-exit
33832 @end smallexample
33833
33834 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33835
33836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33837
33838 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33839
33840 @subsubheading Example
33841
33842 @smallexample
33843 (gdb)
33844 -gdb-exit
33845 ^exit
33846 @end smallexample
33847
33848
33849 @ignore
33850 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33851 @findex -exec-abort
33852
33853 @subsubheading Synopsis
33854
33855 @smallexample
33856 -exec-abort
33857 @end smallexample
33858
33859 Kill the inferior running program.
33860
33861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33862
33863 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33864
33865 @subsubheading Example
33866 N.A.
33867 @end ignore
33868
33869
33870 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33871 @findex -gdb-set
33872
33873 @subsubheading Synopsis
33874
33875 @smallexample
33876 -gdb-set
33877 @end smallexample
33878
33879 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33880 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33881
33882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33883
33884 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33885
33886 @subsubheading Example
33887
33888 @smallexample
33889 (gdb)
33890 -gdb-set $foo=3
33891 ^done
33892 (gdb)
33893 @end smallexample
33894
33895
33896 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33897 @findex -gdb-show
33898
33899 @subsubheading Synopsis
33900
33901 @smallexample
33902 -gdb-show
33903 @end smallexample
33904
33905 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33906
33907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33908
33909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33910
33911 @subsubheading Example
33912
33913 @smallexample
33914 (gdb)
33915 -gdb-show annotate
33916 ^done,value="0"
33917 (gdb)
33918 @end smallexample
33919
33920 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33921
33922
33923 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33924 @findex -gdb-version
33925
33926 @subsubheading Synopsis
33927
33928 @smallexample
33929 -gdb-version
33930 @end smallexample
33931
33932 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33933
33934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33935
33936 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33937 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33938
33939 @subsubheading Example
33940
33941 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33942 @c box in TeX.
33943 @smallexample
33944 (gdb)
33945 -gdb-version
33946 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33947 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33948 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33949 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33950 ~ certain conditions.
33951 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33952 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33953 ~ details.
33954 ~This GDB was configured as
33955 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33956 ^done
33957 (gdb)
33958 @end smallexample
33959
33960 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33961 @findex -list-thread-groups
33962
33963 @subheading Synopsis
33964
33965 @smallexample
33966 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33967 @end smallexample
33968
33969 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33970 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33971 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33972 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33973 top-level thread groups.
33974
33975 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33976 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33977 available on the target.
33978
33979 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33980 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33981 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33982 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33983 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33984 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33985 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33986 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33987
33988 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33989 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33990 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33991 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33992 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33993 @samp{threads} field.
33994
33995 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33996 the following caveats:
33997
33998 @itemize @bullet
33999 @item
34000 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
34001 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
34002 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
34003
34004 @item
34005 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
34006 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
34007 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
34008 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
34009 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
34010 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
34011
34012 @end itemize
34013
34014 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
34015 have the following fields:
34016
34017 @table @code
34018 @item id
34019 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
34020 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
34021 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
34022
34023 @item type
34024 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
34025 valid type.
34026
34027 @item pid
34028 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
34029 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
34030
34031 @item exit-code
34032 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
34033 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
34034 only if the process is not running.
34035
34036 @item num_children
34037 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
34038 absent for an available thread group.
34039
34040 @item threads
34041 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
34042 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
34043 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
34044
34045 @item cores
34046 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
34047 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
34048 such information is not available.
34049
34050 @item executable
34051 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
34052 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
34053 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
34054
34055 @end table
34056
34057 @subheading Example
34058
34059 @smallexample
34060 @value{GDBP}
34061 -list-thread-groups
34062 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
34063 -list-thread-groups 17
34064 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
34065 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
34066 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
34067 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
34068 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
34069 -list-thread-groups --available
34070 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
34071 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
34072 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34073 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34074 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
34075 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
34076 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34077 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34078 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
34079 @end smallexample
34080
34081 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
34082 @findex -info-os
34083
34084 @subsubheading Synopsis
34085
34086 @smallexample
34087 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
34088 @end smallexample
34089
34090 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
34091 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
34092 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
34093 of data of that type.
34094
34095 The types of information available depend on the target operating
34096 system.
34097
34098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34099
34100 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
34101
34102 @subsubheading Example
34103
34104 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
34105 like this:
34106
34107 @smallexample
34108 @value{GDBP}
34109 -info-os
34110 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
34111 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
34112 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
34113 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
34114 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
34115 col2="CPUs"@},
34116 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
34117 col2="File descriptors"@},
34118 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
34119 col2="Kernel modules"@},
34120 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
34121 col2="Message queues"@},
34122 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
34123 col2="Processes"@},
34124 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
34125 col2="Process groups"@},
34126 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
34127 col2="Semaphores"@},
34128 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
34129 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
34130 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
34131 col2="Sockets"@},
34132 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
34133 col2="Threads"@}]
34134 @value{GDBP}
34135 -info-os processes
34136 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
34137 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
34138 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
34139 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
34140 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
34141 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
34142 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
34143 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
34144 ...
34145 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
34146 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
34147 (gdb)
34148 @end smallexample
34149
34150 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
34151 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
34152 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
34153 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
34154 @code{info os} omits it.)
34155
34156 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
34157 @findex -add-inferior
34158
34159 @subheading Synopsis
34160
34161 @smallexample
34162 -add-inferior
34163 @end smallexample
34164
34165 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
34166 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
34167 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34168 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34169 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
34170 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34171
34172 @subheading Example
34173
34174 @smallexample
34175 @value{GDBP}
34176 -add-inferior
34177 ^done,inferior="i3"
34178 @end smallexample
34179
34180 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34181 @findex -interpreter-exec
34182
34183 @subheading Synopsis
34184
34185 @smallexample
34186 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34187 @end smallexample
34188 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34189
34190 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34191
34192 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34193
34194 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34195
34196 @subheading Example
34197
34198 @smallexample
34199 (gdb)
34200 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34201 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34202 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34203 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34204 ^done
34205 (gdb)
34206 @end smallexample
34207
34208 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34209 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34210
34211 @subheading Synopsis
34212
34213 @smallexample
34214 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34215 @end smallexample
34216
34217 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34218
34219 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34220
34221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34222
34223 @subheading Example
34224
34225 @smallexample
34226 (gdb)
34227 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34228 ^done
34229 (gdb)
34230 @end smallexample
34231
34232 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34233 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34234
34235 @subheading Synopsis
34236
34237 @smallexample
34238 -inferior-tty-show
34239 @end smallexample
34240
34241 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34242
34243 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34244
34245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34246
34247 @subheading Example
34248
34249 @smallexample
34250 (gdb)
34251 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34252 ^done
34253 (gdb)
34254 -inferior-tty-show
34255 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34256 (gdb)
34257 @end smallexample
34258
34259 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34260 @findex -enable-timings
34261
34262 @subheading Synopsis
34263
34264 @smallexample
34265 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34266 @end smallexample
34267
34268 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34269 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34270 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34271 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34272
34273 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34274
34275 No equivalent.
34276
34277 @subheading Example
34278
34279 @smallexample
34280 (gdb)
34281 -enable-timings
34282 ^done
34283 (gdb)
34284 -break-insert main
34285 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34286 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34287 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34288 times="0"@},
34289 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34290 (gdb)
34291 -enable-timings no
34292 ^done
34293 (gdb)
34294 -exec-run
34295 ^running
34296 (gdb)
34297 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34298 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34299 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34300 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34301 (gdb)
34302 @end smallexample
34303
34304 @node Annotations
34305 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34306
34307 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34308 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34309 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34310 relatively high level.
34311
34312 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34313 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34314
34315 @ignore
34316 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34317 @end ignore
34318
34319 @menu
34320 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34321 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34322 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34323 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34324 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34325 * Annotations for Running::
34326 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34327 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34328 @end menu
34329
34330 @node Annotations Overview
34331 @section What is an Annotation?
34332 @cindex annotations
34333
34334 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34335 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34336 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34337 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34338 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34339 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34340 cannot contain newline characters.
34341
34342 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34343 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34344 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34345 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34346 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34347 means those three characters as output.
34348
34349 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34350 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34351 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34352 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34353 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34354 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34355 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34356 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34357 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34358
34359 @table @code
34360 @kindex set annotate
34361 @item set annotate @var{level}
34362 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34363 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34364
34365 @item show annotate
34366 @kindex show annotate
34367 Show the current annotation level.
34368 @end table
34369
34370 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34371
34372 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34373
34374 @smallexample
34375 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34376 GNU gdb 6.0
34377 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34378 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34379 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34380 under certain conditions.
34381 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34382 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34383 for details.
34384 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34385
34386 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34387 (@value{GDBP})
34388 ^Z^Zprompt
34389 @kbd{quit}
34390
34391 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34392 $
34393 @end smallexample
34394
34395 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34396 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34397 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34398 output from @value{GDBN}.
34399
34400 @node Server Prefix
34401 @section The Server Prefix
34402 @cindex server prefix
34403
34404 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34405 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34406 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34407 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34408 a transparent manner.
34409
34410 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34411 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34412 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34413 @code{print} command.
34414
34415 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34416 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34417
34418 @node Prompting
34419 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34420
34421 @cindex annotations for prompts
34422 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34423 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34424 over, etc.
34425
34426 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34427 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34428 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34429 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34430 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34431 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34432 features the following annotations:
34433
34434 @smallexample
34435 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34436 ^Z^Zprompt
34437 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34438 @end smallexample
34439
34440 The input types are
34441
34442 @table @code
34443 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34444 @findex prompt annotation
34445 @findex post-prompt annotation
34446 @item prompt
34447 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34448
34449 @findex pre-commands annotation
34450 @findex commands annotation
34451 @findex post-commands annotation
34452 @item commands
34453 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34454 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34455
34456 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34457 @findex overload-choice annotation
34458 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34459 @item overload-choice
34460 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34461
34462 @findex pre-query annotation
34463 @findex query annotation
34464 @findex post-query annotation
34465 @item query
34466 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34467
34468 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34469 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34470 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34471 @item prompt-for-continue
34472 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34473 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34474 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34475 presence of annotations.
34476 @end table
34477
34478 @node Errors
34479 @section Errors
34480 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34481
34482 @findex quit annotation
34483 @smallexample
34484 ^Z^Zquit
34485 @end smallexample
34486
34487 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34488
34489 @findex error annotation
34490 @smallexample
34491 ^Z^Zerror
34492 @end smallexample
34493
34494 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34495
34496 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34497 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34498 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34499 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34500 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34501 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34502 to the top level.
34503
34504 @findex error-begin annotation
34505 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34506
34507 @smallexample
34508 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34509 @end smallexample
34510
34511 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34512 message.
34513
34514 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34515 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34516 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34517
34518 @node Invalidation
34519 @section Invalidation Notices
34520
34521 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34522 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34523 changed.
34524
34525 @table @code
34526 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34527 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34528
34529 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34530 have changed.
34531
34532 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34533 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34534
34535 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34536 deleted a breakpoint.
34537 @end table
34538
34539 @node Annotations for Running
34540 @section Running the Program
34541 @cindex annotations for running programs
34542
34543 @findex starting annotation
34544 @findex stopping annotation
34545 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34546 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34547
34548 @smallexample
34549 ^Z^Zstarting
34550 @end smallexample
34551
34552 is output. When the program stops,
34553
34554 @smallexample
34555 ^Z^Zstopped
34556 @end smallexample
34557
34558 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34559 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34560
34561 @table @code
34562 @findex exited annotation
34563 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34564 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34565 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34566
34567 @findex signalled annotation
34568 @findex signal-name annotation
34569 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34570 @findex signal-string annotation
34571 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34572 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34573 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34574 annotation continues:
34575
34576 @smallexample
34577 @var{intro-text}
34578 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34579 @var{name}
34580 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34581 @var{middle-text}
34582 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34583 @var{string}
34584 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34585 @var{end-text}
34586 @end smallexample
34587
34588 @noindent
34589 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34590 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34591 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34592 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34593 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34594
34595 @findex signal annotation
34596 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34597 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34598 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34599 terminated with it.
34600
34601 @findex breakpoint annotation
34602 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34603 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34604
34605 @findex watchpoint annotation
34606 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34607 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34608 @end table
34609
34610 @node Source Annotations
34611 @section Displaying Source
34612 @cindex annotations for source display
34613
34614 @findex source annotation
34615 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34616
34617 @smallexample
34618 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34619 @end smallexample
34620
34621 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34622 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34623 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34624 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34625 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34626 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34627 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34628 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34629 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34630 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34631 depend on the language).
34632
34633 @node JIT Interface
34634 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34635 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34636 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34637
34638 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34639 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34640 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34641 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34642
34643 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34644 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34645 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34646 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34647 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34648 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34649
34650 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34651 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34652 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34653 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34654 LLVM JIT.
34655
34656 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34657 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34658 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34659 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34660 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34661 out about additional code.
34662
34663 @menu
34664 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34665 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34666 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34667 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34668 @end menu
34669
34670 @node Declarations
34671 @section JIT Declarations
34672
34673 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34674 implement the interface:
34675
34676 @smallexample
34677 typedef enum
34678 @{
34679 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34680 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34681 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34682 @} jit_actions_t;
34683
34684 struct jit_code_entry
34685 @{
34686 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34687 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34688 const char *symfile_addr;
34689 uint64_t symfile_size;
34690 @};
34691
34692 struct jit_descriptor
34693 @{
34694 uint32_t version;
34695 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34696 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34697 uint32_t action_flag;
34698 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34699 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34700 @};
34701
34702 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34703 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34704
34705 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34706 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34707 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34708 @end smallexample
34709
34710 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34711 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34712 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34713
34714 @node Registering Code
34715 @section Registering Code
34716
34717 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34718
34719 @itemize @bullet
34720 @item
34721 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34722 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34723
34724 @item
34725 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34726 file.
34727
34728 @item
34729 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34730
34731 @item
34732 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34733
34734 @item
34735 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34736 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34737 @end itemize
34738
34739 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34740 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34741 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34742 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34743
34744 @node Unregistering Code
34745 @section Unregistering Code
34746
34747 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34748
34749 @itemize @bullet
34750 @item
34751 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34752
34753 @item
34754 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34755
34756 @item
34757 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34758 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34759 @end itemize
34760
34761 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34762 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34763
34764 @node Custom Debug Info
34765 @section Custom Debug Info
34766 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34767 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34768
34769 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34770 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34771 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34772 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34773 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34774 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34775 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34776 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34777 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34778
34779 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34780 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34781 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34782 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34783 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34784 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34785 compiler.
34786
34787 @menu
34788 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34789 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34790 @end menu
34791
34792 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34793 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34794 @kindex jit-reader-load
34795 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34796
34797 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34798 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34799
34800 @table @code
34801 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34802 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34803 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34804 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34805 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34806 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34807 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34808
34809 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34810 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34811 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34812 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34813 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34814
34815 @item jit-reader-unload
34816 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34817
34818 @end table
34819
34820 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34821 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34822 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34823
34824 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34825 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34826
34827 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34828 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34829 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34830 the system include directory.
34831
34832 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34833 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34834 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34835
34836 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34837 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34838
34839 @findex gdb_init_reader
34840 @smallexample
34841 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34842 @end smallexample
34843
34844 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34845
34846 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34847 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34848 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34849 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34850 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34851 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34852
34853 @smallexample
34854 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34855 @{
34856 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34857 int reader_version;
34858
34859 /* For use by the reader. */
34860 void *priv_data;
34861
34862 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34863 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34864 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34865 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34866 @};
34867 @end smallexample
34868
34869 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34870 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34871
34872 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34873 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34874 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34875 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34876 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34877 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34878 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34879 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34880 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34881 target's address space.
34882
34883 @node In-Process Agent
34884 @chapter In-Process Agent
34885 @cindex debugging agent
34886 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34887 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34888 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34889 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34890 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34891 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34892 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34893 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34894 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34895 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34896 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34897 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34898 behavior without interrupting it.
34899
34900 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34901 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34902 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34903 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34904 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34905 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34906 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34907 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34908 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34909
34910 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34911 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34912 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34913 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34914
34915 @anchor{Control Agent}
34916 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34917 debugging with the following commands:
34918
34919 @table @code
34920 @kindex set agent on
34921 @item set agent on
34922 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34923 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34924 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34925 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34926 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34927 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34928
34929 @kindex set agent off
34930 @item set agent off
34931 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34932 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34933
34934 @kindex show agent
34935 @item show agent
34936 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34937 the in-process agent.
34938 @end table
34939
34940 @menu
34941 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34942 @end menu
34943
34944 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34945 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34946 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34947
34948 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34949 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34950 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34951 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34952 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34953 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34954 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34955 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34956 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34957
34958 @menu
34959 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34960 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34961 @end menu
34962
34963 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34964 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34965 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34966
34967 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34968 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34969
34970 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34971 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34972 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34973 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34974
34975 @enumerate
34976 @item
34977 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34978 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34979 @item
34980 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34981 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34982 the other one.
34983 @end enumerate
34984
34985 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34986
34987 @enumerate
34988 @item
34989 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34990 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34991 @anchor{agent expression object}
34992 @item
34993 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34994 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34995 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34996 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34997 @item
34998 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34999 @anchor{tracepoint object}
35000
35001 @end enumerate
35002
35003 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
35004 object:
35005
35006 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
35007 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
35008 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
35009 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
35010 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
35011 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
35012 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35013 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
35014 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
35015 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
35016 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
35017 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
35018 memory address for collecting.
35019 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
35020 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35021 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
35022 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35023 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
35024 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35025 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
35026 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
35027 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
35028 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
35029 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
35030 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
35031 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
35032 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
35033 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
35034 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
35035 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
35036 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
35037 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
35038 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
35039 @ref{agent expression object}
35040 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
35041 @ref{agent expression object}
35042 @item actions @tab variable
35043 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
35044 @end multitable
35045
35046 @node IPA Protocol Commands
35047 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
35048 @cindex ipa protocol commands
35049
35050 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
35051 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
35052
35053 @table @samp
35054
35055 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
35056 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
35057 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
35058 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
35059 in IPA finally.
35060
35061 Replies:
35062 @table @samp
35063 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
35064 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
35065 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
35066 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
35067 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
35068 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
35069 @item E @var{NN}
35070 for an error
35071
35072 @end table
35073
35074 @item close
35075 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
35076 is about to kill inferiors.
35077
35078 @item qTfSTM
35079 @xref{qTfSTM}.
35080 @item qTsSTM
35081 @xref{qTsSTM}.
35082 @item qTSTMat
35083 @xref{qTSTMat}.
35084 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
35085 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
35086
35087 Replies:
35088 @table @samp
35089 @item E @var{NN}
35090 for an error
35091 @end table
35092 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
35093 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
35094 @end table
35095
35096 @node GDB Bugs
35097 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
35098 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
35099 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
35100
35101 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
35102
35103 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
35104 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
35105 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
35106 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
35107
35108 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
35109 information that enables us to fix the bug.
35110
35111 @menu
35112 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
35113 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
35114 @end menu
35115
35116 @node Bug Criteria
35117 @section Have You Found a Bug?
35118 @cindex bug criteria
35119
35120 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
35121
35122 @itemize @bullet
35123 @cindex fatal signal
35124 @cindex debugger crash
35125 @cindex crash of debugger
35126 @item
35127 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
35128 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
35129
35130 @cindex error on valid input
35131 @item
35132 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
35133 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
35134 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
35135
35136 @cindex invalid input
35137 @item
35138 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
35139 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
35140 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
35141 for traditional practice''.
35142
35143 @item
35144 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
35145 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
35146 @end itemize
35147
35148 @node Bug Reporting
35149 @section How to Report Bugs
35150 @cindex bug reports
35151 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
35152
35153 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
35154 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
35155 contact that organization first.
35156
35157 You can find contact information for many support companies and
35158 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
35159 distribution.
35160 @c should add a web page ref...
35161
35162 @ifset BUGURL
35163 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
35164 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35165 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
35166 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
35167 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35168 be used.
35169
35170 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35171 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35172 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35173 @samp{bug-gdb}.
35174
35175 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35176 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35177 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35178 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35179 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35180 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35181 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35182 bug reports to the mailing list.
35183 @end ifset
35184 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35185 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35186 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35187 @end ifclear
35188 @end ifset
35189
35190 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35191 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35192 fact or leave it out, state it!
35193
35194 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35195 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35196 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35197 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35198 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35199 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35200 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35201 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35202 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35203
35204 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35205 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35206 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35207 self-contained.
35208
35209 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35210 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35211 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35212 bugs properly.
35213
35214 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35215
35216 @itemize @bullet
35217 @item
35218 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35219 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35220 version}.
35221
35222 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35223 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35224
35225 @item
35226 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35227 version number.
35228
35229 @item
35230 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35231 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35232 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35233 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35234
35235 @item
35236 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35237 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35238
35239 @item
35240 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35241 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35242 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35243 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35244 those compilers.
35245
35246 @item
35247 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35248 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35249 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35250 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35251
35252 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35253 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35254
35255 @item
35256 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35257 reproduce the bug.
35258
35259 @item
35260 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35261 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35262
35263 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35264 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35265 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35266 a chance to make a mistake.
35267
35268 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35269 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35270 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35271 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35272 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35273 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35274 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35275 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35276
35277 @pindex script
35278 @cindex recording a session script
35279 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35280 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35281 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35282 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35283
35284 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35285 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35286
35287 @item
35288 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35289 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35290 it by context, not by line number.
35291
35292 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35293 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35294
35295 @end itemize
35296
35297 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35298
35299 @itemize @bullet
35300 @item
35301 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35302
35303 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35304 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35305 changes will not affect it.
35306
35307 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35308 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35309 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35310 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35311
35312 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35313 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35314 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35315 less time, and so on.
35316
35317 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35318 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35319
35320 @item
35321 A patch for the bug.
35322
35323 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35324 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35325 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35326 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35327
35328 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35329 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35330 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35331 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35332
35333 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35334 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35335 help us to understand.
35336
35337 @item
35338 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35339
35340 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35341 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35342 @end itemize
35343
35344 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35345 @c and consists of the two following files:
35346 @c rluser.texi
35347 @c hsuser.texi
35348 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35349 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35350 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35351 @include rluser.texi
35352 @include hsuser.texi
35353 @end ifclear
35354
35355 @node In Memoriam
35356 @appendix In Memoriam
35357
35358 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35359 contributors:
35360
35361 @table @code
35362 @item Fred Fish
35363 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35364 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35365 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35366
35367 @item Michael Snyder
35368 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35369 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35370 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35371 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35372 @end table
35373
35374 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35375 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35376
35377 @node Formatting Documentation
35378 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35379
35380 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35381 @cindex reference card
35382 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35383 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35384 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35385 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35386 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35387 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35388
35389 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35390 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35391
35392 @smallexample
35393 make refcard.dvi
35394 @end smallexample
35395
35396 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35397 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35398 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35399 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35400 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35401
35402 @cindex documentation
35403
35404 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35405 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35406 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35407 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35408 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35409 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35410
35411 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35412 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35413 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35414 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35415 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35416 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35417 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35418 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35419
35420 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35421 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35422 @code{makeinfo}.
35423
35424 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35425 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35426 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35427
35428 @smallexample
35429 cd gdb
35430 make gdb.info
35431 @end smallexample
35432
35433 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35434 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35435 Texinfo definitions file.
35436
35437 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35438 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35439 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35440 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35441 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35442 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35443 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35444
35445 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35446 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35447 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35448 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35449 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35450 directory.
35451
35452 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35453 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35454 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35455 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35456
35457 @smallexample
35458 make gdb.dvi
35459 @end smallexample
35460
35461 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35462
35463 @node Installing GDB
35464 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35465 @cindex installation
35466
35467 @menu
35468 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35469 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35470 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35471 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35472 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35473 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35474 @end menu
35475
35476 @node Requirements
35477 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35478 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35479
35480 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35481 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35482
35483 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35484 @table @asis
35485 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35486 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35487 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35488
35489 @item GNU make
35490 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35491 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35492 @end table
35493
35494 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35495 @table @asis
35496 @item Expat
35497 @anchor{Expat}
35498 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35499 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35500 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35501 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35502 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35503 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35504
35505 Expat is used for:
35506
35507 @itemize @bullet
35508 @item
35509 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35510 @item
35511 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35512 @item
35513 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35514 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35515 @item
35516 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35517 @item
35518 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35519 @item
35520 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35521 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35522 @end itemize
35523
35524 @item Guile
35525 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35526 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35527 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35528 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35529 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35530 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35531
35532 @item iconv
35533 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35534 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35535 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35536 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35537
35538 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35539 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35540 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35541 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35542 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35543
35544 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35545 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35546 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35547 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35548 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35549
35550 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35551 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35552 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35553 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35554 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35555 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35556 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35557 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35558 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35559
35560 @item lzma
35561 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35562 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35563 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35564 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35565 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35566 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35567 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35568
35569 @item MPFR
35570 @anchor{MPFR}
35571 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35572 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35573 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35574 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35575 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35576 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35577 option to specify its location.
35578
35579 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35580 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35581 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35582 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35583
35584 @item Python
35585 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35586 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35587 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35588 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35589 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35590 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35591 installation of Python.
35592
35593 @item zlib
35594 @cindex compressed debug sections
35595 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35596 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35597 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35598 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35599 information in such binaries.
35600
35601 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35602 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35603 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35604 @end table
35605
35606 @node Running Configure
35607 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35608 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35609 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35610 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35611 build the @code{gdb} program.
35612 @iftex
35613 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35614 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35615 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35616 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35617 @end iftex
35618
35619 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35620 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35621 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35622
35623 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35624 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35625
35626 @table @code
35627 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35628 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35629
35630 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35631 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35632
35633 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35634 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35635
35636 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35637 @sc{gnu} include files
35638
35639 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35640 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35641
35642 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35643 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35644
35645 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35646 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35647 @end table
35648
35649 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35650
35651 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35652 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35653 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35654
35655 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35656 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35657 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35658 argument.
35659
35660 For example:
35661
35662 @smallexample
35663 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35664 ./configure
35665 make
35666 @end smallexample
35667
35668 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35669 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35670 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35671 directories.
35672
35673 @need 750
35674 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35675 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35676 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35677
35678 @smallexample
35679 sh configure
35680 @end smallexample
35681
35682 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35683 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35684 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35685 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35686 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35687 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35688 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35689 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35690 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35691
35692 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35693 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35694 install it with @code{make install}.
35695
35696 @node Separate Objdir
35697 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35698
35699 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35700 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35701 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35702 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35703 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35704 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35705 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35706 program specified there.
35707
35708 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35709 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35710 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35711 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35712 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35713 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35714
35715 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35716 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35717
35718 @smallexample
35719 @group
35720 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35721 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35722 cd ../gdb-sun4
35723 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35724 make
35725 @end group
35726 @end smallexample
35727
35728 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35729 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35730 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35731 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35732 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35733 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35734
35735 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35736 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35737 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35738 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35739 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35740
35741 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35742 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35743 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35744 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35745 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35746 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35747
35748 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35749 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35750 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35751
35752 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35753 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35754 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35755 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35756 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35757
35758 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35759 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35760 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35761 with each other.
35762
35763 @node Config Names
35764 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35765
35766 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35767 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35768 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35769 of information in the following pattern:
35770
35771 @smallexample
35772 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35773 @end smallexample
35774
35775 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35776 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35777 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35778
35779 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35780 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35781 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35782 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35783 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35784 abbreviations---for example:
35785
35786 @smallexample
35787 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35788 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35789 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35790 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35791 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35792 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35793 % sh config.sub sun4
35794 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35795 % sh config.sub sun3
35796 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35797 % sh config.sub i986v
35798 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35799 @end smallexample
35800
35801 @noindent
35802 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35803 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35804
35805 @node Configure Options
35806 @section @file{configure} Options
35807
35808 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35809 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35810 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35811 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35812 explanation of @file{configure}.
35813
35814 @smallexample
35815 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35816 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35817 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35818 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35819 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35820 @end smallexample
35821
35822 @noindent
35823 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35824 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35825 @samp{--}.
35826
35827 @table @code
35828 @item --help
35829 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35830
35831 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35832 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35833 @file{@var{dir}}.
35834
35835 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35836 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35837 @file{@var{dir}}.
35838
35839 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35840 @need 2000
35841 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35842 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35843 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35844 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35845 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35846 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35847 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35848 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35849 @var{dirname}.
35850
35851 @item --target=@var{target}
35852 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35853 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35854 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35855
35856 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35857 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35858 @end table
35859
35860 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35861 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35862 options not described here.
35863
35864 @table @code
35865 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
35866 @itemx --enable-targets=all
35867 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
35868 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
35869 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
35870
35871 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
35872 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
35873 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
35874 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
35875 @code{--datadir}).
35876
35877 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
35878 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
35879 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
35880 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
35881 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
35882 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
35883 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
35884 after it is built.
35885
35886 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
35887 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
35888
35889 @item --disable-gdbmi
35890 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
35891 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35892
35893 @item --enable-tui
35894 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
35895 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
35896 supported).
35897
35898 @item --with-curses
35899 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
35900 terminal operations.
35901
35902 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
35903 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
35904 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
35905 details.
35906
35907 @item --with-system-readline
35908 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
35909 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35910
35911 @item --with-system-zlib
35912 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
35913 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35914
35915 @item --with-expat
35916 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
35917 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
35918 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
35919 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
35920 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
35921 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
35922 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
35923 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
35924
35925 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
35926
35927 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
35928 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
35929 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
35930 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
35931 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
35932
35933 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
35934 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
35935
35936 @item --with-lzma
35937 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
35938 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
35939 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
35940 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
35941 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
35942 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
35943
35944 @item --with-mpfr
35945 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
35946 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
35947 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
35948 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
35949 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
35950 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
35951 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
35952 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
35953 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
35954
35955 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
35956 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
35957 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
35958 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
35959 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
35960 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
35961 of Python supported by GDB is 2.4. The optional argument @var{python}
35962 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
35963 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
35964 Python is installed.
35965
35966 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
35967 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
35968 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
35969 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
35970 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
35971 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
35972 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
35973 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
35974 compile and link against Guile.
35975
35976 @item --without-included-regex
35977 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
35978 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
35979 the GNU C library.
35980
35981 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
35982 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
35983 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
35984 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
35985 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
35986 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
35987 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
35988 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
35989
35990 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35991 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
35992 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
35993 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
35994 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
35995 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
35996
35997 @item --enable-build-warnings
35998 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
35999 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
36000 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
36001 compiler you are using.
36002
36003 @item --enable-werror
36004 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
36005 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
36006 outputs any warning messages.
36007
36008 @item --enable-ubsan
36009 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
36010 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
36011 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
36012 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
36013 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
36014 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
36015 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
36016 @end table
36017
36018 @node System-wide configuration
36019 @section System-wide configuration and settings
36020 @cindex system-wide init file
36021
36022 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
36023 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
36024 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
36025
36026 Here is the corresponding configure option:
36027
36028 @table @code
36029 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36030 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
36031 @var{file}.
36032 @end table
36033
36034 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
36035 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
36036
36037 @itemize @bullet
36038 @item
36039 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
36040 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
36041 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
36042 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
36043 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
36044 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
36045
36046 @item
36047 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
36048 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
36049 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36050 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36051 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
36052 @end itemize
36053
36054 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
36055 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
36056 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
36057 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
36058 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
36059 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
36060 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
36061 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
36062 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
36063 reread.
36064
36065 @menu
36066 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36067 @end menu
36068
36069 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
36070 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36071 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
36072
36073 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
36074 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
36075 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
36076 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
36077 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
36078 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
36079
36080 The following scripts are currently available:
36081 @itemize @bullet
36082
36083 @item @file{elinos.py}
36084 @pindex elinos.py
36085 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
36086 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
36087 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
36088 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
36089 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
36090 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
36091
36092 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
36093 @pindex wrs-linux.py
36094 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
36095 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
36096 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
36097 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
36098
36099 @end itemize
36100
36101 @node Maintenance Commands
36102 @appendix Maintenance Commands
36103 @cindex maintenance commands
36104 @cindex internal commands
36105
36106 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
36107 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
36108 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
36109 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
36110 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
36111
36112 @table @code
36113 @kindex maint agent
36114 @kindex maint agent-eval
36115 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36116 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36117 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
36118 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
36119 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
36120 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
36121 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
36122 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
36123 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
36124 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
36125 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
36126 addition and return the sum.
36127 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
36128 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
36129
36130 @kindex maint agent-printf
36131 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
36132 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
36133 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
36134 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
36135 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
36136
36137 @kindex maint info breakpoints
36138 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
36139 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
36140 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
36141 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
36142 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
36143 is shown:
36144
36145 @table @code
36146 @item breakpoint
36147 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
36148
36149 @item watchpoint
36150 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
36151
36152 @item longjmp
36153 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
36154 @code{longjmp} calls.
36155
36156 @item longjmp resume
36157 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
36158
36159 @item until
36160 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
36161
36162 @item finish
36163 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
36164
36165 @item shlib events
36166 Shared library events.
36167
36168 @end table
36169
36170 @kindex maint info btrace
36171 @item maint info btrace
36172 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
36173
36174 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
36175 @item maint btrace packet-history
36176 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
36177 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
36178 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
36179 recording format.
36180
36181 @table @code
36182 @item bts
36183 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
36184 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
36185
36186 @table @asis
36187 @item Block number
36188 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
36189 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
36190 @item Highest @samp{PC}
36191 @end table
36192
36193 @item pt
36194 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
36195 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
36196 information is printed:
36197
36198 @table @asis
36199 @item Packet number
36200 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
36201 @item Trace offset
36202 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
36203 @item Packet opcode and payload
36204 @end table
36205 @end table
36206
36207 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
36208 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
36209 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
36210 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
36211 needed.
36212
36213 @kindex maint btrace clear
36214 @item maint btrace clear
36215 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36216 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36217
36218 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36219 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36220 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36221 buffer.
36222
36223 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36224 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36225 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36226 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36227 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36228 packet history.
36229
36230 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36231 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36232 @cindex displaced stepping support
36233 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36234 @item set displaced-stepping
36235 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36236 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36237 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36238 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36239 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36240 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36241
36242 @table @code
36243 @item set displaced-stepping on
36244 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36245 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36246
36247 @item set displaced-stepping off
36248 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36249 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36250
36251 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36252 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36253 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36254 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36255 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36256 @end table
36257
36258 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36259 @item maint check-psymtabs
36260 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36261 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36262
36263 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36264 @item maint check-symtabs
36265 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36266
36267 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36268 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36269 Expand symbol tables.
36270 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36271 names matching @var{regexp}.
36272
36273 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36274 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36275 @cindex demangler crashes
36276 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36277 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36278 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36279 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36280 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36281 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36282 option to terminate the current session.
36283
36284 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36285 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36286 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36287
36288 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36289 @item maint cplus namespace
36290 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36291
36292 @kindex maint deprecate
36293 @kindex maint undeprecate
36294 @cindex deprecated commands
36295 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36296 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36297 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36298 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36299 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36300 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36301 the replacement as part of the warning.
36302
36303 @kindex maint dump-me
36304 @item maint dump-me
36305 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36306 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36307 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36308 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36309
36310 @kindex maint internal-error
36311 @kindex maint internal-warning
36312 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36313 @cindex demangler crashes
36314 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36315 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36316 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36317
36318 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36319 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36320 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36321 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36322 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36323 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36324 @value{GDBN} session.
36325
36326 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36327 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36328
36329 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36330
36331 @smallexample
36332 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36333 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36334 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36335 debugging may prove unreliable.
36336 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36337 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36338 (@value{GDBP})
36339 @end smallexample
36340
36341 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36342 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36343 @cindex demangler crashes
36344
36345 @kindex maint set internal-error
36346 @kindex maint show internal-error
36347 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36348 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36349 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36350 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36351 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36352 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36353 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36354 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36355 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36356 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36357 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36358 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36359 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36360 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36361 described in the table below.
36362
36363 @table @samp
36364 @item quit
36365 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36366 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36367
36368 @item corefile
36369 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36370 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36371 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36372 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36373 disabled.
36374 @end table
36375
36376 @kindex maint packet
36377 @item maint packet @var{text}
36378 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36379 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36380 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36381 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36382 checksum.
36383
36384 @kindex maint print architecture
36385 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36386 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36387 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36388
36389 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36390 @item maint print c-tdesc
36391 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36392 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36393 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36394 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36395 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36396 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36397 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36398 modify XML target descriptions.
36399
36400 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36401 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36402 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36403 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36404
36405 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36406 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36407 @item maint check libthread-db
36408 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36409 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36410 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36411 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36412 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36413 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36414
36415 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36416 @item maint print dummy-frames
36417 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36418
36419 @smallexample
36420 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36421 @dots{}
36422 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36423 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36424 58 return (a + b);
36425 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36426 @dots{}
36427 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36428 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36429 (@value{GDBP})
36430 @end smallexample
36431
36432 Takes an optional file parameter.
36433
36434 @kindex maint print registers
36435 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36436 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36437 @kindex maint print register-groups
36438 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36439 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36440 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36441 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36442 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36443 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36444 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36445
36446 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36447 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36448 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36449 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36450 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36451 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36452 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36453 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36454
36455 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36456 write the information.
36457
36458 @kindex maint print reggroups
36459 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36460 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36461 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36462 information.
36463
36464 The register groups info looks like this:
36465
36466 @smallexample
36467 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36468 Group Type
36469 general user
36470 float user
36471 all user
36472 vector user
36473 system user
36474 save internal
36475 restore internal
36476 @end smallexample
36477
36478 @kindex flushregs
36479 @item flushregs
36480 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36481
36482 @kindex maint print objfiles
36483 @cindex info for known object files
36484 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36485 Print a dump of all known object files.
36486 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36487 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36488 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36489
36490 @kindex maint print user-registers
36491 @cindex user registers
36492 @item maint print user-registers
36493 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36494 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36495 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36496 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36497 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36498 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36499 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36500
36501 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36502 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36503 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36504 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36505 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36506 matching @var{regexp}.
36507 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36508 and the full path if known.
36509 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36510
36511 @kindex maint print statistics
36512 @cindex bcache statistics
36513 @item maint print statistics
36514 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36515 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36516 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36517 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36518 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36519 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36520 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36521 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36522 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36523 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36524 lengths.
36525
36526 @kindex maint print target-stack
36527 @cindex target stack description
36528 @item maint print target-stack
36529 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36530 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36531 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36532 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36533 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36534 address.
36535
36536 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36537 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36538
36539 @kindex maint print type
36540 @cindex type chain of a data type
36541 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36542 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36543 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36544 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36545 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36546 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36547
36548 @kindex maint selftest
36549 @cindex self tests
36550 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36551 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36552 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36553 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36554 name will by ran.
36555
36556 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36557 @cindex self tests
36558 @item maint info selftests
36559 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36560
36561 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36562 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36563 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36564 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36565 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36566 information.
36567
36568 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36569 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36570 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36571 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36572 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36573 always see the disassembly form.
36574
36575 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36576
36577 @smallexample
36578 (gdb) info addr argc
36579 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36580 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36581 @end smallexample
36582
36583 For more information on these expressions, see
36584 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36585
36586 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36587 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36588 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36589 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36590 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36591
36592 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36593 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36594 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36595 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36596 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36597 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36598 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36599 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36600 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36601
36602 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36603 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36604 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36605 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36606 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36607
36608 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36609 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36610 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36611 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36612 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36613 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36614
36615 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36616 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36617 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36618
36619 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36620 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36621 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36622 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36623
36624 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36625 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36626 @kindex maint set profile
36627 @kindex maint show profile
36628 @cindex profiling GDB
36629 @item maint set profile
36630 @itemx maint show profile
36631 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36632
36633 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36634 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36635 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36636 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36637 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36638 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36639 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36640
36641 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36642 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36643
36644 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36645 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36646 @cindex hardware debug registers
36647 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36648 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36649 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36650 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36651 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36652 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36653 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36654
36655 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36656 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36657 @item maint set show-all-tib
36658 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36659 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36660 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36661 command.
36662
36663 @kindex maint set target-async
36664 @kindex maint show target-async
36665 @item maint set target-async
36666 @itemx maint show target-async
36667 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36668 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36669 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36670 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36671
36672 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36673 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36674 @item maint set target-non-stop
36675 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36676
36677 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36678 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36679 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36680 if supported by the target.
36681
36682 @table @code
36683 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36684 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36685 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36686
36687 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36688 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36689 does not indicate support.
36690
36691 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36692 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36693 target supports it.
36694 @end table
36695
36696 @kindex maint set per-command
36697 @kindex maint show per-command
36698 @item maint set per-command
36699 @itemx maint show per-command
36700 @cindex resources used by commands
36701
36702 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36703 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36704
36705 @table @code
36706 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36707 @itemx maint show per-command space
36708 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36709 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36710 took, following the command's own output.
36711 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36712 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36713
36714 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36715 @itemx maint show per-command time
36716 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36717 for each command.
36718 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36719 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36720 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36721 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36722 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36723 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36724 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36725 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36726 spent by the program been debugged.
36727 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36728 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36729
36730 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36731 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36732 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36733 for each command.
36734 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36735
36736 @enumerate a
36737 @item
36738 number of symbol tables
36739 @item
36740 number of primary symbol tables
36741 @item
36742 number of blocks in the blockvector
36743 @end enumerate
36744 @end table
36745
36746 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36747 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36748 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36749 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36750 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36751 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36752 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36753 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36754 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36755 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36756
36757 @kindex maint space
36758 @cindex memory used by commands
36759 @item maint space @var{value}
36760 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36761 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36762
36763 @kindex maint time
36764 @cindex time of command execution
36765 @item maint time @var{value}
36766 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36767 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36768
36769 @kindex maint translate-address
36770 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36771 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36772 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36773 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36774 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36775 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36776 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36777
36778 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36779 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36780 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36781
36782 @end table
36783
36784 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36785 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36786
36787 @table @code
36788 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36789 @kindex set watchdog
36790 @cindex watchdog timer
36791 @cindex timeout for commands
36792 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36793 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36794 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36795
36796 @item show watchdog
36797 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36798 @end table
36799
36800 @node Remote Protocol
36801 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36802
36803 @menu
36804 * Overview::
36805 * Packets::
36806 * Stop Reply Packets::
36807 * General Query Packets::
36808 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36809 * Tracepoint Packets::
36810 * Host I/O Packets::
36811 * Interrupts::
36812 * Notification Packets::
36813 * Remote Non-Stop::
36814 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36815 * Examples::
36816 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36817 * Library List Format::
36818 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36819 * Memory Map Format::
36820 * Thread List Format::
36821 * Traceframe Info Format::
36822 * Branch Trace Format::
36823 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36824 @end menu
36825
36826 @node Overview
36827 @section Overview
36828
36829 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36830 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36831 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36832 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36833
36834 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36835 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36836
36837 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36838 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36839 @cindex remote serial protocol
36840 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36841 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36842 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36843 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36844 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36845
36846 @smallexample
36847 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36848 @end smallexample
36849 @noindent
36850
36851 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36852 @noindent
36853 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36854 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36855 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36856
36857 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36858 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36859
36860 @smallexample
36861 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36862 @end smallexample
36863
36864 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36865 @noindent
36866 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36867 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36868 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36869
36870 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36871 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36872 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36873 retransmission):
36874
36875 @smallexample
36876 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36877 <- @code{+}
36878 @end smallexample
36879 @noindent
36880
36881 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36882 once a connection is established.
36883 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36884
36885 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36886 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36887 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36888 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36889 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36890 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36891 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36892
36893 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36894 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36895 exceptions).
36896
36897 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36898 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36899 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36900 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36901
36902 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36903 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36904 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36905
36906 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36907 @anchor{Binary Data}
36908 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36909 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36910 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36911 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36912 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36913 binary data.
36914
36915 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36916 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36917 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36918 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36919 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36920 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36921 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36922 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36923 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36924 (described next).
36925
36926 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36927 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36928 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36929 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36930 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36931 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36932 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36933 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36934 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36935 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36936 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36937 3}} more times.
36938
36939 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36940 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36941 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36942 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36943 @samp{0*"00}.
36944
36945 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36946 error number. That number is not well defined.
36947
36948 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36949 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36950 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36951 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36952 on that response.
36953
36954 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36955 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36956 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36957 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36958 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36959 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36960
36961 @node Packets
36962 @section Packets
36963
36964 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36965 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36966 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36967 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36968
36969 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36970 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36971 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36972 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36973 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36974 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36975 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36976 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36977 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36978 @var{baz}.
36979
36980 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36981 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36982 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36983 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36984 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36985 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36986 pick any thread.
36987
36988 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36989 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36990 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36991 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36992 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36993 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36994 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36995 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36996 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36997 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36998 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36999 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
37000 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
37001
37002 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
37003 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
37004 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
37005 more information.
37006
37007 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
37008 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
37009
37010 Here are the packet descriptions.
37011
37012 @table @samp
37013
37014 @item !
37015 @cindex @samp{!} packet
37016 @anchor{extended mode}
37017 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
37018 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
37019 debugged.
37020
37021 Reply:
37022 @table @samp
37023 @item OK
37024 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
37025 @end table
37026
37027 @item ?
37028 @cindex @samp{?} packet
37029 @anchor{? packet}
37030 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
37031 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
37032 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37033
37034 Reply:
37035 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37036
37037 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
37038 @cindex @samp{A} packet
37039 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
37040 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
37041 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
37042
37043 Reply:
37044 @table @samp
37045 @item OK
37046 The arguments were set.
37047 @item E @var{NN}
37048 An error occurred.
37049 @end table
37050
37051 @item b @var{baud}
37052 @cindex @samp{b} packet
37053 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
37054 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
37055
37056 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
37057 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
37058 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
37059
37060 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
37061 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
37062 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
37063 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
37064 of view, nothing actually happened.}
37065
37066 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
37067 @cindex @samp{B} packet
37068 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
37069 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
37070
37071 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
37072 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
37073
37074 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
37075 @anchor{bc}
37076 @item bc
37077 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
37078 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37079
37080 Reply:
37081 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37082
37083 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
37084 @anchor{bs}
37085 @item bs
37086 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
37087 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37088
37089 Reply:
37090 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37091
37092 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37093 @cindex @samp{c} packet
37094 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
37095 is omitted, resume at current address.
37096
37097 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37098 packet}.
37099
37100 Reply:
37101 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37102
37103 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37104 @cindex @samp{C} packet
37105 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
37106 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
37107
37108 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37109 packet}.
37110
37111 Reply:
37112 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37113
37114 @item d
37115 @cindex @samp{d} packet
37116 Toggle debug flag.
37117
37118 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
37119 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
37120
37121 @item D
37122 @itemx D;@var{pid}
37123 @cindex @samp{D} packet
37124 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
37125 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
37126 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
37127
37128 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
37129 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
37130 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
37131 big-endian hex string.
37132
37133 Reply:
37134 @table @samp
37135 @item OK
37136 for success
37137 @item E @var{NN}
37138 for an error
37139 @end table
37140
37141 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
37142 @cindex @samp{F} packet
37143 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
37144 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
37145 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
37146
37147 @item g
37148 @anchor{read registers packet}
37149 @cindex @samp{g} packet
37150 Read general registers.
37151
37152 Reply:
37153 @table @samp
37154 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37155 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
37156 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
37157 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
37158 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
37159 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
37160
37161 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
37162 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
37163 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
37164 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
37165 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
37166 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
37167 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37168 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37169
37170 @smallexample
37171 -> @code{g}
37172 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37173 @end smallexample
37174
37175 @item E @var{NN}
37176 for an error.
37177 @end table
37178
37179 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37180 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37181 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37182 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37183
37184 Reply:
37185 @table @samp
37186 @item OK
37187 for success
37188 @item E @var{NN}
37189 for an error
37190 @end table
37191
37192 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37193 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37194 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37195 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
37196 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37197 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37198 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37199 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37200 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37201
37202 Reply:
37203 @table @samp
37204 @item OK
37205 for success
37206 @item E @var{NN}
37207 for an error
37208 @end table
37209
37210 @c FIXME: JTC:
37211 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37212 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37213 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37214 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37215 @c described. For example:
37216 @c
37217 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37218 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37219 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37220 @c
37221 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37222 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37223 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37224
37225 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37226 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37227 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37228 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37229 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37230 step starting at that address.
37231
37232 @item I
37233 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37234 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37235 step packet}.
37236
37237 @item k
37238 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37239 Kill request.
37240
37241 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37242
37243 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37244 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37245
37246 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37247
37248 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37249 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37250 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37251
37252 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37253 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37254 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37255
37256 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37257 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37258 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37259 (@pxref{? packet}).
37260
37261 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37262 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37263 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37264 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37265 any particular boundary.
37266
37267 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37268 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37269 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37270 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37271 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37272 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37273 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37274 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37275
37276 Reply:
37277 @table @samp
37278 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37279 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37280 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37281 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37282 @item E @var{NN}
37283 @var{NN} is errno
37284 @end table
37285
37286 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37287 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37288 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37289 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37290 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37291
37292 Reply:
37293 @table @samp
37294 @item OK
37295 for success
37296 @item E @var{NN}
37297 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37298 written).
37299 @end table
37300
37301 @item p @var{n}
37302 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37303 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37304 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37305 register value is encoded.
37306
37307 Reply:
37308 @table @samp
37309 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37310 the register's value
37311 @item E @var{NN}
37312 for an error
37313 @item @w{}
37314 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37315 @end table
37316
37317 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37318 @anchor{write register packet}
37319 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37320 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37321 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37322 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37323
37324 Reply:
37325 @table @samp
37326 @item OK
37327 for success
37328 @item E @var{NN}
37329 for an error
37330 @end table
37331
37332 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37333 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37334 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37335 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37336 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37337 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37338
37339 @item r
37340 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37341 Reset the entire system.
37342
37343 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37344
37345 @item R @var{XX}
37346 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37347 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37348 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37349
37350 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37351
37352 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37353 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37354 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37355 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37356
37357 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37358 packet}.
37359
37360 Reply:
37361 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37362
37363 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37364 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37365 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37366 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37367 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37368
37369 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37370 packet}.
37371
37372 Reply:
37373 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37374
37375 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37376 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37377 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37378 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37379 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37380
37381 @item T @var{thread-id}
37382 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37383 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37384
37385 Reply:
37386 @table @samp
37387 @item OK
37388 thread is still alive
37389 @item E @var{NN}
37390 thread is dead
37391 @end table
37392
37393 @item v
37394 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37395 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37396
37397 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37398 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37399 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37400 The process ID is a
37401 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37402 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37403 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37404
37405 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37406 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37407 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37408 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37409 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37410 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37411 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37412 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37413
37414 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37415
37416 Reply:
37417 @table @samp
37418 @item E @var{nn}
37419 for an error
37420 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37421 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37422 @item OK
37423 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37424 @end table
37425
37426 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37427 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37428 @anchor{vCont packet}
37429 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37430
37431 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37432 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37433 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37434 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37435 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37436 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37437 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37438 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37439 error.
37440
37441 Currently supported actions are:
37442
37443 @table @samp
37444 @item c
37445 Continue.
37446 @item C @var{sig}
37447 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37448 @item s
37449 Step.
37450 @item S @var{sig}
37451 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37452 @item t
37453 Stop.
37454 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37455 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37456 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37457 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37458 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37459 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37460
37461 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37462 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37463 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37464 jumps to @var{start}).
37465
37466 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37467 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37468 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37469
37470 @end table
37471
37472 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37473 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37474 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37475
37476 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37477 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37478 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37479 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37480 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37481 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37482 as an implementation detail.
37483
37484 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37485 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37486 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37487 stopped.
37488
37489 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37490 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37491 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37492
37493 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37494 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37495
37496 Reply:
37497 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37498
37499 @item vCont?
37500 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37501 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37502
37503 Reply:
37504 @table @samp
37505 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37506 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37507 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37508 @item @w{}
37509 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37510 @end table
37511
37512 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37513 @item vCtrlC
37514 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37515 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37516 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37517 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37518 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37519 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37520 variant.
37521
37522 Reply:
37523 @table @samp
37524 @item E @var{nn}
37525 for an error
37526 @item OK
37527 for success
37528 @end table
37529
37530 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37531 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37532 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37533 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37534
37535 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37536 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37537 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37538 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37539 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37540 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37541 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37542 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37543 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37544 packet is received.
37545
37546 Reply:
37547 @table @samp
37548 @item OK
37549 for success
37550 @item E @var{NN}
37551 for an error
37552 @end table
37553
37554 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37555 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37556 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37557 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37558 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37559 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37560 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37561 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37562 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37563 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37564 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37565 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37566
37567
37568 Reply:
37569 @table @samp
37570 @item OK
37571 for success
37572 @item E.memtype
37573 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37574 @item E @var{NN}
37575 for an error
37576 @end table
37577
37578 @item vFlashDone
37579 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37580 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37581 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37582 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37583 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37584 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37585 request is completed.
37586
37587 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37588 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37589 @anchor{vKill packet}
37590 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37591 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37592 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37593 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37594
37595 Reply:
37596 @table @samp
37597 @item E @var{nn}
37598 for an error
37599 @item OK
37600 for success
37601 @end table
37602
37603 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37604 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37605 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37606 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37607 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37608
37609 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37610 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37611 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37612 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37613 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37614 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37615
37616 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37617 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37618 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37619 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37620 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37621 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37622 state.
37623
37624 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37625
37626 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37627
37628 Reply:
37629 @table @samp
37630 @item E @var{nn}
37631 for an error
37632 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37633 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37634 @end table
37635
37636 @item vStopped
37637 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37638 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37639
37640 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37641 @anchor{X packet}
37642 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37643 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37644 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37645 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37646 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37647
37648 Reply:
37649 @table @samp
37650 @item OK
37651 for success
37652 @item E @var{NN}
37653 for an error
37654 @end table
37655
37656 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37657 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37658 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37659 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37660 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37661 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37662 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37663
37664 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37665 separately.
37666
37667 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37668 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37669 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37670 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37671 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37672 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37673
37674 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37675 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37676 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37677 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37678 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37679 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37680
37681 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37682 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37683 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37684 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37685 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37686 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37687 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37688 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37689 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37690 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37691 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37692 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37693 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37694
37695 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37696 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37697
37698 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37699 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37700
37701 @table @samp
37702
37703 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37704 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37705 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37706
37707 @end table
37708
37709 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37710 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37711 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37712 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37713 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37714 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37715 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37716
37717 @table @samp
37718
37719 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37720 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37721 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37722
37723 @end table
37724
37725 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37726 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37727 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37728 target, is not defined.}
37729
37730 Reply:
37731 @table @samp
37732 @item OK
37733 success
37734 @item @w{}
37735 not supported
37736 @item E @var{NN}
37737 for an error
37738 @end table
37739
37740 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37741 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37742 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37743 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37744 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37745 address @var{addr}.
37746
37747 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37748 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37749 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37750 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37751
37752 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37753 movement.}
37754
37755 Reply:
37756 @table @samp
37757 @item OK
37758 success
37759 @item @w{}
37760 not supported
37761 @item E @var{NN}
37762 for an error
37763 @end table
37764
37765 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37766 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37767 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37768 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37769 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37770 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37771
37772 Reply:
37773 @table @samp
37774 @item OK
37775 success
37776 @item @w{}
37777 not supported
37778 @item E @var{NN}
37779 for an error
37780 @end table
37781
37782 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37783 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37784 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37785 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37786 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37787 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37788
37789 Reply:
37790 @table @samp
37791 @item OK
37792 success
37793 @item @w{}
37794 not supported
37795 @item E @var{NN}
37796 for an error
37797 @end table
37798
37799 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37800 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37801 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37802 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37803 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37804 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37805
37806 Reply:
37807 @table @samp
37808 @item OK
37809 success
37810 @item @w{}
37811 not supported
37812 @item E @var{NN}
37813 for an error
37814 @end table
37815
37816 @end table
37817
37818 @node Stop Reply Packets
37819 @section Stop Reply Packets
37820 @cindex stop reply packets
37821
37822 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37823 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37824 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37825 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37826 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37827 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37828 @value{GDBN} source code.
37829
37830 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37831 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37832 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37833
37834 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37835 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37836 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37837 components.
37838
37839 @table @samp
37840
37841 @item S @var{AA}
37842 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37843 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37844 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37845
37846 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37847 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37848 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37849 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37850 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37851 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37852 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37853 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37854
37855 @itemize @bullet
37856 @item
37857 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37858 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37859 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37860 two-digit hex number.
37861
37862 @item
37863 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37864 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37865
37866 @item
37867 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37868 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37869
37870 @item
37871 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37872 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37873 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37874 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37875
37876 @item
37877 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37878 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37879 future.
37880 @end itemize
37881
37882 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37883
37884 @table @samp
37885 @item watch
37886 @itemx rwatch
37887 @itemx awatch
37888 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37889 hex.
37890
37891 @item syscall_entry
37892 @itemx syscall_return
37893 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37894 syscall number, in hex.
37895
37896 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37897 @item library
37898 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37899 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37900 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37901
37902 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37903 @item replaylog
37904 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37905 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37906 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37907 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37908 for more information.
37909
37910 @item swbreak
37911 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37912 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37913 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37914 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37915 part must be left empty.
37916
37917 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37918 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37919 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37920 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37921 address.
37922
37923 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37924 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37925 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37926 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37927 indicating support.
37928
37929 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37930
37931 @item hwbreak
37932 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37933 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37934
37935 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37936 apply.
37937
37938 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37939 @item fork
37940 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37941 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37942 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37943 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37944 fork events.
37945
37946 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37947 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37948 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37949 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37950 indicating support.
37951
37952 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37953 @item vfork
37954 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37955 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37956 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37957 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37958 vfork events.
37959
37960 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37961 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37962 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37963 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37964 indicating support.
37965
37966 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37967 @item vforkdone
37968 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37969 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37970 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37971 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37972 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37973
37974 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37975 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37976 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37977 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37978 indicating support.
37979
37980 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37981 @item exec
37982 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37983 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37984 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37985
37986 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37987 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37988 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37989 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37990 indicating support.
37991
37992 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37993 @anchor{thread create event}
37994 @item create
37995 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37996 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37997 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37998 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37999 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
38000 @var{r} part is ignored.
38001
38002 @end table
38003
38004 @item W @var{AA}
38005 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38006 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
38007 applicable to certain targets.
38008
38009 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38010 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38011 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38012 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38013 hex strings.
38014
38015 @item X @var{AA}
38016 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38017 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
38018
38019 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38020 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38021 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38022 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38023 hex strings.
38024
38025 @anchor{thread exit event}
38026 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
38027 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
38028
38029 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
38030 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
38031 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
38032 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
38033
38034 @item N
38035 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
38036 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
38037 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
38038 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
38039 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
38040 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
38041 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
38042 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
38043 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
38044 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
38045 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
38046 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
38047 support.
38048
38049 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
38050 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
38051 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
38052 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
38053 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
38054
38055 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
38056 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
38057 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
38058 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
38059 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
38060 system calls.
38061
38062 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
38063 this very system call.
38064
38065 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
38066 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
38067 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
38068 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38069 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
38070 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
38071
38072 @end table
38073
38074 @node General Query Packets
38075 @section General Query Packets
38076 @cindex remote query requests
38077
38078 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
38079 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
38080 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
38081 sending information to and from the stub.
38082
38083 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
38084 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
38085 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
38086 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
38087 conventions:
38088
38089 @itemize @bullet
38090 @item
38091 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
38092 @item
38093 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
38094 letter.
38095 @item
38096 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
38097 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
38098 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
38099 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
38100 @end itemize
38101
38102 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
38103 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
38104 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
38105 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
38106 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
38107 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
38108 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
38109 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
38110 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
38111 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
38112 packet.}.
38113
38114 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
38115 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
38116 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38117 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38118 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38119
38120 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38121
38122 @table @samp
38123
38124 @item QAgent:1
38125 @itemx QAgent:0
38126 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38127 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38128
38129 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38130 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38131 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38132 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38133 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38134 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38135 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38136 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38137 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38138 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38139 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38140
38141 @item qC
38142 @cindex current thread, remote request
38143 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38144 Return the current thread ID.
38145
38146 Reply:
38147 @table @samp
38148 @item QC @var{thread-id}
38149 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
38150 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38151 @item @r{(anything else)}
38152 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
38153 @end table
38154
38155 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
38156 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
38157 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
38158 @anchor{qCRC packet}
38159 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
38160 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
38161 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
38162 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
38163
38164 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
38165 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
38166 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
38167 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38168 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38169 detect trailing zeros.
38170
38171 Reply:
38172 @table @samp
38173 @item E @var{NN}
38174 An error (such as memory fault)
38175 @item C @var{crc32}
38176 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38177 @end table
38178
38179 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38180 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38181 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38182 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38183 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38184 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38185 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38186 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38187 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38188 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38189 randomization.
38190
38191 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38192
38193 Reply:
38194 @table @samp
38195 @item OK
38196 The request succeeded.
38197
38198 @item E @var{nn}
38199 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38200
38201 @item @w{}
38202 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38203 by the stub.
38204 @end table
38205
38206 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38207 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38208 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38209 address space randomization.
38210
38211 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38212 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38213 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38214 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38215 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38216 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38217 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38218 inferior using a shell or not.
38219
38220 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38221 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38222 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38223 values are considered an error.
38224
38225 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38226 mode}).
38227
38228 Reply:
38229 @table @samp
38230 @item OK
38231 The request succeeded.
38232
38233 @item E @var{nn}
38234 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38235 @end table
38236
38237 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38238 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38239 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38240 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38241
38242 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38243 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38244
38245 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38246 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38247 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38248 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38249 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38250 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38251 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38252 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38253 environment}).
38254
38255 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38256 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38257 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38258 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38259 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38260 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38261 not be present.
38262
38263 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38264 mode}).
38265
38266 Reply:
38267 @table @samp
38268 @item OK
38269 The request succeeded.
38270 @end table
38271
38272 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38273 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38274 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38275 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38276 inferior.
38277
38278 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38279 @pxref{set environment}.
38280
38281 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38282 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38283 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38284 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38285 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38286 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38287 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38288 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38289
38290 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38291 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38292
38293 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38294 mode}).
38295
38296 Reply:
38297 @table @samp
38298 @item OK
38299 The request succeeded.
38300 @end table
38301
38302 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38303 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38304 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38305 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38306 inferior.
38307
38308 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38309 @pxref{unset environment}.
38310
38311 @item QEnvironmentReset
38312 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38313 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38314 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38315 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38316 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38317 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38318 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38319 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38320 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38321 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38322 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38323
38324 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38325 mode}).
38326
38327 Reply:
38328 @table @samp
38329 @item OK
38330 The request succeeded.
38331 @end table
38332
38333 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38334 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38335 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38336 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38337 inferior.
38338
38339 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38340 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38341 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38342 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38343 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38344 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38345
38346 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38347 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38348 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38349 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38350 directory to its original, empty value.
38351
38352 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38353 mode}).
38354
38355 Reply:
38356 @table @samp
38357 @item OK
38358 The request succeeded.
38359 @end table
38360
38361 @item qfThreadInfo
38362 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38363 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38364 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38365 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38366 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38367 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38368 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38369 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38370 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38371 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38372
38373 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38374
38375 Reply:
38376 @table @samp
38377 @item m @var{thread-id}
38378 A single thread ID
38379 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38380 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38381 @item l
38382 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38383 @end table
38384
38385 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38386 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38387 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38388 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38389 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38390 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38391 fields.
38392
38393 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38394 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38395 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38396 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38397 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38398
38399 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38400 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38401 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38402 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38403 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38404
38405 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38406 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38407
38408 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38409 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38410 information associated with the variable.)
38411
38412 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38413 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38414 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38415 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38416 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38417 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38418
38419 Reply:
38420 @table @samp
38421 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38422 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38423 local storage requested.
38424
38425 @item E @var{nn}
38426 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38427
38428 @item @w{}
38429 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38430 @end table
38431
38432 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38433 @cindex get thread information block address
38434 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38435 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38436
38437 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38438
38439 Reply:
38440 @table @samp
38441 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38442 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38443 thread information block.
38444
38445 @item E @var{nn}
38446 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38447 address could not be retrieved.
38448
38449 @item @w{}
38450 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38451 @end table
38452
38453 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38454 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38455 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38456 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38457 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38458 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38459 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38460
38461 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38462
38463 Reply:
38464 @table @samp
38465 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38466 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38467 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38468 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38469 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38470 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38471 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38472 @end table
38473
38474 @item qOffsets
38475 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38476 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38477 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38478 image.
38479
38480 Reply:
38481 @table @samp
38482 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38483 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38484 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38485 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38486 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38487 segments by the supplied offsets.
38488
38489 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38490 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38491 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38492
38493 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38494 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38495 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38496 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38497 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38498 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38499 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38500 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38501 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38502 @end table
38503
38504 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38505 @cindex thread information, remote request
38506 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38507 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38508 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38509 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38510
38511 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38512 (see below).
38513
38514 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38515
38516 @item QNonStop:1
38517 @itemx QNonStop:0
38518 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38519 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38520 @anchor{QNonStop}
38521 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38522 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38523
38524 Reply:
38525 @table @samp
38526 @item OK
38527 The request succeeded.
38528
38529 @item E @var{nn}
38530 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38531
38532 @item @w{}
38533 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38534 the stub.
38535 @end table
38536
38537 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38538 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38539 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38540 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38541
38542 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38543 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38544 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38545 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38546 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38547 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38548 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38549
38550 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38551 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38552 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38553
38554 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38555 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38556 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38557 report the requested syscalls.
38558
38559 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38560 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38561
38562 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38563 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38564 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38565 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38566
38567 Reply:
38568 @table @samp
38569 @item OK
38570 The request succeeded.
38571
38572 @item E @var{nn}
38573 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38574
38575 @item @w{}
38576 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38577 the stub.
38578 @end table
38579
38580 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38581 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38582 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38583 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38584
38585 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38586 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38587 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38588 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38589 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38590 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38591 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38592 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38593 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38594 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38595 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38596 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38597 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38598
38599 Reply:
38600 @table @samp
38601 @item OK
38602 The request succeeded.
38603
38604 @item E @var{nn}
38605 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38606
38607 @item @w{}
38608 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38609 the stub.
38610 @end table
38611
38612 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38613 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38614 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38615 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38616
38617 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38618 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38619 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38620 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38621 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38622 Others should be silently discarded.
38623
38624 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38625 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38626 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38627 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38628 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38629 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38630 signals.
38631
38632 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38633 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38634
38635 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38636 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38637 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38638 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38639 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38640
38641 Reply:
38642 @table @samp
38643 @item OK
38644 The request succeeded.
38645
38646 @item E @var{nn}
38647 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38648
38649 @item @w{}
38650 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38651 by the stub.
38652 @end table
38653
38654 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38655 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38656 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38657 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38658
38659 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38660 @item QThreadEvents:1
38661 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38662 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38663 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38664
38665 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38666 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38667 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38668 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38669 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38670 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38671 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38672 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38673 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38674 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38675
38676 Reply:
38677 @table @samp
38678 @item OK
38679 The request succeeded.
38680
38681 @item E @var{nn}
38682 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38683
38684 @item @w{}
38685 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38686 the stub.
38687 @end table
38688
38689 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38690 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38691
38692 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38693 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38694 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38695 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38696 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38697 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38698 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38699 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38700 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38701
38702 Reply:
38703 @table @samp
38704 @item OK
38705 A command response with no output.
38706 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38707 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38708 @item E @var{NN}
38709 Indicate a badly formed request.
38710 @item @w{}
38711 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38712 @end table
38713
38714 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38715 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38716 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38717 packets.)
38718
38719 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38720 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38721 @ifnotinfo
38722 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38723 @end ifnotinfo
38724 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38725 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38726 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38727 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38728 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38729
38730 Reply:
38731 @table @samp
38732 @item 0
38733 The pattern was not found.
38734 @item 1,address
38735 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38736 @item E @var{NN}
38737 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38738 @item @w{}
38739 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38740 @end table
38741
38742 @item QStartNoAckMode
38743 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38744 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38745 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38746 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38747
38748 Reply:
38749 @table @samp
38750 @item OK
38751 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38752 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38753 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38754 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38755 @item @w{}
38756 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38757 @end table
38758
38759 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38760 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38761 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38762 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38763 @anchor{qSupported}
38764 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38765 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38766 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38767 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38768 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38769 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38770 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38771 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38772 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38773 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38774 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38775 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38776 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38777 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38778
38779 Reply:
38780 @table @samp
38781 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38782 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38783 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38784 possible forms).
38785 @item @w{}
38786 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38787 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38788 @end table
38789
38790 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38791 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38792 are:
38793
38794 @table @samp
38795 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38796 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38797 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38798 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38799 @item @var{name}+
38800 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38801 need an associated value.
38802 @item @var{name}-
38803 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38804 @item @var{name}?
38805 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38806 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38807 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38808 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38809 @end table
38810
38811 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38812 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38813 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38814 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38815 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38816
38817 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38818 are defined:
38819
38820 @table @samp
38821 @item multiprocess
38822 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38823 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38824 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38825 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38826 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38827
38828 @item xmlRegisters
38829 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38830 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38831 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38832 description.
38833
38834 @item qRelocInsn
38835 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38836 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38837 instruction reply packet}).
38838
38839 @item swbreak
38840 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38841 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38842
38843 @item hwbreak
38844 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38845 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38846
38847 @item fork-events
38848 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38849 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38850 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38851 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38852
38853 @item vfork-events
38854 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38855 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38856 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38857 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38858
38859 @item exec-events
38860 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38861 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38862 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38863 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38864
38865 @item vContSupported
38866 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38867 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38868 @end table
38869
38870 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38871 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38872 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38873 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38874 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38875 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38876 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38877 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38878 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38879 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38880 all the features it supports.
38881
38882 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38883 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38884
38885 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38886 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38887 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38888 form response.
38889
38890 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38891 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38892 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38893 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38894
38895 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38896 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38897 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38898 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38899 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38900
38901 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38902
38903 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38904 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38905 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38906 @item Feature Name
38907 @tab Value Required
38908 @tab Default
38909 @tab Probe Allowed
38910
38911 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38912 @tab Yes
38913 @tab @samp{-}
38914 @tab No
38915
38916 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38917 @tab No
38918 @tab @samp{-}
38919 @tab Yes
38920
38921 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38922 @tab No
38923 @tab @samp{-}
38924 @tab Yes
38925
38926 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38927 @tab No
38928 @tab @samp{-}
38929 @tab Yes
38930
38931 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38932 @tab No
38933 @tab @samp{-}
38934 @tab Yes
38935
38936 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38937 @tab No
38938 @tab @samp{-}
38939 @tab Yes
38940
38941 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38942 @tab No
38943 @tab @samp{-}
38944 @tab Yes
38945
38946 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38947 @tab No
38948 @tab @samp{-}
38949 @tab Yes
38950
38951 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38952 @tab No
38953 @tab @samp{-}
38954 @tab No
38955
38956 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38957 @tab No
38958 @tab @samp{-}
38959 @tab Yes
38960
38961 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38962 @tab No
38963 @tab @samp{-}
38964 @tab Yes
38965
38966 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38967 @tab No
38968 @tab @samp{-}
38969 @tab Yes
38970
38971 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38972 @tab No
38973 @tab @samp{-}
38974 @tab Yes
38975
38976 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38977 @tab No
38978 @tab @samp{-}
38979 @tab Yes
38980
38981 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38982 @tab No
38983 @tab @samp{-}
38984 @tab Yes
38985
38986 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38987 @tab No
38988 @tab @samp{-}
38989 @tab Yes
38990
38991 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38992 @tab No
38993 @tab @samp{-}
38994 @tab Yes
38995
38996 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38997 @tab No
38998 @tab @samp{-}
38999 @tab Yes
39000
39001 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39002 @tab No
39003 @tab @samp{-}
39004 @tab Yes
39005
39006 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
39007 @tab Yes
39008 @tab @samp{-}
39009 @tab Yes
39010
39011 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
39012 @tab Yes
39013 @tab @samp{-}
39014 @tab Yes
39015
39016 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
39017 @tab Yes
39018 @tab @samp{-}
39019 @tab Yes
39020
39021 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
39022 @tab Yes
39023 @tab @samp{-}
39024 @tab Yes
39025
39026 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
39027 @tab Yes
39028 @tab @samp{-}
39029 @tab Yes
39030
39031 @item @samp{QNonStop}
39032 @tab No
39033 @tab @samp{-}
39034 @tab Yes
39035
39036 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
39037 @tab No
39038 @tab @samp{-}
39039 @tab Yes
39040
39041 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
39042 @tab No
39043 @tab @samp{-}
39044 @tab Yes
39045
39046 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
39047 @tab No
39048 @tab @samp{-}
39049 @tab Yes
39050
39051 @item @samp{multiprocess}
39052 @tab No
39053 @tab @samp{-}
39054 @tab No
39055
39056 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
39057 @tab No
39058 @tab @samp{-}
39059 @tab No
39060
39061 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
39062 @tab No
39063 @tab @samp{-}
39064 @tab No
39065
39066 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
39067 @tab No
39068 @tab @samp{-}
39069 @tab No
39070
39071 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
39072 @tab No
39073 @tab @samp{-}
39074 @tab No
39075
39076 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
39077 @tab No
39078 @tab @samp{-}
39079 @tab No
39080
39081 @item @samp{QAgent}
39082 @tab No
39083 @tab @samp{-}
39084 @tab No
39085
39086 @item @samp{QAllow}
39087 @tab No
39088 @tab @samp{-}
39089 @tab No
39090
39091 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
39092 @tab No
39093 @tab @samp{-}
39094 @tab No
39095
39096 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
39097 @tab No
39098 @tab @samp{-}
39099 @tab No
39100
39101 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
39102 @tab No
39103 @tab @samp{-}
39104 @tab No
39105
39106 @item @samp{tracenz}
39107 @tab No
39108 @tab @samp{-}
39109 @tab No
39110
39111 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
39112 @tab No
39113 @tab @samp{-}
39114 @tab No
39115
39116 @item @samp{swbreak}
39117 @tab No
39118 @tab @samp{-}
39119 @tab No
39120
39121 @item @samp{hwbreak}
39122 @tab No
39123 @tab @samp{-}
39124 @tab No
39125
39126 @item @samp{fork-events}
39127 @tab No
39128 @tab @samp{-}
39129 @tab No
39130
39131 @item @samp{vfork-events}
39132 @tab No
39133 @tab @samp{-}
39134 @tab No
39135
39136 @item @samp{exec-events}
39137 @tab No
39138 @tab @samp{-}
39139 @tab No
39140
39141 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
39142 @tab No
39143 @tab @samp{-}
39144 @tab No
39145
39146 @item @samp{no-resumed}
39147 @tab No
39148 @tab @samp{-}
39149 @tab No
39150
39151 @end multitable
39152
39153 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
39154
39155 @table @samp
39156 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
39157 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
39158 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
39159 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
39160 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
39161 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
39162 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
39163 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
39164 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
39165 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
39166
39167 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39168 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39169 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39170
39171 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39172 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39173 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39174
39175 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
39176 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39177 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
39178
39179 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
39180 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
39181 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
39182
39183 @item qXfer:features:read
39184 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39185 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39186
39187 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39188 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39189 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39190
39191 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39192 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39193 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39194
39195 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39196 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39197 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39198 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39199
39200 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39201 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39202 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39203
39204 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39205 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39206 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39207
39208 @item qXfer:spu:read
39209 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39210 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39211
39212 @item qXfer:spu:write
39213 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39214 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39215
39216 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39217 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39218 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39219
39220 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39221 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39222 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39223
39224 @item qXfer:threads:read
39225 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39226 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39227
39228 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39229 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39230 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39231
39232 @item qXfer:uib:read
39233 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39234 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39235
39236 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39237 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39238 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39239
39240 @item QNonStop
39241 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39242 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39243
39244 @item QCatchSyscalls
39245 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39246 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39247
39248 @item QPassSignals
39249 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39250 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39251
39252 @item QStartNoAckMode
39253 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39254 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39255
39256 @item multiprocess
39257 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39258 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39259 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39260 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39261 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39262 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39263 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39264 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39265 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39266 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39267 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39268
39269 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39270 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39271 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39272
39273 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39274 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39275 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39276 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39277
39278 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39279 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39280 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39281
39282 @item ReverseContinue
39283 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39284 (@pxref{bc}).
39285
39286 @item ReverseStep
39287 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39288 (@pxref{bs}).
39289
39290 @item TracepointSource
39291 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39292 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39293
39294 @item QAgent
39295 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39296
39297 @item QAllow
39298 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39299
39300 @item QDisableRandomization
39301 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39302
39303 @item StaticTracepoint
39304 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39305 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39306
39307 @item InstallInTrace
39308 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39309 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39310
39311 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39312 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39313 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39314 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39315
39316 @item QTBuffer:size
39317 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39318 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39319
39320 @item tracenz
39321 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39322 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39323 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39324
39325 @item BreakpointCommands
39326 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39327 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39328 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39329
39330 @item Qbtrace:off
39331 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39332
39333 @item Qbtrace:bts
39334 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39335
39336 @item Qbtrace:pt
39337 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39338
39339 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39340 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39341
39342 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39343 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39344
39345 @item swbreak
39346 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39347 breakpoints.
39348
39349 @item hwbreak
39350 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39351 breakpoints.
39352
39353 @item fork-events
39354 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39355
39356 @item vfork-events
39357 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39358 and vforkdone events.
39359
39360 @item exec-events
39361 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39362
39363 @item vContSupported
39364 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39365 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39366
39367 @item QThreadEvents
39368 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39369
39370 @item no-resumed
39371 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39372
39373 @end table
39374
39375 @item qSymbol::
39376 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39377 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39378 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39379 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39380
39381 Reply:
39382 @table @samp
39383 @item OK
39384 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39385 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39386 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39387 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39388 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39389 below.
39390 @end table
39391
39392 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39393 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39394
39395 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39396 target has previously requested.
39397
39398 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39399 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39400 will be empty.
39401
39402 Reply:
39403 @table @samp
39404 @item OK
39405 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39406 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39407 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39408 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39409 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39410 @end table
39411
39412 @item qTBuffer
39413 @itemx QTBuffer
39414 @itemx QTDisconnected
39415 @itemx QTDP
39416 @itemx QTDPsrc
39417 @itemx QTDV
39418 @itemx qTfP
39419 @itemx qTfV
39420 @itemx QTFrame
39421 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39422
39423 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39424
39425 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39426 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39427 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39428 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39429 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39430 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39431 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39432 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39433 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39434 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39435 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39436
39437 Reply:
39438 @table @samp
39439 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39440 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39441 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39442 the thread's attributes.
39443 @end table
39444
39445 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39446 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39447 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39448 packets.)
39449
39450 @item QTNotes
39451 @itemx qTP
39452 @itemx QTSave
39453 @itemx qTsP
39454 @itemx qTsV
39455 @itemx QTStart
39456 @itemx QTStop
39457 @itemx QTEnable
39458 @itemx QTDisable
39459 @itemx QTinit
39460 @itemx QTro
39461 @itemx qTStatus
39462 @itemx qTV
39463 @itemx qTfSTM
39464 @itemx qTsSTM
39465 @itemx qTSTMat
39466 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39467
39468 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39469 @cindex read special object, remote request
39470 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39471 @anchor{qXfer read}
39472 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39473 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39474 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39475 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39476 additional details about what data to access.
39477
39478 Reply:
39479 @table @samp
39480 @item m @var{data}
39481 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39482 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39483 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39484 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39485 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39486 request.
39487
39488 @item l @var{data}
39489 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39490 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39491 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39492
39493 @item l
39494 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39495 There is no more data to be read.
39496
39497 @item E00
39498 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39499
39500 @item E @var{nn}
39501 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39502 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39503
39504 @item @w{}
39505 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39506 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39507 @end table
39508
39509 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39510 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39511 formats, listed above.
39512
39513 @table @samp
39514 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39515 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39516 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39517 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39518
39519 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39520 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39521
39522 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39523 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39524
39525 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39526 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39527 packet may have one of the following values:
39528
39529 @table @code
39530 @item all
39531 Returns all available branch trace.
39532
39533 @item new
39534 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39535 the last read request.
39536
39537 @item delta
39538 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39539 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39540 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39541 used to stitch traces together.
39542
39543 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39544 @end table
39545
39546 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39547 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39548
39549 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39550 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39551
39552 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39553 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39554
39555 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39556 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39557
39558 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39559 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39560 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39561 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39562 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39563 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39564 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39565
39566 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39567 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39568
39569 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39570 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39571 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39572 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39573 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39574
39575 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39576 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39577
39578 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39579 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39580 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39581 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39582 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39583
39584 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39585 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39586 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39587
39588 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39589 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39590
39591 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39592 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39593 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39594 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39595 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39596 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39597 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39598 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39599
39600 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39601 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39602
39603 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39604 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39605
39606 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39607 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39608 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39609 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39610
39611 @table @code
39612 @item start=@var{address}
39613 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39614 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39615 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39616 chosen as the starting point.
39617
39618 @item prev=@var{address}
39619 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39620 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39621 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39622 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39623 exists prior to the starting point.
39624
39625 @end table
39626
39627 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39628 ignored.
39629
39630 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39631 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39632 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39633 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39634 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39635
39636 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39637 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39638
39639 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39640 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39641
39642 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39643 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39644 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39645 Action Lists}.
39646
39647 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39648 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39649 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39650
39651 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39652 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39653 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39654 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39655 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39656
39657 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39658 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39659 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39660
39661 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39662 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39663 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39664 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39665 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39666 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39667 in that context to be accessed.
39668
39669 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39670 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39671 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39672
39673 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39674 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39675 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39676 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39677 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39678
39679 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39680 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39681
39682 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39683 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39684
39685 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39686 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39687 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39688
39689 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39690 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39691
39692 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39693 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39694
39695 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39696 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39697
39698 This packet is not probed by default.
39699
39700 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39701 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39702 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39703 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39704 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39705
39706 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39707 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39708
39709 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39710 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39711 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39712 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39713
39714 @end table
39715
39716 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39717 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39718 @anchor{qXfer write}
39719 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39720 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39721 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39722 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39723 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39724 to access.
39725
39726 Reply:
39727 @table @samp
39728 @item @var{nn}
39729 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39730 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39731
39732 @item E00
39733 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39734
39735 @item E @var{nn}
39736 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39737 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39738
39739 @item @w{}
39740 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39741 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39742 @end table
39743
39744 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39745 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39746 formats, listed above.
39747
39748 @table @samp
39749 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39750 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39751 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39752 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39753 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39754
39755 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39756 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39757 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39758
39759 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39760 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39761 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39762 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39763 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39764 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39765 in that context to be accessed.
39766
39767 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39768 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39769 @end table
39770
39771 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39772 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39773 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39774 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39775 must respond with an empty packet.
39776
39777 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39778 @cindex query attached, remote request
39779 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39780 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39781 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39782 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39783 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39784 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39785 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39786
39787 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39788 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39789 the @code{quit} command.
39790
39791 Reply:
39792 @table @samp
39793 @item 1
39794 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39795 @item 0
39796 The remote server created a new process.
39797 @item E @var{NN}
39798 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39799 @end table
39800
39801 @item Qbtrace:bts
39802 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39803
39804 Reply:
39805 @table @samp
39806 @item OK
39807 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39808 @item E.errtext
39809 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39810 @end table
39811
39812 @item Qbtrace:pt
39813 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39814
39815 Reply:
39816 @table @samp
39817 @item OK
39818 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39819 @item E.errtext
39820 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39821 @end table
39822
39823 @item Qbtrace:off
39824 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39825
39826 Reply:
39827 @table @samp
39828 @item OK
39829 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39830 @item E.errtext
39831 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39832 @end table
39833
39834 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39835 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39836 btrace recording method in bts format.
39837
39838 Reply:
39839 @table @samp
39840 @item OK
39841 The ring buffer size has been set.
39842 @item E.errtext
39843 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39844 @end table
39845
39846 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39847 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39848 btrace recording method in pt format.
39849
39850 Reply:
39851 @table @samp
39852 @item OK
39853 The ring buffer size has been set.
39854 @item E.errtext
39855 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39856 @end table
39857
39858 @end table
39859
39860 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39861 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39862
39863 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39864 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39865 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39866
39867 @menu
39868 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39869 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39870 @end menu
39871
39872 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39873 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39874
39875 @menu
39876 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39877 @end menu
39878
39879 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39880 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39881 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39882
39883 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39884
39885 @table @r
39886
39887 @item 2
39888 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39889
39890 @item 3
39891 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39892
39893 @item 4
39894 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39895
39896 @end table
39897
39898 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39899 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39900
39901 @menu
39902 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39903 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39904 @end menu
39905
39906 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39907 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39908 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39909
39910 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39911 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39912 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39913 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39914 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39915 most-significant -- least-significant.
39916
39917 @table @r
39918
39919 @item MIPS32
39920 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39921 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39922 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39923
39924 @item MIPS64
39925 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39926 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39927 as @code{MIPS32}.
39928
39929 @end table
39930
39931 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39932 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39933 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39934
39935 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39936
39937 @table @r
39938
39939 @item 2
39940 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39941
39942 @item 3
39943 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39944
39945 @item 4
39946 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39947
39948 @item 5
39949 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39950
39951 @end table
39952
39953 @node Tracepoint Packets
39954 @section Tracepoint Packets
39955 @cindex tracepoint packets
39956 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39957
39958 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39959 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39960
39961 @table @samp
39962
39963 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39964 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39965 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39966 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39967 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39968 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39969 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39970 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39971 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39972 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39973 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39974 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39975 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39976 actions.
39977
39978 Replies:
39979 @table @samp
39980 @item OK
39981 The packet was understood and carried out.
39982 @item qRelocInsn
39983 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39984 @item @w{}
39985 The packet was not recognized.
39986 @end table
39987
39988 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39989 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39990 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39991 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39992 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39993 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39994 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39995
39996 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39997 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39998 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39999 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
40000 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
40001 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
40002 tracepoint actions.
40003
40004 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
40005 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
40006 following forms:
40007
40008 @table @samp
40009
40010 @item R @var{mask}
40011 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
40012 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
40013 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
40014 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
40015 not fit in a 32-bit word.
40016
40017 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
40018 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
40019 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
40020 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
40021 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
40022 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
40023 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
40024
40025 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
40026 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
40027 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
40028 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
40029 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
40030 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
40031 packet).
40032
40033 @end table
40034
40035 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
40036 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
40037 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
40038 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
40039 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
40040 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
40041 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
40042 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
40043
40044 Replies:
40045 @table @samp
40046 @item OK
40047 The packet was understood and carried out.
40048 @item qRelocInsn
40049 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40050 @item @w{}
40051 The packet was not recognized.
40052 @end table
40053
40054 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
40055 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
40056 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
40057 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
40058 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
40059 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
40060 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
40061 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
40062
40063 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
40064 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
40065 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
40066 fit in a single packet.
40067 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
40068 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
40069
40070 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
40071 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
40072 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
40073 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
40074
40075 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
40076 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
40077 query packets.
40078
40079 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
40080 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
40081 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
40082 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
40083 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
40084 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
40085 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
40086 be found.
40087
40088 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
40089 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
40090 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
40091 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
40092 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
40093 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
40094 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
40095 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
40096 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
40097 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
40098 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
40099 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
40100 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
40101 variable.
40102
40103 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
40104 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
40105 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
40106 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
40107 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
40108
40109 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
40110 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
40111 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
40112 one of the following forms:
40113
40114 @table @samp
40115 @item F @var{f}
40116 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
40117 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
40118 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
40119
40120 @item T @var{t}
40121 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
40122 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
40123
40124 @end table
40125
40126 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
40127 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40128 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
40129 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
40130
40131 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
40132 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40133 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
40134 is a hexadecimal number.
40135
40136 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
40137 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40138 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
40139 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
40140 numbers.
40141
40142 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
40143 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
40144 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
40145
40146 @item qTMinFTPILen
40147 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
40148 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
40149 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
40150 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
40151 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
40152 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
40153 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
40154 arrange for that.
40155
40156 Replies:
40157
40158 @table @samp
40159 @item 0
40160 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
40161 @item @var{length}
40162 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
40163 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
40164 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
40165 regardless of size.
40166 @item E
40167 An error has occurred.
40168 @item @w{}
40169 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40170 @end table
40171
40172 @item QTStart
40173 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40174 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40175 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40176 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40177 instruction reply packet}).
40178
40179 @item QTStop
40180 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40181 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40182
40183 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40184 @anchor{QTEnable}
40185 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40186 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40187 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40188 of data from it will resume.
40189
40190 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40191 @anchor{QTDisable}
40192 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40193 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40194 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40195 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40196
40197 @item QTinit
40198 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40199 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40200
40201 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40202 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40203 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40204 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40205 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40206
40207 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40208 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40209 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40210 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40211
40212 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40213 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40214 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40215 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40216 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40217 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40218
40219 @item qTStatus
40220 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40221 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40222
40223 The reply has the form:
40224
40225 @table @samp
40226
40227 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40228 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40229 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40230 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40231
40232 @end table
40233
40234 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40235 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40236
40237 @table @samp
40238
40239 @item tnotrun:0
40240 No trace has been run yet.
40241
40242 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40243 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40244 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40245 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40246 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40247
40248 @item tfull:0
40249 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40250
40251 @item tdisconnected:0
40252 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40253
40254 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40255 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40256
40257 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40258 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40259 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40260 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40261 is hex encoded.
40262
40263 @item tunknown:0
40264 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40265
40266 @end table
40267
40268 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40269 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40270 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40271 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40272 trace.
40273
40274 @table @samp
40275
40276 @item tframes:@var{n}
40277 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40278
40279 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40280 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40281 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40282
40283 @item tsize:@var{n}
40284 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40285
40286 @item tfree:@var{n}
40287 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40288
40289 @item circular:@var{n}
40290 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40291 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40292 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40293 and may fill up.
40294
40295 @item disconn:@var{n}
40296 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40297 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40298 that the trace run will stop.
40299
40300 @end table
40301
40302 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40303 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40304 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40305 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40306 address @var{addr}.
40307
40308 Replies:
40309 @table @samp
40310 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40311 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40312 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40313 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40314 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40315
40316 @end table
40317
40318 @item qTV:@var{var}
40319 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40320 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40321 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40322
40323 Replies:
40324 @table @samp
40325 @item V@var{value}
40326 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40327 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40328 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40329 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40330 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40331 program is running.
40332
40333 @item U
40334 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40335 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40336 was not collected.
40337 @end table
40338
40339 @item qTfP
40340 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40341 @itemx qTsP
40342 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40343 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40344 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40345 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40346 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40347 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40348
40349 @item qTfV
40350 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40351 @itemx qTsV
40352 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40353 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40354 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40355 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40356 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40357 trace state variables.
40358
40359 @item qTfSTM
40360 @itemx qTsSTM
40361 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40362 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40363 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40364 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40365 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40366 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40367 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40368 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40369
40370 Reply:
40371 @table @samp
40372 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40373 A single marker
40374 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40375 a comma-separated list of markers
40376 @item l
40377 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40378 @item E @var{nn}
40379 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40380 @item @w{}
40381 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40382 stub.
40383 @end table
40384
40385 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40386 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40387
40388 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40389 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40390 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40391 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40392 @dfn{last}).
40393
40394 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40395 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40396 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40397 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40398 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40399 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40400 tracepoint markers.
40401
40402 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40403 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40404 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40405 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40406 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40407 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40408
40409 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40410 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40411 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40412 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40413 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40414 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40415 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40416 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40417 available.
40418
40419 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40420 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40421 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40422
40423 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40424 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40425 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40426 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40427 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40428 use whatever size it prefers.
40429
40430 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40431 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40432 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40433 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40434 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40435
40436 @end table
40437
40438 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40439 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40440 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40441 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40442 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40443 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40444 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40445 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40446 it had executed in the original location.
40447
40448 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40449 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40450 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40451 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40452 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40453 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40454 format of the request is:
40455
40456 @table @samp
40457 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40458
40459 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40460 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40461 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40462 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40463 memory starting at @var{to}.
40464 @end table
40465
40466 Replies:
40467 @table @samp
40468 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40469 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40470 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40471 @item E @var{NN}
40472 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40473 relocating the instruction.
40474 @end table
40475
40476 @node Host I/O Packets
40477 @section Host I/O Packets
40478 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40479 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40480
40481 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40482 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40483 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40484 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40485 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40486 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40487 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40488 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40489 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40490 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40491
40492 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40493 its arguments. They have this format:
40494
40495 @table @samp
40496
40497 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40498 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40499 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40500 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40501 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40502 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40503 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40504 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40505 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40506
40507 @end table
40508
40509 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40510
40511 @table @samp
40512
40513 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40514 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40515 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40516 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40517 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40518 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40519 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40520 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40521 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40522 @var{attachment}.
40523
40524 @item @w{}
40525 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40526
40527 @end table
40528
40529 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40530
40531 @table @samp
40532 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40533 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40534 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40535 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40536 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40537 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40538 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40539
40540 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40541 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40542 -1 if an error occurs.
40543
40544 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40545 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40546 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40547 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40548 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40549 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40550 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40551 @var{count} was zero.
40552
40553 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40554 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40555 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40556 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40557 some characters were escaped.
40558
40559 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40560 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40561 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40562 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40563 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40564 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40565 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40566 error occurred.
40567
40568 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40569 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40570 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40571 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40572 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40573 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40574
40575 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40576 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40577 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40578
40579 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40580 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40581 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40582
40583 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40584 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40585 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40586 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40587 some characters were escaped.
40588
40589 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40590 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40591 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40592 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40593 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40594 inferior(s).
40595
40596 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40597 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40598 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40599 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40600 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40601 operation.
40602
40603 @end table
40604
40605 @node Interrupts
40606 @section Interrupts
40607 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40608 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40609
40610 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40611 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40612 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40613 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40614
40615 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40616 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40617 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40618 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40619 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40620
40621 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40622 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40623 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40624 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40625 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40626 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40627 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40628 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40629
40630 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40631 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40632 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40633
40634 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40635 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40636 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40637 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40638 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40639 @code{0x03}.
40640
40641 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40642 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40643 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40644 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40645 currently-executing threads and processes.
40646 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40647 running program, it should send one of the stop
40648 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40649 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40650 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40651 Interrupts received while the
40652 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40653 it is resumed next time.
40654
40655 @node Notification Packets
40656 @section Notification Packets
40657 @cindex notification packets
40658 @cindex packets, notification
40659
40660 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40661 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40662 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40663 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40664 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40665 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40666 is not a problem.
40667
40668 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40669 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40670 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40671 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40672 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40673 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40674 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40675
40676 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40677 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40678
40679 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40680 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40681 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40682 not they understand it.
40683
40684 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40685 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40686 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40687 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40688 recipients.
40689
40690 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40691 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40692 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40693 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40694 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40695
40696 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40697 @table @samp
40698 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40699 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40700 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40701 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40702 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40703 @item @var{ack}
40704 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40705 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40706 @end table
40707
40708 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40709 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40710
40711 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40712 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40713 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40714 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40715 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40716 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40717 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40718 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40719 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40720 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40721
40722 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40723 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40724 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40725 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40726 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40727 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40728
40729 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40730 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40731 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40732 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40733 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40734
40735 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40736 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40737 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40738 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40739 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40740 normally.
40741
40742 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40743 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40744 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40745 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40746 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40747 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40748 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40749 the process shall be repeated.
40750
40751 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40752 following example:
40753 @smallexample
40754 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40755 @code{...}
40756 -> @code{vStopped}
40757 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40758 -> @code{vStopped}
40759 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40760 -> @code{vStopped}
40761 <- @code{OK}
40762 @end smallexample
40763
40764 The following notifications are defined:
40765 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40766
40767 @item Notification
40768 @tab Ack
40769 @tab Event
40770 @tab Description
40771
40772 @item Stop
40773 @tab vStopped
40774 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40775 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40776 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40777 @value{GDBN}.
40778 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40779
40780 @end multitable
40781
40782 @node Remote Non-Stop
40783 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40784
40785 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40786 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40787 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40788 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40789
40790 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40791 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40792 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40793 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40794 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40795 probe the target state after a mode change.
40796
40797 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40798 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40799 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40800 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40801 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40802 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40803 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40804 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40805 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40806 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40807 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40808
40809 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40810 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40811 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40812 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40813 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40814 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40815 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40816 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40817 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40818 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40819 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40820 @samp{OK}.
40821
40822 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40823 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40824 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40825 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40826 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40827 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40828 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40829 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40830 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40831 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40832 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40833 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40834 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40835
40836 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40837 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40838
40839 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40840 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40841 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40842 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40843 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40844 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40845 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40846
40847 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40848 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40849 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40850 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40851 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40852
40853 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40854 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40855 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40856 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40857
40858 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40859 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40860 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40861 @pxref{qSupported}.
40862 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40863 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40864 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40865 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40866 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40867 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40868 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40869
40870 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40871 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40872 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40873 connection.
40874 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40875 new connection is established,
40876 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40877 for the current connection, once disabled.
40878
40879 @node Examples
40880 @section Examples
40881
40882 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40883 does not get any direct output:
40884
40885 @smallexample
40886 -> @code{R00}
40887 <- @code{+}
40888 @emph{target restarts}
40889 -> @code{?}
40890 <- @code{+}
40891 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40892 -> @code{+}
40893 @end smallexample
40894
40895 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40896
40897 @smallexample
40898 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40899 <- @code{+}
40900 -> @code{s}
40901 <- @code{+}
40902 @emph{time passes}
40903 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40904 -> @code{+}
40905 -> @code{g}
40906 <- @code{+}
40907 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40908 -> @code{+}
40909 @end smallexample
40910
40911 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40912 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40913 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40914
40915 @menu
40916 * File-I/O Overview::
40917 * Protocol Basics::
40918 * The F Request Packet::
40919 * The F Reply Packet::
40920 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40921 * Console I/O::
40922 * List of Supported Calls::
40923 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40924 * Constants::
40925 * File-I/O Examples::
40926 @end menu
40927
40928 @node File-I/O Overview
40929 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40930 @cindex file-i/o overview
40931
40932 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40933 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40934 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40935 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40936 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40937 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40938
40939 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40940 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40941 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40942 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40943 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40944
40945 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40946 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40947 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40948 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40949 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40950 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40951 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40952
40953 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40954 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40955 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40956 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40957 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40958
40959 @smallexample
40960 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40961 <- target requests 'system call X'
40962 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40963 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40964 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40965 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40966 @end smallexample
40967
40968 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40969 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40970 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40971 system are not supported by this protocol.
40972
40973 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40974
40975 @node Protocol Basics
40976 @subsection Protocol Basics
40977 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40978
40979 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40980 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40981 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40982 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40983 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40984 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40985 to call the appropriate host system call:
40986
40987 @itemize @bullet
40988 @item
40989 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40990
40991 @item
40992 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40993 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40994 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40995 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40996
40997 @end itemize
40998
40999 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
41000
41001 @itemize @bullet
41002 @item
41003 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
41004 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
41005 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
41006 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
41007 packet.
41008
41009 @item
41010 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
41011 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
41012
41013 @item
41014 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
41015
41016 @item
41017 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
41018
41019 @item
41020 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
41021 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
41022 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
41023 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
41024 packet.
41025
41026 @end itemize
41027
41028 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
41029 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
41030
41031 @itemize @bullet
41032 @item
41033 Return value.
41034
41035 @item
41036 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
41037
41038 @item
41039 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
41040
41041 @end itemize
41042
41043 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
41044 the latest continue or step action.
41045
41046 @node The F Request Packet
41047 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
41048 @cindex file-i/o request packet
41049 @cindex @code{F} request packet
41050
41051 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
41052
41053 @table @samp
41054 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
41055
41056 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
41057 This is just the name of the function.
41058
41059 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
41060 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
41061 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
41062 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
41063 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
41064 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
41065 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
41066
41067 @end table
41068
41069
41070
41071 @node The F Reply Packet
41072 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
41073 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
41074 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
41075
41076 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
41077
41078 @table @samp
41079
41080 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
41081
41082 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
41083
41084 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
41085 representation.
41086 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
41087
41088 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
41089 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
41090 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
41091
41092 @smallexample
41093 F0,0,C
41094 @end smallexample
41095
41096 @noindent
41097 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
41098
41099 @smallexample
41100 F-1,4,C
41101 @end smallexample
41102
41103 @noindent
41104 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
41105
41106 @end table
41107
41108
41109 @node The Ctrl-C Message
41110 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
41111 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
41112
41113 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
41114 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
41115 the target should behave as if it had
41116 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
41117 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
41118 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
41119 packet.
41120
41121 It's important for the target to know in which
41122 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
41123
41124 @itemize @bullet
41125 @item
41126 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
41127
41128 @item
41129 The system call on the host has been finished.
41130
41131 @end itemize
41132
41133 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
41134 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
41135 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
41136 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
41137 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
41138 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
41139
41140 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
41141 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
41142 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
41143 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
41144 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
41145 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
41146 or the full action has been completed.
41147
41148 @node Console I/O
41149 @subsection Console I/O
41150 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
41151
41152 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
41153 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
41154 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
41155 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
41156 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
41157 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
41158 conditions is met:
41159
41160 @itemize @bullet
41161 @item
41162 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
41163 @code{read}
41164 system call is treated as finished.
41165
41166 @item
41167 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41168 newline.
41169
41170 @item
41171 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41172 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41173
41174 @end itemize
41175
41176 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41177 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41178 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41179 is stopped at the user's request.
41180
41181
41182 @node List of Supported Calls
41183 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41184 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41185
41186 @menu
41187 * open::
41188 * close::
41189 * read::
41190 * write::
41191 * lseek::
41192 * rename::
41193 * unlink::
41194 * stat/fstat::
41195 * gettimeofday::
41196 * isatty::
41197 * system::
41198 @end menu
41199
41200 @node open
41201 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41202 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41203
41204 @table @asis
41205 @item Synopsis:
41206 @smallexample
41207 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41208 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41209 @end smallexample
41210
41211 @item Request:
41212 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41213
41214 @noindent
41215 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41216
41217 @table @code
41218 @item O_CREAT
41219 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41220 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41221 are concerned.
41222
41223 @item O_EXCL
41224 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41225 an error and open() fails.
41226
41227 @item O_TRUNC
41228 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41229 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41230 truncated to zero length.
41231
41232 @item O_APPEND
41233 The file is opened in append mode.
41234
41235 @item O_RDONLY
41236 The file is opened for reading only.
41237
41238 @item O_WRONLY
41239 The file is opened for writing only.
41240
41241 @item O_RDWR
41242 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41243 @end table
41244
41245 @noindent
41246 Other bits are silently ignored.
41247
41248
41249 @noindent
41250 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41251
41252 @table @code
41253 @item S_IRUSR
41254 User has read permission.
41255
41256 @item S_IWUSR
41257 User has write permission.
41258
41259 @item S_IRGRP
41260 Group has read permission.
41261
41262 @item S_IWGRP
41263 Group has write permission.
41264
41265 @item S_IROTH
41266 Others have read permission.
41267
41268 @item S_IWOTH
41269 Others have write permission.
41270 @end table
41271
41272 @noindent
41273 Other bits are silently ignored.
41274
41275
41276 @item Return value:
41277 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41278 occurred.
41279
41280 @item Errors:
41281
41282 @table @code
41283 @item EEXIST
41284 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41285
41286 @item EISDIR
41287 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41288
41289 @item EACCES
41290 The requested access is not allowed.
41291
41292 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41293 @var{pathname} was too long.
41294
41295 @item ENOENT
41296 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41297
41298 @item ENODEV
41299 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41300
41301 @item EROFS
41302 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41303 write access was requested.
41304
41305 @item EFAULT
41306 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41307
41308 @item ENOSPC
41309 No space on device to create the file.
41310
41311 @item EMFILE
41312 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41313
41314 @item ENFILE
41315 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41316 has been reached.
41317
41318 @item EINTR
41319 The call was interrupted by the user.
41320 @end table
41321
41322 @end table
41323
41324 @node close
41325 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41326 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41327
41328 @table @asis
41329 @item Synopsis:
41330 @smallexample
41331 int close(int fd);
41332 @end smallexample
41333
41334 @item Request:
41335 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41336
41337 @item Return value:
41338 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41339
41340 @item Errors:
41341
41342 @table @code
41343 @item EBADF
41344 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41345
41346 @item EINTR
41347 The call was interrupted by the user.
41348 @end table
41349
41350 @end table
41351
41352 @node read
41353 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41354 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41355
41356 @table @asis
41357 @item Synopsis:
41358 @smallexample
41359 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41360 @end smallexample
41361
41362 @item Request:
41363 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41364
41365 @item Return value:
41366 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41367 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41368 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41369
41370 @item Errors:
41371
41372 @table @code
41373 @item EBADF
41374 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41375 reading.
41376
41377 @item EFAULT
41378 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41379
41380 @item EINTR
41381 The call was interrupted by the user.
41382 @end table
41383
41384 @end table
41385
41386 @node write
41387 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41388 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41389
41390 @table @asis
41391 @item Synopsis:
41392 @smallexample
41393 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41394 @end smallexample
41395
41396 @item Request:
41397 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41398
41399 @item Return value:
41400 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41401 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41402 is returned.
41403
41404 @item Errors:
41405
41406 @table @code
41407 @item EBADF
41408 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41409 writing.
41410
41411 @item EFAULT
41412 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41413
41414 @item EFBIG
41415 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41416 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41417
41418 @item ENOSPC
41419 No space on device to write the data.
41420
41421 @item EINTR
41422 The call was interrupted by the user.
41423 @end table
41424
41425 @end table
41426
41427 @node lseek
41428 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41429 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41430
41431 @table @asis
41432 @item Synopsis:
41433 @smallexample
41434 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41435 @end smallexample
41436
41437 @item Request:
41438 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41439
41440 @var{flag} is one of:
41441
41442 @table @code
41443 @item SEEK_SET
41444 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41445
41446 @item SEEK_CUR
41447 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41448 bytes.
41449
41450 @item SEEK_END
41451 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41452 bytes.
41453 @end table
41454
41455 @item Return value:
41456 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41457 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41458 value of -1 is returned.
41459
41460 @item Errors:
41461
41462 @table @code
41463 @item EBADF
41464 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41465
41466 @item ESPIPE
41467 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41468
41469 @item EINVAL
41470 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41471
41472 @item EINTR
41473 The call was interrupted by the user.
41474 @end table
41475
41476 @end table
41477
41478 @node rename
41479 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41480 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41481
41482 @table @asis
41483 @item Synopsis:
41484 @smallexample
41485 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41486 @end smallexample
41487
41488 @item Request:
41489 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41490
41491 @item Return value:
41492 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41493
41494 @item Errors:
41495
41496 @table @code
41497 @item EISDIR
41498 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41499 directory.
41500
41501 @item EEXIST
41502 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41503
41504 @item EBUSY
41505 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41506 process.
41507
41508 @item EINVAL
41509 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41510 of itself.
41511
41512 @item ENOTDIR
41513 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41514 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41515 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41516
41517 @item EFAULT
41518 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41519
41520 @item EACCES
41521 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41522
41523 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41524
41525 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41526
41527 @item ENOENT
41528 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41529
41530 @item EROFS
41531 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41532
41533 @item ENOSPC
41534 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41535 directory entry.
41536
41537 @item EINTR
41538 The call was interrupted by the user.
41539 @end table
41540
41541 @end table
41542
41543 @node unlink
41544 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41545 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41546
41547 @table @asis
41548 @item Synopsis:
41549 @smallexample
41550 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41551 @end smallexample
41552
41553 @item Request:
41554 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41555
41556 @item Return value:
41557 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41558
41559 @item Errors:
41560
41561 @table @code
41562 @item EACCES
41563 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41564
41565 @item EPERM
41566 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41567
41568 @item EBUSY
41569 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41570 being used by another process.
41571
41572 @item EFAULT
41573 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41574
41575 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41576 @var{pathname} was too long.
41577
41578 @item ENOENT
41579 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41580
41581 @item ENOTDIR
41582 A component of the path is not a directory.
41583
41584 @item EROFS
41585 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41586
41587 @item EINTR
41588 The call was interrupted by the user.
41589 @end table
41590
41591 @end table
41592
41593 @node stat/fstat
41594 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41595 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41596 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41597
41598 @table @asis
41599 @item Synopsis:
41600 @smallexample
41601 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41602 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41603 @end smallexample
41604
41605 @item Request:
41606 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41607 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41608
41609 @item Return value:
41610 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41611
41612 @item Errors:
41613
41614 @table @code
41615 @item EBADF
41616 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41617
41618 @item ENOENT
41619 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41620 path is an empty string.
41621
41622 @item ENOTDIR
41623 A component of the path is not a directory.
41624
41625 @item EFAULT
41626 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41627
41628 @item EACCES
41629 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41630
41631 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41632 @var{pathname} was too long.
41633
41634 @item EINTR
41635 The call was interrupted by the user.
41636 @end table
41637
41638 @end table
41639
41640 @node gettimeofday
41641 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41642 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41643
41644 @table @asis
41645 @item Synopsis:
41646 @smallexample
41647 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41648 @end smallexample
41649
41650 @item Request:
41651 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41652
41653 @item Return value:
41654 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41655
41656 @item Errors:
41657
41658 @table @code
41659 @item EINVAL
41660 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41661
41662 @item EFAULT
41663 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41664 @end table
41665
41666 @end table
41667
41668 @node isatty
41669 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41670 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41671
41672 @table @asis
41673 @item Synopsis:
41674 @smallexample
41675 int isatty(int fd);
41676 @end smallexample
41677
41678 @item Request:
41679 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41680
41681 @item Return value:
41682 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41683
41684 @item Errors:
41685
41686 @table @code
41687 @item EINTR
41688 The call was interrupted by the user.
41689 @end table
41690
41691 @end table
41692
41693 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41694 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41695 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41696 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41697 needed.
41698
41699
41700 @node system
41701 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41702 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41703
41704 @table @asis
41705 @item Synopsis:
41706 @smallexample
41707 int system(const char *command);
41708 @end smallexample
41709
41710 @item Request:
41711 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41712
41713 @item Return value:
41714 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41715 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41716 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41717 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41718 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41719 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41720 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41721
41722 @item Errors:
41723
41724 @table @code
41725 @item EINTR
41726 The call was interrupted by the user.
41727 @end table
41728
41729 @end table
41730
41731 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41732 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41733 the host is simplified before it's returned
41734 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41735 is discarded, and the return value consists
41736 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41737
41738 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41739 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41740 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41741
41742 @table @code
41743 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41744 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41745 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41746 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41747
41748 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41749 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41750 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41751 protocol.
41752 @end table
41753
41754 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41755 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41756 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41757
41758 @menu
41759 * Integral Datatypes::
41760 * Pointer Values::
41761 * Memory Transfer::
41762 * struct stat::
41763 * struct timeval::
41764 @end menu
41765
41766 @node Integral Datatypes
41767 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41768 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41769
41770 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41771 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41772 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41773
41774 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41775 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41776
41777 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41778
41779 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41780 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41781
41782 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41783
41784 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41785 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41786 byte order.
41787
41788 @node Pointer Values
41789 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41790 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41791
41792 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41793 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41794 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41795 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41796
41797 @smallexample
41798 @code{1aaf/12}
41799 @end smallexample
41800
41801 @noindent
41802 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41803 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41804 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41805 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41806
41807 @smallexample
41808 @code{123456/d}
41809 @end smallexample
41810
41811 @node Memory Transfer
41812 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41813 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41814
41815 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41816 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41817 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41818 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41819 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41820 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41821 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41822
41823
41824 @node struct stat
41825 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41826 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41827
41828 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41829 is defined as follows:
41830
41831 @smallexample
41832 struct stat @{
41833 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41834 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41835 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41836 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41837 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41838 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41839 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41840 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41841 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41842 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41843 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41844 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41845 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41846 @};
41847 @end smallexample
41848
41849 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41850 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41851 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41852
41853 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41854 range of values.
41855
41856 @table @code
41857
41858 @item st_dev
41859 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41860
41861 @item st_ino
41862 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41863
41864 @item st_mode
41865 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41866 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41867
41868 @item st_uid
41869 @itemx st_gid
41870 @itemx st_rdev
41871 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41872
41873 @item st_atime
41874 @itemx st_mtime
41875 @itemx st_ctime
41876 These values have a host and file system dependent
41877 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41878 support exact timing values.
41879 @end table
41880
41881 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41882 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41883 continuing.
41884
41885 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41886 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41887 get truncated on the target.
41888
41889 @node struct timeval
41890 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41891 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41892
41893 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41894 is defined as follows:
41895
41896 @smallexample
41897 struct timeval @{
41898 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41899 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41900 @};
41901 @end smallexample
41902
41903 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41904 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41905 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41906
41907 @node Constants
41908 @subsection Constants
41909 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41910
41911 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41912 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41913 values before and after the call as needed.
41914
41915 @menu
41916 * Open Flags::
41917 * mode_t Values::
41918 * Errno Values::
41919 * Lseek Flags::
41920 * Limits::
41921 @end menu
41922
41923 @node Open Flags
41924 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41925 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41926
41927 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41928
41929 @smallexample
41930 O_RDONLY 0x0
41931 O_WRONLY 0x1
41932 O_RDWR 0x2
41933 O_APPEND 0x8
41934 O_CREAT 0x200
41935 O_TRUNC 0x400
41936 O_EXCL 0x800
41937 @end smallexample
41938
41939 @node mode_t Values
41940 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41941 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41942
41943 All values are given in octal representation.
41944
41945 @smallexample
41946 S_IFREG 0100000
41947 S_IFDIR 040000
41948 S_IRUSR 0400
41949 S_IWUSR 0200
41950 S_IXUSR 0100
41951 S_IRGRP 040
41952 S_IWGRP 020
41953 S_IXGRP 010
41954 S_IROTH 04
41955 S_IWOTH 02
41956 S_IXOTH 01
41957 @end smallexample
41958
41959 @node Errno Values
41960 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41961 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41962
41963 All values are given in decimal representation.
41964
41965 @smallexample
41966 EPERM 1
41967 ENOENT 2
41968 EINTR 4
41969 EBADF 9
41970 EACCES 13
41971 EFAULT 14
41972 EBUSY 16
41973 EEXIST 17
41974 ENODEV 19
41975 ENOTDIR 20
41976 EISDIR 21
41977 EINVAL 22
41978 ENFILE 23
41979 EMFILE 24
41980 EFBIG 27
41981 ENOSPC 28
41982 ESPIPE 29
41983 EROFS 30
41984 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41985 EUNKNOWN 9999
41986 @end smallexample
41987
41988 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41989 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41990
41991 @node Lseek Flags
41992 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41993 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41994
41995 @smallexample
41996 SEEK_SET 0
41997 SEEK_CUR 1
41998 SEEK_END 2
41999 @end smallexample
42000
42001 @node Limits
42002 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
42003 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
42004
42005 All values are given in decimal representation.
42006
42007 @smallexample
42008 INT_MIN -2147483648
42009 INT_MAX 2147483647
42010 UINT_MAX 4294967295
42011 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
42012 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
42013 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
42014 @end smallexample
42015
42016 @node File-I/O Examples
42017 @subsection File-I/O Examples
42018 @cindex file-i/o examples
42019
42020 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42021 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
42022
42023 @smallexample
42024 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
42025 @emph{request memory read from target}
42026 -> @code{m1234,6}
42027 <- XXXXXX
42028 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
42029 -> @code{F6}
42030 @end smallexample
42031
42032 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42033 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
42034
42035 @smallexample
42036 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42037 @emph{request memory write to target}
42038 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42039 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
42040 -> @code{F6}
42041 @end smallexample
42042
42043 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
42044 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
42045
42046 @smallexample
42047 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42048 -> @code{F-1,9}
42049 @end smallexample
42050
42051 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
42052 host is called:
42053
42054 @smallexample
42055 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42056 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
42057 <- @code{T02}
42058 @end smallexample
42059
42060 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
42061 host is called:
42062
42063 @smallexample
42064 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42065 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42066 <- @code{T02}
42067 @end smallexample
42068
42069 @node Library List Format
42070 @section Library List Format
42071 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42072
42073 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
42074 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
42075 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
42076 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
42077 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
42078 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
42079 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
42080 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
42081 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
42082 are loaded.
42083
42084 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
42085 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
42086 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
42087 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
42088
42089 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
42090 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
42091 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
42092 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
42093 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
42094 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
42095
42096 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42097 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42098
42099 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
42100 offset, looks like this:
42101
42102 @smallexample
42103 <library-list>
42104 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
42105 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
42106 </library>
42107 </library-list>
42108 @end smallexample
42109
42110 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
42111 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
42112
42113 @smallexample
42114 <library-list>
42115 <library name="sharedlib.o">
42116 <section address="0x10000000"/>
42117 <section address="0x20000000"/>
42118 <section address="0x30000000"/>
42119 </library>
42120 </library-list>
42121 @end smallexample
42122
42123 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
42124
42125 @smallexample
42126 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
42127 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
42128 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42129 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
42130 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42131 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
42132 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42133 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
42134 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42135 @end smallexample
42136
42137 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
42138 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
42139 section for each library.
42140
42141 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42142 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42143 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42144
42145 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
42146 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
42147 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
42148 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
42149
42150 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
42151 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
42152 target, the following parameters are reported:
42153
42154 @itemize @minus
42155 @item
42156 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
42157 @code{struct link_map}.
42158 @item
42159 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
42160 (Thread Local Storage) access.
42161 @item
42162 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
42163 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
42164 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
42165 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
42166 @item
42167 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42168 @end itemize
42169
42170 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42171 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42172 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42173
42174 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42175 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42176
42177 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42178 looks like this:
42179
42180 @smallexample
42181 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42182 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42183 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42184 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42185 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42186 </library-list-svr>
42187 @end smallexample
42188
42189 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42190
42191 @smallexample
42192 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42193 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42194 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42195 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42196 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42197 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42198 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42199 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42200 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42201 @end smallexample
42202
42203 @node Memory Map Format
42204 @section Memory Map Format
42205 @cindex memory map format
42206
42207 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42208 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42209 memory map.
42210
42211 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42212 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42213 lists memory regions.
42214
42215 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42216 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42217
42218 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42219
42220 @smallexample
42221 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42222 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42223 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42224 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42225 <memory-map>
42226 region...
42227 </memory-map>
42228 @end smallexample
42229
42230 Each region can be either:
42231
42232 @itemize
42233
42234 @item
42235 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42236 bytes from there:
42237
42238 @smallexample
42239 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42240 @end smallexample
42241
42242
42243 @item
42244 A region of read-only memory:
42245
42246 @smallexample
42247 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42248 @end smallexample
42249
42250
42251 @item
42252 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42253 bytes in length:
42254
42255 @smallexample
42256 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42257 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42258 </memory>
42259 @end smallexample
42260
42261 @end itemize
42262
42263 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42264 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42265 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42266
42267 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42268
42269 @smallexample
42270 <!-- ................................................... -->
42271 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42272 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42273 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42274 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42275 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42276 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42277 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42278 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42279 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42280 and its type, or device. -->
42281 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42282 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42283 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42284 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42285 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42286 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42287 @end smallexample
42288
42289 @node Thread List Format
42290 @section Thread List Format
42291 @cindex thread list format
42292
42293 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42294 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42295 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42296 the following structure:
42297
42298 @smallexample
42299 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42300 <threads>
42301 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42302 ... description ...
42303 </thread>
42304 </threads>
42305 @end smallexample
42306
42307 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42308 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42309 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42310 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42311 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42312 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42313 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42314 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42315
42316
42317 @node Traceframe Info Format
42318 @section Traceframe Info Format
42319 @cindex traceframe info format
42320
42321 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42322 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42323 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42324 collected in a traceframe.
42325
42326 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42327 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42328
42329 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42330 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42331
42332 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42333
42334 @smallexample
42335 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42336 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42337 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42338 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42339 <traceframe-info>
42340 block...
42341 </traceframe-info>
42342 @end smallexample
42343
42344 Each traceframe block can be either:
42345
42346 @itemize
42347
42348 @item
42349 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42350 @var{length} bytes from there:
42351
42352 @smallexample
42353 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42354 @end smallexample
42355
42356 @item
42357 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42358 collected:
42359
42360 @smallexample
42361 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42362 @end smallexample
42363
42364 @end itemize
42365
42366 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42367
42368 @smallexample
42369 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42370 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42371
42372 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42373 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42374 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42375 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42376 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42377 @end smallexample
42378
42379 @node Branch Trace Format
42380 @section Branch Trace Format
42381 @cindex branch trace format
42382
42383 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42384 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42385 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42386 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42387
42388 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42389 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42390
42391 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42392 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42393
42394 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42395
42396 @smallexample
42397 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42398 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42399 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42400 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42401 <btrace>
42402 block...
42403 </btrace>
42404 @end smallexample
42405
42406 @itemize
42407
42408 @item
42409 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42410 and ending at @var{end}:
42411
42412 @smallexample
42413 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42414 @end smallexample
42415
42416 @end itemize
42417
42418 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42419
42420 @smallexample
42421 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42422 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42423
42424 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42425 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42426 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42427
42428 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42429
42430 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42431
42432 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42433 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42434 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42435 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42436 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42437
42438 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42439 @end smallexample
42440
42441 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42442 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42443 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42444
42445 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42446 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42447 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42448
42449 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42450 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42451
42452 @table @code
42453 @item bts
42454 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42455 @table @code
42456 @item size
42457 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42458 @end table
42459 @item pt
42460 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42461 PT}) format.
42462 @table @code
42463 @item size
42464 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42465 @end table
42466 @end table
42467
42468 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42469 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42470
42471 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42472
42473 @smallexample
42474 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42475 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42476
42477 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42478 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42479
42480 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42481 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42482 @end smallexample
42483
42484 @include agentexpr.texi
42485
42486 @node Target Descriptions
42487 @appendix Target Descriptions
42488 @cindex target descriptions
42489
42490 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42491 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42492 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42493 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42494 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42495 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42496 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42497
42498 @itemize @bullet
42499 @item
42500 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42501 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42502 @item
42503 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42504 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42505 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42506 @item
42507 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42508 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42509 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42510 @end itemize
42511
42512 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42513 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42514 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42515 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42516 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42517
42518 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42519 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42520
42521 @menu
42522 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42523 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42524 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42525 descriptions.
42526 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42527 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42528 @end menu
42529
42530 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42531 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42532
42533 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42534 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42535 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42536 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42537 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42538 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42539 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42540 Format}.
42541
42542 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42543 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42544 specify a file are:
42545
42546 @table @code
42547 @cindex set tdesc filename
42548 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42549 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42550
42551 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42552 @item unset tdesc filename
42553 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42554 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42555
42556 @cindex show tdesc filename
42557 @item show tdesc filename
42558 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42559 @end table
42560
42561
42562 @node Target Description Format
42563 @section Target Description Format
42564 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42565
42566 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42567 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42568 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42569 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42570 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42571 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42572 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42573
42574 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42575 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42576 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42577 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42578 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42579
42580 Here is a simple target description:
42581
42582 @smallexample
42583 <target version="1.0">
42584 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42585 </target>
42586 @end smallexample
42587
42588 @noindent
42589 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42590 the x86-64 architecture.
42591
42592 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42593 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42594 are explained further below.
42595
42596 @smallexample
42597 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42598 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42599 <target version="1.0">
42600 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42601 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42602 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42603 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42604 </target>
42605 @end smallexample
42606
42607 @noindent
42608 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42609 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42610 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42611 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42612 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42613 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42614 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42615 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42616 the version mismatch.
42617
42618 @subsection Inclusion
42619 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42620 @cindex XInclude
42621 @ifnotinfo
42622 @cindex <xi:include>
42623 @end ifnotinfo
42624
42625 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42626 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42627 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42628 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42629 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42630
42631 @smallexample
42632 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42633 @end smallexample
42634
42635 @noindent
42636 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42637 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42638 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42639 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42640 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42641 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42642 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42643 original description.
42644
42645 @subsection Architecture
42646 @cindex <architecture>
42647
42648 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42649
42650 @smallexample
42651 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42652 @end smallexample
42653
42654 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42655 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42656
42657 @subsection OS ABI
42658 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42659
42660 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42661 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42662
42663 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42664
42665 @smallexample
42666 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42667 @end smallexample
42668
42669 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42670 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42671
42672 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42673 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42674
42675 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42676 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42677
42678 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42679
42680 @smallexample
42681 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42682 @end smallexample
42683
42684 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42685 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42686
42687 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42688 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42689 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42690 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42691 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42692 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42693 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42694
42695 @smallexample
42696 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42697 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42698 @end smallexample
42699
42700 @subsection Features
42701 @cindex <feature>
42702
42703 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42704 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42705 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42706 has this form:
42707
42708 @smallexample
42709 <feature name="@var{name}">
42710 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42711 @var{reg}@dots{}
42712 </feature>
42713 @end smallexample
42714
42715 @noindent
42716 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42717 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42718 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42719 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42720
42721 @subsection Types
42722
42723 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42724 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42725 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42726 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42727 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42728 and enum types.
42729
42730 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42731 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42732 Types must be defined before they are used.
42733
42734 @cindex <vector>
42735 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42736 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42737 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42738 @var{count}:
42739
42740 @smallexample
42741 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42742 @end smallexample
42743
42744 @cindex <union>
42745 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42746 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42747 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42748 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42749
42750 @smallexample
42751 <union id="@var{id}">
42752 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42753 @dots{}
42754 </union>
42755 @end smallexample
42756
42757 @cindex <struct>
42758 @cindex <flags>
42759 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42760 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42761 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42762 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42763 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42764 specified.
42765
42766 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42767
42768 @smallexample
42769 <struct id="@var{id}">
42770 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42771 @dots{}
42772 </struct>
42773 @end smallexample
42774
42775 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42776 No implicit padding is added.
42777
42778 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42779
42780 @smallexample
42781 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42782 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42783 @dots{}
42784 </struct>
42785 @end smallexample
42786
42787 @smallexample
42788 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42789 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42790 @dots{}
42791 </flags>
42792 @end smallexample
42793
42794 The @var{name} value is required.
42795 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42796 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42797 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42798
42799 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42800 is optional.
42801 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42802 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42803
42804 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42805 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42806
42807 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42808
42809 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42810 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42811
42812 @itemize @bullet
42813 @item
42814 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42815 @item
42816 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42817 @end itemize
42818
42819 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42820 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42821
42822 @itemize @bullet
42823 @item
42824 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42825
42826 @smallexample
42827 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42828 $1 = 42
42829 @end smallexample
42830
42831 @end itemize
42832
42833 @subsection Registers
42834 @cindex <reg>
42835
42836 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42837
42838 @smallexample
42839 <reg name="@var{name}"
42840 bitsize="@var{size}"
42841 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42842 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42843 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42844 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42845 @end smallexample
42846
42847 @noindent
42848 The components are as follows:
42849
42850 @table @var
42851
42852 @item name
42853 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42854
42855 @item bitsize
42856 The register's size, in bits.
42857
42858 @item regnum
42859 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42860 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42861 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42862 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42863 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42864 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42865 in order of increasing register number.
42866
42867 @item save-restore
42868 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42869 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42870 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42871 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42872 ABI.
42873
42874 @item type
42875 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42876 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42877 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42878 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42879 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42880 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42881
42882 @item group
42883 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42884 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42885 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42886 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42887 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42888 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42889 @code{info registers}.
42890
42891 @end table
42892
42893 @node Predefined Target Types
42894 @section Predefined Target Types
42895 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42896
42897 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42898 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42899 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42900 types. The currently supported types are:
42901
42902 @table @code
42903
42904 @item bool
42905 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42906
42907 @item int8
42908 @itemx int16
42909 @itemx int24
42910 @itemx int32
42911 @itemx int64
42912 @itemx int128
42913 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42914
42915 @item uint8
42916 @itemx uint16
42917 @itemx uint24
42918 @itemx uint32
42919 @itemx uint64
42920 @itemx uint128
42921 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42922
42923 @item code_ptr
42924 @itemx data_ptr
42925 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42926 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42927 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42928 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42929 may be marked as data pointers.
42930
42931 @item ieee_single
42932 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42933
42934 @item ieee_double
42935 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42936
42937 @item arm_fpa_ext
42938 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42939
42940 @item i387_ext
42941 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42942
42943 @item i386_eflags
42944 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42945
42946 @item i386_mxcsr
42947 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42948
42949 @end table
42950
42951 @node Enum Target Types
42952 @section Enum Target Types
42953 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42954
42955 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42956 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42957
42958 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42959
42960 @smallexample
42961 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42962 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42963 @dots{}
42964 </enum>
42965 @end smallexample
42966
42967 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42968
42969 @smallexample
42970 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42971 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42972 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42973 </enum>
42974 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42975 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42976 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42977 </flags>
42978 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42979 @end smallexample
42980
42981 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42982 would be printed as:
42983
42984 @smallexample
42985 (gdb) info register flags
42986 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42987 @end smallexample
42988
42989 @node Standard Target Features
42990 @section Standard Target Features
42991 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42992
42993 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42994 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42995 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42996 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42997 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42998 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42999 can recognize them.
43000
43001 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
43002 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
43003 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
43004 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
43005 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
43006 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
43007 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
43008 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
43009
43010 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
43011 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
43012 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
43013
43014 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
43015 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
43016 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
43017 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
43018
43019 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
43020 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
43021 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
43022
43023 @menu
43024 * AArch64 Features::
43025 * ARC Features::
43026 * ARM Features::
43027 * i386 Features::
43028 * MicroBlaze Features::
43029 * MIPS Features::
43030 * M68K Features::
43031 * NDS32 Features::
43032 * Nios II Features::
43033 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
43034 * PowerPC Features::
43035 * RISC-V Features::
43036 * S/390 and System z Features::
43037 * Sparc Features::
43038 * TIC6x Features::
43039 @end menu
43040
43041
43042 @node AArch64 Features
43043 @subsection AArch64 Features
43044 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
43045
43046 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
43047 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
43048 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43049
43050 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43051 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
43052 and @samp{fpcr}.
43053
43054 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
43055 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
43056 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
43057
43058 @node ARC Features
43059 @subsection ARC Features
43060 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
43061
43062 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
43063 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
43064 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
43065 that one of the core registers features is present.
43066 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
43067
43068 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
43069 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43070 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43071 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
43072 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43073 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
43074 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
43075
43076 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
43077 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
43078 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
43079 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
43080 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
43081 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43082
43083 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
43084 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43085 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43086 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
43087 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
43088 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
43089 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
43090 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
43091 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
43092 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
43093
43094 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
43095 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
43096
43097 @node ARM Features
43098 @subsection ARM Features
43099 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
43100
43101 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
43102 ARM targets.
43103 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
43104 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43105
43106 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
43107 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
43108 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
43109 and @samp{xpsr}.
43110
43111 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
43112 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
43113
43114 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
43115 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
43116 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
43117 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
43118
43119 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
43120 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
43121 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
43122 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
43123 halves of the double-precision registers.
43124
43125 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
43126 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
43127 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
43128 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
43129 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
43130 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
43131
43132 @node i386 Features
43133 @subsection i386 Features
43134 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
43135
43136 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
43137 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43138
43139 @itemize @minus
43140 @item
43141 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
43142 @item
43143 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
43144 @item
43145 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
43146 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
43147 @item
43148 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
43149 @item
43150 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
43151 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
43152 @end itemize
43153
43154 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
43155
43156 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
43157 describe registers:
43158
43159 @itemize @minus
43160 @item
43161 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
43162 @item
43163 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
43164 @item
43165 @samp{mxcsr}
43166 @end itemize
43167
43168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43169 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43170 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43171
43172 @itemize @minus
43173 @item
43174 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43175 @item
43176 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43177 @end itemize
43178
43179 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
43180 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43181
43182 @itemize @minus
43183 @item
43184 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43185 @item
43186 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43187 @end itemize
43188
43189 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43190 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43191
43192 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
43193 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
43194
43195 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
43196 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
43197 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
43198
43199 @itemize @minus
43200 @item
43201 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43202 @end itemize
43203
43204 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
43205
43206 @itemize @minus
43207 @item
43208 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43209 @end itemize
43210
43211 It should
43212 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43213
43214 @itemize @minus
43215 @item
43216 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43217 @item
43218 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43219 @end itemize
43220
43221 It should
43222 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43223
43224 @itemize @minus
43225 @item
43226 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43227 @end itemize
43228
43229 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43230 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43231 valid for i386 and amd64.
43232
43233 @node MicroBlaze Features
43234 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43235 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43236
43237 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43238 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43239 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43240 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43241 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43242
43243 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43244 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43245
43246 @node MIPS Features
43247 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43248 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43249
43250 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43251 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43252 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43253 on the target.
43254
43255 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43256 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43257 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43258
43259 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43260 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43261 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43262 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43263
43264 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43265 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43266 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43267 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43268
43269 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43270 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43271 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43272
43273 @node M68K Features
43274 @subsection M68K Features
43275 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43276
43277 @table @code
43278 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43279 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43280 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43281 One of those features must be always present.
43282 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43283 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43284 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43285 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43286
43287 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43288 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43289 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43290 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43291 @end table
43292
43293 @node NDS32 Features
43294 @subsection NDS32 Features
43295 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43296
43297 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43298 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43299 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43300 and @samp{pc}.
43301
43302 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43303 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43304 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43305 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43306
43307 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43308 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43309 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43310 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43311 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43312 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43313 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43314
43315 @node Nios II Features
43316 @subsection Nios II Features
43317 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43318
43319 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43320 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43321 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43322 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43323 @samp{mpuacc}).
43324
43325 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43326 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43327 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43328
43329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43330 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43331 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43332
43333 @node PowerPC Features
43334 @subsection PowerPC Features
43335 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43336
43337 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43338 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43339 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43340 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43341
43342 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43343 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43344
43345 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43346 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
43347 and @samp{vrsave}.
43348
43349 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43350 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
43351 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
43352 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
43353 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
43354 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
43355 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
43356 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
43357
43358 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43359 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43360 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43361 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43362 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43363 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43364 user.
43365
43366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43367 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
43368
43369 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43370 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
43371
43372 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
43373 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
43374
43375 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
43376 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
43377 64-bit wide.
43378
43379 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
43380 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
43381 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
43382 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
43383
43384 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
43385 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
43386 64-bit wide.
43387
43388 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
43389 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
43390 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
43391 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
43392 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
43393 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
43394 wide.
43395
43396 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43397 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
43398 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
43399 @samp{cfpscr}.
43400
43401 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
43402 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
43403 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
43404 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
43405 wide.
43406
43407 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43408 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43409 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
43410 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
43411 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
43412 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
43413 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
43414 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
43415 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
43416
43417 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43418 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
43419
43420 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43421 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
43422
43423 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
43424 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
43425
43426
43427 @node RISC-V Features
43428 @subsection RISC-V Features
43429 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
43430
43431 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
43432 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
43433 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
43434 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
43435 etc).
43436
43437 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
43438 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
43439 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
43440 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
43441
43442 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
43443 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
43444 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
43445 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
43446 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
43447 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
43448 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
43449 least significant two bits.
43450
43451 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
43452 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
43453 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
43454 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
43455 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
43456 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
43457 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
43458 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
43459 other floating point hardware.
43460
43461 @node S/390 and System z Features
43462 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43463 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43464 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43465
43466 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43467 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43468 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43469 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43470 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43471 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43472 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43473 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43474 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43475
43476 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43477 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43478 @samp{fpc}.
43479
43480 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43481 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43482
43483 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43484 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43485 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43486 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43487 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43488 32-bit wide.
43489
43490 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43491 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43492 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43493
43494 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43495 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43496 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43497 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43498 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43499 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43500 @samp{v31}.
43501
43502 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43503 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43504 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43505
43506 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43507 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43508 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43509
43510 @node Sparc Features
43511 @subsection Sparc Features
43512 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43513 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43514 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43515 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43516
43517 @itemize @minus
43518 @item
43519 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43520 @item
43521 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43522 @item
43523 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43524 @item
43525 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43526 @end itemize
43527
43528 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43529
43530 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43531 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43532
43533 @itemize @minus
43534 @item
43535 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43536 @item
43537 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43538 @end itemize
43539
43540 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43541 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43542
43543 @itemize @minus
43544 @item
43545 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43546 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43547 @item
43548 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43549 for sparc64
43550 @end itemize
43551
43552 @node TIC6x Features
43553 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43554 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43555 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43556 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43557 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43558 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43559
43560 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43561 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43562 through @samp{B31}.
43563
43564 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43565 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43566
43567 @node Operating System Information
43568 @appendix Operating System Information
43569 @cindex operating system information
43570
43571 @menu
43572 * Process list::
43573 @end menu
43574
43575 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43576 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43577 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43578 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43579 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43580 on a different aspect of target.
43581
43582 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43583 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43584 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43585 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43586
43587 @node Process list
43588 @appendixsection Process list
43589 @cindex operating system information, process list
43590
43591 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43592 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43593 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43594 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43595
43596 An example document is:
43597
43598 @smallexample
43599 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43600 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43601 <osdata type="processes">
43602 <item>
43603 <column name="pid">1</column>
43604 <column name="user">root</column>
43605 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43606 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43607 </item>
43608 </osdata>
43609 @end smallexample
43610
43611 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43612 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43613 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43614 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43615 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43616 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43617 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43618
43619 @node Trace File Format
43620 @appendix Trace File Format
43621 @cindex trace file format
43622
43623 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43624 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43625
43626 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43627 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43628 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43629 in the future.
43630
43631 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43632 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43633 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43634 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43635 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43636 of this section.
43637
43638 @table @code
43639 @item R @var{size}
43640 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43641 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43642 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43643 a single trace file.
43644
43645 @item status @var{status}
43646 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43647 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43648 file.
43649
43650 @item tp @var{payload}
43651 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43652 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43653 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43654 reply packets.
43655
43656 @item tsv @var{payload}
43657 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43658 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43659 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43660 reply packets.
43661
43662 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43663 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43664 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43665 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43666 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43667 file. Includes are not allowed.
43668
43669 @end table
43670
43671 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43672 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43673 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43674 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43675 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43676 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43677 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43678 endianness.
43679
43680 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43681
43682 @table @code
43683 @item R @var{bytes}
43684 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43685 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43686 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43687
43688 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43689 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43690 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43691 @var{length} bytes.
43692
43693 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43694 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43695 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43696
43697 @end table
43698
43699 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43700 of blocks.
43701
43702 @node Index Section Format
43703 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43704 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43705 @cindex index section format
43706
43707 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43708 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43709 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43710 description.
43711
43712 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43713 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43714 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43715 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43716 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43717 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43718
43719 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43720
43721 @enumerate
43722 @item
43723 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43724 unless otherwise noted:
43725
43726 @enumerate
43727 @item
43728 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43729 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43730 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43731 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43732 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43733 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43734 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43735
43736 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43737 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43738 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43739 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43740
43741 @item
43742 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43743
43744 @item
43745 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43746 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43747 to the next offset.
43748
43749 @item
43750 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43751
43752 @item
43753 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43754
43755 @item
43756 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43757 @end enumerate
43758
43759 @item
43760 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43761 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43762 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43763 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43764 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43765 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43766 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43767 CU indices.
43768
43769 @item
43770 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43771 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43772 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43773 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43774
43775 @item
43776 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43777 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43778
43779 @enumerate
43780 @item
43781 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43782
43783 @item
43784 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43785 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43786
43787 @item
43788 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43789 @end enumerate
43790
43791 @item
43792 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43793 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43794
43795 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43796 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43797 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43798 constant pool.
43799
43800 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43801 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43802 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43803
43804 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43805 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43806 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43807 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43808 index version:
43809
43810 @table @asis
43811 @item Version 4
43812 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43813
43814 @item Versions 5 to 7
43815 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43816 @end table
43817
43818 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43819
43820 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43821 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43822 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43823 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43824 collision.
43825
43826 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43827 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43828 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43829 the code.
43830
43831 @item
43832 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43833 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43834 strings.
43835
43836 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43837 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43838 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43839 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43840 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43841 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43842
43843 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43844 @end enumerate
43845
43846 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43847 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43848 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43849
43850 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43851 (bit 0 = LSB):
43852
43853 @table @asis
43854
43855 @item Bits 0-23
43856 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43857 @item Bits 24-27
43858 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43859 @item Bits 28-30
43860 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43861
43862 @table @asis
43863 @item 0
43864 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43865 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43866 with previous versions of the index.
43867 @item 1
43868 The symbol is a type.
43869 @item 2
43870 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43871 @item 3
43872 The symbol is a function.
43873 @item 4
43874 Any other kind of symbol.
43875 @item 5,6,7
43876 These values are reserved.
43877 @end table
43878
43879 @item Bit 31
43880 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43881
43882 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43883 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43884 @value{GDBN} sources.
43885
43886 @end table
43887
43888 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43889 global/static attributes in the index.
43890
43891 @smallexample
43892 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43893 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43894 switch (die->tag)
43895 @{
43896 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43897 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43898 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43899 kind = TYPE;
43900 is_static = 1;
43901 break;
43902 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43903 kind = VARIABLE;
43904 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43905 break;
43906 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43907 kind = FUNCTION;
43908 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43909 break;
43910 case DW_TAG_constant:
43911 kind = VARIABLE;
43912 is_static = ! is_external;
43913 break;
43914 case DW_TAG_variable:
43915 kind = VARIABLE;
43916 is_static = ! is_external;
43917 break;
43918 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43919 kind = TYPE;
43920 is_static = 0;
43921 break;
43922 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43923 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43924 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43925 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43926 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43927 kind = TYPE;
43928 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43929 break;
43930 default:
43931 assert (0);
43932 @}
43933 @end smallexample
43934
43935 @node Man Pages
43936 @appendix Manual pages
43937 @cindex Man pages
43938
43939 @menu
43940 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43941 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43942 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43943 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43944 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43945 @end menu
43946
43947 @node gdb man
43948 @heading gdb man
43949
43950 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43951
43952 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43953 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43954 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43955 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43956 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43957 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43958 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43959 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43960 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43961 @c man end
43962
43963 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43964 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43965 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43966 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43967
43968 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43969 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43970
43971 @itemize @bullet
43972 @item
43973 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43974
43975 @item
43976 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43977
43978 @item
43979 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43980
43981 @item
43982 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43983 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43984 @end itemize
43985
43986 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43987 Modula-2.
43988
43989 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43990 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43991 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43992 by using the command @code{help}.
43993
43994 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43995 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43996 executable program as the argument:
43997
43998 @smallexample
43999 gdb program
44000 @end smallexample
44001
44002 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
44003
44004 @smallexample
44005 gdb program core
44006 @end smallexample
44007
44008 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
44009 to debug a running process:
44010
44011 @smallexample
44012 gdb program 1234
44013 gdb -p 1234
44014 @end smallexample
44015
44016 @noindent
44017 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
44018 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
44019 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
44020
44021 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
44022
44023 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
44024 @table @env
44025 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44026 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
44027
44028 @item run [@var{arglist}]
44029 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
44030
44031 @item bt
44032 Backtrace: display the program stack.
44033
44034 @item print @var{expr}
44035 Display the value of an expression.
44036
44037 @item c
44038 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
44039
44040 @item next
44041 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
44042 function calls in the line.
44043
44044 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44045 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
44046
44047 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44048 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
44049
44050 @item step
44051 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
44052 function calls in the line.
44053
44054 @item help [@var{name}]
44055 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
44056 about using @value{GDBN}.
44057
44058 @item quit
44059 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
44060 @end table
44061
44062 @ifset man
44063 For full details on @value{GDBN},
44064 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44065 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
44066 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
44067 @end ifset
44068 @c man end
44069
44070 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
44071 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
44072 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
44073 encountered with no
44074 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
44075 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
44076 Many options have
44077 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
44078 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
44079 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
44080 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
44081 more usual convention.)
44082
44083 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
44084 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
44085 option is used.
44086
44087 @table @env
44088 @item -help
44089 @itemx -h
44090 List all options, with brief explanations.
44091
44092 @item -symbols=@var{file}
44093 @itemx -s @var{file}
44094 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
44095
44096 @item -write
44097 Enable writing into executable and core files.
44098
44099 @item -exec=@var{file}
44100 @itemx -e @var{file}
44101 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
44102 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
44103 dump.
44104
44105 @item -se=@var{file}
44106 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
44107 file.
44108
44109 @item -core=@var{file}
44110 @itemx -c @var{file}
44111 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
44112
44113 @item -command=@var{file}
44114 @itemx -x @var{file}
44115 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
44116
44117 @item -ex @var{command}
44118 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
44119
44120 @item -directory=@var{directory}
44121 @itemx -d @var{directory}
44122 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
44123
44124 @item -nh
44125 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
44126
44127 @item -nx
44128 @itemx -n
44129 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
44130
44131 @item -quiet
44132 @itemx -q
44133 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
44134 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
44135
44136 @item -batch
44137 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
44138 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
44139 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
44140 commands in the command files.
44141
44142 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
44143 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
44144 more useful, the message
44145
44146 @smallexample
44147 Program exited normally.
44148 @end smallexample
44149
44150 @noindent
44151 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
44152 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
44153
44154 @item -cd=@var{directory}
44155 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
44156 instead of the current directory.
44157
44158 @item -fullname
44159 @itemx -f
44160 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
44161 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
44162 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
44163 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
44164 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
44165 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
44166 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
44167 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
44168
44169 @item -b @var{bps}
44170 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
44171 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
44172
44173 @item -tty=@var{device}
44174 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
44175 @end table
44176 @c man end
44177
44178 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
44179 @ifset man
44180 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44181 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44182 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44183
44184 @smallexample
44185 info gdb
44186 @end smallexample
44187
44188 @noindent
44189 should give you access to the complete manual.
44190
44191 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44192 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44193 @end ifset
44194 @c man end
44195
44196 @node gdbserver man
44197 @heading gdbserver man
44198
44199 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
44200 @format
44201 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
44202 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44203
44204 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44205
44206 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44207 @c man end
44208 @end format
44209
44210 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44211 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44212 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44213
44214 @ifclear man
44215 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44216 @end ifclear
44217 @ifset man
44218 Usage (server (target) side):
44219 @end ifset
44220
44221 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44222 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44223 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44224 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44225
44226 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44227 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44228 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44229
44230 @smallexample
44231 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44232 @end smallexample
44233
44234 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44235
44236 @smallexample
44237 @ifset man
44238 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44239 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44240 @end ifset
44241 @ifclear man
44242 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44243 @end ifclear
44244 @end smallexample
44245
44246 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44247 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44248 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44249
44250 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44251
44252 @smallexample
44253 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44254 @end smallexample
44255
44256 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44257 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44258 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44259 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44260 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44261 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44262 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44263 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44264 print an error message and exit.
44265
44266 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44267 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44268
44269 @smallexample
44270 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44271 @end smallexample
44272
44273 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44274 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44275
44276 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44277 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44278 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44279 the program you want to debug.
44280
44281 @smallexample
44282 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44283 @end smallexample
44284
44285 @ifclear man
44286 @subheading Usage (host side)
44287 @end ifclear
44288 @ifset man
44289 Usage (host side):
44290 @end ifset
44291
44292 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44293 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44294 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44295 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44296 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44297 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44298 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44299 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44300 descriptor. For example:
44301
44302 @smallexample
44303 @ifset man
44304 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44305 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44306 @end ifset
44307 @ifclear man
44308 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44309 @end ifclear
44310 @end smallexample
44311
44312 @noindent
44313 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44314
44315 @smallexample
44316 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44317 @end smallexample
44318
44319 @noindent
44320 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44321 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44322 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44323 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44324 `Connection refused'.
44325
44326 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44327 described in
44328 @ifset man
44329 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44330 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44331 @end ifset
44332 @ifclear man
44333 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44334 @end ifclear
44335 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44336
44337 @smallexample
44338 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44339 @end smallexample
44340
44341 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44342 case.
44343 @c man end
44344
44345 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44346 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44347
44348 @itemize @bullet
44349
44350 @item
44351 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44352
44353 @smallexample
44354 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44355 @end smallexample
44356
44357 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44358 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44359 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44360 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44361 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44362 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44363 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44364
44365 @item
44366 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44367 program:
44368
44369 @smallexample
44370 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44371 @end smallexample
44372
44373 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44374 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44375 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44376 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44377
44378 @item
44379 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44380
44381 @smallexample
44382 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44383 @end smallexample
44384
44385 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44386 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44387 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44388 debug several processes in the same session.
44389 @end itemize
44390
44391 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44392
44393 @table @env
44394
44395 @item --help
44396 List all options, with brief explanations.
44397
44398 @item --version
44399 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44400
44401 @item --attach
44402 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44403
44404 @smallexample
44405 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44406 @end smallexample
44407
44408 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44409 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44410
44411 @item --multi
44412 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44413 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44414 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44415 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44416
44417 @smallexample
44418 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44419 @end smallexample
44420
44421 @item --debug
44422 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44423 process.
44424 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44425 the developers.
44426
44427 @item --remote-debug
44428 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44429 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44430 the developers.
44431
44432 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44433 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44434 of debugging output.
44435 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44436
44437 @item --wrapper
44438 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44439 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44440 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44441 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44442
44443 @item --once
44444 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44445 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44446 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44447 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44448
44449 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44450
44451 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44452 @c QDisableRandomization.
44453
44454 @end table
44455 @c man end
44456
44457 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44458 @ifset man
44459 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44460 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44461 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44462
44463 @smallexample
44464 info gdb
44465 @end smallexample
44466
44467 should give you access to the complete manual.
44468
44469 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44470 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44471 @end ifset
44472 @c man end
44473
44474 @node gcore man
44475 @heading gcore
44476
44477 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44478
44479 @format
44480 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44481 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44482 @c man end
44483 @end format
44484
44485 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44486 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44487 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44488 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44489 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44490 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44491 its job the program remains running without any change.
44492 @c man end
44493
44494 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44495 @table @env
44496 @item -a
44497 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44498 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44499 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44500 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44501 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44502
44503 @item -o @var{prefix}
44504 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44505 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44506 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44507 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44508 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44509 @end table
44510 @c man end
44511
44512 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44513 @ifset man
44514 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44515 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44516 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44517
44518 @smallexample
44519 info gdb
44520 @end smallexample
44521
44522 @noindent
44523 should give you access to the complete manual.
44524
44525 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44526 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44527 @end ifset
44528 @c man end
44529
44530 @node gdbinit man
44531 @heading gdbinit
44532
44533 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44534
44535 @format
44536 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44537 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44538 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44539 @end ifset
44540
44541 ~/.gdbinit
44542
44543 ./.gdbinit
44544 @c man end
44545 @end format
44546
44547 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44548 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44549 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44550 described in
44551 @ifset man
44552 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44553 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44554 @end ifset
44555 @ifclear man
44556 @ref{Sequences}.
44557 @end ifclear
44558
44559 Please read more in
44560 @ifset man
44561 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44562 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44563 @end ifset
44564 @ifclear man
44565 @ref{Startup}.
44566 @end ifclear
44567
44568 @table @env
44569 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44570 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44571 @end ifset
44572 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44573 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44574 @end ifclear
44575 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44576 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44577 See more in
44578 @ifset man
44579 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44580 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44581 @end ifset
44582 @ifclear man
44583 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44584 @end ifclear
44585
44586 @item ~/.gdbinit
44587 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44588 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44589
44590 @item ./.gdbinit
44591 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44592 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44593 See more in
44594 @ifset man
44595 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44596 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44597 @end ifset
44598 @ifclear man
44599 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44600 @end ifclear
44601 @end table
44602 @c man end
44603
44604 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44605 @ifset man
44606 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44607
44608 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44609 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44610 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44611
44612 @smallexample
44613 info gdb
44614 @end smallexample
44615
44616 should give you access to the complete manual.
44617
44618 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44619 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44620 @end ifset
44621 @c man end
44622
44623 @node gdb-add-index man
44624 @heading gdb-add-index
44625 @pindex gdb-add-index
44626 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44627
44628 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44629
44630 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44631 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44632 @c man end
44633
44634 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44635 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44636 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44637 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44638 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44639 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44640
44641 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44642 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44643 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44644 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44645 named @code{.debug_*}).
44646
44647 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44648 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44649 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44650 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44651
44652 See more in
44653 @ifset man
44654 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44655 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44656 @end ifset
44657 @ifclear man
44658 @ref{Index Files}.
44659 @end ifclear
44660 @c man end
44661
44662 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44663 @ifset man
44664 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44665 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44666 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44667
44668 @smallexample
44669 info gdb
44670 @end smallexample
44671
44672 should give you access to the complete manual.
44673
44674 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44675 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44676 @end ifset
44677 @c man end
44678
44679 @include gpl.texi
44680
44681 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44682 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44683 @include fdl.texi
44684
44685 @node Concept Index
44686 @unnumbered Concept Index
44687
44688 @printindex cp
44689
44690 @node Command and Variable Index
44691 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44692
44693 @printindex fn
44694
44695 @tex
44696 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44697 % meantime:
44698 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44699 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44700 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44701 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44702 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44703 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44704 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44705 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44706 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44707 \page\colophon
44708 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44709 @end tex
44710
44711 @bye
This page took 0.971214 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.